Docs: add explicit warnings for some variables likely tainted
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
... / ...
CommitLineData
1. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2. This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3. converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printable and online
4. formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5. The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6.
7. WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8. adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9. unwanted vertical space.
10. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12.include stdflags
13.include stdmacs
14
15. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16. This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19.docbook
20
21. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22. These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23. Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24. PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25. processors.
26. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28.literal xml
29<?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34?>
35.literal off
36
37. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38. This generates the outermost <book> element that wraps the entire document.
39. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41.book
42
43. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44. These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45. Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48.set previousversion "4.93"
49.include ./local_params
50
51.set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52.set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54.macro copyyear
552019
56.endmacro
57
58. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59. Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60. provided in the xfpt library.
61. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63. --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name.
64
65.flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67. --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68. --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be in Roman.
69
70.flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71.flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73. --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74. --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75. --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76. --- index entry.
77
78.macro option
79.arg 5
80.oindex "&%$5%&"
81.endarg
82.arg -5
83.oindex "&%$1%&"
84.endarg
85.itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86.row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87.endtable
88.endmacro
89
90. --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91. --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92. --- a small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94.macro table2 196pt 254pt
95.itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96.endmacro
97
98. --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99. --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100. --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102.macro irow
103.arg 4
104.row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105.endarg
106.arg -4
107.arg 3
108.row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109.endarg
110.arg -3
111.row "&I;$1" "$2"
112.endarg
113.endarg
114.endmacro
115
116. --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117. --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118. --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119. --- ID that ties them together.
120
121.macro cindex
122&<indexterm role="concept">&
123&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124.arg 2
125&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126.endarg
127&</indexterm>&
128.endmacro
129
130.macro scindex
131&<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132&<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133.arg 3
134&<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135.endarg
136&</indexterm>&
137.endmacro
138
139.macro ecindex
140&<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141.endmacro
142
143.macro oindex
144&<indexterm role="option">&
145&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146.arg 2
147&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148.endarg
149&</indexterm>&
150.endmacro
151
152.macro vindex
153&<indexterm role="variable">&
154&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155.arg 2
156&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157.endarg
158&</indexterm>&
159.endmacro
160
161.macro index
162.echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163.endmacro
164. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168. The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for ASCII
169. output formats.
170. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172.literal xml
173<bookinfo>
174<title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175<titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176<date>
177.fulldate
178</date>
179<author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180<authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181<revhistory><revision>
182.versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184</revision></revhistory>
185<copyright><year>
186.copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188</bookinfo>
189.literal off
190
191
192. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193. This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194. "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195. at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198.chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199.literal xml
200
201<indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204</indexterm>
205<indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209</indexterm>
210<indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213</indexterm>
214<indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217</indexterm>
218<indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221</indexterm>
222<indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225</indexterm>
226<indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230</indexterm>
231<indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234</indexterm>
235<indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238</indexterm>
239<indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242</indexterm>
243<indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246</indexterm>
247<indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251</indexterm>
252<indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255</indexterm>
256<indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259</indexterm>
260<indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263</indexterm>
264<indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267</indexterm>
268<indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271</indexterm>
272<indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275</indexterm>
276<indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279</indexterm>
280<indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283</indexterm>
284<indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287</indexterm>
288<indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291</indexterm>
292<indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295</indexterm>
296<indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299</indexterm>
300<indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303</indexterm>
304<indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308</indexterm>
309<indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312</indexterm>
313<indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316</indexterm>
317<indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320</indexterm>
321
322.literal off
323
324
325. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326. This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327. we can't have the .chapter line here.
328. chapter "Introduction"
329. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and UnixWare.
341Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352The use, supply, or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of Exim,
354which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367&_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368contributors.
369
370
371.section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372. Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374.new
375.cindex "documentation"
376This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378renditions of this document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379capable of showing a change indicator.
380.wen
381
382This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387Furthermore, this manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389very wide interest.
390
391.cindex "books about Exim"
392An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395(&url(https://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
396
397The book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
401
402.cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404Debian-specific features in the file
405&_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407information.
408
409.cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410.cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
411.cindex "change log"
412As Exim develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416&_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
417
418Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
422
423All changes to Exim (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
425
426.cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
429directory are:
430
431.table2 100pt
432.row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433.row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434.row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435.row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436.row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437.row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438.row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439.row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
440.endtable
441
442The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
443available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
444&<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
445
446
447
448.section "FTP site and websites" "SECID2"
449.cindex "website"
450.cindex "FTP site"
451The primary site for Exim source distributions is the &%exim.org%& FTP site,
452available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP. These services, and the &%exim.org%&
453website, are hosted at the University of Cambridge.
454
455.cindex "wiki"
456.cindex "FAQ"
457As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim website contains a number of
458differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
459online information is the Exim wiki (&url(https://wiki.exim.org)),
460which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
461examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
462The wiki site should always redirect to the correct place, which is currently
463provided by GitHub, and is open to editing by anyone with a GitHub account.
464
465.cindex Bugzilla
466An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
467this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
468first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
469Please do not ask for configuration help in the bug-tracker.
470
471
472.section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
473.cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
474The following Exim mailing lists exist:
475
476.table2 140pt
477.row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478.row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
479.row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
480.row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
481.endtable
482
483You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
484or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
485.cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
486If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
487the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
488via this web page:
489.display
490&url(https://alioth-lists.debian.net/cgi-bin/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
491.endd
492Please ask Debian-specific questions on that list and not on the general Exim
493lists.
494
495.section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
496.cindex "bug reports"
497.cindex "reporting bugs"
498Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
499via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
500whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
501message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
502
503
504
505.section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
506.cindex "FTP site"
507.cindex "HTTPS download site"
508.cindex "distribution" "FTP site"
509.cindex "distribution" "https site"
510The master distribution site for the Exim distribution is
511.display
512&url(https://downloads.exim.org/)
513.endd
514The service is available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP.
515We encourage people to migrate to HTTPS.
516
517The content served at &url(https://downloads.exim.org/) is identical to the
518content served at &url(https://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim) and
519&url(ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim).
520
521If accessing via a hostname containing &'ftp'&, then the file references that
522follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at these sites.
523If accessing via the hostname &'downloads'& then the subdirectories described
524here are top-level directories.
525
526There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
527the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
528
529Within the top exim directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
530previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
531distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
532subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
533.display
534&_exim-n.nn.tar.xz_&
535&_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
536&_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
537.endd
538where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The three
539files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
540The &_.xz_& file is usually the smallest, while the &_.gz_& file is the
541most portable to old systems.
542
543.cindex "distribution" "signing details"
544.cindex "distribution" "public key"
545.cindex "public key for signed distribution"
546The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
547Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
548&'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
549other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
550PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from the Exim Maintainer's
551PGP keys, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
552&_Exim-Maintainers-Keyring.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
553such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
554
555At the time of the last update, releases were being made by Jeremy Harris and signed
556with key &'0xBCE58C8CE41F32DF'&. Other recent keys used for signing are those
557of Heiko Schlittermann, &'0x26101B62F69376CE'&,
558and of Phil Pennock, &'0x4D1E900E14C1CC04'&.
559
560The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
561.display
562&_exim-n.nn.tar.xz.asc_&
563&_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
564&_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
565.endd
566For each released version, the log of changes is made available in a
567separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
568find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
569
570.cindex "documentation" "available formats"
571The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
572documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
573inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
574.display
575&_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576&_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577&_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578&_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
579.endd
580These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
581distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& and &_.xz_& forms.
582
583
584.section "Limitations" "SECID6"
585.ilist
586.cindex "limitations of Exim"
587.cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
588Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
589RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
590simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
591configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
592UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
593.next
594.cindex "domainless addresses"
595.cindex "address" "without domain"
596Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
597local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
598configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
599systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
600arrival.
601.next
602.cindex "transport" "external"
603.cindex "external transports"
604The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
605and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
606transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
607and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
608to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
609handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
610.next
611Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
612such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
613(that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
614other means.
615.next
616Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
617are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
618are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
619compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
620a number of common scanners are provided.
621.endlist
622
623
624.section "Runtime configuration" "SECID7"
625Exim's runtime configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
626into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
627values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
628file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
629distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
630
631
632.section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
633.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
634Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
635can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
636&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
637about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
638Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
639example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages in the queue) do so in Exim's own
640format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
6413, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
642documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
643made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
644
645Control of messages in the queue can be done via certain privileged command
646line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
647which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
648interface to Exim's command line administration options.
649
650
651
652.section "Terminology" "SECID9"
653.cindex "terminology definitions"
654.cindex "body of message" "definition of"
655The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
656It is the last part of a message and is separated from the &'header'& (see
657below) by a blank line.
658
659.cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
660When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
661delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
662&'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
663called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
664failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
665message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
666rise to further bounce messages.
667
668The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
669value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
670also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
671otherwise.
672
673The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
674destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
675down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
676until a later time.
677
678The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
679host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
680the part of an email address following the @ sign.
681
682.cindex "envelope, definition of"
683.cindex "sender" "definition of"
684A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
685body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
686be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
687sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
688envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
689messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
690
691.cindex "message" "header, definition of"
692.cindex "header section" "definition of"
693The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
694of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
695&'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
696indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
697line.
698
699.cindex "local part" "definition of"
700.cindex "domain" "definition of"
701The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to the
702part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
703@ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
704
705.cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
706.cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
707The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
708delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
709TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
710host it is running on are &'remote'&.
711
712.cindex "return path" "definition of"
713&'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
714message's envelope.
715
716.cindex "queue" "definition of"
717The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery
718because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
719Exim's case, the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
720normally no ordering of waiting messages.
721
722.cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
723The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
724and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
725is used by other MTAs and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
726the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
727
728.cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
729The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
730messages in its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
731delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
732mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
733the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
734
735
736
737
738
739
740. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
741. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
742
743.chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
744.cindex "incorporated code"
745.cindex "regular expressions" "library"
746.cindex "PCRE"
747.cindex "OpenDMARC"
748A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
749
750.ilist
751Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
752Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
753&copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
754Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
755or obtain and install the full version of the library from
756&url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
757.next
758.cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
759Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
760contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
761Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
762It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
763following statements:
764
765.blockquote
766Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
767
768This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
769the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
770Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
771version.
772This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
773the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
774&url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
775some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
776restrictions applied to it).
777.endblockquote
778.next
779.cindex "SPA authentication"
780.cindex "Samba project"
781.cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
782Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
783by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
784Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
785under the Gnu GPL.
786.next
787.cindex "Cyrus"
788.cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
789.cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
790Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
791by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
792Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
793conditions expressed therein.
794
795.blockquote
796Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
797
798Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
799modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
800are met:
801
802.olist
803Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
804notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
805.next
806Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
807notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
808the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
809distribution.
810.next
811The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
812endorse or promote products derived from this software without
813prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
814details, please contact
815.display
816 Office of Technology Transfer
817 Carnegie Mellon University
818 5000 Forbes Avenue
819 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
820 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
821 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
822.endd
823.next
824Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
825acknowledgment:
826
827&"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
828at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(https://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
829
830CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
831THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
832AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
833FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
834WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
835AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
836OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
837.endlist
838.endblockquote
839
840.next
841.cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
842.cindex "X-windows"
843.cindex "Athena"
844The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
845modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
846This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
847below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
848
849.blockquote
850Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
851and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
852
853All Rights Reserved
854
855Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
856documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
857provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
858both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
859supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
860used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
861software without specific, written prior permission.
862
863DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
864ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
865DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
866ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
867WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
868ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
869SOFTWARE.
870.endblockquote
871
872.next
873.cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
874The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
875The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
876derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
877license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
878source code.
879
880.next
881Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
882not covered by any specific license requirements. It is assumed that the
883contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
884.endlist
885
886
887
888
889
890. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
891. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
892
893.chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
894 "Receiving and delivering mail"
895
896
897.section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
898.cindex "design philosophy"
899Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
900to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
901most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
902maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
903it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
904has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
905
906
907.section "Policy control" "SECID11"
908.cindex "policy control" "overview"
909Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
910Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs from being abused as
911&"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
912unsolicited junk and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
913facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
914
915.ilist
916.cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
917Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
918incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
919series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
920several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
921host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
922very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
923rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
924two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
925error code.
926.next
927An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
928case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
929.next
930When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
931provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
932spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
933which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
934.next
935When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
936host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
937function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
938whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
939is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
940.next
941Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
942software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
943Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
944.next
945After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
946the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
947runs at the start of every delivery process.
948.endlist
949
950
951
952.section "User filters" "SECID12"
953.cindex "filter" "introduction"
954.cindex "Sieve filter"
955In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
956setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
957chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
958configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
959&'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
960of filtering are available:
961
962.ilist
963Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
964by RFC 3028.
965.next
966Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
967powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
968.endlist
969
970User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
971
972
973
974.section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
975.cindex "message ids" "details of format"
976.cindex "format" "of message id"
977.cindex "id of message"
978.cindex "base62"
979.cindex "base36"
980.cindex "Darwin"
981.cindex "Cygwin"
982Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
983characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
984example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
985normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
986system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
987(avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
988id is used to construct filenames, and the names of files in those systems are
989not always case-sensitive.
990
991.cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
992The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
993Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
994within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
995be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
996the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
997somewhat eccentric:
998
999.ilist
1000The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1001started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1002contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1003way of representing the date and time of day).
1004.next
1005After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1006received the message.
1007.next
1008There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1009.olist
1010.oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1011If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1012time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1013that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1014systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1015.next
1016If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1017the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1018(1/100) of a second.
1019.endlist
1020.endlist
1021
1022After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1023appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1024received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1025pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1026will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1027
1028
1029.section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1030.cindex "receiving mail"
1031.cindex "message" "reception"
1032The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1033TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1034SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1035there are several possibilities:
1036
1037.ilist
1038If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1039non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1040command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1041.next
1042If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1043non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1044the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1045command. This is called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1046but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1047envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1048.next
1049If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1050interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1051passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1052This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1053example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1054.next
1055A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1056(127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1057does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1058in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1059.endlist
1060
1061
1062.cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1063.cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1064In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1065constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1066qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1067option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1068SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1069certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender addresses
1070unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1071address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1072different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1073users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1074users to change sender addresses.
1075
1076Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1077checking by the non-SMTP ACL if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1078(either over TCP/IP or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1079number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1080individual recipients or the entire message can be rejected if local policy
1081requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1082&<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1083
1084Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1085received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1086connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1087queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1088configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1089message is received.
1090
1091
1092
1093
1094
1095.section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1096.cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1097.cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1098When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1099first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1100the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1101the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1102file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1103
1104.cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1105By default, all these message files are held in a single directory called
1106&_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1107not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1108improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1109used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1110whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1111processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1112overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1113affect file system performance.
1114
1115The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1116the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1117any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1118a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1119first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1120
1121.cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1122Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1123(see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1124both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1125If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1126example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1127generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1128rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1129different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1130addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1131delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1132&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1133
1134
1135
1136.section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1137.cindex "message" "life of"
1138.cindex "message" "frozen"
1139A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1140its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1141administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1142cannot proceed &-- for example when a message can neither be delivered to its
1143recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1144spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1145
1146.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1147.cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1148An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1149corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1150addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1151to be sent.
1152
1153.oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1154.oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1155There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1156&%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1157The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to all frozen messages.
1158
1159.cindex "message" "log file for"
1160.cindex "log" "file for each message"
1161While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1162attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1163delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1164lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1165These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator and are normally
1166deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1167The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1168&%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1169systems.
1170
1171.cindex "journal file"
1172.cindex "file" "journal"
1173All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1174spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1175address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1176message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1177addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1178is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1179Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1180minimize the possibility of data loss.
1181
1182Should the system or Exim crash after a successful delivery but before
1183the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1184time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1185updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1186deliveries caused by crashes.
1187
1188
1189
1190.section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1191.cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1192.cindex "router" "definition of"
1193.cindex "transport" "definition of"
1194The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1195&'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1196number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1197specify which ones are included in the binary. Runtime options specify which
1198ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1199
1200.cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1201Each driver that is specified in the runtime configuration is an &'instance'&
1202of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1203you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1204option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1205instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1206instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1207configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1208the driver's features in general.
1209
1210A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1211its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1212converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1213alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1214to be bounced.
1215
1216A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1217spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1218transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1219&'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1220to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1221several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1222
1223.cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1224An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1225turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1226specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1227detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1228address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1229
1230To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1231routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1232routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1233configuration.
1234
1235The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1236addresses in domains that are not recognized specifically by the local host.
1237Typically these are addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1238is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1239its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1240match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1241find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1242assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1243configured to fail the address.
1244
1245The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1246&"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1247aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1248original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1249router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1250address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1251
1252The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1253address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1254see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1255local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1256the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1257the address is bounced.
1258
1259
1260
1261.section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1262.cindex "router" "for verification"
1263.cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1264As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1265are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1266one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1267sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1268&%-bvs%& command line options.
1269
1270When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1271does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1272detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1273when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1274sends all messages to a message-scanning program unless they have been
1275previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1276checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1277would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1278
1279
1280
1281
1282.section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1283.cindex "router" "running details"
1284.cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1285.cindex "router" "result of running"
1286As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1287running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1288passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1289the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1290the following:
1291
1292.ilist
1293&'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1294transport or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1295original address ceases
1296.oindex "&%unseen%&"
1297unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1298can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1299for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1300passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1301end of routing.
1302
1303Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1304starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1305setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1306child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1307&%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1308.next
1309&'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1310requests that the address be passed to another router. By default, the address
1311is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1312&%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1313must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1314.next
1315&'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1316recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1317this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1318set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1319&'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1320.next
1321&'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1322the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1323original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1324.next
1325&'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1326database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1327processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1328next time the message is considered for delivery.
1329.next
1330&'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1331its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1332.endlist
1333
1334If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1335any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1336situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1337making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1338router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1339
1340Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1341met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1342You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1343when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1344facility for this purpose.
1345
1346
1347.section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1348.cindex "case of local parts"
1349.cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1350.cindex "duplicate addresses"
1351Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1352and remote transports and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1353check, local parts are treated case-sensitively. This happens only when
1354actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1355routed addresses are shown.
1356
1357
1358
1359.section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1360.cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1361.cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1362The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1363order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1364described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1365
1366.ilist
1367.cindex affix "router precondition"
1368The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1369the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1370suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1371skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1372removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1373of any other conditions.
1374.next
1375Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1376only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1377&%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1378address.
1379Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1380&%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1381sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1382you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1383Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1384.next
1385If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1386run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1387when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1388makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1389having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1390.next
1391Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1392opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1393Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1394.next
1395Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1396check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1397.next
1398If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1399of domains that it defines.
1400.next
1401.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1402.vindex "&$local_part$&"
1403.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1404.cindex affix "router precondition"
1405If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1406the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1407&%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1408part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1409that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1410that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1411&$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1412.next
1413.vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1414.vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1415.vindex "&$home$&"
1416If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1417an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1418local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1419user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1420remaining preconditions.
1421.next
1422If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1423because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1424later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1425subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1426could lead to confusion.
1427.next
1428If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1429set of addresses that it defines.
1430.next
1431If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1432specified files is tested.
1433.next
1434.cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1435If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1436uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1437Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1438.endlist
1439
1440
1441Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1442it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1443part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1444&%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1445&%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1446going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1447example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1448
1449
1450
1451.section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1452.cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1453When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1454
1455.ilist
1456If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1457filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1458message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1459fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1460files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1461filtering'&.
1462.cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1463(&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1464
1465Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1466&<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1467filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1468if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1469be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1470condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1471filter.
1472.next
1473Each recipient address is offered to each configured router, in turn, subject to
1474its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1475address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1476can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1477processed entirely independently of each other.
1478.next
1479.cindex "routing" "loops in"
1480.cindex "loop" "while routing"
1481A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1482transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1483is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1484Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1485from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1486process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1487which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1488.next
1489When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1490handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1491doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1492local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1493collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1494addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1495address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1496addresses to the same domain.
1497.next
1498Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1499non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1500deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1501to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1502run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1503one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1504The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1505deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1506.next
1507.cindex "queue runner"
1508When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1509database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1510address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1511Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1512reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1513queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1514follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1515better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1516causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1517.next
1518.cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1519Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1520deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1521retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1522reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1523not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1524.next
1525If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1526appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1527for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1528messages to other addresses.
1529.next
1530.cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1531If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1532the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1533&'deferred'&.
1534.next
1535When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1536handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1537deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1538.endlist
1539
1540
1541
1542
1543.section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1544.cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1545.cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1546.cindex "queue runner"
1547Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1548attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1549uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1550intervals or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1551not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1552first attempt will remain in your queue forever. A queue runner process works
1553its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1554passed its retry time.
1555You can run several queue runners at once.
1556
1557Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1558address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1559should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1560bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1561error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1562as permanent.
1563
1564
1565
1566.section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1567.cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1568There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1569particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1570connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1571detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1572Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1573is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1574impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1575also apply.
1576
1577If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1578waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1579connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1580deferred,
1581.cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1582Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1583SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1584for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1585connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1586one connection.
1587
1588
1589
1590.section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1591.cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1592.cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1593When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1594bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1595errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1596delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1597many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1598attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1599message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1600See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1601
1602.cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1603Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1604failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1605automatically.
1606
1607.cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1608A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1609obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1610address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1611forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1612failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1613&<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1614of the list.
1615
1616
1617
1618.section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1619.cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1620If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1621itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left in the queue,
1622but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1623that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1624for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1625&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1626
1627
1628
1629
1630
1631. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1632. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1633
1634.chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1635.scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1636
1637.section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1638Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1639creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1640&_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1641
1642.table2 140pt
1643.irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1644.irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1645 documented"
1646.irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1647.irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1648.irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1649.irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1650 instructions"
1651.endtable
1652
1653Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1654following subdirectories are created:
1655
1656.table2 140pt
1657.irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1658.irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1659.irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1660.irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1661.irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1662.irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1663.irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1664.endtable
1665
1666The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory and are built
1667with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1668that may be useful to some sites.
1669
1670
1671.section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1672.cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1673The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1674a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1675source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1676Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1677system.
1678.cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1679Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1680the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1681architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1682overridden if necessary.
1683.cindex compiler requirements
1684.cindex compiler version
1685A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1686
1687
1688.section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1689.cindex "PCRE library"
1690Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1691modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need to
1692install the PCRE package or the PCRE development package for your operating
1693system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1694process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1695headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1696and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1697or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1698If your operating system has no
1699PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1700from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1701More information on PCRE is available at &url(https://www.pcre.org/).
1702
1703.section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1704.cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1705.cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1706Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1707DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1708databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1709different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1710
1711.cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1712.cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1713.cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1714.cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1715If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1716Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1717may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1718you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1719
1720.cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1721Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1722via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1723versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1724some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1725distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1726versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1727Berkeley DB library.
1728
1729Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1730use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1731possibilities:
1732
1733.olist
1734A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1735Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1736.next
1737.cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1738The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1739compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1740&_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1741filename is used unmodified.
1742.next
1743.cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1744The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1745operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1746programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1747.next
1748If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1749file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1750the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1751.next
1752To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1753Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
17542.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions when Exim last revamped support were numbered 4.&'x'&.
1755Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All versions of
1756Berkeley DB could be obtained from
1757&url(http://www.sleepycat.com/), which is now a redirect to their new owner's
1758page with far newer versions listed.
1759It is probably wise to plan to move your storage configurations away from
1760Berkeley DB format, as today there are smaller and simpler alternatives more
1761suited to Exim's usage model.
1762.next
1763.cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1764Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1765&url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/tdb/files/). It has its own interface, and also
1766operates on a single file.
1767.endlist
1768
1769.cindex "USE_DB"
1770.cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1771Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1772to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1773USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1774&_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1775.code
1776USE_DB=yes
1777.endd
1778Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1779error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1780
1781At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1782thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1783configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1784Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1785configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1786&_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1787
1788As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1789necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1790in one of these lines:
1791.code
1792DBMLIB = -ldb
1793DBMLIB = -ltdb
1794.endd
1795Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1796place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1797the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1798file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1799this example:
1800.code
1801INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1802DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1803.endd
1804There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1805file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1806
1807
1808
1809.section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1810.cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1811.cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1812.cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1813.cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1814Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1815independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1816&_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1817&_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1818therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1819building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1820&_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1821
1822There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1823without them. They are the location of the runtime configuration file
1824(CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1825(BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1826maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1827a colon-separated list of filenames; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1828
1829There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1830at runtime, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1831machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1832directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1833you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at runtime, so that errors
1834detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1835be logged.
1836
1837.cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1838Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1839access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1840facilities, you need to set
1841.code
1842WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1843.endd
1844in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1845chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1846
1847
1848.cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1849.cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1850If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1851required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1852your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1853happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1854&_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1855
1856This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1857operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1858to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1859configuration files, for example, to change the C compiler, which
1860defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1861do this.
1862
1863
1864
1865.section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1866.cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1867.cindex "RFC 2047"
1868The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1869described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1870in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1871character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1872mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1873(default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1874supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1875
1876However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1877very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1878&url(https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1879systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1880&[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1881.code
1882HAVE_ICONV=yes
1883.endd
1884to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1885
1886
1887
1888.section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1889.cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1890.cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1891.cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1892.cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1893Exim is usually built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1894command as per RFC 2487. It can also support clients that expect to
1895start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1896&%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1897line option).
1898
1899If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1900OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1901implementing SSL.
1902
1903If you do not want TLS support you should set
1904.code
1905DISABLE_TLS=yes
1906.endd
1907in &_Local/Makefile_&.
1908
1909If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1910.code
1911USE_OPENSL=yes
1912TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1913.endd
1914in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1915OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1916.code
1917USE_OPENSSL=yes
1918TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1919TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1920.endd
1921.cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1922If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1923.code
1924USE_OPENSSL=yes
1925USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1926.endd
1927.cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1928If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1929.code
1930USE_GNUTLS=yes
1931TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1932.endd
1933in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1934library and include files. For example:
1935.code
1936USE_GNUTLS=yes
1937TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1938TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1939.endd
1940.cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1941If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1942.code
1943USE_GNUTLS=yes
1944USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1945.endd
1946
1947You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1948specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1949given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1950
1951
1952
1953
1954.section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1955
1956.cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1957.cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1958.cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1959.cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1960Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1961SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1962alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1963already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1964should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1965&_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1966&_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1967EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1968you might have
1969.code
1970USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1971CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1972EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1973.endd
1974in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1975files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1976.code
1977exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1978.endd
1979in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1980the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1981All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1982can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1983&_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1984configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1985further details.
1986
1987
1988.section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1989.cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1990Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1991&`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1992it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1993where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1994library files.
1995
1996Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1997defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1998currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1999as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
2000over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
2001Exim used to
2002have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
2003withdrawn.
2004
2005
2006
2007.section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
2008.cindex "lookup modules"
2009.cindex "dynamic modules"
2010.cindex ".so building"
2011On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2012the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2013on demand.
2014This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2015library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2016dependencies.
2017Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2018
2019Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2020installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2021measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2022for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2023Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2024see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2025
2026Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2027&`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2028For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2029on demand:
2030.code
2031LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2032LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2033LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2034.endd
2035
2036
2037.section "The building process" "SECID29"
2038.cindex "build directory"
2039Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2040created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2041operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2042For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2043&_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2044.cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2045Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2046
2047If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2048a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2049&_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2050&'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2051then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2052number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2053makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2054directory, should this ever be necessary.
2055
2056If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2057&_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2058FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2059
2060
2061
2062.section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2063The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2064unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2065output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2066appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2067each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2068get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2069.code
2070FULLECHO='' make -e
2071.endd
2072The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2073command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2074given in addition to the short output.
2075
2076
2077
2078.section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2079.cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2080The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2081consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2082values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2083more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2084convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2085order:
2086.display
2087&_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2088&_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2089&_Local/Makefile_&
2090&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2091&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2092&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2093&_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2094.endd
2095.cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2096.cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2097.cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2098where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2099architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2100process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2101and are often not needed.
2102
2103The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2104called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2105the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2106values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2107Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2108fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2109of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2110that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2111to find out what values are being used on your system.
2112
2113
2114&_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2115therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2116needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2117file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2118default values are.
2119
2120
2121.cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2122If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2123or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2124need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2125putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2126.cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2127when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2128formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2129compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2130called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2131Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2132default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2133containing the lines
2134.code
2135CC=cc
2136CFLAGS=-std1
2137.endd
2138If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2139these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2140
2141Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2142files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2143the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2144
2145
2146.cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2147.cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2148.cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2149.cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2150Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2151lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2152not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2153and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2154which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2155case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2156.code
2157LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2158LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2159LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2160.endd
2161and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2162&_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2163libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2164.cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2165However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2166the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2167files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2168binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause runtime configuration
2169errors.
2170
2171.cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2172.cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2173Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2174about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2175being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2176makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2177variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2178name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2179&'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2180with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2181syntax. For instance:
2182.code
2183LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2184LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2185AUTH_GSASL=yes
2186AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2187AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2188AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2189.endd
2190
2191.cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2192Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2193subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2194.code
2195EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2196.endd
2197must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2198chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2199
2200.cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2201The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2202operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2203with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2204monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2205The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2206.code
2207X11=/usr/X11R6
2208XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2209XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2210.endd
2211These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2212example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2213.code
2214X11=/usr/openwin
2215XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2216XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2217.endd
2218If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2219definition of all three of these variables into your
2220&_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2221
2222.cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2223If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2224variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2225default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2226command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2227
2228.cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2229There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2230use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2231EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2232binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2233libraries.
2234
2235.cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2236The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2237files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2238necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2239&_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2240
2241
2242.section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2243.cindex "&_os.h_&"
2244.cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2245The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2246&_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2247normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2248recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2249are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2250
2251
2252
2253.section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2254.cindex "building Eximon"
2255A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2256where the files that are involved are
2257.display
2258&_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2259&_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2260&_Local/eximon.conf_&
2261&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2262&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2263&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2264.endd
2265.cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2266As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2267&_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2268&_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2269variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2270EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2271LOG_DEPTH at runtime.
2272.ecindex IIDbuex
2273
2274
2275.section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2276.cindex "installing Exim"
2277.cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2278The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2279arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2280whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2281.cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2282The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2283going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2284&'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2285install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2286some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2287it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2288chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2289
2290.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2291Exim's runtime configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2292in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2293exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2294by the installation script. If a runtime configuration file already exists, it
2295is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2296alternative files, no default is installed.
2297
2298.cindex "system aliases file"
2299.cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2300One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2301default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2302The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2303SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2304If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2305and outputs a comment to the user.
2306
2307The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2308aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2309kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2310&_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2311Exim's configuration if necessary.
2312
2313The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2314and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2315running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2316directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2317other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2318over SMTP.
2319
2320It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2321distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2322command such as
2323.code
2324make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2325.endd
2326This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2327paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2328configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2329For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2330but this usage is deprecated.
2331
2332.cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2333Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2334&'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2335upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2336directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2337INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2338
2339For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2340to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2341installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2342for example, &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2343called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2344of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2345from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2346
2347.cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2348If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2349real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2350command:
2351.code
2352make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2353.endd
2354The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2355script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2356the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2357directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2358command:
2359.code
2360(cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2361.endd
2362.cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2363There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2364
2365.ilist
2366&%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2367to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2368.next
2369&%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2370installed binary.
2371.endlist
2372
2373INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2374.code
2375make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2376.endd
2377The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2378to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2379without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2380.code
2381make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2382.endd
2383
2384
2385
2386.section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2387.cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2388Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2389reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2390distribution. Instead it is available separately from the FTP site (see section
2391&<<SECTavail>>&).
2392
2393If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2394source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2395install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2396
2397
2398
2399.section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2400.cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2401When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2402exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2403directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2404necessary.
2405
2406
2407
2408
2409.section "Testing" "SECID34"
2410.cindex "testing" "installation"
2411Having installed Exim, you can check that the runtime configuration file is
2412syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2413Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2414.code
2415exim -bV
2416.endd
2417If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2418Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2419the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2420other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2421Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2422example,
2423.display
2424&`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2425.endd
2426should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2427.display
2428&`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2429.endd
2430a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2431This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2432user agent. For example:
2433.code
2434exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2435From: user@your.domain.example
2436To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2437Subject: Testing Exim
2438
2439This is a test message.
2440^D
2441.endd
2442The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2443In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2444arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2445
2446.cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2447If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2448&'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2449of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2450&%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2451with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2452.display
2453&`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2454.endd
2455You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2456produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2457For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2458relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2459&<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2460
2461.cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2462.cindex "lock files"
2463One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2464local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2465&"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2466writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2467is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2468directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2469that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2470&(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2471approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2472&[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2473agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2474see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2475
2476One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2477the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2478&%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2479port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2480&'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2481incoming SMTP mail.
2482
2483Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2484be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2485within the runtime configuration, all other file and directory names
2486that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2487production version.
2488
2489
2490.section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2491.cindex "replacing another MTA"
2492Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2493general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2494is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2495operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2496binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2497normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2498or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2499.cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2500a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2501privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2502and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2503
2504.cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2505.cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2506Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2507example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2508&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2509described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2510as follows:
2511.code
2512sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2513send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2514mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2515newaliases /usr/bin/true
2516.endd
2517Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2518your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2519favourite user agent.
2520
2521You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2522have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2523various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2524command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2525use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2526&'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2527
2528
2529
2530.section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2531.cindex "upgrading Exim"
2532If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2533version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2534call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2535.cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2536.cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2537to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2538new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2539version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2540configuration file.
2541
2542
2543
2544
2545.section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2546.cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2547The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2548.code
2549/etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2550.endd
2551If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2552fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2553for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2554(that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2555solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2556.code
2557pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2558.endd
2559to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2560
2561Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2562still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2563(the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2564
2565
2566
2567
2568. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2569. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2570
2571.chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2572.scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2573.scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2574Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2575each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2576options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2577some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2578combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2579The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2580
2581
2582.section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2583.cindex "&'mailq'&"
2584If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2585were present before any other options.
2586The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2587standard output.
2588This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2589that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2590&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2591
2592.cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2593If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2594were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2595&%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2596format.
2597
2598.cindex "&'rmail'&"
2599If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2600&%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2601Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2602
2603.cindex "&'runq'&"
2604.cindex "queue runner"
2605If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2606were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2607option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2608
2609.cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2610.cindex "alias file" "building"
2611.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2612If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2613&%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2614This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2615the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2616command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2617
2618
2619.section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2620Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2621available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2622user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2623EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2624&%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2625
2626.ilist
2627.cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2628.cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2629The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2630&%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2631supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2632configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2633
2634.cindex '&"From"& line'
2635.cindex "envelope from"
2636.cindex "envelope sender"
2637Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2638&"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2639Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2640See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2641users to set envelope senders.
2642
2643.cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2644.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2645.cindex "header lines" "From:"
2646.cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
2647For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2648header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2649&'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2650
2651Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2652protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2653locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2654have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2655users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2656that are available to trusted users.
2657.next
2658.cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2659.cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2660The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2661Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2662The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2663
2664Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2665operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2666necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2667the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2668
2669By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2670Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2671However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2672option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2673
2674Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2675is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2676false.
2677.endlist
2678
2679
2680&*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2681edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2682getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2683&<<CHAPconf>>&.
2684
2685
2686
2687
2688.section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2689Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2690of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2691a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2692format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2693on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2694with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2695outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2696
2697. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2698. Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2699. options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2700. creates a man page for the options.
2701. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2702
2703.literal xml
2704<!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2705.literal off
2706
2707
2708.vlist
2709.vitem &%--%&
2710.oindex "--"
2711.cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2712This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2713therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2714rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2715
2716.vitem &%--help%&
2717.oindex "&%--help%&"
2718This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2719The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2720no arguments.
2721
2722.vitem &%--version%&
2723.oindex "&%--version%&"
2724This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2725displayed.
2726
2727.vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2728 &%-Am%&
2729.oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2730.oindex "&%-Am%&"
2731These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2732ignored by Exim.
2733
2734.vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2735.oindex "&%-B%&"
2736.cindex "8-bit characters"
2737.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2738This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2739clean; it ignores this option.
2740
2741.vitem &%-bd%&
2742.oindex "&%-bd%&"
2743.cindex "daemon"
2744.cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2745.cindex "queue runner"
2746This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2747the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2748that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2749
2750The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2751(debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2752disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2753stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2754
2755By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2756all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2757ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2758&<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2759
2760When a listening daemon
2761.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2762.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2763is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2764configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2765in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2766PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2767running as root.
2768
2769When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2770process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2771used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2772
2773The SIGHUP signal
2774.cindex "SIGHUP"
2775.cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2776.cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2777.cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2778.cindex signal "to reload configuration"
2779.cindex daemon "reload configuration"
2780.cindex reload configuration
2781can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2782whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2783means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2784of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2785referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2786because these are reread each time they are used.
2787
2788.vitem &%-bdf%&
2789.oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2790This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2791from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2792
2793.vitem &%-be%&
2794.oindex "&%-be%&"
2795.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2796.cindex "expansion" "testing"
2797Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2798prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2799files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2800of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2801
2802If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2803to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2804used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2805function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2806test data. A line history is supported.
2807
2808Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2809continuations. As in Exim's runtime configuration, white space at the start of
2810continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2811string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2812configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2813message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2814is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2815
2816&*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2817files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2818the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2819of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2820
2821Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2822defined and macros will be expanded.
2823Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2824available to admin users.
2825
2826.vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2827.oindex "&%-bem%&"
2828.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2829.cindex "expansion" "testing"
2830This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2831of a file. For example:
2832.code
2833exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2834.endd
2835The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2836message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2837variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2838no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2839recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2840&$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2841line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2842&%-be%&).
2843
2844.vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2845.oindex "&%-bF%&"
2846.cindex "system filter" "testing"
2847.cindex "testing" "system filter"
2848This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2849tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2850system filters are recognized.
2851
2852.vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2853.oindex "&%-bf%&"
2854.cindex "filter" "testing"
2855.cindex "testing" "filter file"
2856.cindex "forward file" "testing"
2857.cindex "testing" "forward file"
2858.cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2859This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2860to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2861there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2862supplied.
2863
2864If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2865can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2866filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2867.code
2868exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2869.endd
2870This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2871variables that are used by the user filter.
2872
2873If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2874.code
2875# Exim filter
2876# Sieve filter
2877.endd
2878it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2879that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2880&<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2881redirection lists.
2882
2883The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2884detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2885with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2886separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2887
2888When testing a filter file,
2889.cindex "&""From""& line"
2890.cindex "envelope from"
2891.cindex "envelope sender"
2892.oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2893the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2894or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2895that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2896can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2897options).
2898
2899.vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2900.oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2901.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2902This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2903tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2904&$qualify_domain$&.
2905
2906.vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2907.oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2908This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2909tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2910process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2911suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2912actually being delivered.
2913
2914.vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2915.oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2916.cindex affix "filter testing"
2917This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2918file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2919prefix.
2920
2921.vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2922.oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2923.cindex affix "filter testing"
2924This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2925file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2926suffix.
2927
2928.vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2929.oindex "&%-bh%&"
2930.cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2931.cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2932.cindex "testing" "relay control"
2933.cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2934.cindex "policy control" "testing"
2935.cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2936This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2937standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2938after a full stop. For example:
2939.code
2940exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2941exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2942.endd
2943When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2944of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2945conversion to the canonical form is
2946&`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2947
2948Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2949include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2950This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2951messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2952test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2953
2954&*Warning 1*&:
2955.cindex "RFC 1413"
2956You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2957information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2958an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2959connection.
2960
2961&*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2962are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2963occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2964
2965Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2966written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2967lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2968can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2969and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2970session were authenticated.
2971
2972The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2973output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2974acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2975
2976Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2977plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2978specialized SMTP test program such as
2979&url(https://www.jetmore.org/john/code/swaks/,swaks).
2980
2981.vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2982.oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2983This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2984verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2985updating the callout cache database.
2986
2987.vitem &%-bi%&
2988.oindex "&%-bi%&"
2989.cindex "alias file" "building"
2990.cindex "building alias file"
2991.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2992Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2993Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2994this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2995tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2996recognized.
2997
2998If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2999configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
3000the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
3001The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
3002use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
3003if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
3004&%-bi%& is a no-op.
3005
3006. // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
3007.vitem &%-bI:help%&
3008.oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
3009.cindex "querying exim information"
3010We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
3011information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
3012consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
3013synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
3014options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
3015
3016.vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
3017.oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
3018.cindex "DSCP" "values"
3019This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
3020recognised DSCP names.
3021
3022.vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
3023.oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
3024.cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3025This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3026Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3027useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3028&`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3029compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3030way to guarantee a correct response.
3031
3032.vitem &%-bm%&
3033.oindex "&%-bm%&"
3034.cindex "local message reception"
3035This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3036locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3037command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3038argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3039default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3040if no other conflicting option is present.
3041
3042If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3043qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3044options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3045suppressing this for special cases.
3046
3047Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3048the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3049
3050.cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3051The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3052action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3053
3054The format
3055.cindex "message" "format"
3056.cindex "format" "message"
3057.cindex "&""From""& line"
3058.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3059.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3060of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3061compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3062.code
3063From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3064From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3065.endd
3066(with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3067is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3068authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3069matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3070option, which can be changed if necessary.
3071
3072.oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3073The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3074&%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3075preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3076trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3077
3078.vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3079.oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3080.cindex "testing", "malware"
3081.cindex "malware scan test"
3082This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3083(depending on the used scanner interface),
3084using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3085this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3086the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3087not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3088will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3089
3090Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3091using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3092user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3093This option requires admin privileges.
3094
3095The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3096there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3097administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3098
3099.vitem &%-bnq%&
3100.oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3101.cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3102By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3103without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3104is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3105envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3106&%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3107defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3108
3109Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3110being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3111content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3112header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3113syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3114
3115The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3116messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3117addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3118unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3119
3120
3121.vitem &%-bP%&
3122.oindex "&%-bP%&"
3123.cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3124.cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3125If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3126main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3127of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3128arguments, for example:
3129.code
3130exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3131.endd
3132.cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3133.cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3134.cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3135However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3136configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3137users, the output is as in this example:
3138.code
3139mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3140.endd
3141If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3142output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3143
3144If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the runtime
3145configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3146backward compatibility.)
3147If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3148is the name of the file that was actually used.
3149
3150.cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3151If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3152name will not be output.
3153
3154.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3155.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3156If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3157directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3158respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3159sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3160written directly into the spool directory.
3161
3162If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3163.code
3164exim -bP +local_domains
3165.endd
3166it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3167local part) and outputs what it finds.
3168
3169.cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3170.cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3171.cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3172If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3173followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3174that driver are output. For example:
3175.code
3176exim -bP transport local_delivery
3177.endd
3178The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3179options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3180using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3181&%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3182settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3183&%authenticators%&.
3184
3185.cindex "environment"
3186If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3187variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3188variables.
3189
3190.cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3191If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3192are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3193for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3194The output format is one item per line.
3195For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3196the exit status will be nonzero.
3197
3198.vitem &%-bp%&
3199.oindex "&%-bp%&"
3200.cindex "queue" "listing messages in"
3201.cindex "listing" "messages in the queue"
3202This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3203standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3204just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3205admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3206to allow any user to see the queue.
3207
3208Each message in the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3209.code
321025m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3211 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3212 <other addresses>
3213.endd
3214.cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3215.cindex "size" "of message"
3216The first line contains the length of time the message has been in the queue
3217(in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3218identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3219envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3220&"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3221the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3222before the sender address.
3223
3224.cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3225If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3226&"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3227
3228The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3229displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3230been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3231expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3232displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3233complete.
3234
3235
3236.vitem &%-bpa%&
3237.oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3238This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3239that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3240alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3241of just &"D"&.
3242
3243
3244.vitem &%-bpc%&
3245.oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3246.cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3247This option counts the number of messages in the queue, and writes the total
3248to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3249&%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3250
3251
3252.vitem &%-bpr%&
3253.oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3254This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3255chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3256lots of messages in the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3257going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3258
3259.vitem &%-bpra%&
3260.oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3261This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3262
3263.vitem &%-bpru%&
3264.oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3265This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3266
3267
3268.vitem &%-bpu%&
3269.oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3270This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3271addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3272forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3273router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3274
3275
3276.vitem &%-brt%&
3277.oindex "&%-brt%&"
3278.cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3279.cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3280This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3281arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3282and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3283.code
3284exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3285Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3286.endd
3287See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3288argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3289&'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3290contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3291retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3292with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3293rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3294sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3295used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3296.code
3297exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3298Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3299.endd
3300
3301.vitem &%-brw%&
3302.oindex "&%-brw%&"
3303.cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3304.cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3305This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3306a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3307complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3308would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3309&<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3310
3311.vitem &%-bS%&
3312.oindex "&%-bS%&"
3313.cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3314.cindex "batched SMTP input"
3315This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3316for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3317submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3318input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3319input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3320&%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3321believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3322
3323The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3324dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3325provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3326
3327As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3328messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3329Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3330&%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3331
3332Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3333as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3334QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3335
3336.cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3337If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3338error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3339was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3340was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3341
3342More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3343&<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3344
3345.vitem &%-bs%&
3346.oindex "&%-bs%&"
3347.cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3348.cindex "local SMTP input"
3349This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3350on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3351policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3352Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3353messages to the MTA.
3354
3355In
3356.cindex "sender" "source of"
3357this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3358set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3359Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3360the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3361&%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3362&%-bnq%& option is used.
3363
3364.cindex "inetd"
3365The
3366&%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3367using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3368whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3369&'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3370above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3371Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3372the listening daemon.
3373
3374.vitem &%-bt%&
3375.oindex "&%-bt%&"
3376.cindex "testing" "addresses"
3377.cindex "address" "testing"
3378This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3379as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3380written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3381user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3382sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3383
3384If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3385right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3386
3387Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3388&[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3389security issues.
3390
3391Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3392(compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3393written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3394&%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3395genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3396program.
3397
3398.cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3399The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3400failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3401code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3402
3403.cindex "duplicate addresses"
3404&*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3405addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3406This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3407always shown.
3408
3409&*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3410routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3411message,
3412.oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3413you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3414&%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3415default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3416whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3417those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3418doing such tests.
3419
3420.vitem &%-bV%&
3421.oindex "&%-bV%&"
3422.cindex "version number of Exim"
3423This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3424number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3425It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3426specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3427name of the runtime configuration file that is in use.
3428
3429As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3430configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3431values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3432detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3433alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3434realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3435dynamic testing facilities.
3436
3437.vitem &%-bv%&
3438.oindex "&%-bv%&"
3439.cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3440.cindex "address" "verification"
3441This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3442taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3443not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3444happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3445(see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3446including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3447
3448If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3449failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3450usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3451
3452If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3453right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3454
3455Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3456&[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3457security issues.
3458
3459Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3460that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3461router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3462verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3463address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3464
3465If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3466address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3467latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3468causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3469addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3470and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3471to succeed.
3472
3473When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3474and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3475considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3476
3477The
3478.cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3479return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3480failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3481code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3482
3483If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3484address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3485sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3486calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3487
3488.vitem &%-bvs%&
3489.oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3490This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3491than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3492might happen.
3493
3494.vitem &%-bw%&
3495.oindex "&%-bw%&"
3496.cindex "daemon"
3497.cindex "inetd"
3498.cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3499This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3500similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3501and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3502
3503In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3504listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3505inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3506each port only when the first connection is received.
3507
3508If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3509which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3510
3511.vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3512.oindex "&%-C%&"
3513.cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3514.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3515.cindex "alternate configuration file"
3516This option causes Exim to find the runtime configuration file from the given
3517list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3518compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single filename,
3519but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3520file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3521proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3522
3523When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3524from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3525runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3526However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3527file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3528which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3529listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3530CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3531not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3532
3533Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3534configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3535even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3536running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3537delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3538test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3539in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3540
3541If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3542prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3543must start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3544However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3545CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3546usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3547unset, any filename can be used with &%-C%&.
3548
3549ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3550to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3551broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3552configuration file.
3553
3554The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3555syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3556caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3557require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3558specified by this option.
3559
3560
3561.vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3562.oindex "&%-D%&"
3563.cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3564This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3565(see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3566unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3567If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3568completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3569
3570If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3571colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3572supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3573not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3574the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3575to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3576regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3577
3578The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3579command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3580string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3581synonymous:
3582.code
3583exim -DABC ...
3584exim -DABC= ...
3585.endd
3586To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3587quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3588example:
3589.code
3590exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3591.endd
3592&%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3593Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3594
3595
3596.vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3597.oindex "&%-d%&"
3598.cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3599.cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3600This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3601error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3602database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3603filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3604writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3605return code.
3606
3607When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3608standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3609some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3610made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3611of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3612debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3613no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3614are:
3615.display
3616&`acl `& ACL interpretation
3617&`auth `& authenticators
3618&`deliver `& general delivery logic
3619&`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3620&`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3621&`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3622&`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3623&`filter `& filter handling
3624&`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3625&`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3626&`ident `& ident lookup
3627&`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3628&`lists `& matching things in lists
3629&`load `& system load checks
3630&`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3631 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3632&`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3633&`memory `& memory handling
3634&`noutf8 `& modifier: avoid UTF-8 line-drawing
3635&`pid `& modifier: add pid to debug output lines
3636&`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3637&`queue_run `& queue runs
3638&`receive `& general message reception logic
3639&`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3640&`retry `& retry handling
3641&`rewrite `& address rewriting
3642&`route `& address routing
3643&`timestamp `& modifier: add timestamp to debug output lines
3644&`tls `& TLS logic
3645&`transport `& transports
3646&`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3647&`verify `& address verification logic
3648&`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3649.endd
3650The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3651for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3652tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3653is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3654generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3655turn everything off.
3656
3657.cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3658.cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3659The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3660with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3661unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3662rather than stderr.
3663
3664The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3665&`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3666However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3667daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3668automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3669run in parallel.
3670
3671The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3672of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3673in processing.
3674
3675.cindex debugging "UTF-8 in"
3676.cindex UTF-8 "in debug output"
3677The &`noutf8`& selector disables the use of
3678UTF-8 line-drawing characters to group related information.
3679When disabled. ascii-art is used instead.
3680Using the &`+all`& option does not set this modifier,
3681
3682If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3683any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3684
3685.vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3686.oindex "&%-dd%&"
3687This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3688starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3689subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3690behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3691
3692.vitem &%-dropcr%&
3693.oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3694This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3695handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3696described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3697
3698.vitem &%-E%&
3699.oindex "&%-E%&"
3700.cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3701This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3702failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3703and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3704generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3705could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3706follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3707new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3708
3709.vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3710.oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3711There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3712called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3713example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3714form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3715
3716.vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3717.oindex "&%-F%&"
3718.cindex "sender" "name"
3719.cindex "name" "of sender"
3720This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3721message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3722entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3723their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3724between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3725
3726.vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3727.oindex "&%-f%&"
3728.cindex "sender" "address"
3729.cindex "address" "sender"
3730.cindex "trusted users"
3731.cindex "envelope from"
3732.cindex "envelope sender"
3733.cindex "user" "trusted"
3734This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3735message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3736by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3737users to use it.
3738
3739Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3740trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3741options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3742of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3743domain.
3744
3745There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3746can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3747never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3748string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3749examples of shell commands:
3750.code
3751exim -f '<>' user@domain
3752exim -f "" user@domain
3753.endd
3754In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3755with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3756&%-bv%& options.
3757
3758Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3759it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3760refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3761though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3762
3763White
3764.cindex "&""From""& line"
3765space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3766given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3767locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3768&"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3769if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3770
3771.vitem &%-G%&
3772.oindex "&%-G%&"
3773.cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3774This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3775.code
3776control = suppress_local_fixups
3777.endd
3778for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3779bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3780in future.
3781
3782As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3783this option.
3784
3785.vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3786.oindex "&%-h%&"
3787.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3788This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3789Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3790headers.)
3791
3792.vitem &%-i%&
3793.oindex "&%-i%&"
3794.cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3795.cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3796This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3797line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3798no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3799command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3800
3801.vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3802.oindex "&%-L%&"
3803.cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3804This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3805file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3806Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3807read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3808effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3809
3810The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3811
3812.vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3813.oindex "&%-M%&"
3814.cindex "forcing delivery"
3815.cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3816.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3817This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3818any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3819delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3820and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3821
3822Retry
3823.cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3824hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3825the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3826to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3827which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3828for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3829
3830The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3831not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3832produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3833use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3834
3835.vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3836.oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3837.cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3838.cindex "recipient" "adding"
3839This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3840message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3841id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3842active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3843can be used only by an admin user.
3844
3845.vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3846 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3847.oindex "&%-MC%&"
3848.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3849.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3850.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3851This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3852by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3853an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3854given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3855must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3856
3857.vitem &%-MCA%&
3858.oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3859This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3860by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3861connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3862
3863.vitem &%-MCD%&
3864.oindex "&%-MCD%&"
3865This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3866by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3867remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3868
3869.vitem &%-MCG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>
3870.oindex "&%-MCG%&"
3871This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3872by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3873alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3874
3875.vitem &%-MCK%&
3876.oindex "&%-MCK%&"
3877This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3878by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that a
3879remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3880
3881.vitem &%-MCP%&
3882.oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3883This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3884by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3885which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3886
3887.vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3888.oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3889This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3890by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3891started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3892together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3893signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3894messages through the same SMTP connection.
3895
3896.vitem &%-MCS%&
3897.oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3898This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3899by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3900SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3901connection.
3902
3903.vitem &%-MCT%&
3904.oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3905This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3906by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3907host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3908
3909.vitem &%-MCt%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3910.oindex "&%-MCt%&"
3911This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3912by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3913connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3914The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3915
3916.vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3917.oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3918.cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3919.cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3920This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message, in turn,
3921but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3922that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3923provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3924order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3925However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3926respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3927overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3928If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3929&%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3930and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3931
3932.vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3933.oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3934.cindex "message" "changing sender"
3935.cindex "sender" "changing"
3936This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3937given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3938&"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3939be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3940is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3941This option can be used only by an admin user.
3942
3943.vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3944.oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3945.cindex "freezing messages"
3946.cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3947This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3948prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3949either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3950However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3951attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3952user.
3953
3954.vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3955.oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3956.cindex "giving up on messages"
3957.cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3958.cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3959This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3960including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3961their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3962is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3963Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3964user.
3965
3966.vitem &%-MG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3967.oindex "&%-MG%&"
3968.cindex queue named
3969.cindex "named queues"
3970.cindex "queue" "moving messages"
3971This option requests that each listed message be moved from its current
3972queue to the given named queue.
3973The destination queue name argument is required, but can be an empty
3974string to define the default queue.
3975If the messages are not currently located in the default queue,
3976a &%-qG<name>%& option will be required to define the source queue.
3977
3978.vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3979.oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3980.cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3981This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3982as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3983message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3984altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3985
3986.vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3987.oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3988.cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3989.cindex "recipient" "removing"
3990.cindex "removing recipients"
3991This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3992(&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3993the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3994addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3995(in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3996can be used only by an admin user.
3997
3998.vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3999.oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
4000.cindex "removing messages"
4001.cindex "abandoning mail"
4002.cindex "message" "manually discarding"
4003This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
4004bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
4005the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
4006only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
4007placed in the queue.
4008
4009. .new
4010. .vitem &%-MS%&
4011. .oindex "&%-MS%&"
4012. .cindex REQUIRETLS
4013. This option is used to request REQUIRETLS processing on the message.
4014. It is used internally by Exim in conjunction with -E when generating
4015. a bounce message.
4016. .wen
4017
4018.vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4019.oindex "&%-Mset%&"
4020.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
4021.cindex "expansion" "testing"
4022This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
4023string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
4024the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
4025&$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
4026available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
4027make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
4028user. See also &%-bem%&.
4029
4030.vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4031.oindex "&%-Mt%&"
4032.cindex "thawing messages"
4033.cindex "unfreezing messages"
4034.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
4035.cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
4036This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
4037&"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
4038messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
4039by an admin user.
4040
4041.vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4042.oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
4043.cindex "listing" "message body"
4044.cindex "message" "listing body of"
4045This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
4046written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4047
4048.vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4049.oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
4050.cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
4051.cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
4052This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
4053be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
4054only by an admin user.
4055
4056.vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4057.oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
4058.cindex "listing" "message headers"
4059.cindex "header lines" "listing"
4060.cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4061This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4062written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4063
4064.vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4065.oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
4066.cindex "listing" "message log"
4067.cindex "message" "listing message log"
4068This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4069the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4070
4071.vitem &%-m%&
4072.oindex "&%-m%&"
4073This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
4074treats it that way too.
4075
4076.vitem &%-N%&
4077.oindex "&%-N%&"
4078.cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4079.cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4080This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4081level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4082it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4083had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4084database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4085than &"=>"&.
4086
4087Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4088user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4089words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4090which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4091address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4092routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4093the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4094for that message.
4095
4096.vitem &%-n%&
4097.oindex "&%-n%&"
4098This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4099For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4100When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4101option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4102
4103.vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4104.oindex "&%-O%&"
4105This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4106Exim.
4107
4108.vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4109.oindex "&%-oA%&"
4110.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4111This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4112alternative alias filename. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4113description above.
4114
4115.vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4116.oindex "&%-oB%&"
4117.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4118.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4119.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4120This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4121be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4122transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4123
4124.vitem &%-odb%&
4125.oindex "&%-odb%&"
4126.cindex "background delivery"
4127.cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4128This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4129including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4130messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4131delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4132processes to finish.
4133
4134When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4135leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4136and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4137This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4138
4139If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4140(&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4141overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4142setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4143
4144.vitem &%-odf%&
4145.oindex "&%-odf%&"
4146.cindex "foreground delivery"
4147.cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4148This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4149accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4150&%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4151and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4152
4153The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4154process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4155during deliveries.
4156
4157However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4158false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4159
4160If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4161message is left in the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4162process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4163restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4164
4165
4166.vitem &%-odi%&
4167.oindex "&%-odi%&"
4168This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4169Sendmail.
4170
4171.vitem &%-odq%&
4172.oindex "&%-odq%&"
4173.cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4174.cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4175.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4176This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4177including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4178not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4179are placed in the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4180process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4181&%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4182conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4183forces queueing.
4184
4185.vitem &%-odqs%&
4186.oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4187.cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4188This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4189However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4190&%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4191configuration file is in effect.
4192
4193When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4194message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4195also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4196in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4197done at this time, so the message remains in the queue until a subsequent queue
4198runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4199messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4200host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4201configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4202&%-qq%& option.
4203
4204.vitem &%-oee%&
4205.oindex "&%-oee%&"
4206.cindex "error" "reporting"
4207If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4208example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4209message.
4210
4211.cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4212Provided
4213this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4214exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4215is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4216This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4217
4218.vitem &%-oem%&
4219.oindex "&%-oem%&"
4220.cindex "error" "reporting"
4221.cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4222This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4223return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4224This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4225
4226.vitem &%-oep%&
4227.oindex "&%-oep%&"
4228.cindex "error" "reporting"
4229If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4230error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4231.cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4232The return code is 1 for all errors.
4233
4234.vitem &%-oeq%&
4235.oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4236.cindex "error" "reporting"
4237This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4238effect as &%-oep%&.
4239
4240.vitem &%-oew%&
4241.oindex "&%-oew%&"
4242.cindex "error" "reporting"
4243This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4244effect as &%-oem%&.
4245
4246.vitem &%-oi%&
4247.oindex "&%-oi%&"
4248.cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4249This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4250line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4251single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4252lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4253&'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4254
4255.vitem &%-oitrue%&
4256.oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4257This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4258
4259.vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4260.oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4261.cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4262A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4263with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4264over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4265&%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4266other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4267
4268The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4269number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4270.code
4271exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4272.endd
4273An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4274followed by a colon and the port number:
4275.code
4276exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4277.endd
4278The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4279port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4280are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4281whichever one is last.
4282
4283.vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4284.oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4285.cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4286See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4287option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4288name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4289This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4290authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4291
4292.vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4293.oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4294.cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4295See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4296option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4297This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4298where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4299&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4300
4301.vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4302.oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4303.cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4304See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4305option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4306overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4307messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4308default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4309specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4310&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4311
4312.vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4313.oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4314.cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4315See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4316option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4317using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4318&$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4319
4320.vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4321.oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4322.cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4323See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4324option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4325delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4326messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4327abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4328running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4329
4330The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4331The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4332is sending the bounce.
4333
4334.vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4335.oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4336.cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4337.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4338See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4339option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4340&$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4341or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4342SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4343&<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4344one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4345be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4346
4347.vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4348.oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4349.cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4350See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4351option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4352present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4353uses the name it is given.
4354
4355.vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4356.oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4357.cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4358See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4359option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4360local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4361used, when there is no default.
4362
4363.vitem &%-om%&
4364.oindex "&%-om%&"
4365.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4366In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4367message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4368expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4369
4370.vitem &%-oo%&
4371.oindex "&%-oo%&"
4372.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4373This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4374whatever that means.
4375
4376.vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4377.oindex "&%-oP%&"
4378.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4379.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4380This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4381value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4382written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4383without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4384because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4385
4386.new
4387.vitem &%-oPX%&
4388.oindex "&%-oPX%&"
4389.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4390.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4391This option is not intended for general use.
4392The daemon uses it when terminating due to a SIGTEM, possibly in
4393combination with &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>.
4394It causes the pid file to be removed.
4395.wen
4396
4397.vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4398.oindex "&%-or%&"
4399.cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4400This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4401set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4402by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4403described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4404
4405.vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4406.oindex "&%-os%&"
4407.cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4408.cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4409This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4410applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4411the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4412for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4413
4414.vitem &%-ov%&
4415.oindex "&%-ov%&"
4416This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4417
4418.vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4419.oindex "&%-oX%&"
4420.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4421.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4422.cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4423This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4424is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4425of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4426in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4427file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid filename.
4428
4429.vitem &%-pd%&
4430.oindex "&%-pd%&"
4431.cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4432This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4433chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4434option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4435needed.
4436
4437.vitem &%-ps%&
4438.oindex "&%-ps%&"
4439.cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4440This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4441chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4442option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4443started.
4444
4445.vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4446.oindex "&%-p%&"
4447For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4448.display
4449&`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4450.endd
4451It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4452host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4453Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4454to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4455or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4456Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4457
4458.vitem &%-q%&
4459.oindex "&%-q%&"
4460.cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4461This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4462configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4463relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4464and &%-S%& options).
4465
4466.cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4467If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4468the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4469waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4470for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4471process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4472have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4473
4474If
4475.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4476.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4477.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4478the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4479passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4480proceeding.
4481
4482When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4483process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4484mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4485this to be repeated periodically.
4486
4487Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4488random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4489If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4490MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4491
4492It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4493order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4494&%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4495
4496.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4497The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4498behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4499appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4500
4501.vitem &%-qq...%&
4502.oindex "&%-qq%&"
4503.cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4504.cindex "queue" "routing"
4505.cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4506An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4507stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4508every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4509transports are run.
4510
4511.cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4512The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4513is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4514complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4515place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4516delivered down a single SMTP
4517.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4518.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4519.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4520connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4521This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4522intermittently.
4523
4524.vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4525.oindex "&%-qi%&"
4526.cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4527If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4528those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4529delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages in the queue using
4530&%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4531
4532.vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4533.oindex "&%-qf%&"
4534.cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4535.cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4536If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4537message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4538their retry times are tried.
4539
4540.vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4541.oindex "&%-qff%&"
4542.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4543If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4544frozen or not.
4545
4546.vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4547.oindex "&%-ql%&"
4548.cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4549The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4550be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains in the queue
4551for later delivery.
4552
4553.vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4554.oindex "&%-qG%&"
4555.cindex queue named
4556.cindex "named queues"
4557.cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4558If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4559queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4560The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4561For a periodic queue run (see below)
4562append to the name a slash and a time value.
4563
4564If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4565will specify a queue to operate on.
4566For example:
4567.code
4568exim -bp -qGquarantine
4569mailq -qGquarantine
4570exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4571.endd
4572
4573.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4574When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4575lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4576starting message id. For example:
4577.code
4578exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4579.endd
4580Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4581second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4582are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4583.code
4584exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4585.endd
4586just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4587&%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4588that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4589mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4590are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4591queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4592
4593.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4594.cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4595.cindex "periodic queue running"
4596When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4597starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4598(whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4599&%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4600single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4601combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4602.code
4603/usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4604.endd
4605Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4606process every 30 minutes.
4607
4608When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4609pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4610
4611.vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4612.oindex "&%-qR%&"
4613This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4614compatibility.
4615
4616.vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4617.oindex "&%-qS%&"
4618This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4619
4620.vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4621.oindex "&%-R%&"
4622.cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4623.cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4624.cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4625The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4626is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4627which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4628<&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4629
4630This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4631perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4632queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4633address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4634way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4635regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4636
4637If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4638you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4639.code
4640exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4641.endd
4642This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4643every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4644applied to each queue run.
4645
4646Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4647are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4648information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4649means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4650existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4651address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4652will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4653information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4654address will be skipped.
4655
4656.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4657If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4658all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4659&'ff'& is present.
4660
4661The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4662to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4663command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4664effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4665an arbitrary command instead.
4666
4667.vitem &%-r%&
4668.oindex "&%-r%&"
4669This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4670
4671.vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4672.oindex "&%-S%&"
4673.cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4674.cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4675This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4676message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4677conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4678has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4679
4680.vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4681.oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4682This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4683recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4684&"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4685
4686.vitem &%-t%&
4687.oindex "&%-t%&"
4688.cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4689.cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4690.cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4691.cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4692When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4693input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4694from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4695from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4696takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4697
4698.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4699If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4700is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4701the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4702and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4703Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4704Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4705argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4706Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4707instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4708&%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4709
4710.cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4711If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4712recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4713lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4714with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4715&%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4716
4717RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4718message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4719added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4720not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4721nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4722In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4723are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4724once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4725&%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4726
4727.vitem &%-ti%&
4728.oindex "&%-ti%&"
4729This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4730compatibility with Sendmail.
4731
4732.vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4733.oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4734.cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4735.cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4736This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4737incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4738&%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4739&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4740
4741
4742.vitem &%-U%&
4743.oindex "&%-U%&"
4744.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4745Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4746documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4747syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4748set. Exim ignores this option.
4749
4750.vitem &%-v%&
4751.oindex "&%-v%&"
4752This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4753describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4754receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4755dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4756the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4757selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4758unconditional.
4759
4760.vitem &%-x%&
4761.oindex "&%-x%&"
4762AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4763National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4764It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4765this option.
4766
4767.vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4768.oindex "&%-X%&"
4769This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4770to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4771
4772.vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4773.oindex "&%-z%&"
4774This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4775Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4776Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4777under most shells.
4778.endlist
4779
4780.ecindex IIDclo1
4781.ecindex IIDclo2
4782
4783
4784. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4785. Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4786. line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4787. creates a man page for the options.
4788. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4789
4790.literal xml
4791<!-- === End of command line options === -->
4792.literal off
4793
4794
4795
4796
4797
4798. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4799. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4800
4801
4802.chapter "The Exim runtime configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4803 "The runtime configuration file"
4804
4805.cindex "runtime configuration"
4806.cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4807.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4808.cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4809.cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4810.cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4811Exim uses a single runtime configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4812binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4813because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4814control.
4815
4816If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4817writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4818The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4819errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4820not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4821actually alter the string.
4822
4823The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4824reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4825most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4826give a colon-separated list of filenames, in which case Exim uses the first
4827existing file in the list.
4828
4829.cindex "EXIM_USER"
4830.cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4831.cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4832.cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4833.cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4834.cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4835The runtime configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4836specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4837configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4838group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4839CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4840
4841&*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4842to root, anybody who is able to edit the runtime configuration file has an
4843easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4844CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4845who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4846
4847Up to Exim version 4.72, the runtime configuration file was also permitted to
4848be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4849since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4850compromise the Exim user account.
4851
4852A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4853is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4854defines just one filename, the installation process copies the default
4855configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4856CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4857&<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4858configuration.
4859
4860
4861
4862.section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4863.cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4864A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4865option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4866&%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4867unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4868CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4869is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4870is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4871installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4872specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4873
4874Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4875with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4876listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4877testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4878delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4879Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4880the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4881can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4882message in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4883&%-M%&).
4884
4885If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4886prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4887start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4888There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any
4889filename can be used with &%-C%&.
4890
4891One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4892option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4893configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4894non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4895If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4896completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4897
4898The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4899to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4900necessarily be discarded.
4901WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4902considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4903values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4904is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4905transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4906values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4907
4908Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4909share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4910If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4911looks for a file whose name is the configuration filename followed by a dot
4912and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4913file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4914each filename in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4915
4916In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4917different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4918help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4919
4920
4921
4922.section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4923.cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4924.cindex "format" "configuration file"
4925Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4926option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4927are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4928is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4929space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4930
4931.ilist
4932&'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4933&<<CHAPACL>>&).
4934.next
4935.cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4936&'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4937are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4938.next
4939&'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4940addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4941&<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4942.next
4943&'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4944define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4945&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4946.next
4947&'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4948If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4949defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4950are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4951&<<CHAPretry>>&.
4952.next
4953&'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4954when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4955chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4956.next
4957&'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4958want to use this feature, you must set
4959.code
4960LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4961.endd
4962in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4963facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4964.endlist
4965
4966.cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4967.cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4968.cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4969Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4970
4971Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4972leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4973# character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4974and does not introduce a comment.
4975
4976Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4977the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4978backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4979lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4980appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4981
4982A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4983default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4984change settings as required.
4985
4986The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4987described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4988respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4989items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4990onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4991described.
4992
4993
4994
4995.section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4996.cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4997.cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4998.cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4999.cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
5000You can include other files inside Exim's runtime configuration file by
5001using this syntax:
5002.display
5003&`.include`& <&'filename'&>
5004&`.include_if_exists`& <&'filename'&>
5005.endd
5006on a line by itself. Double quotes round the filename are optional. If you use
5007the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
5008second form does nothing for non-existent files.
5009The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
5010the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute filename
5011is required.
5012
5013Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
5014configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
5015If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
5016because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
5017
5018The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
5019comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
5020for example:
5021.code
5022hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
5023 .include /some/file
5024.endd
5025Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
5026process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
5027inclusion appears.
5028
5029
5030
5031.section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
5032.cindex "macro" "description of"
5033.cindex "configuration file" "macros"
5034If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
5035&"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
5036definition, and must be of the form
5037.display
5038<&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
5039.endd
5040The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
5041in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
5042continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
5043space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
5044a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
5045
5046Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
5047definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
5048ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
5049
5050.section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
5051Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
5052files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
5053scanned for each, in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
5054replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
5055for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
5056the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
5057define
5058.display
5059&`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
5060&`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
5061.endd
5062but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
5063error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
5064before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
5065consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
5066line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
5067comment line or a &`.include`& line.
5068
5069
5070.section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5071Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5072(or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5073&'='&. For example:
5074.code
5075MAC = initial value
5076...
5077MAC == updated value
5078.endd
5079Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5080subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5081the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5082Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5083.code
5084MAC = initial value
5085...
5086MAC == MAC and something added
5087.endd
5088This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5089from a number of other files.
5090
5091.section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5092The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5093&%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5094used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5095using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5096file to be ignored.
5097
5098
5099
5100.section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5101As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5102up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5103strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5104.code
5105ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5106 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5107.endd
5108This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5109.code
5110data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5111.endd
5112In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5113address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5114section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5115
5116
5117.section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5118Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5119differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5120All of these macros start with an underscore.
5121They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5122(see below).
5123
5124The following classes of macros are defined:
5125.display
5126&` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5127&` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5128&` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5129&` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5130&` _LOG_* `& log_selector values
5131&` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5132&` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5133&` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5134&` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5135&` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5136&` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5137&` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5138.endd
5139
5140Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5141
5142
5143.section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5144.cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5145.cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5146You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5147&`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5148portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5149read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5150
5151The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5152be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5153that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5154line. Thus:
5155.code
5156.ifdef AAA
5157message_size_limit = 50M
5158.else
5159message_size_limit = 100M
5160.endif
5161.endd
5162sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5163(or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5164otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5165is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5166obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5167
5168Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5169it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5170in this line"& will always be true.
5171
5172Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5173to clarify complicated nestings.
5174
5175
5176
5177.section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5178.cindex "common option syntax"
5179.cindex "syntax of common options"
5180.cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5181For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5182each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5183lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5184these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5185space) and then the value. For example:
5186.code
5187qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5188.endd
5189.cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5190.cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5191.cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5192Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5193accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5194line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5195word &"hide"&. For example:
5196.code
5197hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5198.endd
5199For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5200.code
5201mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5202.endd
5203If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5204all instances of the same driver.
5205
5206The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5207that are found in option settings.
5208
5209
5210.section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5211.cindex "format" "boolean"
5212.cindex "boolean configuration values"
5213.oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5214.oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5215Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5216different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5217the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5218if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5219boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5220&"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5221the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5222.code
5223queue_only
5224queue_only = true
5225.endd
5226The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5227.code
5228no_queue_only
5229queue_only = false
5230.endd
5231You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5232
5233
5234
5235
5236.section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5237.cindex "integer configuration values"
5238.cindex "format" "integer"
5239If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5240hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5241number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5242with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5243hexadecimal number.
5244
5245If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5246it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5247if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5248When the values
5249of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
52501024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5251and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5252used.
5253
5254
5255.section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5256.cindex "integer format"
5257.cindex "format" "octal integer"
5258If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5259interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5260Such options are always output in octal.
5261
5262
5263.section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5264.cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5265.cindex "format" "fixed point"
5266If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5267integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5268
5269
5270
5271.section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5272.cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5273.cindex "format" "time interval"
5274A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5275the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5276
5277.table2 30pt
5278.irow &%s%& seconds
5279.irow &%m%& minutes
5280.irow &%h%& hours
5281.irow &%d%& days
5282.irow &%w%& weeks
5283.endtable
5284
5285For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5286intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5287is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5288
5289
5290
5291.section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5292.cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5293.cindex "format" "string"
5294If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5295or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5296consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5297the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5298removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5299Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5300appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5301therefore equivalent:
5302.code
5303trusted_users = uucp:mail
5304trusted_users = uucp:\
5305 # This comment line is ignored
5306 mail
5307.endd
5308.cindex "string" "quoted"
5309.cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5310If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5311double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5312continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5313
5314.table2 100pt
5315.irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5316.irow &`\n`& "newline"
5317.irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5318.irow &`\t`& "tab"
5319.irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5320.irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5321 character"
5322.endtable
5323
5324If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5325character, that character replaces the pair.
5326
5327Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5328insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5329trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5330current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5331in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5332and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5333
5334
5335.section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5336.cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5337Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5338by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5339circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5340is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5341strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5342However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5343backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5344within a quoted configuration string.
5345
5346
5347.section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5348.cindex "user name" "format of"
5349.cindex "format" "user name"
5350.cindex "groups" "name format"
5351.cindex "format" "group name"
5352User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5353above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5354either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5355&[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5356
5357
5358.section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5359.cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5360.cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5361.cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5362The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5363default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5364the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5365&"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5366are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5367particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5368&<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5369
5370In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5371input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5372&<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5373in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5374on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5375start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5376example, the list
5377.code
5378local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5379.endd
5380contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5381
5382&*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5383list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5384colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5385be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5386
5387.section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5388.cindex "list separator" "changing"
5389.cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5390Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5391introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5392with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5393character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5394above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5395.code
5396local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5397.endd
5398This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5399&%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5400confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5401
5402.cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5403.cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5404It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5405code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5406must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5407are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5408sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5409interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5410generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5411.code
5412domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5413.endd
5414This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5415to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5416expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5417the value in quotes. For example:
5418.code
5419local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5420.endd
5421Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5422doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5423set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5424enclosing an empty list item.
5425
5426
5427
5428.section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5429.cindex "list" "empty item in"
5430An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5431separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5432.code
5433senders = user@domain :
5434.endd
5435contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5436in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5437items, the second of which is empty:
5438.code
5439senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5440.endd
5441&*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5442are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5443would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5444just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5445.code
5446senders = :
5447.endd
5448In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5449is at the end of the list.
5450
5451
5452
5453
5454.section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5455.cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5456There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5457and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5458instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5459a sequence of lines like this:
5460.display
5461<&'instance name'&>:
5462 <&'option'&>
5463 ...
5464 <&'option'&>
5465.endd
5466In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5467followed by three options settings:
5468.code
5469localuser:
5470 driver = accept
5471 check_local_user
5472 transport = local_delivery
5473.endd
5474For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5475setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5476settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5477deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5478a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5479described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5480
5481You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5482the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5483
5484The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5485passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5486transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5487authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5488them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5489server.
5490
5491.cindex "generic options"
5492.cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5493Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5494and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5495same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5496&%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5497.cindex "private options"
5498The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5499they all have default values.
5500
5501The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5502precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5503this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5504
5505Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5506elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5507with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5508a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5509instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5510confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5511configuration lines:
5512.code
5513remote_smtp:
5514 driver = smtp
5515.endd
5516create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5517&(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5518different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5519instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5520thus:
5521.code
5522special_smtp:
5523 driver = smtp
5524 port = 1234
5525 command_timeout = 10s
5526.endd
5527The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5528these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5529lines.
5530
5531Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5532list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5533defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5534option.
5535
5536
5537
5538
5539
5540
5541. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5542. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5543
5544.chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5545.scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5546.cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5547The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5548is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5549the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5550configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5551of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5552itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5553initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5554mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5555
5556
5557
5558.section "Macros" "SECTdefconfmacros"
5559All macros should be defined before any options.
5560
5561One macro is specified, but commented out, in the default configuration:
5562.code
5563# ROUTER_SMARTHOST=MAIL.HOSTNAME.FOR.CENTRAL.SERVER.EXAMPLE
5564.endd
5565If all off-site mail is expected to be delivered to a "smarthost", then set the
5566hostname here and uncomment the macro. This will affect which router is used
5567later on. If this is left commented out, then Exim will perform direct-to-MX
5568deliveries using a &(dnslookup)& router.
5569
5570In addition to macros defined here, Exim includes a number of built-in macros
5571to enable configuration to be guarded by a binary built with support for a
5572given feature. See section &<<SECTbuiltinmacros>>& for more details.
5573
5574
5575.section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5576The main (global) configuration option settings section must always come first
5577in the file, after the macros.
5578The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is the line
5579.code
5580# primary_hostname =
5581.endd
5582This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5583to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5584can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5585it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5586
5587The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5588.code
5589domainlist local_domains = @
5590domainlist relay_to_domains =
5591hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5592.endd
5593These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5594domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5595domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5596configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5597
5598The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5599later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5600on the local host.
5601
5602.cindex "@ in a domain list"
5603There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5604of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5605called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5606be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5607the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5608
5609The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5610list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5611controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5612domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5613domain is permitted.
5614
5615The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5616used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5617that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5618loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5619submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5620hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5621
5622Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5623we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5624and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5625
5626The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5627.code
5628acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5629acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5630.endd
5631These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5632during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5633command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5634respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5635&'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5636section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5637accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5638to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5639contents of a message to be checked.
5640
5641Two commented-out option settings are next:
5642.code
5643# av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5644# spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5645.endd
5646These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5647content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5648scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5649details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5650
5651Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5652.code
5653# tls_advertise_hosts = *
5654# tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5655# tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5656.endd
5657These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5658support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5659first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5660connecting to this server; in this case, the wildcard means all clients. The
5661other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5662key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5663More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5664
5665Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5666.code
5667# daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5668# tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5669.endd
5670.cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5671.cindex "port" "for message submission"
5672.cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5673.cindex "submissions protocol"
5674.cindex "smtps protocol"
5675.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5676.cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5677.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5678.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5679These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5680server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5681TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5682more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5683Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5684to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5685much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5686consequences).
5687RFC 6409 (previously 4409) specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5688which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5689RFC 8314 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5690which should be used in preference to 587.
5691You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5692these ports.
5693Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5694
5695Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5696.code
5697# qualify_domain =
5698# qualify_recipient =
5699.endd
5700The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5701complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5702receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5703the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5704you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5705addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5706
5707.cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5708The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5709addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5710(an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5711.code
5712# allow_domain_literals
5713.endd
5714The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5715Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5716quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5717try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5718people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5719&'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5720
5721The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5722.code
5723never_users = root
5724.endd
5725It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5726convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5727setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5728The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5729list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5730FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5731contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5732FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5733
5734When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5735Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5736line,
5737.code
5738host_lookup = *
5739.endd
5740specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5741in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5742information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5743or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5744Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5745because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5746unreachable.
5747
5748The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
57491413 (hence their names):
5750.code
5751rfc1413_hosts = *
5752rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5753.endd
5754These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5755Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5756terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5757of an incoming SMTP connection.
5758If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5759information, you can change this.
5760
5761This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5762and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5763.code
5764prdr_enable = true
5765.endd
5766
5767When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5768be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5769if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5770find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5771.code
5772# sender_unqualified_hosts =
5773# recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5774.endd
5775show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5776and recipient addresses, respectively.
5777
5778The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5779over the default:
5780.code
5781log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5782 +tls_certificate_verified
5783.endd
5784
5785The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5786.code
5787# percent_hack_domains =
5788.endd
5789It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5790This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5791anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5792
5793The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5794concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5795message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5796occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5797address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5798bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5799are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5800always bounce messages.
5801.code
5802ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5803timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5804.endd
5805The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5806discarded after 2 days in the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5807message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5808after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5809bounce message ever lasts a week.
5810
5811Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5812large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5813directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5814many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5815Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5816not often needed).
5817.code
5818# split_spool_directory = true
5819.endd
5820
5821In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5822messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5823characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5824violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5825In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5826problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5827check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5828.code
5829# check_rfc2047_length = false
5830.endd
5831
5832If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
58338BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5834that are not 8-bit clean.
5835.code
5836# accept_8bitmime = false
5837.endd
5838
5839Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5840imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5841&%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5842&%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5843Note that TZ is handled separately, by the $%timezone%$ runtime
5844option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5845.code
5846# keep_environment = ^LDAP
5847# add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5848.endd
5849
5850
5851.section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5852.cindex "default" "ACLs"
5853.cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5854In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5855It starts with the line
5856.code
5857begin acl
5858.endd
5859and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5860&'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5861and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5862
5863.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5864The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5865RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5866are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5867rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5868result of the ACL processing.
5869.code
5870acl_check_rcpt:
5871.endd
5872This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5873ACL, and names it.
5874.code
5875accept hosts = :
5876.endd
5877This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5878But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5879names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5880list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5881host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5882important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5883
5884What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5885messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5886input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5887manner.
5888.code
5889deny message = Restricted characters in address
5890 domains = +local_domains
5891 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5892
5893deny message = Restricted characters in address
5894 domains = !+local_domains
5895 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5896.endd
5897These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5898characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5899Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5900&"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5901in Internet mail addresses.
5902
5903The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5904addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5905option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5906in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5907programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5908at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5909characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5910policy of being as safe as possible.
5911
5912The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5913to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5914first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5915&'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5916reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5917&'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5918
5919The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5920block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5921or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5922have to modify this rule.
5923
5924Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5925allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5926common convention of local parts constructed as
5927&"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5928the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5929with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5930filename (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5931that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5932is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5933
5934The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5935allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5936and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5937with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5938local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5939and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5940(or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5941.code
5942accept local_parts = postmaster
5943 domains = +local_domains
5944.endd
5945This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5946local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5947&'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5948reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5949&'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5950
5951The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5952by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5953in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5954.code
5955require verify = sender
5956.endd
5957This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5958ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5959address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5960see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5961addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5962used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5963discusses the details of address verification.
5964.code
5965accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5966 control = submission
5967.endd
5968This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5969hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5970verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5971that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5972second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5973is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5974messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5975&'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5976probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5977.code
5978accept authenticated = *
5979 control = submission
5980.endd
5981This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5982Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5983likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5984authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5985examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5986fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5987.code
5988require message = relay not permitted
5989 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5990.endd
5991This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5992one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5993.code
5994require verify = recipient
5995.endd
5996This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5997fails, the address is rejected.
5998.code
5999# deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
6000# is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
6001# $dnslist_text
6002# dnslists = black.list.example
6003#
6004# warn dnslists = black.list.example
6005# add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
6006# a black list at $dnslist_domain
6007# log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
6008.endd
6009These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
6010sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
6011from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
6012line.
6013.code
6014# require verify = csa
6015.endd
6016This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
6017authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
6018records.
6019.code
6020accept
6021.endd
6022The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
6023address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
6024.code
6025acl_check_data:
6026.endd
6027This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
6028of this ACL are commented out:
6029.code
6030# deny malware = *
6031# message = This message contains a virus \
6032# ($malware_name).
6033.endd
6034These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
6035viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
6036suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
6037virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
6038.code
6039# warn spam = nobody
6040# message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
6041# X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
6042# X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
6043# X-Spam_report: $spam_report
6044.endd
6045These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
6046SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
6047and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
6048&`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
6049series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
6050whatever the spam score.
6051.code
6052accept
6053.endd
6054This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
6055
6056
6057.section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
6058.cindex "default" "routers"
6059.cindex "routers" "default"
6060The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
6061by the line
6062.code
6063begin routers
6064.endd
6065Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
6066messages. An address is passed to each router, in turn, until it is either
6067accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
6068matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
6069manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
6070.code
6071# domain_literal:
6072# driver = ipliteral
6073# domains = !+local_domains
6074# transport = remote_smtp
6075.endd
6076.cindex "domain literal" "default router"
6077This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
6078support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
6079you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
6080&%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
6081
6082Which router is used next depends upon whether or not the ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6083macro has been defined, per
6084.code
6085.ifdef ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6086smarthost:
6087#...
6088.else
6089dnslookup:
6090#...
6091.endif
6092.endd
6093
6094If ROUTER_SMARTHOST has been defined, either at the top of the file or on the
6095command-line, then we route all non-local mail to that smarthost; otherwise, we'll
6096perform DNS lookups for direct-to-MX lookup. Any mail which is to a local domain will
6097skip these routers because of the &%domains%& option.
6098
6099.code
6100smarthost:
6101 driver = manualroute
6102 domains = ! +local_domains
6103 transport = smarthost_smtp
6104 route_data = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6105 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0.0.0.0 ; 127.0.0.0/8 ; ::1
6106 no_more
6107.endd
6108This router only handles mail which is not to any local domains; this is
6109specified by the line
6110.code
6111domains = ! +local_domains
6112.endd
6113The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6114exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6115that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6116the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6117indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6118passed on to the following routers.
6119
6120The name of the router driver is &(manualroute)& because we are manually
6121specifying how mail should be routed onwards, instead of using DNS MX.
6122While the name of this router instance is arbitrary, the &%driver%& option must
6123be one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6124
6125With no pre-conditions other than &%domains%&, all mail for non-local domains
6126will be handled by this router, and the &%no_more%& setting will ensure that no
6127other routers will be used for messages matching the pre-conditions. See
6128&<<SECTrouprecon>>& for more on how the pre-conditions apply. For messages which
6129are handled by this router, we provide a hostname to deliver to in &%route_data%&
6130and the macro supplies the value; the address is then queued for the
6131&(smarthost_smtp)& transport.
6132
6133.code
6134dnslookup:
6135 driver = dnslookup
6136 domains = ! +local_domains
6137 transport = remote_smtp
6138 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6139 no_more
6140.endd
6141The &%domains%& option behaves as per smarthost, above.
6142
6143The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6144and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6145the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6146instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6147one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6148
6149The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6150DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6151router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6152specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6153in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6154the address fails and is bounced.
6155
6156The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6157be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6158encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6159whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6160Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6161email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6162continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6163out.
6164.code
6165system_aliases:
6166 driver = redirect
6167 allow_fail
6168 allow_defer
6169 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6170# user = exim
6171 file_transport = address_file
6172 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6173.endd
6174Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6175domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6176alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6177data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6178the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6179the next router.
6180
6181&_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6182often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6183file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6184&_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6185.code
6186userforward:
6187 driver = redirect
6188 check_local_user
6189# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6190# local_part_suffix_optional
6191 file = $home/.forward
6192# allow_filter
6193 no_verify
6194 no_expn
6195 check_ancestor
6196 file_transport = address_file
6197 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6198 reply_transport = address_reply
6199.endd
6200This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6201redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6202individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6203local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6204router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6205namely:
6206.code
6207# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6208# local_part_suffix_optional
6209.endd
6210.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6211show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6212is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6213by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6214variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6215presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6216the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6217
6218When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6219home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6220declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6221redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6222
6223.cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6224Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6225files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6226is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6227of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6228filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6229separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6230
6231The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6232verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6233There are two reasons for doing this:
6234
6235.olist
6236Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6237checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6238unnecessary work.
6239.next
6240More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6241command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6242The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6243It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6244this time.
6245.endlist
6246
6247The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6248address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6249works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6250forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6251
6252The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6253forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6254auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6255.code
6256a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6257.endd
6258the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6259transport.
6260.code
6261localuser:
6262 driver = accept
6263 check_local_user
6264# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6265# local_part_suffix_optional
6266 transport = local_delivery
6267.endd
6268The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6269part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6270the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6271routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6272same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6273
6274
6275.section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6276.cindex "default" "transports"
6277.cindex "transports" "default"
6278Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6279only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6280not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6281.code
6282begin transports
6283.endd
6284Two remote transports and four local transports are defined.
6285.code
6286remote_smtp:
6287 driver = smtp
6288 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6289.ifdef _HAVE_PRDR
6290 hosts_try_prdr = *
6291.endif
6292.endd
6293This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6294The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6295The &%message_size_limit%& usage is a hack to avoid sending on messages
6296with over-long lines.
6297
6298The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is
6299negotiated between client and server and not expected to cause problems
6300but can be disabled if needed. The built-in macro _HAVE_PRDR guards the
6301use of the &%hosts_try_prdr%& configuration option.
6302
6303The other remote transport is used when delivering to a specific smarthost
6304with whom there must be some kind of existing relationship, instead of the
6305usual federated system.
6306
6307.code
6308smarthost_smtp:
6309 driver = smtp
6310 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6311 multi_domain
6312 #
6313.ifdef _HAVE_TLS
6314 # Comment out any of these which you have to, then file a Support
6315 # request with your smarthost provider to get things fixed:
6316 hosts_require_tls = *
6317 tls_verify_hosts = *
6318 # As long as tls_verify_hosts is enabled, this won't matter, but if you
6319 # have to comment it out then this will at least log whether you succeed
6320 # or not:
6321 tls_try_verify_hosts = *
6322 #
6323 # The SNI name should match the name which we'll expect to verify;
6324 # many mail systems don't use SNI and this doesn't matter, but if it does,
6325 # we need to send a name which the remote site will recognize.
6326 # This _should_ be the name which the smarthost operators specified as
6327 # the hostname for sending your mail to.
6328 tls_sni = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6329 #
6330.ifdef _HAVE_OPENSSL
6331 tls_require_ciphers = HIGH:!aNULL:@STRENGTH
6332.endif
6333.ifdef _HAVE_GNUTLS
6334 tls_require_ciphers = SECURE192:-VERS-SSL3.0:-VERS-TLS1.0:-VERS-TLS1.1
6335.endif
6336.endif
6337.ifdef _HAVE_PRDR
6338 hosts_try_prdr = *
6339.endif
6340.endd
6341After the same &%message_size_limit%& hack, we then specify that this Transport
6342can handle messages to multiple domains in one run. The assumption here is
6343that you're routing all non-local mail to the same place and that place is
6344happy to take all messages from you as quickly as possible.
6345All other options depend upon built-in macros; if Exim was built without TLS support
6346then no other options are defined.
6347If TLS is available, then we configure "stronger than default" TLS ciphersuites
6348and versions using the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option, where the value to be
6349used depends upon the library providing TLS.
6350Beyond that, the options adopt the stance that you should have TLS support available
6351from your smarthost on today's Internet, so we turn on requiring TLS for the
6352mail to be delivered, and requiring that the certificate be valid, and match
6353the expected hostname. The &%tls_sni%& option can be used by service providers
6354to select an appropriate certificate to present to you and here we re-use the
6355ROUTER_SMARTHOST macro, because that is unaffected by CNAMEs present in DNS.
6356You want to specify the hostname which you'll expect to validate for, and that
6357should not be subject to insecure tampering via DNS results.
6358
6359For the &%hosts_try_prdr%& option see the previous transport.
6360
6361All other options are defaulted.
6362.code
6363local_delivery:
6364 driver = appendfile
6365 file = /var/mail/$home
6366 delivery_date_add
6367 envelope_to_add
6368 return_path_add
6369# group = mail
6370# mode = 0660
6371.endd
6372This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6373traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6374local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6375directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6376under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6377show how this can be done.
6378
6379Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6380&'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6381similarly-named options above.
6382.code
6383address_pipe:
6384 driver = pipe
6385 return_output
6386.endd
6387This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6388redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6389option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6390be returned to the sender.
6391.code
6392address_file:
6393 driver = appendfile
6394 delivery_date_add
6395 envelope_to_add
6396 return_path_add
6397.endd
6398This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6399redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6400&(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6401.code
6402address_reply:
6403 driver = autoreply
6404.endd
6405This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6406filter files.
6407
6408
6409
6410.section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6411.cindex "retry" "default rule"
6412.cindex "default" "retry rule"
6413The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6414Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6415introduced by the line
6416.code
6417begin retry
6418.endd
6419In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6420errors:
6421.code
6422* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6423.endd
6424This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
64252 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
64261.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6427is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6428measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6429
6430If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6431if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6432temporary errors into permanent errors.
6433
6434
6435.section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6436The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6437.code
6438begin rewrite
6439.endd
6440contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6441rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6442
6443
6444
6445.section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6446.cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6447The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6448.code
6449begin authenticators
6450.endd
6451defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6452configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6453which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6454standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6455mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6456to support most MUA software.
6457
6458The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6459.code
6460#PLAIN:
6461# driver = plaintext
6462# server_set_id = $auth2
6463# server_prompts = :
6464# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6465# server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6466.endd
6467And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6468.code
6469#LOGIN:
6470# driver = plaintext
6471# server_set_id = $auth1
6472# server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6473# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6474# server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6475.endd
6476
6477The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6478in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6479&%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6480that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6481i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6482when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6483when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6484need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6485
6486The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6487password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6488To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6489expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6490
6491Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6492usercode and password are in different positions.
6493Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6494
6495.ecindex IIDconfiwal
6496
6497
6498
6499. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6500. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6501
6502.chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6503
6504.cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6505.cindex "PCRE"
6506Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6507uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6508matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6509regular expressions is discussed in
6510online Perl manpages, in
6511many Perl reference books, and also in
6512Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6513O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6514. --- the http: URL here redirects to another page with the ISBN in the URL
6515. --- where trying to use https: just redirects back to http:, so sticking
6516. --- to the old URL for now. 2018-09-07.
6517
6518The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6519are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6520description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6521the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6522the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6523case-insensitive.
6524
6525In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6526it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6527or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6528second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6529.code
6530domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6531.endd
6532The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6533precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6534of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6535regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6536backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6537normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6538matched.
6539
6540There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6541recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6542string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6543these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6544it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6545match anywhere in the subject string.
6546
6547In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6548you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6549.code
6550domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6551.endd
6552matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6553You need to use:
6554.code
6555domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6556.endd
6557if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6558$ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6559
6560
6561
6562. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6563. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6564
6565.chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6566.scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6567.scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6568.cindex "lookup" "description of"
6569Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6570messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6571
6572.olist
6573A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6574cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6575lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6576can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6577&<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6578The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6579.next
6580Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6581way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6582returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6583succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6584chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6585The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6586.endlist
6587
6588String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6589that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6590involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6591if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6592time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6593chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6594
6595.section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6596It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6597lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6598processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6599Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6600.code
6601domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6602domains = lsearch;/some/file
6603.endd
6604The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6605No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6606defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6607The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6608file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6609.code
6610192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6611192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6612.endd
6613When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6614possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6615
6616In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6617Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6618in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6619.code
6620domain1:
6621domain2:
6622.endd
6623Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6624matches the list item.
6625
6626It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6627Consider a file containing lines like this:
6628.code
6629192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6630.endd
6631If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6632first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6633causes a second lookup to occur.
6634
6635The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6636available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6637lookup is permitted.
6638
6639
6640.section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6641.cindex "lookup" "types of"
6642.cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6643Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6644
6645.ilist
6646The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6647and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6648lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6649.next
6650.cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6651The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6652key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6653Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6654.endlist
6655
6656The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6657the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6658default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6659.code
6660LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6661LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6662.endd
6663which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6664For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6665libraries and header files before building Exim.
6666
6667
6668
6669
6670.section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6671.cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6672.cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6673The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6674
6675.ilist
6676.cindex "cdb" "description of"
6677.cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6678.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6679&(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6680string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6681indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6682re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6683aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb and
6684tools for building the files can be found in several places:
6685.display
6686&url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html)
6687&url(https://www.corpit.ru/mjt/tinycdb.html)
6688&url(https://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb)
6689&url(https://github.com/philpennock/cdbtools) (in Go)
6690.endd
6691A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6692because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6693However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6694you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6695.next
6696.cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6697.cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6698.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6699&(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6700DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6701zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6702&<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6703
6704.cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6705For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6706when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6707using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6708the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6709that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6710other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6711.next
6712.cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6713.cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6714.cindex "sasldb2"
6715.cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6716&(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6717interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6718ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6719authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6720&_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6721&(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6722.next
6723.cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6724.cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6725.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6726.cindex "Courier"
6727.cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6728.cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6729&(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6730is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6731if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6732other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6733use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6734calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6735utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6736by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6737.next
6738.cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6739.cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6740&(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6741whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6742contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6743the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6744symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6745lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6746&<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6747.next
6748.cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6749.cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6750&(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6751terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6752file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6753IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6754being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6755.code
67561.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6757192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6758"abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6759"abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6760.endd
6761The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6762file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6763key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6764&"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6765&(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6766
6767&*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6768&(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6769lookup types support only literal keys.
6770
6771&*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6772the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6773&<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6774
6775&*Warning 3*&: Do not use an IPv4-mapped IPv6 address for a key; use the
6776IPv4, in dotted-quad form. (Exim converts IPv4-mapped IPv6 addresses to this
6777notation before executing the lookup.)
6778.next
6779.cindex lookup json
6780.cindex json "lookup type"
6781.cindex JSON expansions
6782&(json)&: The given file is a text file with a JSON structure.
6783An element of the structure is extracted, defined by the search key.
6784The key is a list of subelement selectors
6785(colon-separated by default but changeable in the usual way)
6786which are applied in turn to select smaller and smaller portions
6787of the JSON structure.
6788If a selector is numeric, it must apply to a JSON array; the (zero-based)
6789nunbered array element is selected.
6790Otherwise it must apply to a JSON object; the named element is selected.
6791The final resulting element can be a simple JSON type or a JSON object
6792or array; for the latter two a string-representation os the JSON
6793is returned.
6794For elements of type string, the returned value is de-quoted.
6795.next
6796.cindex "linear search"
6797.cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6798.cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6799.cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6800&(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6801line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6802end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6803letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6804in the file is used.
6805
6806White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6807line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6808continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6809space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6810junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6811colon, for example:
6812.code
6813baduser: :fail:
6814.endd
6815Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6816middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6817that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6818wildcarding of any kind.
6819
6820.cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6821.cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6822In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6823characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6824If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6825matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6826contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6827quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6828quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6829
6830.next
6831.cindex "NIS lookup type"
6832.cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6833.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6834&(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6835the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6836&(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6837reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6838aliases; the full map names must be used.
6839
6840.next
6841.cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6842.cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6843.cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6844.cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6845&(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6846&(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6847the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6848that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6849used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6850
6851.cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6852Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6853file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6854&`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6855
6856. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6857. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6858
6859.olist
6860The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6861.code
6862 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6863 *fish data for anythingfish
6864.endd
6865.next
6866The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6867example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6868.code
6869 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6870.endd
6871Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6872expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6873string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6874.code
6875 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6876.endd
6877The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6878expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6879For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6880.code
6881 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6882.endd
6883
6884If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6885either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6886ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6887colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6888escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6889
6890&*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6891match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6892is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6893takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6894&((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6895
6896.next
6897Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6898is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6899lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6900example:
6901.code
6902 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6903.endd
6904The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6905.endlist olist
6906
6907Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6908continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6909be followed by optional colons.
6910
6911&*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6912&((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6913lookup types support only literal keys.
6914
6915.next
6916.cindex "lookup" "spf"
6917If Exim is built with SPF support, manual lookups can be done
6918(as opposed to the standard ACL condition method.
6919For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
6920.endlist ilist
6921
6922
6923.section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
6924.cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6925.cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6926The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6927many of them are given in later sections.
6928
6929.ilist
6930.cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6931.cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6932&(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6933are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6934records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6935.next
6936.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6937.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6938&(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6939.next
6940.cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6941.cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6942&(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6943returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6944that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6945called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6946any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6947.next
6948.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6949.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6950&(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6951MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6952.next
6953.cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6954.cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6955&(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6956the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6957.next
6958.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6959.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6960&(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6961Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6962.next
6963.cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6964.cindex "passwd lookup type"
6965.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6966&(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6967lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6968success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6969lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6970password value. For example:
6971.code
6972*:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6973.endd
6974.next
6975.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6976.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6977&(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6978PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6979
6980.next
6981.cindex "Redis lookup type"
6982.cindex lookup Redis
6983&(redis)&: The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
6984passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6985
6986.next
6987.cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6988.cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6989&(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a filename followed by an SQL statement
6990that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6991
6992.next
6993&(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6994not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6995.next
6996.cindex "whoson lookup type"
6997.cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6998. --- still http:-only, 2018-09-07
6999&(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
7000allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
7001address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
7002obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
7003at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
7004superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
7005&"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
7006.code
7007require condition = \
7008 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
7009.endd
7010The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
7011the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
7012this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
7013one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
7014.endlist
7015
7016
7017
7018.section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
7019.cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
7020Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
7021completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
7022reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
7023options such as a list of local domains.
7024
7025When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
7026of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
7027temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
7028or may give up altogether.
7029
7030
7031
7032.section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
7033.cindex "wildcard lookups"
7034.cindex "lookup" "default values"
7035.cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7036.cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
7037.cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
7038In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
7039that is to be used if a lookup fails.
7040
7041&*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
7042lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
7043specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
7044
7045If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
7046and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
7047provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
7048
7049.cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
7050.cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
7051.cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
7052Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
7053&%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
7054character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
7055by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
7056that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
7057take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
7058For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
7059.code
7060data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
7061.endd
7062Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
7063looks up these keys, in this order:
7064.code
7065jane@eyre.example
7066*@eyre.example
7067*
7068.endd
7069The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
7070&(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
7071complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
7072Exim move on to try the next key.
7073
7074
7075
7076.section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
7077.cindex "partial matching"
7078.cindex "wildcard lookups"
7079.cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
7080.cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7081.cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
7082The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
7083match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
7084being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
7085information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
7086domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
7087a key in a DBM file is
7088.code
7089*.dates.fict.example
7090.endd
7091then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
7092&'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
7093by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
7094file.
7095
7096&*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
7097also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
7098&<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
7099
7100Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
7101keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
7102be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
7103partial matching keys
7104beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
7105Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
7106unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
7107
7108Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
7109the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
7110is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
7111is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
7112fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
7113start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
7114remains.
7115
7116A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
7117by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
7118&%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
7119modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
7120subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
7121up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
7122.code
71232250.dates.fict.example
7124*.2250.dates.fict.example
7125*.dates.fict.example
7126*.fict.example
7127.endd
7128As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
7129finishes.
7130
7131.cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
7132.cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
7133The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
7134changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
7135formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
7136parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
7137.code
7138domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
7139.endd
7140In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7141&`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
7142components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
7143other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
7144.code
7145domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
7146.endd
7147For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7148&`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
7149
7150If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
7151just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
7152down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
7153
7154.ilist
7155If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
7156.next
7157If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
7158example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
7159.next
7160Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
7161remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
7162for &"*"& on its own.
7163.next
7164Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
7165.endlist
7166
7167
7168If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
7169&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
7170this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
7171specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
7172prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
7173lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
7174&"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
7175
7176The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
7177in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
7178dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
7179in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
7180subject key is always followed by a dot.
7181
7182
7183
7184
7185.section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
7186.cindex "lookup" "caching"
7187.cindex "caching" "lookup data"
7188Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
7189lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
7190of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
7191single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
7192
7193For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
7194another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
7195many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
7196the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
7197closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
7198own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
7199
7200The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
7201strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
7202complete.
7203
7204
7205
7206
7207.section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
7208.cindex "lookup" "quoting"
7209.cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
7210When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
7211is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
7212the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
7213.code
7214[name=$local_part]
7215.endd
7216will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
7217For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
7218.code
7219[name="$local_part"]
7220.endd
7221but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
7222NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
7223rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
7224of the following form is provided:
7225.code
7226${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7227.endd
7228For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
7229.code
7230[name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7231.endd
7232See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7233operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7234lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7235
7236
7237
7238
7239.section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7240.cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7241.cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7242.cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7243The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7244of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7245an expansion string could contain:
7246.code
7247${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7248.endd
7249If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7250is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7251&`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7252&<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7253
7254The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7255and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7256If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7257
7258For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7259concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7260depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7261between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7262by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7263.code
7264${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7265.endd
7266It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7267white space is ignored.
7268For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7269an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7270separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7271
7272.cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7273When the type is PTR,
7274the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7275&%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7276.code
7277${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7278.endd
7279If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7280altered and nothing is added.
7281
7282.cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7283.cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7284For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7285each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7286port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7287The field separator can be modified as above.
7288
7289.cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7290.cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7291For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7292unless a field separator is specified.
7293To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7294For SPF records the
7295default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7296.code
7297${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7298${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7299${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7300.endd
7301It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7302white space is ignored.
7303
7304.cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7305For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7306successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7307Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7308specified.
7309.code
7310${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7311.endd
7312
7313.section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
7314.cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7315.cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7316.cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7317Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7318each followed by a comma,
7319that may appear before the record type.
7320
7321The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7322temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7323a defer-option modifier.
7324The possible keywords are
7325&"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7326With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7327whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7328ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7329With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7330error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7331succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7332.code
7333${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7334${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7335.endd
7336Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7337yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7338
7339.cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7340Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7341The possible keywords are
7342&"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7343With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7344with the lookup.
7345With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7346is not labelled as authenticated data
7347is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7348The default is &"lax"&.
7349
7350See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7351
7352.cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7353.cindex "DNS" timeout
7354Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7355The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7356(e.g. &"5s"&).
7357The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7358
7359Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7360The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7361The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7362
7363.cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7364.cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7365.cindex DNS TTL
7366Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7367The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7368value of the set of returned DNS records.
7369
7370
7371.section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7372.cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7373By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7374each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7375the pseudo-type MXH:
7376.code
7377${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7378.endd
7379In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7380returned.
7381
7382.cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7383Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7384records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7385component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7386records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7387error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7388but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7389top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7390.code
7391${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7392${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7393.endd
7394Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7395the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7396the name servers for &%edu%&.
7397
7398You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7399top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7400sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7401given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7402for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7403such a list.
7404
7405.cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7406A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7407records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7408&<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7409not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7410result of a successful lookup such as:
7411.code
7412${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7413.endd
7414has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7415The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7416authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7417
7418.cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7419The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7420and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7421(see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7422.code
7423${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7424.endd
7425
7426
7427.section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7428In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7429However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7430&(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7431the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7432.code
7433${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7434${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7435${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7436.endd
7437In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7438the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7439to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7440case, it does not treat it as a list.
7441
7442The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7443in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7444different separator can be specified, as described above.
7445
7446
7447
7448
7449.section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7450.cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7451.cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7452.cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7453The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7454become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7455implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7456contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7457the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7458it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7459indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7460your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7461.code
7462LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7463LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7464LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7465LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7466LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7467.endd
7468If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7469same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7470
7471There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7472the way they handle the results of a query:
7473
7474.ilist
7475&(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7476gives an error.
7477.next
7478&(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7479Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7480.next
7481&(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7482from all of them are returned.
7483.endlist
7484
7485
7486For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7487Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7488the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7489First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7490
7491
7492.section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7493.cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7494An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7495the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7496.code
7497data = ${lookup ldap \
7498 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7499 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7500.endd
7501.cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7502The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7503secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7504encrypted TLS connection is used.
7505
7506With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7507LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7508See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7509
7510Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7511controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7512&_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7513your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7514&_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7515certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7516running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7517methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7518&_exim.conf_&.
7519
7520
7521.section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7522.cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7523Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7524and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7525within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7526reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7527
7528The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7529filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7530the string:
7531.code
7532* => \2A
7533( => \28
7534) => \29
7535\ => \5C
7536.endd
7537in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7538to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7539.code
7540! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7541.endd
7542are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7543.code
7544${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7545.endd
7546yields
7547.code
7548%20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7549.endd
7550Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7551.code
7552a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7553.endd
7554The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7555base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7556by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7557.code
7558, + " \ < > ;
7559.endd
7560It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7561before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7562is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7563.code
7564${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7565.endd
7566yields
7567.code
7568%5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7569.endd
7570Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7571.code
7572\ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7573.endd
7574There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7575authentication below.
7576
7577
7578.section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7579.cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7580The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7581is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7582an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7583by starting it with
7584.code
7585ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7586.endd
7587If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7588used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7589taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7590colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7591handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7592returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7593are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7594Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7595failures, and timeouts.
7596
7597For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7598of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7599&%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7600doubled. For example
7601.code
7602ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7603.endd
7604If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7605to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7606the local host) is used.
7607
7608If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7609a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7610&`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7611to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7612not available.
7613
7614For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7615for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7616can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7617the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7618.code
7619ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7620.endd
7621When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7622&`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7623.code
7624${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7625.endd
7626When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7627a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7628specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7629socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7630&%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7631or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7632the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7633backup host.
7634
7635If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7636specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7637&%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7638
7639.ilist
7640Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7641interface.
7642.next
7643Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7644.endlist
7645
7646
7647Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7648&%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7649
7650
7651
7652.section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7653.cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7654The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7655information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7656be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7657spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7658when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7659them. The following names are recognized:
7660.display
7661&`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7662&`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7663&`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7664&`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7665&`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7666&`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7667&`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7668&`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7669.endd
7670The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7671&"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7672must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7673library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7674
7675.cindex LDAP timeout
7676.cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7677The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7678backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7679enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7680network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7681&'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7682LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7683if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7684SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7685Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7686
7687The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7688set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7689
7690The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7691to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7692default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7693server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7694different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7695different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7696alternate list (colon-separated).
7697
7698Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7699values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7700.code
7701${lookup ldap
7702 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7703 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7704 {$value}fail}
7705.endd
7706The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7707any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7708which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7709non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7710
7711The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7712connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7713on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7714
7715When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7716removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7717some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7718quoting has two advantages:
7719
7720.ilist
7721It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7722DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7723.next
7724It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7725.endlist
7726
7727For example, a setting such as
7728.code
7729USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7730.endd
7731should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7732
7733Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7734expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7735field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7736does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7737.code
7738PASS=${quote:$3}
7739.endd
7740The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7741SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7742&<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7743
7744
7745
7746.section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7747.cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7748The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7749as a sequence of values, for example
7750.code
7751cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7752.endd
7753The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7754search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7755the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7756values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7757you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7758directory.
7759
7760In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7761result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7762has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7763part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7764
7765If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7766strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7767quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7768backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7769Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7770(permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7771Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7772output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7773same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7774
7775Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7776LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7777&%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7778&%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7779(they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7780
7781.code
7782ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7783value1.1,value1,,2
7784
7785ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7786value two
7787
7788ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7789value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7790
7791ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7792attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7793
7794ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7795objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7796.endd
7797You can
7798make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7799results of LDAP lookups.
7800The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7801individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7802The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7803of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7804The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7805comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7806
7807
7808
7809
7810.section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7811.cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7812.cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7813NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7814and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7815contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7816of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7817values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7818.code
7819[name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7820.endd
7821might return the string
7822.code
7823name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7824home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7825.endd
7826(split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7827.code
7828[name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7829.endd
7830would just return
7831.code
7832Martin Guerre
7833.endd
7834with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7835for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7836operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7837
7838
7839
7840.section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7841.cindex "SQL lookup types"
7842.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7843.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7844.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7845.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7846.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7847.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7848.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7849.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7850.cindex "Redis lookup type"
7851.cindex lookup Redis
7852Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7853and SQLite
7854databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7855might be
7856.code
7857${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7858 {$value}fail}
7859.endd
7860If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7861field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7862.code
7863${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7864 {$value}}
7865.endd
7866might be
7867.code
7868home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7869.endd
7870Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7871quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7872field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7873.code
7874Mister X
7875.endd
7876If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7877with a newline between the data for each row.
7878
7879
7880.section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7881.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7882.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7883.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7884.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7885.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7886.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7887.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7888.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7889.cindex "Redis lookup type"
7890.cindex lookup Redis
7891If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7892&%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7893or &%redis_servers%&
7894option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7895information.
7896(For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7897queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7898&<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7899For all but Redis
7900each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7901items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7902Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7903name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7904.code
7905hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7906.endd
7907Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7908&"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7909option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7910.code
7911hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7912 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7913.endd
7914For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7915because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7916query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7917a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7918found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7919servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7920
7921For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
7922own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
7923If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7924information.
7925Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
7926host, database number, and password.
7927.olist
7928The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
7929port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
7930higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
7931.next
7932The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
7933.next
7934The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
7935.endlist
7936
7937The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7938convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7939respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7940itself are escaped with backslashes.
7941
7942The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
7943escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
7944
7945.section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7946For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7947it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7948done by starting the query with
7949.display
7950&`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7951.endd
7952Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7953.olist
7954If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7955global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7956of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7957taken from there.
7958.next
7959If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7960.endlist
7961The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7962Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7963successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7964
7965This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7966are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7967master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7968like this:
7969.code
7970mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7971 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7972 master/db/name/pw
7973.endd
7974In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7975.code
7976${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7977.endd
7978That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7979the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7980option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7981.code
7982${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7983.endd
7984
7985
7986.section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7987For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7988causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7989socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
7990An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
7991the default value is &"exim"&.
7992The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7993.display
7994<&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
7995 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7996.endd
7997Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7998the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7999
8000No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
8001the queries.
8002
8003If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
8004or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
8005
8006&*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
8007anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
8008is zero because no rows are affected.
8009
8010
8011.section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
8012PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
8013This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
8014However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
8015database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
8016looks like this:
8017.code
8018hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
8019.endd
8020In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
8021given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
8022visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
8023
8024If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
8025update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
8026affected.
8027
8028.section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
8029.cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
8030.cindex "sqlite lookup type"
8031SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a filename is required in
8032addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
8033daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
8034of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
8035separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
8036contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
8037.code
8038${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
8039 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
8040.endd
8041In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
8042.code
8043domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
8044 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
8045.endd
8046The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
8047quote, which it doubles.
8048
8049.cindex timeout SQLite
8050.cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
8051The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
8052internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
8053update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
8054are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
8055waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
8056to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
8057option.
8058
8059.section "More about Redis" "SECTredis"
8060.cindex "lookup" "Redis"
8061.cindex "redis lookup type"
8062Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
8063Examples:
8064.code
8065${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
8066${lookup redis{get keyname}}
8067.endd
8068
8069As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
8070Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
8071of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
8072master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
8073servers.
8074
8075When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, Exim does not
8076immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
8077to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
8078reached.
8079
8080.ecindex IIDfidalo1
8081.ecindex IIDfidalo2
8082
8083
8084. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8085. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8086
8087.chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
8088 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
8089 "Domain, host, and address lists"
8090.scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
8091A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
8092email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
8093contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
8094are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
8095arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
8096
8097Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
8098host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
8099different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
8100general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
8101
8102Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
8103support all the complexity available in
8104domain, host, address and local part lists.
8105
8106
8107
8108.section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
8109.cindex "expansion" "of lists"
8110Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
8111
8112&'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
8113splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
8114
8115The result of
8116expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
8117into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
8118but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
8119&<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
8120discusses the way to specify empty list items.
8121
8122
8123If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
8124testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
8125expansion failures cause temporary errors.
8126
8127If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
8128other special characters in the expression must be protected against
8129misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
8130the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
8131expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
8132.code
8133deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
8134 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
8135.endd
8136The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
8137&`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
8138senders based on the receiving domain.
8139
8140
8141
8142
8143.section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
8144.cindex "list" "negation"
8145.cindex "negation" "in lists"
8146Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
8147leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
8148defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
8149it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
8150(respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
8151
8152The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
8153subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
8154subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
8155subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
8156was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
8157.code
8158domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
8159.endd
8160matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
8161neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
8162list is positive. However, if the setting were
8163.code
8164domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
8165.endd
8166then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
8167list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
8168as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
8169
8170Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
8171the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
8172item.
8173
8174
8175
8176.section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
8177.cindex "list" "filename in"
8178If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute
8179filename (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
8180processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
8181filenames are not allowed,
8182and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
8183Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
8184lines:
8185
8186.ilist
8187For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
8188file, it and all following characters are ignored.
8189.next
8190Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
8191address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
8192white space or the start of the line. For example:
8193.code
8194not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
8195.endd
8196.endlist
8197
8198Putting a filename in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
8199file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
8200is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
8201so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
8202
8203If a filename is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
8204within the file is inverted. For example, if
8205.code
8206hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
8207.endd
8208and the file contains the lines
8209.code
8210!a.b.c
8211*.b.c
8212.endd
8213then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
8214any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
8215
8216
8217
8218.section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
8219As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
8220to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
8221confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
8222an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
8223sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
8224non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8225always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8226
8227If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8228list, just give the filename on its own, without a search type, as described
8229in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8230&(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8231
8232
8233
8234
8235.section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
8236.cindex "named lists"
8237.cindex "list" "named"
8238A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8239which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8240particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8241places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8242the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8243a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8244locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8245.code
8246domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8247.endd
8248Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8249for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8250configured with the line
8251.code
8252domains = +local_domains
8253.endd
8254The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8255except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8256.code
8257dnslookup:
8258 driver = dnslookup
8259 domains = ! +local_domains
8260 transport = remote_smtp
8261 no_more
8262.endd
8263The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8264the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8265respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8266equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8267.code
8268hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8269addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8270.endd
8271A named list may refer to other named lists:
8272.code
8273domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8274domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8275domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8276.endd
8277&*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8278effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8279out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8280.code
8281domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8282domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8283.endd
8284The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8285list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8286means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8287.code
8288domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8289.endd
8290where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8291referenced lists if you can.
8292
8293Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8294address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8295lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8296.code
8297domains = +local_domains
8298.endd
8299on several of your routers
8300or in several ACL statements,
8301the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8302if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8303references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8304the same each time they are referenced.
8305
8306By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8307extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8308is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8309hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8310
8311
8312
8313.section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
8314.cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8315.cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8316At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8317configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8318write
8319.code
8320ALIST = host1 : host2
8321auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8322.endd
8323it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8324.code
8325auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8326.endd
8327Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8328list, and write
8329.code
8330hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8331auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8332.endd
8333the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8334.code
8335auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8336.endd
8337
8338
8339.section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
8340.cindex "list" "caching of named"
8341.cindex "caching" "named lists"
8342While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8343it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8344the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8345that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8346an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8347message. For example:
8348.code
8349domainlist special_domains = \
8350 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8351.endd
8352This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8353address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8354in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8355cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8356same list each time.
8357
8358By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8359cache the result anyway. For example:
8360.code
8361domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8362.endd
8363If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8364the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8365
8366
8367
8368.section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8369.cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8370.cindex "list" "domain list"
8371Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8372The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8373
8374.ilist
8375.cindex "primary host name"
8376.cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8377.oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8378.cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8379.cindex "@ in a domain list"
8380If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8381as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8382possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8383differ only in their names.
8384.next
8385.cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8386.cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8387.cindex "domain literal"
8388If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8389in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8390only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8391&%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8392control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8393In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
8394.next
8395.cindex "@mx_any"
8396.cindex "@mx_primary"
8397.cindex "@mx_secondary"
8398.cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8399If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8400has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8401.oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8402&%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8403are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8404local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8405but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8406preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8407
8408The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8409performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8410example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8411resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8412options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8413
8414Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8415patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8416list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8417ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8418on a router). For example:
8419.code
8420domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8421.endd
8422This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8423the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8424
8425The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8426host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8427contain negative items.
8428
8429Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8430be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8431list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8432.code
8433domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8434 an.other.domain : ...
8435.endd
8436so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8437involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8438.code
8439domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8440 an.other.domain ? ...
8441.endd
8442.next
8443.cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8444.cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8445.cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8446If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8447are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8448domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8449list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8450matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8451list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8452&'cipher.key.ex'&.
8453
8454.next
8455.cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8456.cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8457If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8458expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8459function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8460Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8461default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8462with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8463are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8464
8465&*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8466must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8467use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8468it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8469expression by expansion, of course).
8470.next
8471.cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8472.cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8473If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8474semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8475must be a filename in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8476&"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8477.code
8478domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8479.endd
8480The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8481key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8482only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8483is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8484or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8485&$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8486other statements in the same ACL.
8487
8488.next
8489Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8490&`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8491.code
8492domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8493.endd
8494This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8495works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8496
8497.next
8498.cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8499Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8500a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8501original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8502select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8503value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8504expansion variable.
8505.next
8506If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8507semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8508pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8509chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8510.code
8511hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8512 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8513.endd
8514In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8515example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8516whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8517&%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8518variable and can be referred to in other options.
8519.next
8520.cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8521If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8522between the pattern and the domain.
8523.endlist
8524
8525Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8526.code
8527domainlist funny_domains = \
8528 @ : \
8529 lib.unseen.edu : \
8530 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8531 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8532 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8533 nis;domains.byname : \
8534 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8535.endd
8536There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8537an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8538explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8539but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8540patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8541patterns earlier.
8542
8543
8544
8545.section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8546.cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8547.cindex "list" "host list"
8548Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8549example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8550may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8551two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8552pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8553You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8554involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8555
8556
8557.section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8558.cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8559.cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8560If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8561involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8562process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8563not used.
8564
8565.cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8566The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8567the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8568
8569
8570
8571.section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8572.cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8573If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8574the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8575&`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8576list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8577systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8578concerns.)
8579
8580The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8581inspecting its IP address:
8582
8583.ilist
8584If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8585with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8586to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8587&[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8588This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8589with the IP address of the subject host.
8590
8591If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8592lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8593ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8594temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8595what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8596
8597.next
8598.cindex "@ in a host list"
8599If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8600domain name, as just described.
8601
8602.next
8603If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8604subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8605IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8606be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8607separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8608without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8609IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8610that can never match a client host.
8611
8612.next
8613.cindex "@[] in a host list"
8614If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8615the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8616interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8617.code
8618accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8619accept hosts = @[]
8620.endd
8621.next
8622.cindex "CIDR notation"
8623If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8624example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8625host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8626included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8627specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8628significant end of the address.
8629
8630&*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8631of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8632address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8633addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8634.code
8635192.168.23.236/31
8636.endd
8637matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
863832 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8639matches.
8640
8641Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8642.code
8643recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8644 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8645.endd
8646The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8647appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8648For example:
8649.code
8650recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8651.endd
8652could make use of a file containing
8653.code
8654172.16.0.0/12
86553ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8656.endd
8657to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8658addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8659changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8660.code
8661recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8662 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8663.endd
8664The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8665list.
8666.endlist
8667
8668
8669
8670.section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8671 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8672.cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8673When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8674address, the pattern takes this form:
8675.display
8676&`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8677.endd
8678For example:
8679.code
8680hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8681.endd
8682The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8683IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8684letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8685&(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8686quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8687returned by the lookup is not used.
8688
8689.cindex "IP address" "masking"
8690.cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8691Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8692patterns of this form:
8693.display
8694&`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8695.endd
8696For example:
8697.code
8698net24-dbm;/networks.db
8699.endd
8700The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8701length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8702mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8703is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8704&"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8705
8706When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8707of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8708terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8709to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8710recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8711(notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8712For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8713converted using colons and not dots.
8714In all cases except IPv4-mapped IPv6, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8715addresses are always used.
8716The latter are converted to IPv4 addresses, in dotted-quad form.
8717
8718Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8719colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8720However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8721configurations.
8722
8723&*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8724IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8725the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8726case the IP address is used on its own.
8727
8728
8729
8730.section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8731.cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8732.cindex "unknown host name"
8733.cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8734There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8735remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8736complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8737address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8738above.)
8739
8740If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8741patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8742Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8743DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8744Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8745effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8746Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8747
8748Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8749against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8750
8751By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8752if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8753&[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8754are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8755security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8756for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8757Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8758discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8759found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8760
8761There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8762found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8763
8764.cindex "host" "alias for"
8765.cindex "alias for host"
8766As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8767of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8768
8769.ilist
8770.cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8771If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8772the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8773&'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8774requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8775expression.
8776.next
8777.cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8778.cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8779If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8780matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8781expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8782case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8783syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8784example,
8785.code
8786^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8787.endd
8788is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8789&'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8790that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8791string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8792part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8793.code
8794sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8795.endd
8796&*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8797&`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8798example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8799required.
8800.endlist
8801
8802
8803
8804
8805.section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8806.cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8807While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8808name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8809from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8810behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8811
8812&*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8813apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8814
8815.cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8816.cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8817Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8818lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8819Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8820does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8821To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8822&`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8823not recognized in an indirected file).
8824
8825.ilist
8826If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8827cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8828.code
8829host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8830.endd
8831rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8832any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8833
8834.next
8835If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8836be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8837example:
8838.code
8839accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8840 192.168.4.5
8841.endd
8842accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8843whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8844name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8845.endlist
8846
8847Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8848list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8849list.
8850
8851.section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8852 "SECTmixwilhos"
8853.cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8854
8855This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8856as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8857wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8858
8859.ilist
8860If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8861IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8862addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8863.code
8864accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8865.endd
8866The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8867left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8868without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8869a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8870pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8871&%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8872if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8873
8874.next
8875If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8876address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8877.code
8878accept hosts = *.friend.example
8879accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8880.endd
8881If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8882&<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8883&`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8884this section.
8885.endlist
8886
8887
8888.section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8889 "SECTtemdnserr"
8890.cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8891.cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8892.cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8893A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8894&%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8895host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8896&`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8897section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8898host lists such as whitelists.
8899
8900
8901
8902.section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8903 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8904.cindex "unknown host name"
8905.cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8906If a pattern is of the form
8907.display
8908<&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8909.endd
8910for example
8911.code
8912dbm;/host/accept/list
8913.endd
8914a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8915lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8916is not used.
8917
8918&*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8919keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8920addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8921&<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8922two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8923lookup, both using the same file.
8924
8925
8926
8927.section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8928If a pattern is of the form
8929.display
8930<&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8931.endd
8932the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8933data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8934&$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8935.code
8936hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8937 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8938.endd
8939The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8940can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8941use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8942operator.
8943
8944If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8945looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8946&<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8947
8948Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8949host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8950&`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8951still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8952effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8953See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8954
8955
8956
8957
8958
8959.section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8960.cindex "list" "address list"
8961.cindex "address list" "empty item"
8962.cindex "address list" "patterns"
8963Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8964is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8965always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8966list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8967using this option setting:
8968.code
8969senders = :
8970.endd
8971The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8972data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8973detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8974and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8975
8976Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8977example:
8978.code
8979senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8980.endd
8981A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8982character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8983semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8984subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8985with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8986the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8987wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8988.code
8989deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8990 *@+hostile_domains:\
8991 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8992 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8993.endd
8994.cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8995.cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8996If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8997specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8998treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8999
9000If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
9001contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
9002address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
9003domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
9004is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
9005.code
9006deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
9007.endd
9008
9009The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
9010address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
9011senders:
9012
9013.ilist
9014.cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
9015.cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
9016If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
9017done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
9018You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
9019as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
9020to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
9021.code
9022deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
9023 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
9024.endd
9025The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
9026start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
9027
9028.next
9029.cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
9030Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
9031lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
9032example:
9033.code
9034deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
9035 mysql;select address from blocked where \
9036 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
9037.endd
9038Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
9039lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
9040not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
9041always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
9042
9043Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
9044cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
9045panic log.
9046.cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
9047However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
9048&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
9049default. For example, with this lookup:
9050.code
9051accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
9052.endd
9053the file could contains lines like this:
9054.code
9055user1@domain1.example
9056*@domain2.example
9057.endd
9058and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
9059that are tried is:
9060.code
9061nimrod@jaeger.example
9062*@jaeger.example
9063*
9064.endd
9065&*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
9066would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
9067
9068&*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
9069.code
9070deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
9071deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
9072.endd
9073The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
9074because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
9075domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
9076.endlist
9077
9078
9079The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
9080If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
9081always fails.
9082
9083
9084.ilist
9085.cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
9086.cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
9087.cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
9088If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
9089(for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
9090split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
9091it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
9092from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
9093of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
9094
9095.cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
9096The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
9097keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
9098patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
9099even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
9100with
9101.code
9102deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
9103.endd
9104the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
9105.code
9106baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
9107.endd
9108to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
9109
9110.cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9111If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
9112has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
9113may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
9114but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
9115surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
9116.code
9117aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
9118 spammer3 : spammer4
9119.endd
9120As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
9121doubling.
9122
9123If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
9124of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
9125list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
9126might have entries like
9127.code
9128aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
9129xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
9130*: ^\d{8}$
9131.endd
9132in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
9133local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
9134each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
9135chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
9136
9137.cindex "loop" "in lookups"
9138It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
9139them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
9140
9141.next
9142The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
9143lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
9144can only return a single list of local parts.
9145.endlist
9146
9147&*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
9148in these two examples:
9149.code
9150senders = +my_list
9151senders = *@+my_list
9152.endd
9153In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
9154example it is a named domain list.
9155
9156
9157
9158
9159.section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
9160.cindex "case of local parts"
9161.cindex "address list" "case forcing"
9162.cindex "case forcing in address lists"
9163Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
9164case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
9165Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
9166Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
9167blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
9168lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
9169default.
9170
9171The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
9172address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
9173comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
9174the address list itself, in files included as plain filenames, and in any file
9175that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
9176keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
9177works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
9178case-independent.
9179
9180.cindex "&`+caseful`&"
9181To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
9182an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
9183part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
9184longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
9185lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
9186performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
9187become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
9188
9189
9190
9191.section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
9192.cindex "list" "local part list"
9193.cindex "local part" "list"
9194Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
9195lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
9196setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
9197set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
9198case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
9199matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
9200&%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
9201option is case-sensitive from the start.
9202
9203If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
9204comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
9205only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
9206Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
9207that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
9208&`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
9209Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
9210types.
9211.ecindex IIDdohoadli
9212
9213
9214
9215
9216. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9217. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9218
9219.chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
9220.scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
9221Many strings in Exim's runtime configuration are expanded before use. Some of
9222them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
9223
9224When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
9225.cindex expansion "string concatenation"
9226when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
9227start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9228below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9229escape character, as described in the following section.
9230
9231Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9232dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9233options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
9234the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9235conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9236reasons,
9237.cindex "tainted data" expansion
9238.cindex expansion "tainted data"
9239and expansion of data deriving from the sender (&"tainted data"&)
9240is not permitted.
9241
9242
9243
9244.section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9245.cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9246An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9247backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9248character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9249If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9250required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9251the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9252
9253.cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9254A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9255two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9256expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9257.code
9258deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9259.endd
9260On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9261without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9262string.
9263
9264
9265
9266.section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9267.cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9268A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9269expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9270carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9271octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9272backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9273encoding.
9274
9275These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9276in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9277and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9278
9279
9280.section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9281.cindex "expansion" "testing"
9282.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9283.oindex "&%-be%&"
9284Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9285takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9286arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9287to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9288since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9289value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9290database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9291and &%nhash%&.
9292
9293Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9294instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9295using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9296
9297.oindex "&%-bem%&"
9298If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9299from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9300option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a filename. The file is
9301read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9302.code
9303exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9304.endd
9305The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9306Exim message identifier. For example:
9307.code
9308exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9309.endd
9310This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9311is therefore restricted to admin users.
9312
9313
9314.section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9315.cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9316A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9317alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9318(which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9319used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9320instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9321the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9322that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9323its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9324from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9325taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9326being expanded.
9327
9328
9329
9330
9331.section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9332The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9333between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9334outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9335white space is significant.
9336
9337.vlist
9338.vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9339.cindex "expansion" "variables"
9340Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9341.code
9342$local_part
9343${domain}
9344.endd
9345The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9346characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9347&'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9348section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9349given, the expansion fails.
9350
9351.vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9352.cindex "expansion" "operators"
9353The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9354<&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9355.code
9356${lc:$local_part}
9357.endd
9358The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9359leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9360below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9361one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9362string easier to understand.
9363
9364.vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9365This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9366expansion item below.
9367
9368
9369.vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9370.cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9371.cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9372The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9373arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9374Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9375arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9376and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9377are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9378a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9379the result of the expansion.
9380If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9381the expansion result is an empty string.
9382If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9383
9384
9385.vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9386.cindex authentication "results header"
9387.cindex headers "authentication-results:"
9388.cindex authentication "expansion item"
9389This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9390&'Authentication-Results:'&
9391header line.
9392The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9393will be a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9394Methods that might be present in the result include:
9395.code
9396none
9397iprev
9398auth
9399spf
9400dkim
9401.endd
9402
9403Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9404.code
9405 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9406.endd
9407This is safe even if no authentication results are available.
9408
9409
9410.vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9411 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9412.cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9413.cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9414.cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9415The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9416The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9417the certificate. Supported fields are:
9418.display
9419&`version `&
9420&`serial_number `&
9421&`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9422&`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9423&`notbefore `& time
9424&`notafter `& time
9425&`sig_algorithm `&
9426&`signature `&
9427&`subj_altname `& tagged list
9428&`ocsp_uri `& list
9429&`crl_uri `& list
9430.endd
9431If the field is found,
9432<&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9433otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9434variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9435is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9436
9437If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9438key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9439extracted is used.
9440
9441Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9442
9443The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9444output a Distinguished Name string which is
9445not quite
9446parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9447(the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9448RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9449a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9450result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9451The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9452a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9453Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9454
9455The field selectors marked as "time" above
9456take an optional modifier of "int"
9457for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9458Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9459in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9460
9461The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9462newline-separated by default,
9463(embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9464The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9465a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9466
9467The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9468prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9469Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9470which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9471if so the element tags are omitted.
9472
9473If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9474
9475.vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9476 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9477.cindex &%dlfunc%&
9478This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9479This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9480.code
9481EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
9482.endd
9483set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9484object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9485(but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9486
9487There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function.
9488
9489When compiling
9490a local function that is to be called in this way,
9491first &_DLFUNC_IMPL_& should be defined,
9492and second &_local_scan.h_& should be included.
9493The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9494are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9495must have the following type:
9496.code
9497int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9498.endd
9499Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9500function should return one of the following values:
9501
9502&`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9503into the expanded string that is being built.
9504
9505&`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9506from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9507
9508&`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9509taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9510
9511&`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9512
9513When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9514you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9515configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9516
9517
9518.vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9519.cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9520.cindex "environment" "values from"
9521The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9522removed.
9523This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9524If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9525and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9526
9527Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9528appear, for example:
9529.code
9530${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9531.endd
9532This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9533{<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9534
9535If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9536search failure.
9537If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9538search success.
9539
9540The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9541&%add_environment%& main section options.
9542
9543
9544.vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9545 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9546.cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9547.cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9548The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9549white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9550must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9551The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9552.display
9553<&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9554.endd
9555.vindex "&$value$&"
9556where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9557values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9558values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9559described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9560for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9561the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9562otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9563variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9564is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9565
9566If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9567key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9568extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9569yield &"2001"&:
9570.code
9571${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9572${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9573.endd
9574Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9575appear, for example:
9576.code
9577${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9578.endd
9579This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9580{<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9581
9582.vitem "&*${extract json{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9583 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9584 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9585 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9586.cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON object"
9587.cindex JSON expansions
9588The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9589white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9590must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9591The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9592.display
9593{ <&'"key1"'&> : <&'value1'&> , <&'"key2"'&> , <&'value2'&> ... }
9594.endd
9595.vindex "&$value$&"
9596The braces, commas and colons, and the quoting of the member name are required;
9597the spaces are optional.
9598Matching of the key against the member names is done case-sensitively.
9599For the &"json"& variant,
9600if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9601trailing quotes.
9602For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9603leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9604. XXX should be a UTF-8 compare
9605
9606The results of matching are handled as above.
9607
9608
9609.vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9610 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9611.cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9612.cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9613The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9614apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9615This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9616behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9617extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9618argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9619<&'string3'&> as before.
9620
9621The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9622separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9623The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9624counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9625number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9626number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9627expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9628provided. For example:
9629.code
9630${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9631.endd
9632yields &"42"&, and
9633.code
9634${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9635.endd
9636yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9637empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9638
9639
9640.vitem "&*${extract json {*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9641 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9642 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9643 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9644.cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON array"
9645.cindex JSON expansions
9646The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9647apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9648
9649Field selection and result handling is as above;
9650there is no choice of field separator.
9651For the &"json"& variant,
9652if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9653trailing quotes.
9654For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9655leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9656
9657
9658.vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9659.cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9660.cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9661.vindex "&$item$&"
9662After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9663default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9664For each item
9665in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9666evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9667item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9668separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9669input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9670.code
9671${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
9672.endd
9673yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9674to what it was before. See also the &%map%& and &%reduce%& expansion items.
9675
9676
9677.vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9678.cindex "hash function" "textual"
9679.cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9680This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9681early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9682(numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9683
9684The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9685<&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9686<&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9687use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9688.code
9689${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9690.endd
9691The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9692or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9693Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9694function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9695first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9696.code
9697abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9698.endd
9699If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9700letters appear. For example:
9701.display
9702&`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9703&`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9704&`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9705.endd
9706
9707.vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9708 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9709 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9710 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9711 "&*$lheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9712 &*$lh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9713 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9714 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9715.cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9716.vindex "&$header_$&"
9717.vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9718.vindex "&$lheader_$&"
9719.vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9720.cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9721.cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9722.cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9723Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9724.code
9725$header_reply-to:
9726.endd
9727The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9728internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9729lines) may be present.
9730
9731The difference between the four pairs of expansions is in the way
9732the data in the header line is interpreted.
9733
9734.ilist
9735.cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9736&%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9737processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9738
9739.next
9740.cindex "list" "of header lines"
9741&%lheader%& gives a colon-separated list, one element per header when there
9742are multiple headers with a given name.
9743Any embedded colon characters within an element are doubled, so normal Exim
9744list-processing facilities can be used.
9745The terminating newline of each element is removed; in other respects
9746the content is &"raw"&.
9747
9748.next
9749.cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9750&%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9751or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9752character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9753&"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9754.cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9755produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9756what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9757
9758.next
9759&%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9760standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9761be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9762returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9763&[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9764a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9765.endlist ilist
9766
9767In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9768command of the following form:
9769.code
9770headers charset "UTF-8"
9771.endd
9772This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9773subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9774character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9775option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9776value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9777ISO-8859-1.
9778
9779Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9780any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9781&'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9782if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9783
9784Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9785this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9786message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9787filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9788router or transport are not accessible.
9789
9790For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
9791ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
9792because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
9793They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
9794Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9795are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9796point they are added.
9797When any of the above ACLs ar
9798running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
9799
9800Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9801following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9802this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9803white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9804expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9805expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9806section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9807header.)
9808
9809If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9810to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9811&%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9812each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9813newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9814newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9815those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9816junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9817
9818.new
9819.cindex "tainted data"
9820When the headers are from an incoming message,
9821the result of expanding any of these variables is tainted.
9822.wen
9823
9824
9825.vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9826.cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9827.cindex &%hmac%&
9828This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9829shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9830RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9831&`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9832cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9833or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9834present. For example:
9835.code
9836${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9837.endd
9838For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9839produces:
9840.code
9841dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9842.endd
9843As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9844an Exim configuration:
9845.code
9846SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9847.endd
9848In a router or a transport you could then have:
9849.code
9850headers_add = \
9851 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9852 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9853 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9854.endd
9855Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9856&'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9857this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9858host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9859using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example, by using the
9860&'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9861
9862
9863.vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9864.cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9865.cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9866If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9867item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9868in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9869.code
9870${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9871.endd
9872The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9873true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9874be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9875case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9876&<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9877
9878If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9879is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9880cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9881.code
9882condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9883.endd
9884you can use
9885.code
9886condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9887.endd
9888
9889
9890
9891.vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
9892.cindex expansion "imap folder"
9893.cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
9894This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
9895folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
9896For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
9897
9898
9899
9900.vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9901.cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9902.cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9903The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9904strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9905you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9906change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9907some of the braces:
9908.code
9909${length_<n>:<string>}
9910.endd
9911The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> bytes or the whole
9912of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9913&%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9914All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
9915
9916
9917.vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9918 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9919.cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9920.cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9921.cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9922The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9923apart from an optional leading minus,
9924and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9925
9926After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9927default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9928
9929The first field of the list is numbered one.
9930If the number is negative, the fields are
9931counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9932The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9933then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9934
9935If the modulus of the
9936number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9937the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9938
9939For example:
9940.code
9941${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9942.endd
9943yields &"42"&, and
9944.code
9945${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9946.endd
9947yields &"result: 42"&.
9948
9949If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9950If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9951extracted is used.
9952You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9953
9954
9955.vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9956 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9957This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9958described in the next item.
9959
9960.vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9961 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9962.cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9963.cindex "file" "lookups"
9964.cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9965The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9966discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9967lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9968<&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9969
9970If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9971a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9972other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9973in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9974out by the system administrator.
9975
9976.vindex "&$value$&"
9977If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9978During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9979lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9980level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9981the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9982string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9983lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9984original lookup fails.
9985
9986If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9987data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9988expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9989the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9990appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9991to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9992{<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9993successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9994
9995For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9996search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9997type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9998&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9999
10000.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
10001If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
10002and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
10003They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
10004
10005This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
10006.code
10007${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
10008.endd
10009This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
10010the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
10011.code
10012${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
10013 {$value}fail}
10014.endd
10015
10016
10017.vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10018.cindex "expansion" "list creation"
10019.vindex "&$item$&"
10020After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10021default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10022For each item
10023in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
10024expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
10025for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
10026setting is not included in the output. For example:
10027.code
10028${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
10029.endd
10030expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
10031value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &%filter%&
10032and &%reduce%& expansion items.
10033
10034.vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10035.cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10036.cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10037The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10038<&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10039if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10040can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10041.code
10042${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10043.endd
10044The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
10045the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
10046processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
10047slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
10048example,
10049.code
10050${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
10051.endd
10052returns the string &"6/33"&.
10053
10054
10055
10056.vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
10057.cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
10058.cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
10059This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
10060interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
10061expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
10062additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
10063name of the subroutine, is nine.
10064
10065The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
10066the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
10067way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
10068Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
10069return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
10070not its contents.
10071
10072If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
10073with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
10074Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
10075
10076The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
10077out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10078
10079
10080.vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
10081.cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
10082The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
10083keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
10084it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
10085to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
10086as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
10087and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10088
10089.vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
10090 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
10091.cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
10092This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
10093checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
10094yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
10095empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
10096prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
10097version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
10098variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
10099
10100These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
10101retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
10102against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
10103which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
10104
10105The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
10106string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
10107result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
10108whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
10109is the expansion of the third argument.
10110
10111All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
10112However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
10113For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10114
10115.vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
10116.cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
10117.cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
10118.cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
10119The filename and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
10120then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
10121the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
10122newlines are left in the string.
10123String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
10124you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
10125the string expansion fails.
10126
10127The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
10128locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10129
10130
10131
10132.vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
10133 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
10134.cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
10135.cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
10136.cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
10137This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
10138string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
10139examples:
10140.code
10141${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
10142${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
10143.endd
10144For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
10145For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
10146a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
10147number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
10148optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
10149example:
10150.code
10151${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
10152.endd
10153Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
10154one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
10155both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
10156unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
10157and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
10158is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
10159extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
10160.code
10161${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
10162.endd
10163
10164The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
10165and must be present if the argument is given.
10166Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
10167Two option types is currently recognised: shutdown and tls.
10168The first defines whether (the default)
10169or not a shutdown is done on the connection after sending the request.
10170Example, to not do so (preferred, eg. by some webservers):
10171.code
10172${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
10173.endd
10174The second, tls, controls the use of TLS on the connection. Example:
10175.code
10176${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:tls=yes}}
10177.endd
10178The default is to not use TLS.
10179If it is enabled, a shutdown as descripbed above is never done.
10180
10181A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
10182that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
10183turns them into spaces:
10184.code
10185${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
10186.endd
10187As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
10188happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
10189addition, the following errors can occur:
10190
10191.ilist
10192Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
10193.next
10194Failure to connect the socket;
10195.next
10196Failure to write the request string;
10197.next
10198Timeout on reading from the socket.
10199.endlist
10200
10201By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
10202you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
10203errors occurs. For example:
10204.code
10205${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
10206 {socket failure}}
10207.endd
10208You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
10209expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
10210and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
10211if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
10212non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
10213
10214The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
10215locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10216
10217
10218.vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10219.cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
10220.cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
10221.vindex "&$value$&"
10222.vindex "&$item$&"
10223This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
10224<&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
10225separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10226Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
10227assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
10228list is assigned to &$item$&, in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
10229them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
10230iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
10231added to the expansion output. The &%reduce%& expansion item can be used in a
10232number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
10233.code
10234${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
10235.endd
10236The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
10237can be found:
10238.code
10239${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
10240.endd
10241At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
10242restored to what they were before. See also the &%filter%& and &%map%&
10243expansion items.
10244
10245.vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
10246This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
10247expansion item in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
10248
10249.vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
10250 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10251.cindex "expansion" "running a command"
10252.cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
10253The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
10254split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
10255in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
10256executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
10257a shell, you must explicitly code it.
10258
10259Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
10260which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
10261simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
10262script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
10263variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
10264quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
10265in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
10266around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
10267variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
10268character.
10269
10270The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
10271and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
10272.cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
10273.vindex "&$value$&"
10274If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
10275and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
10276from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
10277<&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
10278expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
10279&$value$&.
10280
10281If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
10282can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
10283command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
10284of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
10285
10286.vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
10287The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
10288In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
10289troubleshoot:
10290.code
10291warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
10292 log_message = Output of id: $value
10293.endd
10294If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
10295shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
10296.code
10297${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
10298.endd
10299
10300.vindex "&$runrc$&"
10301The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
10302remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
10303.code
10304if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
10305 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
10306 ...
10307endif
10308.endd
10309If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
10310the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10311commands.
10312
10313&*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10314option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10315testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10316by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10317
10318The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10319out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10320
10321
10322.vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10323.cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10324.cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10325This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10326option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10327modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10328into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10329a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10330.code
10331${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10332.endd
10333yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10334if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10335substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10336.code
10337${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10338.endd
10339yields &"defabc"&, and
10340.code
10341${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10342.endd
10343yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10344the regular expression from string expansion.
10345
10346The regular expression is compiled in 8-bit mode, working against bytes
10347rather than any Unicode-aware character handling.
10348
10349
10350.vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10351.cindex sorting "a list"
10352.cindex list sorting
10353.cindex expansion "list sorting"
10354After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10355default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10356The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10357of a two-argument expansion condition.
10358The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10359The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10360if the first value should sort before the second value.
10361The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10362the element being placed in &$item$&,
10363to give values for comparison.
10364
10365The item result is a sorted list,
10366with the original list separator,
10367of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10368
10369Examples:
10370.code
10371${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10372.endd
10373sorts a list of numbers, and
10374.code
10375${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10376.endd
10377will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10378
10379
10380.vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10381.cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10382.cindex "substring extraction"
10383.cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10384The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10385<&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10386if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10387can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10388.code
10389${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10390.endd
10391The second number is optional (in both notations).
10392If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10393omitted.
10394
10395The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10396&%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10397length required. For example
10398.code
10399${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10400.endd
10401If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10402null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10403length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10404given offset. The first byte (character) in the string has offset zero.
10405
10406The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10407from the right-hand end of its operand. The last byte (character) is offset -1,
10408the second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10409.code
10410${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10411.endd
10412yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10413length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10414the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10415.code
10416${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10417.endd
10418yields an empty string, but
10419.code
10420${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10421.endd
10422yields &"1"&.
10423
10424When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10425is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all bytes (characters) in the
10426string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10427no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10428.code
10429${substr_-1:abcde}
10430${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10431.endd
10432yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10433
10434All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10435
10436
10437
10438.vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10439 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10440.cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10441.cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10442This item does single-character (in bytes) translation on its subject string. The second
10443argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10444matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10445replacement list. For example
10446.code
10447${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10448.endd
10449yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10450last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10451last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10452place.
10453
10454All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10455
10456.endlist
10457
10458
10459
10460.section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10461.cindex "expansion" "operators"
10462For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10463the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10464The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10465following operations can be performed:
10466
10467.vlist
10468.vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10469.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10470.cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10471The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10472header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10473not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10474
10475The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10476
10477
10478.vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10479.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10480.cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10481The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
104822822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10483operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10484result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10485doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10486Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10487
10488It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10489separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10490character. For example:
10491.code
10492${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10493.endd
10494expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10495first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10496separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10497separator explicitly:
10498.code
10499${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10500.endd
10501
10502Compare the &%address%& (singular)
10503expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10504address. See the &%filter%&, &%map%&, and &%reduce%& items for ways of
10505processing lists.
10506
10507To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10508a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10509unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10510email address separator. For the example header line:
10511.code
10512From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10513.endd
10514The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10515properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10516It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10517example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10518de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10519The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10520quoted. The fourth example shows SMTPUTF8 handling.
10521.code
10522# exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10523=?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10524user@example.com
10525# exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10526Last:user@example.com
10527# exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10528user@example.com
10529# exim -be '${addresses:フィル <フィリップ@example.jp>}'
10530フィリップ@example.jp
10531.endd
10532
10533.vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10534.cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10535.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10536The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10537base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10538Only lowercase letters are used.
10539
10540.vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10541.cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10542.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10543The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10544The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10545
10546.vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10547.cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10548.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10549The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10550base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10551the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10552its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive
10553filenames), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just
10554to be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10555
10556.vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10557.cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10558.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10559The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10560environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10561identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10562string.
10563
10564.vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10565.cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10566.cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10567.cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10568.cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10569This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10570
10571If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10572returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10573
10574
10575.vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10576.cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10577.cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10578.cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10579This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10580
10581
10582.vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10583.cindex "domain" "extraction"
10584.cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10585The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10586from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10587
10588
10589.vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10590.cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10591.cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10592If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10593escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10594significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10595is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10596
10597.vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10598.cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
10599.cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
10600If the string contains and characters with the most significant bit set,
10601they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
10602Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
10603
10604
10605.vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10606.cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10607.cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10608.cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10609These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10610expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10611arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10612logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10613integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10614C programming language):
10615.table2 70pt 300pt
10616.irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10617.irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10618.irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10619.irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10620.irow "" "and (&&)"
10621.irow "" "xor (^)"
10622.irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10623.endtable
10624Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10625space is permitted before or after operators.
10626
10627For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10628hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10629decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10630permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10631times, which often do have leading zeros.
10632
10633A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10634or 1024*1024*1024,
10635respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10636a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10637
10638.display
10639&`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10640&`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10641&`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10642&`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10643&`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
10644&`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10645&`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10646&`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10647&`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10648&`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
10649&`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10650.endd
10651
10652As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10653.code
10654deny message = Too many bad recipients
10655 condition = \
10656 ${if and { \
10657 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10658 { \
10659 < \
10660 {$recipients_count} \
10661 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10662 } \
10663 }{yes}{no}}
10664.endd
10665The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10666fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10667
10668
10669.vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10670.cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10671The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10672example,
10673.code
10674${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10675.endd
10676first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10677and then re-expands what it has found.
10678
10679
10680.vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10681.cindex "Unicode"
10682.cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10683.cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10684.cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10685The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10686email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10687to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10688UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10689converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10690the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10691
10692Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10693ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10694For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10695way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10696characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10697single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10698translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10699
10700
10701.vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10702.cindex "hash function" "textual"
10703.cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10704The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10705be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10706change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10707.code
10708${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10709.endd
10710See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10711abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10712
10713
10714
10715.vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10716.cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10717.cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10718.cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10719This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10720be useful for processing the output of the various hashing functions.
10721
10722
10723
10724.vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10725.cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10726.cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10727This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10728escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10729as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example, a
10730byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10731
10732
10733.vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10734.cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10735.cindex "IP address" normalisation
10736This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10737of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10738A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10739Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10740
10741.vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10742.cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10743.cindex "IP address" normalisation
10744.cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10745This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10746Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10747set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10748A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10749Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10750
10751
10752.vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10753.cindex "case forcing in strings"
10754.cindex "string" "case forcing"
10755.cindex "lower casing"
10756.cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10757.cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10758This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10759.code
10760${lc:$local_part}
10761.endd
10762Case is defined per the system C locale.
10763
10764.vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10765.cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10766.cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10767The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10768can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10769changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10770.code
10771${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10772.endd
10773See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10774&%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10775when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10776All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10777
10778
10779.vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10780.cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10781.cindex "list" "item count"
10782.cindex "list" "count of items"
10783.cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10784The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10785
10786
10787.vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10788.cindex "expansion" "named list"
10789.cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10790The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10791expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10792If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10793and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10794Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10795matching list is returned.
10796
10797
10798.vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10799.cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10800.cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10801The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10802extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10803empty.
10804The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10805
10806
10807.vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10808.cindex "masked IP address"
10809.cindex "IP address" "masking"
10810.cindex "CIDR notation"
10811.cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10812.cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10813If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10814slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10815expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10816masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10817the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10818.code
10819${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10820.endd
10821returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10822be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10823address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10824terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10825.code
10826${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10827.endd
10828returns the string
10829.code
108303ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10831.endd
10832Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10833
10834
10835.vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10836.cindex "MD5 hash"
10837.cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10838.cindex certificate fingerprint
10839.cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10840The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10841as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10842
10843If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10844returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10845
10846
10847.vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10848.cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10849.cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10850The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10851that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10852strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10853.code
10854${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10855.endd
10856See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10857
10858
10859.vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10860.cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10861.cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10862.cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10863The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10864is an empty string or
10865contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10866Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10867Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10868respectively For example,
10869.code
10870${quote:ab"*"cd}
10871.endd
10872becomes
10873.code
10874"ab\"*\"cd"
10875.endd
10876The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10877variable or a message header.
10878
10879.vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10880.cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10881This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10882required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10883example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10884If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10885(or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10886
10887This quoting determination is not SMTPUTF8-aware, thus quoting non-ASCII data
10888will likely use the quoting form.
10889Thus &'${quote_local_part:フィル}'& will always become &'"フィル"'&.
10890
10891
10892.vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10893.cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10894This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10895query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10896the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10897.code
10898${quote_ldap:two * two}
10899.endd
10900returns
10901.code
10902two%20%5C2A%20two
10903.endd
10904For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10905yields an unchanged string.
10906
10907
10908.vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10909.cindex "random number"
10910This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10911supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10912on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10913If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10914If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10915for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10916Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10917srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10918random().
10919
10920
10921.vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10922.cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10923This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10924dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10925dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10926for DNS. For example,
10927.code
10928${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10929${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10930.endd
10931returns
10932.code
109334.2.0.192
10934f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10935.endd
10936
10937
10938.vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10939.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10940.cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10941.cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10942This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10943encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10944assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10945&%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
10946contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10947characters
10948.code
10949? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10950.endd
10951it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10952string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10953characters.
10954
10955
10956.vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10957.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10958.cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10959.cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10960This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10961bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10962character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10963not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10964
10965&*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10966access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10967to use this operator as well.
10968
10969
10970
10971.vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10972.cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10973.cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10974.cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10975The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10976characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10977variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10978
10979
10980.vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10981.cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10982.cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10983.cindex certificate fingerprint
10984.cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
10985The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10986it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10987
10988If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10989returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10990
10991
10992.vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10993 &*${sha2:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10994 &*${sha2_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10995.cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10996.cindex "SHA-2 hash"
10997.cindex certificate fingerprint
10998.cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10999.cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
11000.cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
11001The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
11002and returns
11003it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11004
11005If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11006returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11007
11008The operator can also be spelled &%sha2%& and does the same as &%sha256%&
11009(except for certificates, which are not supported).
11010Finally, if an underbar
11011and a number is appended it specifies the output length, selecting a
11012member of the SHA-2 family of hash functions.
11013Values of 256, 384 and 512 are accepted, with 256 being the default.
11014
11015
11016.vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11017 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11018.cindex "SHA3 hash"
11019.cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
11020.cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
11021The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
11022and returns
11023it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11024
11025If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
11026the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
11027with 256 being the default.
11028
11029The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
11030compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
11031or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
11032The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
11033
11034
11035.vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11036.cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
11037.cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
11038.cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
11039The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
11040function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
11041expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
11042series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
11043except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
11044a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
1104510-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
11046&"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
11047can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
11048
11049The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
11050the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
11051systems for files larger than 2GB.
11052
11053.vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11054.cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
11055Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
11056
11057
11058
11059.vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11060.cindex "expansion" "string length"
11061.cindex "string" "length in expansion"
11062.cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
11063The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
11064decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
11065All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11066
11067
11068.vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11069.cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
11070.cindex "substring extraction"
11071.cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
11072The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
11073can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
11074that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11075.code
11076${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
11077.endd
11078See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
11079abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
11080All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11081
11082.vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11083.cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
11084.cindex "time interval" "decoding"
11085This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
11086seconds.
11087
11088.vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11089.cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
11090.cindex "time interval" "formatting"
11091The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
11092represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
11093number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
11094&`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
11095
11096.vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11097.cindex "case forcing in strings"
11098.cindex "string" "case forcing"
11099.cindex "upper casing"
11100.cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11101.cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
11102This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
11103Case is defined per the system C locale.
11104
11105.vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11106.cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
11107.cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
11108.cindex "incorrect utf-8"
11109.cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
11110.cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
11111This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
11112In versions of Exim before 4.92, this did not correctly do so for a truncated
11113final codepoint's encoding, and the character would be silently dropped.
11114If you must handle detection of this scenario across both sets of Exim behavior,
11115the complexity will depend upon the task.
11116For instance, to detect if the first character is multibyte and a 1-byte
11117extraction can be successfully used as a path component (as is common for
11118dividing up delivery folders), you might use:
11119.code
11120condition = ${if inlist{${utf8clean:${length_1:$local_part}}}{:?}{yes}{no}}
11121.endd
11122(which will false-positive if the first character of the local part is a
11123literal question mark).
11124
11125.vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11126 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11127 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11128 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
11129.cindex expansion UTF-8
11130.cindex UTF-8 expansion
11131.cindex EAI
11132.cindex internationalisation
11133.cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11134.cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11135.cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11136.cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11137These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
11138For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
11139.endlist
11140
11141
11142
11143
11144
11145
11146.section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
11147.scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
11148The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
11149while expanding strings:
11150
11151.vlist
11152.vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
11153.cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
11154.cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
11155Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
11156condition.
11157
11158.vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11159.cindex "numeric comparison"
11160.cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
11161There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
11162are:
11163.display
11164&`= `& equal
11165&`== `& equal
11166&`> `& greater
11167&`>= `& greater or equal
11168&`< `& less
11169&`<= `& less or equal
11170.endd
11171For example:
11172.code
11173${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
11174.endd
11175Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
11176two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
11177optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
11178lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
11179As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
11180zero.
11181
11182In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
11183<&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
1118410M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
11185
11186
11187.vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
11188 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
11189.cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
11190.cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
11191The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
11192arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
11193Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
11194arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
11195and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
11196are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
11197a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
11198the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
11199If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
11200If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
11201
11202.vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11203.cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11204.cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
11205This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
11206a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
11207(case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
11208false if zero.
11209An empty string is treated as false.
11210Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
11211thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
11212All other string values will result in expansion failure.
11213
11214When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
11215make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
11216For example:
11217.code
11218${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
11219.endd
11220
11221
11222.vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11223.cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11224.cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
11225Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
11226where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
11227loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
11228and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
11229true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
11230
11231Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
11232
11233.vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11234.cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
11235.cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
11236.cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
11237This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
11238authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
11239necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
11240included in the binary.
11241
11242The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
11243compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
11244be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
11245encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
11246does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
11247&[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
11248Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
11249string in LDAP form is:
11250.code
11251{md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
11252.endd
11253If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
11254be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
11255.code
11256${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
11257.endd
11258The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
11259supported:
11260
11261.ilist
11262.cindex "MD5 hash"
11263.cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
11264&%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11265printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11266length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
11267(as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
11268hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
11269comparison fails.
11270
11271.next
11272.cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11273&%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11274printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11275length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
11276If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
11277SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
11278
11279.next
11280.cindex "&[crypt()]&"
11281&%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
11282only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
11283systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
11284whatever its length.
11285
11286.next
11287.cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
11288&%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
11289use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
11290modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
11291.endlist
11292Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
11293&[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
11294HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
11295operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
11296the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
11297support &[crypt16()]&.
11298
11299Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
11300it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
11301turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
11302&[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
11303algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
11304
11305However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
11306functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
11307Exim is seen as very low priority.
11308
11309If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
11310comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
11311determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
11312default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
11313function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
11314
11315.vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
11316.cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
11317.cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
11318The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
11319variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
11320variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
11321.code
11322${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
11323.endd
11324Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
11325variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
11326
11327.vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
11328 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
11329.cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
11330This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
11331exists in the message. For example,
11332.code
11333${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
11334.endd
11335&*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
11336the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
11337
11338.vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11339 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11340.cindex "string" "comparison"
11341.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11342.cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
11343.cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
11344The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
11345resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
11346letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent, where
11347case is defined per the system C locale.
11348
11349.vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
11350.cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
11351.cindex "file" "existence test"
11352.cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
11353The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11354condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11355is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11356users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11357
11358.vitem &*first_delivery*&
11359.cindex "delivery" "first"
11360.cindex "first delivery"
11361.cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11362.cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11363This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11364attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11365
11366
11367.vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11368 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11369.cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11370.cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11371.cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11372.vindex "&$item$&"
11373These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
11374the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
11375the normal method (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
11376The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
11377be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
11378condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
11379.ilist
11380For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
11381the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
11382items in the list, the overall condition is false.
11383.next
11384For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
11385and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
11386all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
11387.endlist
11388Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
11389items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
11390that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
11391list separator is changed to a comma:
11392.code
11393${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
11394.endd
11395The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &%forany%& or &%forall%& is
11396being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
11397
11398To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
11399
11400.vitem "&*forall_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11401 "&*forany_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11402 "&*forall_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11403 "&*forany_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11404.cindex JSON "iterative conditions"
11405.cindex JSON expansions
11406.cindex expansion "&*forall_json*& condition"
11407.cindex expansion "&*forany_json*& condition"
11408.cindex expansion "&*forall_jsons*& condition"
11409.cindex expansion "&*forany_jsons*& condition"
11410As for the above, except that the first argument must, after expansion,
11411be a JSON array.
11412The array separator is not changeable.
11413For the &"jsons"& variants the elements are expected to be JSON strings
11414and have their quotes removed before the evaluation of the condition.
11415
11416
11417
11418.vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11419 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11420.cindex "string" "comparison"
11421.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11422.cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
11423.cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
11424The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11425string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11426comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11427case-independent.
11428Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11429
11430.vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11431 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11432.cindex "string" "comparison"
11433.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11434.cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11435.cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11436The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11437string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11438includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11439case-independent.
11440Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11441
11442.vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11443 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11444.cindex "string" "comparison"
11445.cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11446Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11447strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11448is true.
11449For the case-independent &%inlisti%& condition, case is defined per the system C locale.
11450
11451These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11452Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11453.code
11454${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11455 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11456${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11457 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11458.endd
11459
11460.vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11461 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11462 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11463.cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11464.cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11465.cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11466.cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11467.cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11468The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11469an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11470&%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11471
11472For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11473which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11474colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11475hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11476component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11477
11478&*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11479values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11480check.
11481This is no longer the case.
11482
11483The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11484host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11485.code
11486${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11487.endd
11488to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11489
11490.vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11491.cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11492.cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11493.cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11494This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11495&<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11496queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11497query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11498password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11499server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11500with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11501will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11502of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11503this can be used.
11504
11505
11506.vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11507 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11508.cindex "string" "comparison"
11509.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11510.cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11511.cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11512The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11513string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11514comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11515case-independent.
11516Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11517
11518.vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11519 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11520.cindex "string" "comparison"
11521.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11522.cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
11523.cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
11524The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11525string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
11526includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
11527case-independent.
11528Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11529
11530
11531.vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11532.cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
11533.cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
11534.cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
11535The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
11536expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
11537regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
11538escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
11539(curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
11540premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
11541&`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
11542For example,
11543.code
11544${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
11545.endd
11546If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
11547backslashes is also required.
11548
11549The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
11550The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
11551metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
11552and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
11553the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
11554metacharacter at an appropriate point.
11555All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware,
11556but we might change this in a future Exim release.
11557
11558.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
11559At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
11560substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
11561succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
11562will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
11563of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
11564combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
11565variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
11566
11567.vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11568.cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
11569See &*match_local_part*&.
11570
11571.vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11572.cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
11573See &*match_local_part*&.
11574
11575.vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11576.cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
11577This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
11578be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
11579address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
11580list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
11581.code
11582${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
11583.endd
11584The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
11585
11586.ilist
11587An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
11588.next
11589A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
11590.next
11591An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
11592useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
11593in a single test such as
11594. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11595. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
11596. ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
11597. ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
11598.code
11599 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
11600.endd
11601where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11602.next
11603The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11604.next
11605Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11606even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11607address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11608&*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11609masks. For example:
11610.code
11611 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11612.endd
11613It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11614do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11615address mask, for example:
11616.code
11617 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11618.endd
11619However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11620just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11621.code
11622 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11623.endd
11624.endlist ilist
11625
11626Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11627Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11628
11629Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11630
11631.vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11632.cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11633.cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11634.cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11635.cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11636This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11637possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11638condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11639example is:
11640.code
11641${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11642.endd
11643In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11644list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
11645is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11646Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11647.code
11648${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11649.endd
11650.cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11651For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11652item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11653have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11654caselessly.
11655
11656Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11657Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11658
11659&*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11660hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11661how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11662matched using &%match_ip%&.
11663
11664.vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11665.cindex "PAM authentication"
11666.cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11667.cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11668.cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11669.cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11670&'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11671(&url(https://mirrors.edge.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11672available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11673distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11674the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11675.code
11676SUPPORT_PAM=yes
11677.endd
11678in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11679in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11680
11681The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11682colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11683The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11684taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11685The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11686from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11687request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11688
11689There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11690characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11691separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
11692item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
11693of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11694.code
11695server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
11696.endd
11697For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
11698.code
11699server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
11700.endd
11701In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11702running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11703messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11704. --- 2018-09-07: the pam_exim modified variant has gone, removed claims re using Exim via that
11705
11706
11707.vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11708.cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11709.cindex "Cyrus"
11710.cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11711.cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11712This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11713This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11714that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11715deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11716
11717The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11718the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11719building Exim. For example:
11720.code
11721CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11722.endd
11723You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11724the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11725from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11726access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11727
11728The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11729password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11730configuration, you might have this:
11731.code
11732server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11733.endd
11734Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11735.code
11736server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11737.endd
11738.vitem &*queue_running*&
11739.cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11740.cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11741.cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11742This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11743initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11744
11745
11746.vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11747.cindex "Radius"
11748.cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11749.cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11750Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11751set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11752the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11753support.
11754
11755With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11756library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11757this library, you need to set
11758.code
11759RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11760.endd
11761in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11762&%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11763.code
11764RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11765.endd
11766in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11767You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11768Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11769
11770The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11771Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11772the authentication is successful. For example:
11773.code
11774server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11775.endd
11776
11777
11778.vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11779 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11780.cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11781.cindex "Cyrus"
11782.cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11783.cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11784This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11785daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11786Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11787by a process that is not running as root.
11788
11789The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11790the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11791building Exim. For example:
11792.code
11793CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11794.endd
11795You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11796the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11797from the Cyrus SASL library.
11798
11799Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11800two are mandatory. For example:
11801.code
11802server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11803.endd
11804The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11805in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11806realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11807.endlist vlist
11808
11809
11810
11811.section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11812.cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11813Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11814and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11815conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11816sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11817the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11818
11819
11820.vlist
11821.vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11822.cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11823.cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11824The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11825any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11826For example,
11827.code
11828${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11829.endd
11830When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11831evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11832numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11833
11834.vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11835.cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11836.cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11837The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11838all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11839sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11840the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11841parsed but not evaluated.
11842.endlist
11843.ecindex IIDexpcond
11844
11845
11846
11847
11848.section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11849.cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11850This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11851of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11852support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11853
11854.vlist
11855.vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11856.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11857When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11858captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11859processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11860In the expansion condition case
11861they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11862values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11863variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11864precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11865Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11866matching condition.
11867
11868.vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11869Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11870any arguments are copied to these variables,
11871any unused variables being made empty.
11872
11873.vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11874Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11875can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11876long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11877example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11878variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11879used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11880same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11881with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11882during subsequent delivery.
11883
11884.vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11885These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11886are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11887received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11888message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11889also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11890message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11891and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11892delivery.
11893
11894.vitem &$acl_narg$&
11895Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11896this variable has the number of arguments.
11897
11898.vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11899.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11900After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11901message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11902be preserved by coding like this:
11903.code
11904warn !verify = sender
11905 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11906.endd
11907You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11908&%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11909failure.
11910
11911.vitem &$address_data$&
11912.vindex "&$address_data$&"
11913This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11914value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11915and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11916the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11917for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11918user filter files.
11919
11920If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11921a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11922conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11923to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11924of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11925from the child's routing.
11926
11927If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11928sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11929&$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11930address.
11931
11932In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11933after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11934these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11935
11936.vitem &$address_file$&
11937.vindex "&$address_file$&"
11938When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11939to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11940is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11941default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11942.code
11943/home/r2d2/savemail
11944.endd
11945then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11946contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11947.cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11948For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11949then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11950to the relevant file.
11951
11952.vitem &$address_pipe$&
11953.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11954When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11955this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11956
11957.vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11958.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11959These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11960&<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11961
11962.vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11963.cindex "authentication" "id"
11964.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11965When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11966preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11967&$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11968user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11969in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11970&$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11971
11972When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11973the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11974process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11975command line option.
11976This second case also sets up information used by the
11977&$authresults$& expansion item.
11978
11979.vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11980.cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11981.vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11982When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11983will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11984id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11985available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11986A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11987authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11988the ACL's as well.
11989
11990
11991.vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11992.cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11993.cindex "authentication" "sender"
11994.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11995.vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11996When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11997SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11998described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11999&"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
12000available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
12001sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
12002
12003.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12004When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
12005value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
12006name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
12007can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
12008
12009
12010.vitem &$authentication_failed$&
12011.cindex "authentication" "failure"
12012.vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
12013This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
12014command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
12015possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
12016(&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
12017&"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
12018is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
12019negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
12020an undefined mechanism.
12021
12022.vitem &$av_failed$&
12023.cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
12024This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
12025extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
12026problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
12027the ACL malware condition.
12028
12029.vitem &$body_linecount$&
12030.cindex "message body" "line count"
12031.cindex "body of message" "line count"
12032.vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
12033When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12034number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
12035
12036.vitem &$body_zerocount$&
12037.cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
12038.cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
12039.cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12040.vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
12041When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12042number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
12043
12044.vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
12045.vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
12046This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
12047it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
12048chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12049
12050.vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
12051.vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
12052This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
12053up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
12054file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12055
12056.vitem &$caller_gid$&
12057.cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
12058.vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12059The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12060not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
12061&$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12062incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
12063
12064.vitem &$caller_uid$&
12065.cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
12066.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12067The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12068not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
12069&$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12070incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
12071
12072.vitem &$callout_address$&
12073.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
12074After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
12075address that was connected to.
12076
12077.vitem &$compile_number$&
12078.vindex "&$compile_number$&"
12079The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
12080of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
12081compilations of the same version of Exim.
12082
12083.vitem &$config_dir$&
12084.vindex "&$config_dir$&"
12085The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
12086&$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
12087contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
12088&$config_dir$& is ".".
12089
12090.vitem &$config_file$&
12091.vindex "&$config_file$&"
12092The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
12093
12094.vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$& &&&
12095 &$dmarc_status$& &&&
12096 &$dmarc_status_text$& &&&
12097 &$dmarc_used_domains$&
12098Results of DMARC verification.
12099For details see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
12100
12101.vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
12102Results of DKIM verification.
12103For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12104
12105.vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
12106 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
12107 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
12108 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
12109 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
12110 &$dkim_algo$& &&&
12111 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
12112 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
12113 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
12114 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
12115 &$dkim_created$& &&&
12116 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
12117 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
12118 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
12119 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
12120 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
12121 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
12122 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
12123 &$dkim_key_length$&
12124These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
12125For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12126
12127.vitem &$dkim_signers$&
12128.vindex &$dkim_signers$&
12129When a message has been received this variable contains
12130a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
12131For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12132
12133.vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
12134 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
12135 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
12136 &$dnslist_value$&
12137.vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
12138.vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
12139.vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
12140.vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
12141.cindex "black list (DNS)"
12142When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
12143the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
12144looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
12145main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
12146
12147.vitem &$domain$&
12148.vindex "&$domain$&"
12149When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
12150contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
12151case for &$domain$&.
12152
12153Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12154&$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
12155is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
12156message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
12157
12158When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
12159RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
12160have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
12161at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
12162the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
12163which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
12164
12165.oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
12166At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
12167set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
12168
12169The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
12170
12171.ilist
12172When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
12173the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
12174&$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
12175normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
12176is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
12177&$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
12178the &(smtp)& transport.
12179
12180.next
12181When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12182&$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
12183it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
12184rewrite domains by file lookup.
12185
12186.next
12187With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
12188&$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
12189a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
12190is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
12191that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
12192recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
12193
12194.next
12195.cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
12196.oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
12197When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
12198the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
12199.endlist
12200
12201.new
12202.cindex "tainted data"
12203If the origin of the data is an incoming message,
12204the result of expanding this variable is tainted.
12205.wen
12206
12207
12208.vitem &$domain_data$&
12209.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
12210When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
12211means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
12212of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
12213address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
12214transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
12215used.
12216
12217&$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
12218domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
12219the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
12220to nothing.
12221
12222.vitem &$exim_gid$&
12223.vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
12224This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
12225
12226.vitem &$exim_path$&
12227.vindex "&$exim_path$&"
12228This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
12229
12230.vitem &$exim_uid$&
12231.vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
12232This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
12233
12234.vitem &$exim_version$&
12235.vindex "&$exim_version$&"
12236This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
12237The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
12238Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
12239There may be other characters following the minor version.
12240This value may be overridden by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
12241
12242.vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
12243This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
12244inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
12245be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
12246characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
12247See the full description in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
12248
12249.vitem &$headers_added$&
12250.vindex "&$headers_added$&"
12251Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
12252the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
12253The headers are a newline-separated list.
12254
12255.vitem &$home$&
12256.vindex "&$home$&"
12257When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
12258directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
12259means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
12260explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
12261by a setting on the transport itself.
12262
12263When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
12264of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
12265&%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
12266
12267.vitem &$host$&
12268.vindex "&$host$&"
12269If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
12270list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
12271to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
12272to local and remote transports.
12273
12274.cindex "transport" "filter"
12275.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12276For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
12277&$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
12278particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
12279using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
12280&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
12281is connected.
12282
12283When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
12284&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
12285client is connected.
12286
12287
12288.vitem &$host_address$&
12289.vindex "&$host_address$&"
12290This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
12291for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
12292when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
12293
12294.vitem &$host_data$&
12295.vindex "&$host_data$&"
12296If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
12297result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
12298allows you, for example, to do things like this:
12299.code
12300deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
12301message = $host_data
12302.endd
12303.vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12304.cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
12305.vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12306This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
12307message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
12308name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
12309variables is set to &"1"&.
12310
12311.ilist
12312If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
12313succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12314
12315.next
12316If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
12317tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
12318lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
12319.endlist ilist
12320
12321Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
12322single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
12323names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
12324is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
12325&$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
12326IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
12327sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
12328lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
12329the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
12330&"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
12331
12332.cindex authentication "expansion item"
12333Performing these checks sets up information used by the
12334&%authresults%& expansion item.
12335
12336
12337.vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
12338.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12339See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
12340
12341.vitem &$host_port$&
12342.vindex "&$host_port$&"
12343This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
12344for an outbound connection.
12345
12346.vitem &$initial_cwd$&
12347.vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
12348This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
12349directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
12350working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
12351to &$spool_directory$& later.
12352
12353.vitem &$inode$&
12354.vindex "&$inode$&"
12355The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
12356option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
12357of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
12358a unique name for the file.
12359
12360.vitem &$interface_address$&
12361.vindex "&$interface_address$&"
12362This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
12363
12364.vitem &$interface_port$&
12365.vindex "&$interface_port$&"
12366This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
12367
12368.vitem &$item$&
12369.vindex "&$item$&"
12370This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
12371conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
12372&*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
12373empty.
12374
12375.vitem &$ldap_dn$&
12376.vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
12377This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
12378contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
12379lookup.
12380
12381.vitem &$load_average$&
12382.vindex "&$load_average$&"
12383This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
12384is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
12385variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
12386
12387.vitem &$local_part$&
12388.vindex "&$local_part$&"
12389When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
12390variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
12391delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
12392session), &$local_part$& is not set.
12393
12394Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12395&$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
12396&$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
12397because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
12398once.
12399
12400.new
12401.cindex "tainted data"
12402If the origin of the data is an incoming message,
12403the result of expanding this variable is tainted.
12404
12405&*Warning*&: the content of this variable is usually provided by a potential attacker.
12406Consider carefully the implications of using it unvalidated as a name
12407for file access.
12408This presents issues for users' &_.forward_& and filter files.
12409For traditional full user accounts, use &%check_local_users%& and the &$home$&
12410variable rather than this one.
12411For virtual users, store a suitable pathname component in the database
12412which is used for account name validation, and use that retrieved value
12413rather than this variable.
12414.wen
12415
12416.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12417.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12418.cindex affix variables
12419If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
12420value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
12421any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
12422&$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
12423
12424When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
12425result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
12426the parent address, not to the filename or command (see &$address_file$& and
12427&$address_pipe$&).
12428
12429When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
12430local part of the recipient address.
12431
12432When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12433&$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
12434it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
12435
12436In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
12437the addresses
12438.code
12439"abc:xyz"@test.example
12440abc\:xyz@test.example
12441.endd
12442the value of &$local_part$& is
12443.code
12444abc:xyz
12445.endd
12446If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
12447inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
12448have:
12449.code
12450data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
12451.endd
12452&*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
12453to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
12454&%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
12455
12456.vitem &$local_part_data$&
12457.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
12458When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
12459lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
12460router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
12461to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
12462handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
12463
12464&$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
12465matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
12466available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
12467variable expands to nothing.
12468
12469.vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
12470.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12471.cindex affix variables
12472When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12473specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12474variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12475
12476.vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
12477.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12478When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12479specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12480variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12481
12482.vitem &$local_scan_data$&
12483.vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
12484This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
12485a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12486
12487.vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12488.vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12489See &$local_user_uid$&.
12490
12491.vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12492.vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12493This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12494&%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
12495are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
12496and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
12497router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
12498are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
12499
12500.vitem &$localhost_number$&
12501.vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
12502This contains the expanded value of the
12503&%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
12504been read.
12505
12506.vitem &$log_inodes$&
12507.vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12508The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
12509log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
12510referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
12511the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
12512
12513.vitem &$log_space$&
12514.vindex "&$log_space$&"
12515The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
12516partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
12517whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
12518ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
12519the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
12520
12521
12522.vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
12523.vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
12524This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
12525a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
12526.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12527It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
12528&"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
12529and &"yes"& if it was.
12530Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
12531the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
12532as authenticated data.
12533
12534.vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
12535.vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
12536This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
12537&(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
12538&%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
12539contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
12540without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
12541variable is empty.
12542
12543.vitem &$malware_name$&
12544.vindex "&$malware_name$&"
12545This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
12546content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
12547when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
12548
12549.vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
12550.vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
12551.cindex "maximum" "line length"
12552.cindex "line length" "maximum"
12553This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
12554received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
12555character(s).
12556It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12557
12558.vitem &$message_age$&
12559.cindex "message" "age of"
12560.vindex "&$message_age$&"
12561This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
12562of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
12563delivery attempt.
12564
12565.vitem &$message_body$&
12566.cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12567.cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12568.cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12569.vindex "&$message_body$&"
12570.oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
12571This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
12572being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
12573number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
12574&%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
12575
12576.oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
12577By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
12578easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
12579this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
12580zeros are always converted into spaces.
12581
12582.vitem &$message_body_end$&
12583.cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12584.cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12585.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
12586This variable contains the final portion of a message's
12587body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
12588&$message_body$&.
12589
12590.vitem &$message_body_size$&
12591.cindex "body of message" "size"
12592.cindex "message body" "size"
12593.vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
12594When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
12595in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
12596separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
12597also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12598
12599If the spool file is wireformat
12600(see the &%spool_files_wireformat%& main option)
12601the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
12602
12603.vitem &$message_exim_id$&
12604.vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
12605When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12606unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
12607An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
12608received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
12609line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
12610&`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
12611
12612.vitem &$message_headers$&
12613.vindex &$message_headers$&
12614This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
12615is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
12616lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
12617same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
12618
12619.vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
12620.vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
12621This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
12622contents of header lines is done.
12623
12624.vitem &$message_id$&
12625This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
12626
12627.vitem &$message_linecount$&
12628.vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
12629This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
12630message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
12631During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
12632number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
12633routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
12634&'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
12635lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
12636from the body is not counted.
12637
12638As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12639appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12640&$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12641file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12642header and the body).
12643
12644Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12645.code
12646deny message = Too many lines in message header
12647 condition = \
12648 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12649.endd
12650In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12651message has not yet been received.
12652
12653This variable is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12654
12655.vitem &$message_size$&
12656.cindex "size" "of message"
12657.cindex "message" "size"
12658.vindex "&$message_size$&"
12659When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12660most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12661message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12662deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12663expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12664doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12665precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12666&$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12667
12668.cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12669While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12670contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12671value may not, of course, be truthful.
12672
12673.vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12674A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12675available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12676details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12677
12678.vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12679These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12680of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12681
12682.vitem &$original_domain$&
12683.vindex "&$domain$&"
12684.vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12685When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12686same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12687generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12688variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12689differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12690aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12691single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12692
12693If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12694filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12695part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12696
12697.vitem &$original_local_part$&
12698.vindex "&$local_part$&"
12699.vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12700When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12701same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12702local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12703part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12704filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12705the original address.
12706
12707If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12708case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12709This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12710one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12711delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12712
12713If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12714filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12715part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12716
12717.vitem &$originator_gid$&
12718.cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12719.cindex "sender" "gid"
12720.vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12721.vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
12722This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
12723message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
12724gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
12725normally the gid of the Exim user.
12726
12727.vitem &$originator_uid$&
12728.cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
12729.cindex "sender" "uid"
12730.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12731.vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
12732The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
12733messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
12734For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
12735user.
12736
12737.vitem &$parent_domain$&
12738.vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12739This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12740above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12741
12742.vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12743.vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12744This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12745(see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12746
12747.vitem &$pid$&
12748.cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12749.vindex "&$pid$&"
12750This variable contains the current process id.
12751
12752.vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12753.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12754.cindex "transport" "filter"
12755.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12756This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12757&`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12758&(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12759(described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12760It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12761variable"& error if encountered.
12762
12763.vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12764.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12765This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12766configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12767a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12768&[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12769qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12770
12771
12772.vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
12773 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
12774 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
12775 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
12776 &$proxy_session$&
12777These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
12778or SOCKS5 support.
12779For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
12780
12781.vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12782.cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12783This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12784current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12785
12786.vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12787This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12788which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12789&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12790
12791.vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12792This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12793which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12794&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12795
12796.vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12797This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12798which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12799&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12800
12801.vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12802.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12803The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12804
12805.vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12806.vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12807The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12808or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12809
12810.vitem &$queue_name$&
12811.vindex &$queue_name$&
12812.cindex "named queues"
12813.cindex queues named
12814The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
12815
12816.vitem &$r_...$&
12817.vindex &$r_...$&
12818.cindex router variables
12819Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& option of a router.
12820They can be given any name that starts with &$r_$&.
12821The values persist for the address being handled through subsequent routers
12822and the eventual transport.
12823
12824.vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12825.vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12826When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12827RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12828RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12829
12830.vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12831.vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12832.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12833When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12834RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12835temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12836
12837.vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12838.vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12839When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12840RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12841permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12842
12843.vitem &$received_count$&
12844.vindex "&$received_count$&"
12845This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12846including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12847is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12848delivering.
12849
12850.vitem &$received_for$&
12851.vindex "&$received_for$&"
12852If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12853variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12854built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12855the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12856
12857.vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12858.vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12859As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12860variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12861is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12862&$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12863the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12864option.
12865
12866As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12867could be used, for example, to make the filename for a TLS certificate depend
12868on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12869values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12870messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12871time.
12872For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12873
12874.vitem &$received_port$&
12875.vindex "&$received_port$&"
12876See &$received_ip_address$&.
12877
12878.vitem &$received_protocol$&
12879.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12880When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12881protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12882by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12883&"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12884(encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12885is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12886connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12887
12888Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12889automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12890&%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12891encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12892where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12893STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12894
12895The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12896messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12897identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12898
12899.vitem &$received_time$&
12900.vindex "&$received_time$&"
12901This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12902as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12903
12904.vitem &$recipient_data$&
12905.vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12906This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12907condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12908until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12909.display
12910&`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12911&`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12912.endd
12913&*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12914method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12915The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12916expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12917
12918.vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12919.vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12920In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12921information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12922
12923.ilist
12924&"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12925was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12926
12927.next
12928&"route"&: Routing failed.
12929
12930.next
12931&"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12932or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12933MAIL).
12934
12935.next
12936&"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12937.next
12938
12939&"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12940.endlist
12941
12942The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12943rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12944
12945.vitem &$recipients$&
12946.vindex "&$recipients$&"
12947This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12948a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12949is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12950unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12951cases:
12952
12953.olist
12954In a system filter file.
12955.next
12956In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12957is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12958&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12959&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12960.next
12961From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12962.endlist
12963
12964
12965.vitem &$recipients_count$&
12966.vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12967When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12968envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12969from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12970increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12971
12972
12973.vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12974.vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12975This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12976&%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12977
12978.vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12979.cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12980When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12981these variables contain the
12982captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12983
12984
12985.vitem &$reply_address$&
12986.vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12987When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12988&'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12989contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12990white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12991decoding or character code translation takes place.
12992
12993.vitem &$return_path$&
12994.vindex "&$return_path$&"
12995When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12996the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12997in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12998same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12999mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
13000for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
13001address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
13002that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
13003the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
13004envelope sender.
13005
13006.vitem &$return_size_limit$&
13007.vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
13008This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
13009
13010.vitem &$router_name$&
13011.cindex "router" "name"
13012.cindex "name" "of router"
13013.vindex "&$router_name$&"
13014During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
13015
13016.vitem &$runrc$&
13017.cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
13018.vindex "&$runrc$&"
13019This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
13020&%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
13021assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
13022preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
13023reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
13024another.
13025
13026.vitem &$self_hostname$&
13027.oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
13028.vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
13029When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
13030local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
13031One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
13032happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
13033original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
13034
13035.vitem &$sender_address$&
13036.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
13037When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
13038that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
13039is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
13040value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
13041
13042.vitem &$sender_address_data$&
13043.vindex "&$address_data$&"
13044.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
13045If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
13046sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
13047distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
13048after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
13049longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
13050
13051.vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
13052.vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
13053The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
13054
13055.vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
13056.vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
13057The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
13058
13059.vitem &$sender_data$&
13060.vindex "&$sender_data$&"
13061This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
13062in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
13063value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
13064this:
13065.display
13066&`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13067&`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
13068.endd
13069&*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13070method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13071The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13072expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13073
13074.vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
13075.vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
13076When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
13077name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
13078brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
13079enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
13080issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
13081looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
13082&%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
13083start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
13084verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
13085the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
13086the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
13087
13088.vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
13089.vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
13090This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
13091.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13092done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
13093
13094.vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
13095.vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
13096When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
13097command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
13098set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
13099the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
13100
13101.vitem &$sender_host_address$&
13102.vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
13103When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
13104this variable contains that
13105host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
13106
13107.vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
13108.vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
13109This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
13110driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
13111received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
13112&$authenticated_id$&.
13113
13114.vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
13115.vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
13116If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
13117(by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
13118otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
13119resolver library states that both
13120the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
13121other times, this variable is false.
13122
13123.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13124It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
13125library, by setting:
13126.code
13127dns_dnssec_ok = 1
13128.endd
13129
13130Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
13131validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
13132
13133If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
13134mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
13135
13136This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
13137DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
13138all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
13139is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
13140
13141
13142.vitem &$sender_host_name$&
13143.vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
13144When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13145host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
13146other means, this variable is empty.
13147
13148.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13149If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
13150&$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
13151A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
13152via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
13153any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
13154&$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
13155
13156.vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
13157However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
13158DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
13159&$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
13160
13161Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
13162host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
13163in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
13164is set to &"1"&.
13165
13166Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
13167maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
13168these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
13169following are true:
13170
13171.ilist
13172A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
13173.next
13174The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
13175configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
13176to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
13177.next
13178Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
13179that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
13180&<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
13181.next
13182The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
13183In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
13184EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
13185.next
13186The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
13187domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
13188. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
13189. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
13190.code
13191 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
13192.endd
13193which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
13194IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
13195.endlist
13196
13197
13198.vitem &$sender_host_port$&
13199.vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
13200When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
13201number that was used on the remote host.
13202
13203.vitem &$sender_ident$&
13204.vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
13205When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13206identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
13207been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
13208called Exim.
13209
13210.vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
13211A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
13212&%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
13213&<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
13214
13215.vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
13216.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13217.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13218.vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
13219This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
13220either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
13221there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
13222there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
13223the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
13224followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
13225first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
13226the parentheses.
13227
13228There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
13229was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
13230address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
13231all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
13232into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
13233
13234.vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
13235.vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
13236In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
13237about the failure. The details are the same as for
13238&$recipient_verify_failure$&.
13239
13240.vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
13241.vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
13242This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13243been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
13244used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
13245on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
13246connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
13247
13248.vitem &$sending_port$&
13249.vindex "&$sending_port$&"
13250This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13251been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
13252connections, see &$received_port$&.
13253
13254.vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
13255.vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
13256During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
13257host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
13258&$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
13259value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
13260
13261.vitem &$smtp_command$&
13262.vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
13263During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
13264entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
13265the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
13266.code
13267MAIL FROM:<>
13268MAIL FROM: <>
13269.endd
13270For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
13271command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
13272rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
13273the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
13274
13275.vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
13276.cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
13277.vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
13278While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
13279argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
13280space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
13281somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
13282
13283.vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
13284.cindex SMTP "command history"
13285.vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
13286A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
13287received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
13288are remembered.
13289
13290.vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
13291.vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
13292This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
13293daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
13294in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
13295connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
13296the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
13297never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
13298there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
13299single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
13300daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
13301
13302.vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
13303These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
13304that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
13305filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
13306example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
13307message is junk mail.
13308
13309.vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
13310A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
13311is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
13312&<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
13313
13314.vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
13315 &$spf_received$& &&&
13316 &$spf_result$& &&&
13317 &$spf_result_guessed$& &&&
13318 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
13319These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
13320For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
13321
13322.vitem &$spool_directory$&
13323.vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
13324The name of Exim's spool directory.
13325
13326.vitem &$spool_inodes$&
13327.vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13328The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
13329being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
13330If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
13331is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
13332
13333.vitem &$spool_space$&
13334.vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13335The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
13336Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
13337variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
13338find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
13339value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
13340megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
13341.code
13342condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
13343.endd
13344See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
13345
13346
13347.vitem &$thisaddress$&
13348.vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
13349This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
13350command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
13351command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
13352interfaces to mail filtering'&.
13353
13354.vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
13355.vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
13356Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13357on the inbound connection; the meaning of
13358this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13359If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13360The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
13361when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
13362
13363The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
13364except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13365the outbound.
13366
13367.vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
13368.vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
13369Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13370on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
13371this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13372If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13373
13374.vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
13375.vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
13376.cindex certificate variables
13377This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13378inbound connection when the message was received.
13379It is only useful as the argument of a
13380&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13381or a &%def%& condition.
13382
13383&*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
13384when a list of more than one
13385file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
13386The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
13387
13388.vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
13389.vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
13390This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13391inbound connection when the message was received.
13392It is only useful as the argument of a
13393&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13394or a &%def%& condition.
13395If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13396which is not the leaf.
13397
13398.vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
13399.vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
13400This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13401outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13402&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13403or a &%def%& condition.
13404
13405.vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
13406.vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
13407This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13408outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13409&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13410or a &%def%& condition.
13411If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13412which is not the leaf.
13413
13414.vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
13415.vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
13416This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
13417message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
13418
13419The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
13420except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13421the outbound.
13422
13423.vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
13424.vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
13425This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
13426outbound SMTP connection was made,
13427and &"0"& otherwise.
13428
13429.vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
13430.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13431.vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13432When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13433connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
13434example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
13435received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
13436&$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
13437non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
13438
13439The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
13440but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
13441becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
13442
13443.vitem &$tls_in_cipher_std$&
13444.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher_std$&"
13445As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13446
13447.vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
13448.vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
13449This variable is
13450cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
13451and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
13452&<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
13453details of the &(smtp)& transport.
13454
13455.vitem &$tls_out_cipher_std$&
13456.vindex "&$tls_out_cipher_std$&"
13457As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13458
13459.vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
13460.vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
13461DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13462
13463.vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
13464.vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
13465When a message is received from a remote client connection
13466the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
13467.code
134680 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
134691 No response to request
134702 Response not verified
134713 Verification failed
134724 Verification succeeded
13473.endd
13474
13475.vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
13476.vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
13477When a message is sent to a remote host connection
13478the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
13479See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
13480
13481.vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
13482.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
13483.vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
13484.cindex certificate "extracting fields"
13485When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13486connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
13487the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13488&$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13489If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13490which is not the leaf.
13491
13492The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
13493except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13494the outbound.
13495
13496.vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
13497.vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
13498When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13499connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
13500the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13501&$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13502If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13503which is not the leaf.
13504
13505.vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
13506.vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
13507.vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
13508.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13509When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
13510Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
13511If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
13512some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
13513will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
13514a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
13515used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
13516
13517The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
13518except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13519the outbound.
13520
13521.vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
13522.vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
13523.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13524During outbound
13525SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
13526the transport.
13527
13528.vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13529.vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13530Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13531
13532.vitem &$tls_in_ver$&
13533.vindex "&$tls_in_ver$&"
13534When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
13535this variable is set to the protocol version, eg &'TLS1.2'&.
13536
13537.vitem &$tls_out_ver$&
13538.vindex "&$tls_out_ver$&"
13539When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
13540this variable is set to the protocol version.
13541
13542
13543.vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
13544.vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
13545The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
13546files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
13547
13548.vitem &$tod_epoch$&
13549.vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
13550The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13551
13552.vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
13553.vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
13554The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13555
13556.vitem &$tod_full$&
13557.vindex "&$tod_full$&"
13558A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
13559+0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
13560positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
13561values for those that are behind (west).
13562
13563.vitem &$tod_log$&
13564.vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13565The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
135661995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
13567
13568.vitem &$tod_logfile$&
13569.vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
13570This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
13571is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
13572flag.
13573
13574.vitem &$tod_zone$&
13575.vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13576This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
13577-0500.
13578
13579.vitem &$tod_zulu$&
13580.vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
13581This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
13582by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
13583
13584.vitem &$transport_name$&
13585.cindex "transport" "name"
13586.cindex "name" "of transport"
13587.vindex "&$transport_name$&"
13588During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
13589
13590.vitem &$value$&
13591.vindex "&$value$&"
13592This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
13593or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
13594&*reduce*& expansion.
13595
13596.vitem &$verify_mode$&
13597.vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
13598While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
13599contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
13600Otherwise, empty.
13601
13602.vitem &$version_number$&
13603.vindex "&$version_number$&"
13604The version number of Exim. Same as &$exim_version$&, may be overridden
13605by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
13606
13607.vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
13608.vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
13609This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13610delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13611
13612.vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
13613.vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
13614This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13615delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13616.endlist
13617.ecindex IIDstrexp
13618
13619
13620
13621. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13622. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13623
13624.chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
13625.scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
13626Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
13627Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
13628use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
13629your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
13630the line
13631.code
13632EXIM_PERL = perl.o
13633.endd
13634in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
13635
13636
13637.section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
13638.oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
13639Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
13640&%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
13641no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
13642interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
13643the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
13644option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
13645a newly created Perl interpreter.
13646
13647The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
13648need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
13649should usually be something like
13650.code
13651perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
13652.endd
13653where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
13654use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
13655soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
13656the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
13657its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
13658fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
13659necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
13660the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
13661two ways:
13662
13663.ilist
13664.oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
13665Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
13666a startup when Exim is entered.
13667.next
13668The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
13669overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
13670.endlist
13671
13672There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
13673initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
13674
13675.ilist
13676.oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
13677.cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
13678To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
13679interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
13680taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
13681option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
13682defaults to false.
13683
13684
13685.section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
13686When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
13687of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
13688by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
13689forms:
13690.code
13691${perl{foo}}
13692${perl{foo}{argument}}
13693${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
13694.endd
13695which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
13696arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
13697with an error message of the form
13698.code
13699Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
13700.endd
13701The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
13702it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
13703return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
13704an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
13705by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
13706that was passed to &%die%&.
13707
13708
13709.section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
13710Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
13711is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
13712the Perl code
13713.code
13714my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
13715.endd
13716makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
13717Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
13718&$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
13719
13720If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
13721&'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
13722expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
13723an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
13724
13725.cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
13726.cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
13727Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
13728&'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
13729debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
13730&'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
13731timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
13732
13733
13734.section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
13735.cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
13736You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
13737Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
13738before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
13739SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
13740is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
13741error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
13742avoided, but the output is lost.
13743
13744.cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
13745The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
13746Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
13747you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
13748output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
13749change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
13750For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
13751.code
13752$SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
13753.endd
13754Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
13755example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
13756include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
13757as the first subroutine argument.
13758.ecindex IIDperl
13759
13760
13761. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13762. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13763
13764.chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
13765 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
13766 "Starting the daemon"
13767.cindex "daemon" "starting"
13768.cindex "interface" "listening"
13769.cindex "network interface"
13770.cindex "interface" "network"
13771.cindex "IP address" "for listening"
13772.cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
13773.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
13774.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13775A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
13776hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
13777or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
13778works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
13779In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
13780IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
13781knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
13782
13783.olist
13784When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
13785and ports to listen on.
13786.next
13787When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
13788are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
13789processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
13790same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
13791when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
13792local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
13793option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
13794as an error situation.
13795.next
13796When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
13797for the outgoing connection.
13798.endlist
13799
13800
13801Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
13802of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
13803addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
13804standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
13805rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
13806
13807In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
13808interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
13809options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
13810chapter describes how they operate.
13811
13812When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
13813actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13814
13815
13816
13817.section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
13818When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
13819option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
13820following options:
13821
13822.ilist
13823&%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
13824or service names.
13825(For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
13826.next
13827&%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
13828listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
13829.endlist
13830
13831The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
13832described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
13833it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
13834colons. For example:
13835.code
13836local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
13837 192.168.23.65 ; \
13838 ::1 ; \
13839 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13840.endd
13841There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13842in &%local_interfaces%&:
13843
13844.olist
13845The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13846on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13847.code
13848local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13849 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13850.endd
13851.next
13852The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13853with a colon separator, for example:
13854.code
13855local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13856 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13857.endd
13858.endlist
13859
13860When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13861default setting contains just one port:
13862.code
13863daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13864.endd
13865If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13866specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13867&%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13868&_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13869IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13870
13871
13872
13873.section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13874The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13875as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13876case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13877instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13878default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13879.code
13880local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13881.endd
13882when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13883.code
13884local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13885.endd
13886Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13887
13888
13889
13890.section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13891The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13892&%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13893instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13894option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13895the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13896exim.
13897
13898The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13899changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) if required.
13900If there are any items that do not
13901contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13902&%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13903items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13904replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13905.code
13906-oX 1225
13907.endd
13908overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13909whereas
13910.code
13911-oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13912.endd
13913overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13914(However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13915value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13916
13917
13918
13919.section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13920.cindex "submissions protocol"
13921.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13922.cindex "smtps protocol"
13923.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13924.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13925Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
13926&"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
13927For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
13928STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
13929the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
13930If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
13931(Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
13932the 465 TCP ports.
13933
13934If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
13935service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
13936proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
13937
13938The common use of this option is expected to be
13939.code
13940tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13941.endd
13942per RFC 8314.
13943There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
13944to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
13945
13946&*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13947daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13948&%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13949because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13950connections via the daemon.)
13951
13952
13953
13954
13955.section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13956.cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13957IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13958can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13959interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13960address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13961percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13962adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13963.code
13964fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13965.endd
13966To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13967allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13968to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13969percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13970address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13971&[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13972.code
13973IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13974.endd
13975is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13976Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13977instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13978function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13979&[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13980
13981.section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13982.cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13983Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13984run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13985using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13986connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13987.oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13988&%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13989activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13990that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13991etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13992to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13993
13994On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13995disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13996option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13997and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13998IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13999
14000
14001
14002.section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
14003The default case in an IPv6 environment is
14004.code
14005daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
14006local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14007.endd
14008This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
14009Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
14010the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
14011read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
14012
14013To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
14014.code
14015daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
14016.endd
14017(leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
14018.code
14019local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
14020 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
14021.endd
14022To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
14023IPv4 loopback address only:
14024.code
14025local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
14026.endd
14027To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
14028.code
14029local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
14030.endd
14031&*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
14032
14033
14034
14035.section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
14036The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
14037whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
14038addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
14039treated as local.
14040
14041For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
14042the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
14043available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
14044(that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
14045
14046Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
14047many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
14048email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
14049interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
14050&%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
14051&"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
14052used for listening. Consider this example:
14053.code
14054local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
14055 192.168.53.235 ; \
14056 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
14057
14058extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14059.endd
14060The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
14061address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
14062Exim is routing.
14063
14064In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
14065address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
14066desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
14067these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
14068This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
14069during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
14070host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
14071addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
14072
14073
14074
14075.section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
14076Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
14077allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
14078there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
14079&%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
14080description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
14081details.
14082
14083
14084
14085
14086. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14087. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14088
14089.chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
14090.scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
14091.scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
14092The first part of the runtime configuration file contains three types of item:
14093
14094.ilist
14095Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
14096&<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
14097.next
14098Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
14099&"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
14100section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
14101.next
14102Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
14103(with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
14104&"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
14105only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
14106settings.
14107.endlist
14108
14109This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
14110types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
14111in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
14112are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
14113an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
14114listed in more than one group.
14115
14116.section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
14117.table2
14118.row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
14119.row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
14120.row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14121.row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
14122.row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
14123.row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
14124.row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
14125.row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
14126.row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
14127.row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
14128.row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
14129.endtable
14130
14131
14132.section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
14133.table2
14134.row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
14135.row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14136.row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
14137.row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
14138.row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
14139.row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
14140.endtable
14141
14142
14143
14144.section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
14145.table2
14146.row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
14147.row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
14148.row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
14149.row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
14150.row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14151.row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14152.row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
14153.row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
14154.row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
14155.row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
14156.row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
14157.row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
14158.endtable
14159
14160
14161
14162.section "Logging" "SECID99"
14163.table2
14164.row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
14165.row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
14166.row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14167.row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
14168.row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
14169.row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
14170.row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
14171.row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
14172.row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
14173.row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
14174.row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
14175.row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
14176.row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
14177.row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
14178.row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
14179.endtable
14180
14181
14182
14183.section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
14184.table2
14185.row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
14186.row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
14187.row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
14188.row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
14189.endtable
14190
14191
14192
14193.section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
14194.table2
14195.row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
14196.row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14197.row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14198.row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
14199.row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
14200.row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
14201.row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
14202.row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
14203.row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
14204.row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
14205.row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
14206.row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
14207.row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
14208.row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
14209.row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
14210.endtable
14211
14212
14213
14214.section "Message ids" "SECID102"
14215.table2
14216.row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
14217.row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
14218.endtable
14219
14220
14221
14222.section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
14223.table2
14224.row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
14225.row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
14226.row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
14227.endtable
14228
14229
14230
14231.section "Daemon" "SECID104"
14232.table2
14233.row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
14234.row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
14235.row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
14236.row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
14237.row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
14238.row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14239.row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14240.endtable
14241
14242
14243
14244.section "Resource control" "SECID105"
14245.table2
14246.row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14247.row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
14248.row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14249.row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
14250.row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
14251.row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
14252.row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14253.row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14254.row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14255.row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14256.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14257.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14258.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14259.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14260.row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14261.row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14262 connection"
14263.row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14264.row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14265.row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14266.row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
14267.row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14268.endtable
14269
14270
14271
14272.section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
14273.table2
14274.row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
14275.row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
14276.row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
14277.row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
14278.row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
14279.row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
14280.row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
14281.row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
14282.row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
14283.row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
14284.row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
14285.row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
14286.row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
14287.row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
14288.row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
14289.row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
14290.row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
14291.row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
14292.row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
14293.row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
14294.row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
14295.row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14296 words""&"
14297.row &%dns_cname_loops%& "follow CNAMEs returned by resolver"
14298.row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
14299.row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
14300.row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14301.row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14302.row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
14303.row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
14304.row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
14305.row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
14306.row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
14307.row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14308.row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14309.row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
14310.row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
14311.row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
14312.row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
14313.row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
14314.row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14315.row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
14316.row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
14317.endtable
14318
14319
14320
14321.section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
14322.table2
14323.row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
14324 item"
14325.row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
14326 item"
14327.row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
14328.row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
14329.row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
14330.endtable
14331
14332
14333
14334.section "TLS" "SECID108"
14335.table2
14336.row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
14337.row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
14338.row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
14339.row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14340.row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
14341.row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
14342.row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
14343.row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
14344.row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
14345.row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
14346.row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
14347.row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
14348.row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
14349.row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
14350.row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
14351.row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
14352.row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
14353.endtable
14354
14355
14356
14357.section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
14358.table2
14359.row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
14360.row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
14361.row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
14362.row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
14363.row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
14364.row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
14365.row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
14366.row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
14367.endtable
14368
14369
14370
14371.section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
14372.table2
14373.row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14374.row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14375.row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
14376.row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14377.row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
14378.row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
14379.row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
14380.row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
14381.endtable
14382
14383
14384
14385
14386.section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
14387.table2
14388.row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
14389.endtable
14390
14391
14392
14393
14394
14395.section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
14396See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
14397
14398.table2
14399.row &%dkim_verify_hashes%& "DKIM hash methods accepted for signatures"
14400.row &%dkim_verify_keytypes%& "DKIM key types accepted for signatures"
14401.row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domains for which DKIM ACL is run"
14402.row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14403.row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14404.row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
14405.row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
14406.row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
14407.row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
14408.row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
14409.row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14410.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14411.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14412.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14413.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14414.row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14415.row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14416 connection"
14417.row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14418.row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
14419.row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
14420.row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14421.row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14422.row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
14423.row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
14424.row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
14425.row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
14426.row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
14427.row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
14428.row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
14429.row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
14430.row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
14431.row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14432.row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14433.endtable
14434
14435
14436
14437.section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
14438.table2
14439.row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
14440.row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
14441.row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
14442.row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
14443.row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
14444.row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
14445.row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14446.row &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14447.row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
14448.row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
14449.row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14450.endtable
14451
14452
14453
14454.section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
14455.table2
14456.row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
14457.row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
14458.row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
14459.row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14460 words""&"
14461.row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14462.row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14463.row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
14464.row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
14465.row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
14466.row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
14467.row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14468.row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
14469.row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
14470.row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
14471.endtable
14472
14473
14474
14475.section "System filter" "SECID115"
14476.table2
14477.row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
14478.row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
14479 directory"
14480.row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
14481.row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
14482.row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
14483.row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
14484.row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
14485.endtable
14486
14487
14488
14489.section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
14490.table2
14491.row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14492.row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
14493.row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
14494.row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
14495.row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
14496.row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
14497.row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
14498.row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
14499.row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
14500.row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
14501.row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
14502.row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
14503.row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
14504.row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
14505.row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
14506.row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14507.row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
14508.row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
14509.row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
14510.row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
14511.row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14512.row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
14513.row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
14514.row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
14515.endtable
14516
14517
14518
14519.section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
14520.table2
14521.row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
14522.row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
14523.row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
14524.row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
14525.row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
14526.row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
14527.row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
14528.row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
14529.row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
14530.row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
14531.row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
14532.row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
14533.row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
14534.row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14535.row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
14536.endtable
14537
14538
14539
14540.section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
14541Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
14542&dagger;.
14543
14544.option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
14545.cindex "8BITMIME"
14546.cindex "8-bit characters"
14547.cindex "log" "selectors"
14548.cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
14549This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
14550EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
14551However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
14552takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
14553
14554Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
14555feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
14556It now defaults to true.
14557A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
14558.display
14559&url(https://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
14560.endd
14561
14562To log received 8BITMIME status use
14563.code
14564log_selector = +8bitmime
14565.endd
14566
14567.option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
14568.cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
14569.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14570This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
14571read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14572further details.
14573
14574.option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14575This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
14576messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
14577SMTP messages.
14578
14579.option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
14580.cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
14581.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14582This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
14583non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14584
14585.option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
14586.cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
14587.cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
14588This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
14589received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14590
14591.option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
14592.cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
14593This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
14594See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14595
14596.option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
14597.cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
14598This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
14599processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
14600acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14601
14602.option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
14603.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
14604.cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
14605.cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
14606.cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
14607This option defines the ACL that,
14608if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
14609is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
14610processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
14611acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14612
14613.option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
14614.cindex DKIM "ACL for"
14615This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
14616(by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
14617of a received message.
14618See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
14619
14620.option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
14621.cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
14622This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
14623received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14624
14625.option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
14626.cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
14627This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
14628received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14629
14630.option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
14631.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
14632.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
14633This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
14634command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14635
14636
14637.option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
14638.cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
14639This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
14640received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14641
14642.option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
14643.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
14644This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
14645a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
14646&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
14647
14648.option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14649.cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
14650This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
14651extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
14652section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
14653
14654.option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
14655.cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
14656This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
14657ends without a QUIT command being received.
14658See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14659
14660.option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
14661This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
14662received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14663further details.
14664
14665.option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
14666.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
14667This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
14668received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14669
14670.option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
14671.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
14672This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
14673received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14674
14675.option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
14676.cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
14677This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
14678received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14679
14680.option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
14681.cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
14682This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
14683received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14684
14685.option add_environment main "string list" empty
14686.cindex "environment" "set values"
14687This option adds individual environment variables that the
14688currently linked libraries and programs in child processes may use.
14689Each list element should be of the form &"name=value"&.
14690
14691See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
14692
14693.option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
14694.cindex "admin user"
14695This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
14696current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
14697colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
14698programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
14699admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
14700not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
14701To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
14702
14703.option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
14704.cindex "domain literal"
14705If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
14706email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
14707format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
14708has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
14709
14710Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
14711format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
14712addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
14713&%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
14714domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
14715configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
14716the local host's IP addresses.
14717
14718
14719.option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
14720.cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
14721It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
14722and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
14723MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
14724that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
14725practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
14726&%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
14727recommended, except when you have no other choice.
14728
14729.option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
14730.cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
14731.cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
14732Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
14733camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
14734that at least two other MTAs permit this.
14735This option allows Exim users to experiment if they wish.
14736
14737If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
14738UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
14739letters, digits, and hyphens.
14740
14741If Exim is built with internationalization support
14742and the SMTPUTF8 ESMTP option is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>&)
14743this option can be left as default.
14744Without that,
14745if you want to look up such domain names in the DNS, you must also
14746adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
14747suitable setting is:
14748.code
14749dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
14750 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
14751.endd
14752Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
14753.code
14754dns_check_names_pattern =
14755.endd
14756That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
14757
14758
14759.option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14760.cindex "authentication" "advertising"
14761.cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
14762If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
14763response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
14764Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
14765Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
14766advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
14767authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
14768&%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
14769authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
14770
14771Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
14772and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
14773not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
14774authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
14775to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
14776which Exim advertises AUTH.
14777
14778.cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
14779If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
14780is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
14781option is expanded, with a setting like this:
14782.code
14783auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
14784.endd
14785.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14786If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
14787the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
14788expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
14789
14790
14791.option auto_thaw main time 0s
14792.cindex "thawing messages"
14793.cindex "unfreezing messages"
14794If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
14795new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
14796this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
14797being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
14798saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
14799
14800&*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
14801&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
14802thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
14803
14804
14805.option av_scanner main string "see below"
14806This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
14807It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
14808.code
14809sophie:/var/run/sophie
14810.endd
14811If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
14812before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
14813
14814
14815.option bi_command main string unset
14816.oindex "&%-bi%&"
14817This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
14818the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
14819just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
14820required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
14821
14822
14823.option bounce_message_file main string unset
14824.cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
14825.cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
14826This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
14827for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
14828chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
14829
14830
14831.option bounce_message_text main string unset
14832When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
14833message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
14834delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
14835
14836.option bounce_return_body main boolean true
14837.cindex "bounce message" "including body"
14838This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
14839bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
14840causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
14841value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
14842message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
14843error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
14844point at which the error was detected are returned.
14845.cindex "bounce message" "including original"
14846
14847.option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
14848.cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
14849.cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
14850.cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
14851This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
14852that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
14853when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
14854The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
14855If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
14856treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
14857
14858The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
14859during reception of a message.
14860In this case lines from the original are truncated.
14861
14862The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
14863
14864
14865.option bounce_return_message main boolean true
14866If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
14867bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
14868&%bounce_return_body%&.
14869
14870
14871.option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
14872.cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
14873.cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
14874.cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
14875This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
14876senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
14877limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
14878any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
14879that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
14880
14881When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
14882greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
14883added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
14884to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
14885size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
14886messages.
14887
14888.option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
14889.cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
14890.cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
14891.cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
14892This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
14893bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
14894connection. A typical setting might be:
14895.code
14896bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14897.endd
14898which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14899.code
14900MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14901.endd
14902The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14903address.
14904
14905.option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14906.cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14907.cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14908This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14909domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14910section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14911
14912
14913.option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14914This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14915domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14916section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14917
14918
14919.option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14920This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14921address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14922section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14923
14924
14925.option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14926This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14927address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14928section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14929
14930
14931.option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14932This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14933callout verification. The default value is
14934.code
14935$primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14936.endd
14937See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14938
14939
14940.option check_log_inodes main integer 100
14941See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14942
14943
14944.option check_log_space main integer 10M
14945See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14946
14947.oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14948.cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14949.option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14950RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14951system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14952word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14953multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14954exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14955of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14956set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14957
14958
14959.option check_spool_inodes main integer 100
14960See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14961
14962
14963.option check_spool_space main integer 10M
14964.cindex "checking disk space"
14965.cindex "disk space, checking"
14966.cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14967The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14968message is accepted.
14969
14970.vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14971.vindex "&$log_space$&"
14972.vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14973.vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14974When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14975want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14976testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14977&$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14978
14979
14980&%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14981either value is greater than zero, for example:
14982.code
14983check_spool_space = 100M
14984check_spool_inodes = 100
14985.endd
14986The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14987SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14988transit.
14989
14990&%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14991files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14992&%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14993
14994If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14995incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14996error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14997SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14998&%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14999&%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
15000
15001The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
15002number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
15003If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
15004
15005For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
15006failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
15007it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
15008
15009There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
15010Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
15011high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
15012may wish to deliberately disable them.
15013
15014.option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15015.cindex CHUNKING advertisement
15016.cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
15017The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
15018these hosts.
15019Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
15020
15021.option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
15022.cindex "restricting access to features"
15023This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
15024administrative user.
15025This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
15026
15027.option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
15028.cindex debugging "memory corruption"
15029.cindex memory debugging
15030This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
15031management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
15032it should normally be left as default.
15033
15034.option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
15035.cindex "port" "for daemon"
15036.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
15037This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
15038listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
15039backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
15040
15041.option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
15042.cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
15043This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
15044the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
15045(typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
15046defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
15047&%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
15048
15049.option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
15050See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
15051
15052.option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
15053.cindex "warning of delay"
15054.cindex "delay warning, specifying"
15055.cindex "queue" "delay warning"
15056When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
15057intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
15058after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
15059string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
15060message has been in the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
15061between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
15062with
15063.code
15064delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
15065.endd
15066the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
15067the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
15068because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
15069just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
15070.code
15071delay_warning = 6h
15072.endd
15073messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
15074a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
15075.code
15076delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
15077.endd
15078Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
15079which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
15080Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
15081
15082.option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
15083.vindex "&$domain$&"
15084The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
15085deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
15086expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
15087forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
15088&"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
15089not sent. The default is:
15090.code
15091delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
15092 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
15093 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
15094 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
15095 } {no}{yes}}
15096.endd
15097This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
15098&'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
15099&"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
15100&"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
15101
15102.option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
15103.cindex "unprivileged delivery"
15104.cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
15105If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
15106delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
15107the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
15108of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
15109chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
15110
15111.option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
15112.cindex "load average"
15113.cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
15114When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
15115becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
15116ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
15117See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15118
15119
15120.option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
15121.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
15122Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
15123message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15124handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
15125should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
15126removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
15127occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15128
15129.option disable_fsync main boolean false
15130.cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
15131This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
15132ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
15133a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
15134build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
15135really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
15136distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
15137
15138When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
15139updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
15140such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
15141Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
15142
15143
15144.option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
15145.cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
15146If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
15147activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
15148that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
15149etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
15150to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
15151
15152
15153.new
15154.option dkim_verify_hashes main "string list" "sha256 : sha512"
15155.cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
15156This option gives a list of hash types which are acceptable in signatures,
15157.wen
15158and an order of processing.
15159Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15160
15161Acceptable values include:
15162.code
15163sha1
15164sha256
15165sha512
15166.endd
15167
15168Note that the acceptance of sha1 violates RFC 8301.
15169
15170.option dkim_verify_keytypes main "string list" "ed25519 : rsa"
15171This option gives a list of key types which are acceptable in signatures,
15172and an order of processing.
15173Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15174
15175.option dkim_verify_minimal main boolean false
15176If set to true, verification of signatures will terminate after the
15177first success.
15178
15179.option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
15180.cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
15181This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
15182It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
15183the ACL once for each signature in the message.
15184See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
15185
15186
15187.option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
15188.cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
15189DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
15190&"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
15191keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
15192incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
15193may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
15194anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
15195This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
15196by a setting such as this:
15197.code
15198dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
15199.endd
15200This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
15201&[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
15202since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
15203&(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
15204when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
15205options are applied after this global option.
15206
15207.option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
15208.cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
15209When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
15210names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
15211the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
15212contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
15213a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
15214done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
15215value of this option. The default pattern is
15216.code
15217dns_check_names_pattern = \
15218 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
15219.endd
15220which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
15221they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
15222permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
15223accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
15224&%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
15225empty string.
15226
15227.option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
15228This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
15229DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15230
15231.option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
15232This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
15233reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
15234section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15235
15236.option dns_cname_loops main integer 1
15237.cindex DNS "CNAME following"
15238This option controls the following of CNAME chains, needed if the resolver does
15239not do it internally.
15240As of 2018 most should, and the default can be left.
15241If you have an ancient one, a value of 10 is likely needed.
15242
15243The default value of one CNAME-follow is needed
15244thanks to the observed return for an MX request,
15245given no MX presence but a CNAME to an A, of the CNAME.
15246
15247
15248.option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
15249.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15250.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15251If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15252DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
15253default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
15254
15255If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
15256
15257
15258.option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
15259.cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
15260.cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
15261.cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
15262When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
15263looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
15264(A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
15265domain matches this list.
15266
15267This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
15268not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
15269servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
15270Note that all lookups, including those done for verification, are affected;
15271this will result in verify failure for IPv6 connections or ones using names
15272only valid for IPv6 addresses.
15273
15274
15275.option dns_retrans main time 0s
15276.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15277.cindex timeout "dns lookup"
15278.cindex "DNS" timeout
15279The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
15280retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
15281defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
15282time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
15283totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
15284take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
15285parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
15286but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
15287to set in them.
15288See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
15289
15290
15291.option dns_retry main integer 0
15292See &%dns_retrans%& above.
15293
15294
15295.option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
15296.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15297.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15298If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
15299(Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
15300DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
15301match with this expanded domain list.
15302
15303Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
15304authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
15305bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
15306mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
15307Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
15308a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
15309
15310Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
15311to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
15312zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
15313
15314If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
15315in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
15316authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
15317authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
15318record in the authoritative section is used instead.
15319
15320.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15321.option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
15322.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15323.cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
15324.cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
15325If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15326DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
15327the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
15328on.
15329
15330If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
15331
15332OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
15333means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
15334is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
15335
15336
15337.option drop_cr main boolean false
15338This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
15339handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
15340described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
15341
15342.option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15343.cindex "bounce messages" "success"
15344.cindex "DSN" "success"
15345.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
15346DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
15347and accepted from, these hosts.
15348Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
15349and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
15350A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
15351A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
15352are sent.
15353
15354.option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
15355.cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
15356.cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
15357This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
15358bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
15359Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
15360.code
15361dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
15362.endd
15363The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
15364panic is logged, and the default value is used.
15365
15366.option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
15367.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
15368Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
15369message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15370handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
15371message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
15372be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
15373the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
15374delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15375
15376
15377.option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
15378.cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
15379.cindex "copy of bounce message"
15380Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
15381generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
15382coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
15383items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
15384a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
15385must be enclosed in double quotes.
15386
15387Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
15388(see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
15389the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
15390items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
15391are examined. For example:
15392.code
15393errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
15394 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
15395 postmaster@mydomain.example
15396.endd
15397.vindex "&$domain$&"
15398.vindex "&$local_part$&"
15399The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
15400and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
15401there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
15402.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
15403variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
15404
15405
15406.option errors_reply_to main string unset
15407.cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
15408By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
15409.display
15410&`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
15411.endd
15412.oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
15413where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
15414A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
15415&(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
15416overrides the default.
15417
15418Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
15419&%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
15420and warning messages. For example:
15421.code
15422errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
15423.endd
15424The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
15425address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
15426&%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
15427own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
15428not used.
15429
15430
15431.option event_action main string&!! unset
15432.cindex events
15433This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
15434For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
15435
15436
15437.option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
15438.cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
15439.cindex "Exim group"
15440This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15441privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
15442option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
15443of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
15444configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
15445security issues.
15446
15447
15448.option exim_path main string "see below"
15449.cindex "Exim binary, path name"
15450This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
15451needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
15452the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
15453is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
15454other place.
15455&*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
15456you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
15457where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
15458settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
15459
15460
15461.option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
15462.cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
15463.cindex "Exim user"
15464This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15465privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
15466time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
15467options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
15468
15469Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
15470&[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
15471not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
15472used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
15473
15474
15475.option exim_version main string "current version"
15476.cindex "Exim version"
15477.cindex customizing "version number"
15478.cindex "version number of Exim" override
15479This option overrides the &$version_number$&/&$exim_version$& that Exim reports in
15480various places. Use with care; this may fool stupid security scanners.
15481
15482
15483.option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
15484This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
15485routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
15486&<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
15487
15488
15489. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15490. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15491
15492.option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
15493 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
15494.oindex "&%-t%&"
15495.cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
15496.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
15497According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
15498are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
15499envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
15500line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
15501behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
15502command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
15503&%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
15504argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
15505addresses.
15506
15507
15508.option finduser_retries main integer 0
15509.cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
15510On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
15511distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
15512related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
15513Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
15514errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
15515many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
15516retries.
15517
15518.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
15519You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
15520a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
15521search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
15522
15523
15524
15525.option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
15526.cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
15527On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
15528ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
15529delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
15530&%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
15531feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
15532warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
15533freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
15534is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
15535supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
15536message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
15537freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
15538log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
15539logging that you require.
15540
15541
15542.option gecos_name main string&!! unset
15543.cindex "HP-UX"
15544.cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
15545Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
15546password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
15547looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
15548headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
15549of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
15550it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
15551upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
15552
15553When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
15554expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
15555login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
15556user's name.
15557
15558.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
15559Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
15560pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
15561name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
15562.code
15563gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
15564gecos_name = $1
15565.endd
15566
15567.option gecos_pattern main string unset
15568See &%gecos_name%& above.
15569
15570
15571.option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
15572This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
15573server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
15574implementations of TLS.
15575
15576
15577.option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
15578This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
15579the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
15580
15581See
15582&url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
15583for documentation.
15584
15585
15586
15587.option headers_charset main string "see below"
15588This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
15589&"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
15590default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
15591ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
15592insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
15593
15594
15595
15596.option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
15597.cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
15598.cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
15599This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
15600section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
15601&_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
15602sections are rejected.
15603
15604
15605.option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
15606.cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
15607.cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
15608This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
15609all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
15610header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
15611zero means &"no limit"&.
15612
15613
15614
15615
15616.option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15617.cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
15618.cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
15619Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
15620mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
15621some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
15622this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
15623if you want to do semantic checking.
15624See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
15625set.
15626
15627
15628.option helo_allow_chars main string unset
15629.cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
15630.cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
15631.cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
15632This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
15633all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
15634hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
15635.code
15636helo_allow_chars = _
15637.endd
15638Note that the value is one string, not a list.
15639
15640
15641.option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
15642.cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15643.cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15644If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
15645list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
15646default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
15647its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
15648do.
15649
15650
15651.option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15652.cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
15653.cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
15654By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
15655&%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
15656to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
15657condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
15658Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
15659to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
15660necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
15661encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
15662Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
15663
15664When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
15665&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
15666EHLO command either:
15667
15668.ilist
15669is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
15670.next
15671.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
15672.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
15673matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
15674calling host address, or
15675.next
15676when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
15677.endlist
15678
15679However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
15680fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
15681be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
15682
15683If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
15684.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15685&$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
15686
15687.option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15688.cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
15689.cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
15690Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
15691backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
15692name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
15693&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
15694rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
15695If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
15696error.
15697
15698.option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15699.cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
15700.cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
15701This option allows mail for particular domains to be held in the queue
15702manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
15703&%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
15704verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
15705item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
15706it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
15707
15708This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
15709delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
15710configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
15711domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
15712&%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
15713
15714A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
15715messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
15716time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
15717retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
15718
15719
15720.option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
15721.cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
15722Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
15723is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
15724&%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
15725option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
15726default configuration file contains
15727.code
15728host_lookup = *
15729.endd
15730which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
15731is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
15732
15733After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
15734has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
15735this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
15736
15737.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
15738.vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
15739After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
15740unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
15741&%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
15742&`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
15743
15744
15745.option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
15746This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
15747to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
15748first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
15749if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
15750if you want.
15751
15752&*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
15753multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
15754&_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
15755case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
15756
15757
15758
15759.option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
15760.cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
15761If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
15762as soon as the connection is made.
15763This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
15764nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
15765connections immediately.
15766
15767The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
15768ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
15769sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
15770incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
15771chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
15772
15773
15774.option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
15775.cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
15776This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
15777happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
15778you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
15779127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
15780the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
15781list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
15782local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
15783.code
15784hosts_connection_nolog = :
15785.endd
15786If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
15787
15788
15789
15790.option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
15791.cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
15792This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
15793connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
15794
15795
15796.option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
15797.cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
15798.cindex "host" "treated as local"
15799If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
15800if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
15801records
15802or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
15803host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
15804
15805This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
15806&`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
15807section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
15808&(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
15809that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
15810chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
15811interfaces and recognizing the local host.
15812
15813
15814.option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
15815.cindex "InterBase" "server list"
15816This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
15817to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15818The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
15819
15820
15821
15822.option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
15823.cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
15824.cindex "discarding bounce message"
15825This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
15826that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
15827suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
15828
15829After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
15830because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
15831message has been in the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
15832the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
15833again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
15834bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
15835for frozen messages. For example,
15836.code
15837ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
15838.endd
15839retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
15840failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
15841failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
15842value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
15843dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
15844&%timeout_frozen_after%&.
15845
15846
15847.option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15848.cindex "&""From""& line"
15849.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15850Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
15851the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
15852message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
15853such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
15854match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
15855process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
15856&%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
15857
15858
15859.option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
15860See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
15861
15862.option keep_environment main "string list" unset
15863.cindex "environment" "values from"
15864This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
15865You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
15866these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
15867during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
15868installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
15869environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
15870external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
15871
15872Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
15873(&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
15874
15875WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
15876FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
15877unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
15878that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
15879
15880Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
15881&%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
15882current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
15883anymore.
15884
15885See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
15886environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
15887transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
15888details.
15889
15890
15891.option keep_malformed main time 4d
15892This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
15893have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
15894next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
15895logged.
15896
15897
15898.option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
15899.cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
15900.cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
15901This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
15902a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15903While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15904Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15905and constrained to be a directory.
15906
15907
15908.option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
15909.cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
15910.cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15911This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
15912a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15913While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15914Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15915and constrained to be a file.
15916
15917
15918.option ldap_cert_file main string unset
15919.cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
15920.cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15921This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
15922Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15923Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
15924
15925
15926.option ldap_cert_key main string unset
15927.cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
15928.cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
15929This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
15930to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15931Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
15932identity to be proven.
15933
15934
15935.option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
15936.cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
15937This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
15938the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
15939cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
15940
15941
15942.option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
15943.cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
15944This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
15945LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
15946details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
15947with LDAP support.
15948
15949
15950.option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
15951.cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
15952This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
15953A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
15954See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
15955Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
15956to hard/demand.
15957
15958
15959.option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
15960.cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
15961If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
15962connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
15963"STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
15964of SSL-on-connect.
15965In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
15966by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
15967This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
15968
15969
15970.option ldap_version main integer unset
15971.cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
15972This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
15973LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
15974-1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
15975the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
15976has been built with LDAP support.
15977
15978
15979
15980.option local_from_check main boolean true
15981.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
15982.cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
15983When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15984an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
15985checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
15986the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
15987
15988&*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
15989locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
15990&%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15991
15992You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
15993on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
15994&'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
15995and the default qualify domain.
15996
15997If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
15998and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
15999&'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
16000&%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
16001
16002.cindex "envelope from"
16003.cindex "envelope sender"
16004These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
16005is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
16006&%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
16007
16008For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
16009request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
16010has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16011
16012
16013
16014
16015.option local_from_prefix main string unset
16016When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
16017matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
16018ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
16019done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
16020appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
16021&%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
16022example, if
16023.code
16024local_from_prefix = *-
16025.endd
16026is set, a &'From:'& line containing
16027.code
16028From: anything-user@your.domain.example
16029.endd
16030will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
16031matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
16032qualify domain.
16033
16034
16035.option local_from_suffix main string unset
16036See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
16037
16038
16039.option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
16040This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
16041listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
16042&<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
16043options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
16044&%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
16045&%local_interfaces%& is
16046.code
16047local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
16048.endd
16049when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
16050.code
16051local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
16052.endd
16053
16054.option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
16055.cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
16056.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
16057This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
16058&<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
16059the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
16060message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
16061non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
16062
16063
16064
16065.option local_sender_retain main boolean false
16066.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
16067When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16068an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
16069do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
16070also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
16071See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
16072&<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16073
16074
16075
16076
16077.option localhost_number main string&!! unset
16078.cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
16079.cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
16080.vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
16081Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
16082uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
16083value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
16084after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
16085host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
16086range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
16087systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
16088&$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
16089characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
16090time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
16091section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
16092
16093
16094
16095.option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
16096.cindex "log" "file path for"
16097This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
16098files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
16099when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
16100name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or runtime,
16101or if the option is unset at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
16102they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
16103A path must start with a slash.
16104To send to syslog, use the word &"syslog"&.
16105Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
16106section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
16107used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
16108variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
16109configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
16110&_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
16111early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
16112
16113
16114.option log_selector main string unset
16115.cindex "log" "selectors"
16116This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
16117writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
16118minus characters. For example:
16119.code
16120log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
16121.endd
16122A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
16123logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
16124
16125
16126.option log_timezone main boolean false
16127.cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
16128.vindex "&$tod_log$&"
16129.vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
16130By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
16131timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
16132in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
16133avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
16134&%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
16135timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
16136of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
16137&$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
16138another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
16139
16140
16141.option lookup_open_max main integer 25
16142.cindex "too many open files"
16143.cindex "open files, too many"
16144.cindex "file" "too many open"
16145.cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
16146.cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
16147This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
16148lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
16149Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
16150file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
16151recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
16152actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
16153as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
16154open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
16155&%lookup_open_max%&.
16156
16157
16158.option max_username_length main integer 0
16159.cindex "length of login name"
16160.cindex "user name" "maximum length"
16161.cindex "limit" "user name length"
16162Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
16163&[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
16164this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
16165an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
16166
16167
16168.option message_body_newlines main bool false
16169.cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
16170.cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
16171.vindex "&$message_body$&"
16172.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16173By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
16174the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
16175option is set true, this no longer happens.
16176
16177
16178.option message_body_visible main integer 500
16179.cindex "body of message" "visible size"
16180.cindex "message body" "visible size"
16181.vindex "&$message_body$&"
16182.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16183This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
16184&$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
16185
16186
16187.option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
16188.cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
16189If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
16190(domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
16191locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
16192means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
16193Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
16194Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
16195replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
16196empty string, the option is ignored.
16197
16198
16199.option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
16200If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
16201the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
16202message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
16203take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
16204the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
16205it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
16206yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
16207before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
16208that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
16209means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
16210colons will become hyphens.
16211
16212
16213.option message_logs main boolean true
16214.cindex "message logs" "disabling"
16215.cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
16216If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
16217&_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
16218Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
16219minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
16220per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
16221which is not affected by this option.
16222
16223
16224.option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
16225.cindex "message" "size limit"
16226.cindex "limit" "message size"
16227.cindex "size" "of message, limit"
16228This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
16229value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
16230to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
16231TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
16232optionally followed by K or M.
16233
16234&*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
16235other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
16236the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
16237error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
16238&%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16239
16240Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
16241exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
16242failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
16243an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
16244the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
16245message that an individual transport can process.
16246
16247If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
16248maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
16249failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
16250virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
16251probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
16252default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
16253some problems may result.
16254
16255A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
16256SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
16257SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
16258
16259
16260.option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
16261.cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
16262This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
16263.code
16264SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
16265.endd
16266in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
16267moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
16268and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
16269standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
16270lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
16271
16272
16273.option mua_wrapper main boolean false
16274Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
16275it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
16276contains a full description of this facility.
16277
16278
16279
16280.option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
16281.cindex "MySQL" "server list"
16282This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
16283be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
16284option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
16285
16286
16287.option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
16288This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
16289message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
16290recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
16291It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
16292safety precaution.
16293
16294When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
16295list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
16296the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
16297contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
16298can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
16299
16300If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
16301&%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
16302example is
16303.code
16304never_users = root:daemon:bin
16305.endd
16306Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
16307harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
16308transport driver.
16309
16310
16311.option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +no_sslv3 +single_dh_use +no_ticket +no_renegotiation"
16312.cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
16313This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
16314by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
16315each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
16316
16317This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
16318available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
16319The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
16320the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
16321list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
16322&"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
16323names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
16324
16325Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
16326SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
16327yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
16328adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
16329invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
16330
16331The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
16332
16333Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
16334"+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
16335with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
16336some now infamous attacks.
16337
16338Examples:
16339.code
16340# Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
16341openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
16342 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
16343
16344# Disable older protocol versions:
16345openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
16346.endd
16347
16348Possible options may include:
16349.ilist
16350&`all`&
16351.next
16352&`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
16353.next
16354&`cipher_server_preference`&
16355.next
16356&`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
16357.next
16358&`ephemeral_rsa`&
16359.next
16360&`legacy_server_connect`&
16361.next
16362&`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
16363.next
16364&`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
16365.next
16366&`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
16367.next
16368&`netscape_challenge_bug`&
16369.next
16370&`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
16371.next
16372&`no_compression`&
16373.next
16374&`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
16375.next
16376&`no_sslv2`&
16377.next
16378&`no_sslv3`&
16379.next
16380&`no_ticket`&
16381.next
16382&`no_tlsv1`&
16383.next
16384&`no_tlsv1_1`&
16385.next
16386&`no_tlsv1_2`&
16387.next
16388&`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
16389.next
16390&`single_dh_use`&
16391.next
16392&`single_ecdh_use`&
16393.next
16394&`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
16395.next
16396&`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
16397.next
16398&`tls_block_padding_bug`&
16399.next
16400&`tls_d5_bug`&
16401.next
16402&`tls_rollback_bug`&
16403.endlist
16404
16405As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
16406all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
16407to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
16408to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
16409release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
16410where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
16411
16412
16413.option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
16414.cindex "Oracle" "server list"
16415This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
16416to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
16417The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
16418
16419
16420.option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16421.cindex "&""percent hack""&"
16422.cindex "source routing" "in email address"
16423.cindex "address" "source-routed"
16424The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
16425percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
16426replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
16427also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
16428option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
16429but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
16430an ACL.
16431
16432&*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
16433trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
16434if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
16435implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
16436routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
16437a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
16438local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
16439
16440
16441.option perl_at_start main boolean false
16442.cindex "Perl"
16443This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16444interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16445
16446
16447.option perl_startup main string unset
16448.cindex "Perl"
16449This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16450interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16451
16452.option perl_taintmode main boolean false
16453.cindex "Perl"
16454This option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
16455
16456
16457.option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
16458.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
16459This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
16460data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
16461&<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
16462PostgreSQL support.
16463
16464
16465.option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
16466.cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
16467.cindex "pid file, path for"
16468This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
16469process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
16470to the host name:
16471.code
16472pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
16473.endd
16474If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
16475spool directory.
16476The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
16477option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
16478of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
16479
16480
16481.option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16482.cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
16483This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
16484PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
16485control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
16486&%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
16487for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
16488that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
16489not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
16490
16491.option pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16492.cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
16493.cindex "pipelining" PIPE_CONNECT
16494If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
16495this option controls which hosts the facility is advertised to
16496and from which pipeline early-connection (before MAIL) SMTP
16497commands are acceptable.
16498When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
16499
16500See also the &%hosts_pipe_connect%& smtp transport option.
16501
16502Currently the option name &"X_PIPE_CONNECT"& is used.
16503
16504
16505.option prdr_enable main boolean false
16506.cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
16507This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
16508to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
16509If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
16510If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
16511an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
16512is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
16513
16514.option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
16515.cindex "message logs" "preserving"
16516If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
16517completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
16518called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
16519purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
16520volume of mail. Use with care!
16521
16522
16523.option primary_hostname main string "see below"
16524.cindex "name" "of local host"
16525.cindex "host" "name of local"
16526.cindex "local host" "name of"
16527.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16528This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
16529HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
16530option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
16531The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
16532server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
16533
16534If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
16535name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
16536contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
16537&[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
16538version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
16539explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
16540
16541
16542.option print_topbitchars main boolean false
16543.cindex "printing characters"
16544.cindex "8-bit characters"
16545By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
1654632&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
16547when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
16548sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
16549is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
16550characters.
16551
16552This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
16553&(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
16554the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
16555described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
16556Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
16557standards.
16558
16559
16560.option process_log_path main string unset
16561.cindex "process log path"
16562.cindex "log" "process log"
16563.cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
16564This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
16565&"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
16566utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
16567in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
16568can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
16569different spool directories.
16570
16571
16572.option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
16573.cindex "restricting access to features"
16574.oindex "&%-M%&"
16575.oindex "&%-R%&"
16576.oindex "&%-q%&"
16577The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
16578admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
16579&%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16580
16581
16582.option qualify_domain main string "see below"
16583.cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
16584.cindex "address" "qualification"
16585This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
16586addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
16587recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
16588are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
16589also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
16590locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16591
16592Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
16593unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
16594&%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
16595addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
16596necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
16597addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
16598&%primary_hostname%& value.
16599
16600
16601.option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
16602This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
16603addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
16604
16605
16606
16607.option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16608.cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
16609.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16610.cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
16611This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
16612A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
16613domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
16614next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
16615
16616
16617.option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
16618.cindex "restricting access to features"
16619.oindex "&%-bp%&"
16620The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
16621queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
16622&%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
16623See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16624
16625
16626.option queue_only main boolean false
16627.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16628.cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
16629If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
16630whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits in the queue for the
16631next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
16632delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
16633
16634The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
16635and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
16636&%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
16637&%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
16638
16639
16640.option queue_only_file main string unset
16641.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16642.cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
16643This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
16644one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
16645it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
16646each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
16647For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
16648&"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
16649.code
16650queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
16651.endd
16652causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
16653&_/some/file_& exists.
16654
16655
16656.option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
16657.cindex "load average"
16658.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16659.cindex "message" "queueing by load"
16660If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
16661all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
16662happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
16663the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
16664the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16665false.
16666
16667Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
16668option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
16669determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
16670&%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16671
16672
16673.option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
16674.cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
16675When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
16676because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
16677all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
16678This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
16679threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
16680connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
16681circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
16682where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16683should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
16684re-evaluated for each message.
16685
16686
16687.option queue_only_override main boolean true
16688.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16689When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
16690setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
16691&%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
16692to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
16693
16694
16695.option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
16696.cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
16697If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
16698in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
16699must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
16700single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
16701and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
16702single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
16703the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
16704avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
16705&%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
16706when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
16707large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
16708
16709
16710
16711.option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
16712.cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
16713This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
16714can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
16715but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
16716start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
16717very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
16718however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
16719started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
16720
16721Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
16722the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
16723run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
16724the daemon's command line.
16725
16726.cindex queues named
16727.cindex "named queues"
16728To set limits for different named queues use
16729an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
16730
16731.option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16732.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16733.cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
16734When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
16735received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
16736However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
16737&%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
16738message waits in the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
16739has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
16740when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
16741over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
16742SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
16743&%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
16744&%queue_domains%&.
16745
16746
16747.option receive_timeout main time 0s
16748.cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
16749This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
16750maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
16751the value is zero, it will wait forever. This setting is overridden by the
16752&%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
16753controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
16754
16755.option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
16756.cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
16757.cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
16758This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
16759added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
16760on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
16761used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
16762added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
16763&"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
16764header lines.
16765The default setting is:
16766
16767.code
16768received_header_text = Received: \
16769 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
16770 {${if def:sender_ident \
16771 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
16772 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
16773 by $primary_hostname \
16774 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol }}\
16775 ${if def:tls_ver { ($tls_ver)}}\
16776 ${if def:tls_in_cipher_std { tls $tls_in_cipher_std\n\t}}\
16777 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
16778 ${if def:sender_address \
16779 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
16780 id $message_exim_id\
16781 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
16782.endd
16783
16784The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
16785support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
16786locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
16787header lines such as the following:
16788.code
16789Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
16790by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
16791(envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
16792id 16IOWa-00019l-00
16793for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
16794Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
16795id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
16796.endd
16797Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
16798the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
16799checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
16800message was accepted.
16801
16802
16803.option received_headers_max main integer 30
16804.cindex "loop" "prevention"
16805.cindex "mail loop prevention"
16806.cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
16807When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
16808counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
16809have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
16810This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
16811
16812
16813.option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16814.cindex "unqualified addresses"
16815.cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16816This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16817recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
16818qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
16819affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
16820addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
16821host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
16822or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
16823option was not set.
16824
16825
16826.option recipients_max main integer 0
16827.cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
16828.cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
16829If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
16830original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
16831by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
16832all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
16833Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
16834done.
16835
16836.cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
16837&*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
16838RCPT commands in a single message.
16839
16840
16841.option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
16842If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
16843recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
16844error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
16845error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
16846initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
16847for the remaining recipients at a later time.
16848
16849
16850.option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
16851.cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
16852This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
16853hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
16854does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
16855message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
16856have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
16857deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
16858deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
16859each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
16860same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
16861&%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
16862with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
16863tagged with its process id.
16864
16865This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
16866message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
16867manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
16868deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
16869is received.
16870
16871.cindex "number of deliveries"
16872.cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
16873If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
16874need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
16875are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
16876daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
16877fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
16878runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
16879delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
16880then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
16881&%remote_max_parallel%&.
16882
16883If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
16884&%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
16885doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
16886host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
16887
16888
16889.option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16890.cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
16891.cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
16892When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
16893domain into the order given by this list. For example,
16894.code
16895remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
16896.endd
16897would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
16898then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
16899
16900
16901.option retry_data_expire main time 7d
16902.cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
16903This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
16904database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
16905host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
16906past failures.
16907
16908
16909.option retry_interval_max main time 24h
16910.cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
16911.cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
16912Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
16913intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
16914straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
16915retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
16916the default value.
16917
16918
16919.option return_path_remove main boolean true
16920.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
16921RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
16922&'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
16923The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
16924MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
16925in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
16926&'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
16927received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
16928the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
16929
16930
16931.option return_size_limit main integer 100K
16932This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16933
16934
16935.option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
16936.cindex "RFC 1413"
16937.cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
16938RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
16939an item in the list.
16940The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
16941for the system.
16942
16943.option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
16944.cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
16945.cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
16946This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
16947no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
16948
16949
16950.option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16951.cindex "unqualified addresses"
16952.cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16953This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16954sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
16955&%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
16956not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
16957it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
16958&%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
16959using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
16960
16961
16962.option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
16963.cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
16964.cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
16965This option controls logging of slow lookups.
16966If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
16967and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
16968Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
16969
16970
16971
16972.option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
16973.cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
16974This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
16975TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
16976connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
16977other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
16978still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
16979this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
16980connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
16981tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
16982hours to detect unreachable hosts.
16983
16984
16985
16986.option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
16987.cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
16988.cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16989.cindex "inetd"
16990This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
16991that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
16992control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
16993value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
16994non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
16995set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16996
16997A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
16998has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
16999that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
17000and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
17001
17002
17003.option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
17004.cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
17005.cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
17006Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
17007the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
17008check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
17009client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
17010client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
17011
17012When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
17013allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
17014but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
17015or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
17016starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
17017counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
17018following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
17019MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
17020
17021
17022.option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17023You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
17024check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
17025changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
17026live with.
17027
17028
17029. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
17030. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
17031. We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
17032. non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
17033. zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
17034. html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
17035. inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
17036. searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
17037. the option name to split.
17038
17039.option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
17040 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17041.cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
17042.cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
17043The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
17044prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
17045results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
17046response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
17047precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
17048seen).
17049
17050
17051.option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
17052.cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
17053.cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
17054This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
17055host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
17056expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
17057reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
17058connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
17059is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
17060of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
17061required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
17062
17063&*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
17064constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
17065happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
17066without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
17067could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
17068doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
17069
17070
17071
17072.option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
17073.cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
17074.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17075.cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
17076If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
17077listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
17078in the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
17079fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
17080subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
17081to all messages received in the same connection.
17082
17083A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
17084if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
17085also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
17086various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
17087
17088
17089. See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17090
17091.option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
17092 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
17093.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17094.cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
17095This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
17096automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
17097the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
17098and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
17099number, subsequent messages are placed in the queue, but no delivery processes
17100are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
17101restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
17102systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
17103dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
17104
17105
17106.option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
17107.cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
17108.cindex "host" "reserved"
17109When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
17110number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
17111that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
17112&%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
17113restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
17114of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
17115of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
17116the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
17117individual host.
17118
17119For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
17120set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
17121connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
17122provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
17123
17124
17125.option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
17126.cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
17127.cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
17128.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
17129This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
17130several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
17131is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
17132responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
17133incoming HELO or EHLO command.
17134
17135.vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
17136The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
17137is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
17138in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
17139
17140If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
17141expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
17142used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
17143panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
17144value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
17145For example:
17146.code
17147smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
17148 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
17149.endd
17150
17151Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
17152messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
17153verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
17154&%helo_data%& value.
17155
17156.option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
17157.cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
17158.cindex "banner for SMTP"
17159.cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
17160.cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
17161This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
17162positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
17163.code
17164smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
17165 $version_number $tod_full
17166.endd
17167Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
17168multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
17169appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
17170in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
17171multiline response).
17172
17173
17174.option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
17175.cindex "checking disk space"
17176.cindex "disk space, checking"
17177.cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
17178When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
17179option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
17180spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
17181leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
17182is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
17183
17184
17185.option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
17186.cindex "connection backlog"
17187.cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
17188.cindex "backlog of connections"
17189This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
17190this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
17191of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
17192attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
17193say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
17194out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
17195value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
17196attacks by SYN flooding.
17197
17198
17199.option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
17200.cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
17201.cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
17202The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
17203the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
17204synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
17205fewer, but they still exist.
17206
17207Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
17208for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
17209client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
17210SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
17211for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
17212input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
17213does detect many instances.
17214
17215The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
17216If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
17217hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
17218(see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
17219
17220
17221
17222.option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
17223.cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
17224.vindex "&$domain$&"
17225If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
17226command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
17227chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
17228are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
17229argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
17230example:
17231.code
17232smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
17233 $sender_host_address
17234.endd
17235A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
17236complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
17237run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
17238a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
17239receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
17240the command.
17241
17242
17243.option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
17244.cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
17245When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
17246one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
17247section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
17248
17249
17250.option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
17251.cindex "load average"
17252If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
17253accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
17254If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
17255the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
17256systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
17257&%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
17258
17259
17260
17261.option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
17262.cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
17263.cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
17264Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
17265particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
17266.code
17267RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
17268.endd
17269causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
17270(The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
17271example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
17272too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
17273dropped. The limit is set by this option.
17274
17275.cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
17276When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
17277&"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
17278Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
17279&%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
17280not count towards the limit.
17281
17282
17283
17284.option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
17285.cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
17286.cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
17287If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
17288Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
17289that subvert web
17290clients
17291into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
17292non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
17293
17294
17295
17296.option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17297.cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
17298.cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
17299.cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
17300Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
17301can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
17302recipients.
17303
17304Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
17305facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
17306&%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
17307&<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
17308
17309When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
17310&%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
17311rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
17312respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
17313values:
17314
17315.ilist
17316A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
17317.next
17318An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
17319fractional parts are allowed here.
17320.next
17321A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
17322.next
17323A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
17324because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
17325.endlist
17326
17327For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
17328first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
17329.code
17330smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
17331smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
17332.endd
17333The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
17334two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
17335seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
17336delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
17337
17338
17339.option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
17340See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17341
17342
17343.option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
17344See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17345
17346
17347.option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
17348.cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
17349.cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
17350This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
17351input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
17352data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
17353the message is abandoned.
17354A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
17355.code
17356SMTP command timeout on connection from...
17357SMTP data timeout on connection from...
17358.endd
17359The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
17360means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
17361
17362If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
17363expanded before use and may depend on
17364&$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
17365
17366
17367.oindex "&%-os%&"
17368The value set by this option can be overridden by the
17369&%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
17370this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
17371of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
17372timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
17373
17374
17375.option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17376This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
17377&%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
17378
17379
17380.option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
17381.cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
17382.cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
17383In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
17384&"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
17385reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
17386to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
17387policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
17388&%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
17389example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
17390.code
17391550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
17392550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
17393.endd
17394
17395
17396.option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17397.cindex "SMTPUTF8" "advertising"
17398When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
17399the availability thereof is advertised in
17400response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17401chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
17402
17403
17404.option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
17405This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
17406extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
17407See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
17408
17409
17410
17411.option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
17412This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
17413See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
17414
17415
17416
17417.option split_spool_directory main boolean false
17418.cindex "multiple spool directories"
17419.cindex "spool directory" "split"
17420.cindex "directories, multiple"
17421If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
17422subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
17423sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
17424subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
17425arrival of the message.
17426
17427Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
17428where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
17429directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
17430directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
17431are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
17432
17433It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
17434changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
17435&"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
17436after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
17437automatically deleted.
17438
17439When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
17440changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
17441trying to deliver each one, in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
17442sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
17443sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
17444spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
17445particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages in the queue. However,
17446if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
17447entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
17448
17449
17450.option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
17451.cindex "spool directory" "path to"
17452This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
17453it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
17454configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
17455string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
17456&$primary_hostname$&.
17457
17458If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
17459that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
17460log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
17461Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
17462as failures in the configuration file.
17463
17464By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
17465tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
17466
17467.option spool_wireformat main boolean false
17468.cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
17469If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternative format
17470for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
17471Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
17472Currently it is only done for messages received using the ESMTP CHUNKING
17473option.
17474
17475The following variables will not have useful values:
17476.code
17477$max_received_linelength
17478$body_linecount
17479$body_zerocount
17480.endd
17481
17482Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
17483and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
17484(except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
17485will need to be aware of the different formats potentially available.
17486
17487Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
17488(as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
17489The transmission benefit is maintained.
17490
17491.option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
17492.cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
17493This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
17494access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
17495
17496.option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
17497.cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
17498This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
17499variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
17500is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
17501&<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
17502
17503.option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
17504.cindex "angle brackets, excess"
17505If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
17506items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
17507treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
17508passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
17509option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
17510
17511
17512.option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
17513.cindex "trailing dot on domain"
17514.cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
17515If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
17516ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
17517MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
17518domain causes a syntax error.
17519However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
17520syntax checking.
17521
17522
17523.option syslog_duplication main boolean true
17524.cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
17525When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
17526separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
17527be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
17528separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
17529nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
17530particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
17531both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
17532containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
17533Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
17534the LOG_ALERT priority.
17535
17536
17537.option syslog_facility main string unset
17538.cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
17539This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17540syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
17541&"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
17542If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17543details of Exim's logging.
17544
17545
17546.option syslog_pid main boolean true
17547.cindex "syslog" "pid"
17548If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
17549omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
17550the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
17551to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
17552into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17553
17554
17555
17556.option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
17557.cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
17558This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17559syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
17560&<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17561
17562
17563
17564.option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
17565.cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
17566If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
17567omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17568details of Exim's logging.
17569
17570
17571.option system_filter main string&!! unset
17572.cindex "filter" "system filter"
17573.cindex "system filter" "specifying"
17574.cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
17575This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
17576the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
17577must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
17578generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
17579appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
17580which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
17581&<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
17582A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
17583
17584
17585.option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
17586.vindex "&$address_file$&"
17587This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
17588&%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
17589implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
17590During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17591
17592
17593.option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
17594.cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
17595This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
17596command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
17597the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17598
17599.option system_filter_group main string unset
17600.cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
17601This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
17602gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
17603with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
17604
17605.option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
17606.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
17607.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
17608This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
17609is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
17610contains the pipe command.
17611
17612
17613.option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
17614.cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
17615This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
17616is used in a system filter.
17617
17618
17619.option system_filter_user main string unset
17620.cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
17621If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
17622delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
17623process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
17624Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
17625is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
17626configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
17627specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
17628&%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
17629
17630If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
17631under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
17632transport option overrides.
17633
17634
17635.option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
17636.cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
17637.cindex "Nagle algorithm"
17638.cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
17639If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
17640TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
17641turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
17642performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
17643should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
17644However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
17645this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
17646daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
17647TCP_NODELAY.
17648
17649
17650.option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
17651.cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
17652.cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
17653If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
17654message of any kind that has been in the queue for longer than the given time
17655is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
17656bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
17657sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
17658If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
17659frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
17660
17661&*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
17662frozen messages remain in the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
17663messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
17664
17665
17666.option timezone main string unset
17667.cindex "timezone, setting"
17668.cindex "environment" "values from"
17669The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
17670running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
17671created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
17672to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
17673.code
17674timezone = UTC
17675.endd
17676The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
17677or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
17678is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
17679time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
17680runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
17681unfortunately not all, operating systems.
17682
17683
17684.option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17685.cindex "TLS" "advertising"
17686.cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
17687.cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
17688When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
17689of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
17690response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17691chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
17692Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
17693using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
17694is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
17695
17696
17697.option tls_certificate main string list&!! unset
17698.cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
17699.cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
17700The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17701files which contain the server's certificates (in PEM format).
17702Commonly only one file is needed.
17703The server's private key is also
17704assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
17705&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17706
17707&*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
17708receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
17709use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
17710option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
17711
17712&*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
17713separator in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) to avoid confusion under IPv6.
17714
17715&*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
17716when a list of more than one
17717file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
17718The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
17719
17720If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
17721if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
17722Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
17723&<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
17724
17725If this option is unset or empty a fresh self-signed certificate will be
17726generated for every connection.
17727
17728.option tls_crl main string&!! unset
17729.cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
17730.cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
17731This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
17732be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
17733
17734Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
17735
17736&*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
17737for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
17738For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
17739
17740See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17741
17742
17743.option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
17744.cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
17745The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
17746the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
17747interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
17748suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
17749
17750The value must be at least 1024.
17751
17752The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
17753hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
17754by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
17755
17756If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
17757number.
17758
17759Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
17760little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
17761larger prime than requested.
17762
17763
17764.option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
17765.cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
17766The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
17767to be used by Exim.
17768
17769This option is ignored for GnuTLS version 3.6.0 and later.
17770The library manages parameter negotiation internally.
17771
17772&*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend,
17773for other TLS library versions,
17774using a filename with site-generated
17775local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
17776other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
17777"unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
17778
17779If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
17780then it names a file from which DH
17781parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
17782PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
17783OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
17784fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
17785loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
17786and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
17787
17788If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
17789loaded by Exim.
17790
17791If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
17792Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
17793does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
17794See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
17795
17796If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
17797a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
17798
17799In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
178002.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
17801in IKE is assigned number 23.
17802
17803Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
17804of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
17805sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
17806the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
17807&`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17808
17809The available standard primes are:
17810&`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
17811&`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
17812&`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
17813&`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
17814
17815The available additional primes are:
17816&`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17817
17818Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
17819Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
17820The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
17821of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
17822(the "ffdhe" identifiers).
17823
17824At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
17825they're still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
17826candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
17827
17828The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
17829to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
17830whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
17831tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
17832need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
17833userbase.
17834
17835Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
17836is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
17837applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
17838used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
17839mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
17840prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
17841acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
17842
17843
17844.option tls_eccurve main string&!! &`auto`&
17845.cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
17846This option selects a EC curve for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
17847It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS.
17848
17849After expansion it must contain a valid EC curve parameter, such as
17850&`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-512`&. Consult your OpenSSL manual
17851for valid selections.
17852
17853For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
17854&`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
17855&`auto`& tells the library to choose.
17856
17857If the option expands to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
17858
17859
17860.option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
17861.cindex TLS "certificate status"
17862.cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
17863This option
17864must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
17865status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
17866Certificate Authority.
17867
17868Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
17869The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP" will be defined for those versions.
17870
17871For OpenSSL 1.1.0 or later, and
17872for GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
17873of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
17874The ordering of the two lists must match.
17875The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP_LIST" will be defined for those versions.
17876
17877The file(s) should be in DER format,
17878except for GnuTLS 3.6.3 or later
17879or for OpenSSL,
17880when an optional filetype prefix can be used.
17881The prefix must be one of "DER" or "PEM", followed by
17882a single space. If one is used it sets the format for subsequent
17883files in the list; the initial format is DER.
17884If multiple proofs are wanted, for multiple chain elements
17885(this only works under TLS1.3)
17886they must be coded as a combined OCSP response.
17887
17888Although GnuTLS will accept PEM files with multiple separate
17889PEM blobs (ie. separate OCSP responses), it sends them in the
17890TLS Certificate record interleaved with the certificates of the chain;
17891although a GnuTLS client is happy with that, an OpenSSL client is not.
17892
17893.option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
17894.cindex SSMTP
17895.cindex SMTPS
17896This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
17897operate the SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
17898set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
17899further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
17900
17901
17902
17903.option tls_privatekey main string list&!! unset
17904.cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
17905The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17906files which contains the server's private keys.
17907If this option is unset, or if
17908the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
17909key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
17910&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17911
17912See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17913
17914
17915.option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
17916.cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
17917.cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
17918If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
17919&"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
17920support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
17921TLS session.
17922
17923
17924.option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
17925.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
17926.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
17927This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
17928The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
17929connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
17930different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
17931permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
17932in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
17933preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
17934&<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
17935
17936
17937.option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17938.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17939.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17940See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
17941
17942
17943.option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
17944.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17945.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17946The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
17947word "system"
17948or the absolute path to
17949a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
17950match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
17951
17952The "system" value for the option will use a
17953system default location compiled into the SSL library.
17954This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
17955and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
17956must be specified.
17957
17958The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
17959preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
17960
17961With OpenSSL the certificates specified
17962explicitly
17963either by file or directory
17964are added to those given by the system default location.
17965
17966These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
17967than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
17968the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
17969connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
17970Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
17971use the explicit directory version.
17972
17973See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17974
17975A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
17976being unset.
17977
17978
17979.option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17980.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17981.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17982This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
17983certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
17984&%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
17985either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
17986&%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
17987
17988Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
17989&%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
17990present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
17991aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
17992the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
17993connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
17994ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
17995
17996A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
17997matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
17998certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
17999abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
18000state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
18001such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
18002but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
18003certificate"&.
18004
18005Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
18006certificates.
18007
18008
18009.option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
18010.cindex "trusted groups"
18011.cindex "groups" "trusted"
18012This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
18013option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
18014which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
18015specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
18016details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
18017&%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
18018are trusted.
18019
18020.option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
18021.cindex "trusted users"
18022.cindex "user" "trusted"
18023This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
18024option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
18025trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
18026&<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
18027If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
18028Exim user are trusted.
18029
18030.option unknown_login main string&!! unset
18031.cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
18032.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
18033This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
18034the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
18035gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
18036used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
18037can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
18038is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
18039&%-F%& option.
18040
18041.option unknown_username main string unset
18042See &%unknown_login%&.
18043
18044.option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
18045.cindex "trusted users"
18046.cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
18047.cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
18048.cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
18049.cindex "envelope from"
18050.cindex "envelope sender"
18051When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
18052normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
18053default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
18054senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
18055is used) is ignored.
18056
18057However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
18058to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
18059.code
18060exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
18061.endd
18062.vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
18063The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
18064other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
18065users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
18066patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
18067identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
18068users to setting senders that start with their login ids
18069followed by a hyphen
18070by a setting like this:
18071.code
18072untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
18073.endd
18074If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
18075restriction, you can use
18076.code
18077untrusted_set_sender = *
18078.endd
18079The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
18080only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
18081to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
18082parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
18083&'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
18084necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
18085overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
18086described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
18087
18088The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
18089&"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
18090&%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
18091envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
18092sender address.
18093
18094
18095.option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
18096.cindex "&""From""& line"
18097.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
18098Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
18099an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
18100particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
18101of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
18102matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
18103&%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
18104default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
18105.code
18106From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
18107From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
18108.endd
18109The pattern can be seen by running
18110.code
18111exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
18112.endd
18113It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
18114year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
18115regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
18116&%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
18117(&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
18118&%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
18119
18120
18121.option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
18122See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
18123
18124
18125.option warn_message_file main string unset
18126.cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
18127.cindex "customizing" "warning message"
18128This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
18129for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
18130been in the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
18131&%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
18132&<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
18133
18134
18135.option write_rejectlog main boolean true
18136.cindex "reject log" "disabling"
18137If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
18138See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
18139.ecindex IIDconfima
18140.ecindex IIDmaiconf
18141
18142
18143
18144
18145. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18146. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18147
18148.chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
18149.scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
18150.scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
18151This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
18152Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
18153
18154For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
18155&<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
18156which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
18157provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
18158&%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
18159
18160
18161
18162.option address_data routers string&!! unset
18163.cindex "router" "data attached to address"
18164The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
18165precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
18166router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
18167&%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
18168delivery of the address to be deferred.
18169
18170.vindex "&$address_data$&"
18171When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
18172accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
18173routers, and the eventual transport.
18174
18175&*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
18176that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
18177in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
18178either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
18179put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
18180
18181Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
18182with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
18183on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
18184&$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
18185&"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
18186
18187The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
18188for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
18189you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
18190.code
18191uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
18192.endd
18193In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
18194.code
18195file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
18196.endd
18197This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
18198lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
18199
18200See also the &%set%& option below.
18201
18202.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
18203.vindex "&$address_data$&"
18204The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
18205from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
18206&$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
18207ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
18208verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
18209
18210
18211
18212.option address_test routers&!? boolean true
18213.oindex "&%-bt%&"
18214.cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
18215If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
18216by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
18217your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
18218having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
18219routing.
18220
18221
18222
18223.option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
18224.cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
18225.cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
18226This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
18227routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
18228&"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
18229&%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
18230value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
18231includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
18232well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
18233you could put:
18234.code
18235cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
18236.endd
18237on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
18238and
18239.code
18240cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
18241.endd
18242on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
18243this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
18244explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
18245logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
18246
18247
18248.option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
18249.cindex "case of local parts"
18250.cindex "router" "case of local parts"
18251By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
18252manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
18253If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
18254this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
18255part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
18256turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
18257more details.
18258
18259.vindex "&$local_part$&"
18260.vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
18261.vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
18262The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
18263router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
18264an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
18265is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
18266addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
18267and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
18268
18269This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
18270recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
18271modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
18272(see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
18273
18274
18275
18276.option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
18277.cindex "local user, checking in router"
18278.cindex "router" "checking for local user"
18279.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
18280.vindex "&$home$&"
18281When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
18282address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
18283local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
18284than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
18285holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
18286user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
18287preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
18288given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
18289overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
18290the router is skipped.
18291
18292If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
18293or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
18294setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
18295two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
18296setting to achieve this. For example:
18297.code
18298local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
18299.endd
18300Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
18301up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
18302&%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
18303
18304
18305
18306.option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
18307.cindex "router" "customized precondition"
18308This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
18309router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
18310evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
18311result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
18312&"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
18313router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
18314
18315If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
18316precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
18317
18318This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
18319All &%condition%& options must succeed.
18320
18321The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
18322running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
18323the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
18324.code
18325condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18326.endd
18327Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
18328.code
18329condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
18330.endd
18331
18332A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
18333.code
18334condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18335condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
18336condition = foobar
18337.endd
18338
18339If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
18340of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
18341be specified using &%condition%&.
18342
18343Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
18344are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
18345they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
18346parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18347ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18348Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
18349Router rules processing behavior.
18350
18351This is best illustrated in an example:
18352.code
18353# If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
18354# in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
18355
18356$ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18357true {yes} {no}}
18358
18359$ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18360 {yes} {no}}
18361.endd
18362In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
18363&"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
18364default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
18365(which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
18366string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
18367with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
18368resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
18369&" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
18370
18371In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
18372&%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
18373mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
18374conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
18375string characters.
18376
18377Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
18378true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
18379match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
18380contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
18381expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
18382
18383
18384.option debug_print routers string&!! unset
18385.cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
18386If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
18387option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
18388the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
18389If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
18390output, and Exim carries on processing.
18391This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
18392so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
18393option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
18394variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
18395&%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
18396are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
18397The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
18398
18399
18400
18401.option disable_logging routers boolean false
18402If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
18403or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
18404unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
18405transport option of the same name.
18406
18407.option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" *
18408.cindex "MX record" "security"
18409.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18410.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18411.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18412DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
18413the dnssec request bit set.
18414This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18415
18416.option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
18417.cindex "MX record" "security"
18418.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18419.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18420.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18421DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
18422the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
18423(AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
18424This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18425
18426
18427.option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
18428.cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
18429.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
18430If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
18431the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
18432lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
18433expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
18434a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
18435
18436
18437
18438.option driver routers string unset
18439This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
18440to be used.
18441
18442
18443.option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
18444.cindex "DSN" "success"
18445.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
18446If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
18447Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
18448instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
18449Not effective on redirect routers.
18450
18451
18452
18453.option errors_to routers string&!! unset
18454.cindex "envelope from"
18455.cindex "envelope sender"
18456.cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
18457If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
18458transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
18459there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
18460message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
18461provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
18462expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
18463
18464The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
18465subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
18466settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
18467setting.
18468
18469If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
18470the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
18471address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
18472expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
18473
18474If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
18475SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
18476any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
18477sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
18478settings:
18479.code
18480errors_to =
18481errors_to = ""
18482.endd
18483An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
18484this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
18485no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
18486address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
18487overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
18488
18489.vindex "&$address_data$&"
18490If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
18491MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
18492path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
18493setting &%return_path%&.
18494
18495The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
18496manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
18497implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
18498
18499
18500
18501.option expn routers&!? boolean true
18502.cindex "address" "testing"
18503.cindex "testing" "addresses"
18504.cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
18505.cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
18506If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
18507as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
18508want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
18509on for the system alias file.
18510See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18511are evaluated.
18512
18513The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
18514&<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
18515an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
18516
18517
18518
18519.option fail_verify routers boolean false
18520.cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
18521Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
18522&%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18523
18524
18525
18526.option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
18527If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18528verifying a recipient, verification fails.
18529
18530
18531
18532.option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
18533If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18534verifying a sender, verification fails.
18535
18536
18537
18538.option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
18539.cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
18540.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
18541String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
18542colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
18543changed (see section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&), and a port can be specified with
18544each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
18545defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
18546&<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
18547
18548If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
18549associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
18550list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
18551randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
18552transport for further details.
18553
18554
18555.option group routers string&!! "see below"
18556.cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
18557.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18558.cindex "transport" "local"
18559.cindex "router" "setting group"
18560When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18561specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
18562process.
18563The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18564error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18565The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
18566is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
18567and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18568
18569
18570
18571.option headers_add routers list&!! unset
18572.cindex "header lines" "adding"
18573.cindex "router" "adding header lines"
18574This option specifies a list of text headers,
18575newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
18576that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18577Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18578option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18579the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
18580&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
18581message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
18582header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
18583&"see"& the added header lines.
18584
18585The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
18586&%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
18587an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
18588failures are treated as configuration errors.
18589
18590Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
18591for a router; all listed headers are added.
18592
18593&*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18594router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18595
18596.cindex "duplicate addresses"
18597.oindex "&%unseen%&"
18598&*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18599additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
18600For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
18601address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
18602modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
18603circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
18604which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
18605avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18606
18607
18608
18609.option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
18610.cindex "header lines" "removing"
18611.cindex "router" "removing header lines"
18612This option specifies a list of text headers,
18613colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
18614that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18615Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18616option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18617the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
18618section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
18619the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
18620to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
18621&"see"& the original header lines.
18622
18623The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
18624&%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
18625the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
18626errors.
18627
18628Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
18629for a router; all listed headers are removed.
18630
18631&*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18632router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18633
18634&*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18635removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
18636routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
18637warning for &%headers_add%& above.
18638
18639&*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
18640items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
18641To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18642
18643
18644
18645.option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
18646.cindex "IP address" "discarding"
18647.cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
18648Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
18649entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
18650IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
18651address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
18652like
18653.code
18654remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
18655.endd
18656by setting
18657.code
18658ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
18659.endd
18660on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
18661discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
18662attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
18663domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
18664Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
18665router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
18666
18667You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
18668means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
18669.code
18670ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
18671ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
18672.endd
18673The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
18674in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
18675
18676This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
18677addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18678is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
18679domain that is being routed.
18680
18681.vindex "&$host_address$&"
18682During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
18683checked.
18684
18685.option initgroups routers boolean false
18686.cindex "additional groups"
18687.cindex "groups" "additional"
18688.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18689.cindex "transport" "local"
18690If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
18691the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
18692&[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
18693any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
18694and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18695
18696
18697
18698.option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
18699.cindex affix "router precondition"
18700.cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
18701.cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
18702If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
18703one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
18704section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
18705evaluated.
18706
18707The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
18708used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
18709asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
18710the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
18711some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
18712.cindex "multiple mailboxes"
18713.cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
18714Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
18715section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
18716
18717.vindex "&$local_part$&"
18718.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
18719During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
18720running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
18721expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
18722the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
18723a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
18724command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
18725This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
18726the relevant transport.
18727
18728When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
18729behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
18730means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
18731callout.
18732
18733The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
18734&%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
18735&%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
18736to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
18737immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
18738.code
18739real_localuser:
18740 driver = accept
18741 local_part_prefix = real-
18742 check_local_user
18743 transport = local_delivery
18744.endd
18745For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18746router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18747.code
18748 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18749 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18750.endd
18751
18752If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
18753both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
18754are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
18755separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
18756
18757
18758.option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
18759See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
18760
18761
18762
18763.option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
18764.cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
18765.cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
18766This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
18767local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
18768&%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
18769mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
18770character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
18771parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
18772&%username-foo%&.
18773
18774
18775.option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
18776See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
18777
18778
18779
18780.option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
18781.cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
18782.cindex "local part" "checking in router"
18783The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
18784See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18785are evaluated, and
18786section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
18787string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
18788example:
18789.code
18790local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
18791.endd
18792.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
18793If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
18794for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
18795expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
18796example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
18797send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
18798each virtual domain:
18799.code
18800postmaster:
18801 driver = redirect
18802 local_parts = postmaster
18803 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
18804.endd
18805
18806
18807.option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
18808.cindex "log" "delivery line"
18809.cindex "delivery" "log line format"
18810Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
18811deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
18812recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
18813this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
18814router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
18815router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
18816redirect addresses.
18817
18818
18819
18820.option more routers boolean&!! true
18821The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18822that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18823result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18824fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
18825delivery to be deferred.
18826
18827If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
18828further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
18829.oindex "&%self%&"
18830However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
18831means of the setting
18832.code
18833self = pass
18834.endd
18835or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
18836does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
18837case, the address is always passed to the next router.
18838
18839Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
18840expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
18841controls what happens next.
18842
18843
18844.option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
18845.cindex "timeout" "of router"
18846.cindex "router" "timeout"
18847If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
18848address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
18849router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
18850intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
18851host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
18852
18853There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
18854lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
18855applies to all of them.
18856
18857
18858
18859.option pass_router routers string unset
18860.cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
18861Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
18862&(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
18863routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
18864these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
18865router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
18866of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
18867be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
18868to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
18869&"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
18870
18871
18872
18873.option redirect_router routers string unset
18874.cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
18875Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
18876generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
18877example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
18878point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
18879
18880The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
18881It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
18882instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
18883which it is set does not generate new addresses.
18884
18885
18886
18887.option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
18888.cindex "file" "requiring for router"
18889.cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
18890This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
18891router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
18892Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
18893through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
18894
18895Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
18896be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used
18897(&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18898If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
18899failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
18900
18901If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
18902below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
18903&"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
18904existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
18905preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
18906
18907.cindex "NFS"
18908If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
18909the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
18910unavailable.
18911
18912This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
18913options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
18914look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
18915full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
18916these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
18917to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
18918that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
18919transport (e.g., &_.procmailrc_&).
18920
18921During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
18922facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
18923This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
18924operates as follows:
18925
18926If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
18927characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
18928comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
18929but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
18930used. For example:
18931.code
18932require_files = mail:/some/file
18933require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
18934.endd
18935If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
18936&%require_files%& condition fails.
18937
18938Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
18939checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
18940directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
18941access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
18942
18943&*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
18944incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
18945may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
18946may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
18947user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
18948
18949&*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
18950&[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
18951without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
18952is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
18953check again in that process.
18954
18955The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
18956be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
18957existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
18958circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
18959not exist. If the filename (or the exclamation mark that precedes the filename
18960for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
18961as if the file did not exist. For example:
18962.code
18963require_files = +/some/file
18964.endd
18965If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
18966handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
18967option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
18968
18969
18970
18971.option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
18972.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18973.cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
18974When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
18975in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
18976domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
18977other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
18978Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
18979latter kind.
18980
18981This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
18982hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
18983router. The default value is true for any router that has any of
18984&%check_local_user%&,
18985&%local_parts%&,
18986&%condition%&,
18987&%local_part_prefix%&,
18988&%local_part_suffix%&,
18989&%senders%& or
18990&%require_files%&
18991set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
18992for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
18993same name.
18994
18995Failing to set this option when it is needed
18996(because a remote router handles only some of the local-parts for a domain)
18997can result in incorrect error messages being generated.
18998
18999The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
19000appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
19001independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
19002
19003
19004
19005.option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
19006.cindex "router" "home directory for"
19007.cindex "home directory" "for router"
19008.vindex "&$home$&"
19009This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
19010&%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
19011transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
19012sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
19013forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
19014cause the router to defer.
19015
19016Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
19017&%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
19018place.
19019(See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19020are evaluated.)
19021While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
19022&$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
19023
19024When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
19025the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
19026delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
19027of these values that is set:
19028
19029.ilist
19030The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
19031.next
19032The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
19033.next
19034The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
19035.next
19036The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
19037.endlist
19038
19039In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
19040router, but not for the transport.
19041
19042
19043
19044.option self routers string freeze
19045.cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19046.cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19047This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
19048list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
19049and &(manualroute)& routers.
19050Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
19051of remote hosts.
19052Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
19053&(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
19054host on the list turns out to be the local host.
19055The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
19056&<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19057
19058Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
19059example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
19060error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
19061reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
19062freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
19063cases:
19064
19065.vlist
19066.vitem &%defer%&
19067Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
19068
19069.vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
19070The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
19071be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
19072behaviour is essentially a redirection.
19073
19074.vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
19075The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
19076reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
19077rewritten.
19078
19079.vitem &%pass%&
19080.oindex "&%more%&"
19081.vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
19082The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
19083&%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
19084subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
19085name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
19086distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
19087combination
19088.code
19089self = pass
19090no_more
19091.endd
19092ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
19093Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
19094be passed to the next router.
19095
19096.vitem &%fail%&
19097Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
19098
19099.vitem &%send%&
19100.cindex "local host" "sending to"
19101The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
19102setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
19103makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
19104is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
19105different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
19106.endlist
19107
19108
19109
19110.option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
19111.cindex "router" "checking senders"
19112If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
19113address matches something on the list.
19114See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19115are evaluated.
19116
19117There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
19118dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
19119setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
19120to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
19121set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
19122verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
19123SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
19124matters.
19125
19126
19127.option set routers "string list" unset
19128.cindex router variables
19129This option may be used multiple times on a router;
19130because of this the list aspect is mostly irrelevant.
19131The list separator is a semicolon but can be changed in the
19132usual way.
19133
19134Each list-element given must be of the form &"name = value"&
19135and the names used must start with the string &"r_"&.
19136Values containing a list-separator should have them doubled.
19137When a router runs, the strings are evaluated in order,
19138to create variables which are added to the set associated with
19139the address.
19140The variable is set with the expansion of the value.
19141The variables can be used by the router options
19142(not including any preconditions)
19143and by the transport.
19144Later definitions of a given named variable will override former ones.
19145Variable use is via the usual &$r_...$& syntax.
19146
19147This is similar to the &%address_data%& option, except that
19148many independent variables can be used, with choice of naming.
19149
19150
19151.option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
19152.cindex "IP address" "translating"
19153.cindex "packet radio"
19154.cindex "router" "IP address translation"
19155There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
19156it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
19157mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
19158routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
19159is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
19160code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
19161SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
19162
19163.vindex "&$host_address$&"
19164The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
19165by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
19166expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
19167For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
19168If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
19169address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
19170up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
19171produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
19172addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
19173.code
19174translate_ip_address = \
19175 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
19176 {$value}fail}}
19177.endd
19178The file would contain lines like
19179.code
1918010.2.3.128/26 some.host
1918110.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
19182.endd
19183You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
19184are doing.
19185
19186
19187
19188.option transport routers string&!! unset
19189This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
19190and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
19191only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
19192after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
19193and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
19194delivery is deferred.
19195
19196The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
19197have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
19198(see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
19199
19200
19201
19202.option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
19203.cindex "current directory for local transport"
19204This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
19205to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
19206explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
19207file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
19208option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
19209overridden by a setting on the transport.
19210If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19211logged, and delivery is deferred.
19212See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
19213environment.
19214
19215
19216
19217
19218.option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
19219.cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
19220This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
19221local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
19222configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
19223pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
19224string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
19225setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
19226If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19227logged, and delivery is deferred.
19228
19229If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
19230&%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
19231the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
19232the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
19233is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
19234
19235See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
19236environment.
19237
19238
19239
19240
19241.option unseen routers boolean&!! false
19242.cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
19243The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
19244that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
19245result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
19246fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
19247delivery to be deferred.
19248
19249When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
19250address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
19251overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
19252&%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
19253the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
19254sometimes true and sometimes false).
19255
19256.cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
19257Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
19258qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
19259delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
19260In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
19261&-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
19262to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
19263&%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
19264
19265&*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
19266this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
19267only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
19268no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
19269a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
19270duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
19271duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
19272&<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
19273so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
19274&%redirect%& router may be of help.
19275
19276Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
19277&%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
19278subsequent routers.
19279
19280
19281.option user routers string&!! "see below"
19282.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19283.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19284.cindex "transport" "local"
19285.cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
19286.cindex "filter" "user for processing"
19287When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
19288specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
19289The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
19290error is logged and delivery is deferred.
19291This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
19292The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
19293the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
19294a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
19295See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
19296&<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19297
19298
19299
19300.option verify routers&!? boolean true
19301Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
19302&%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
19303
19304
19305.option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
19306.cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
19307.oindex "&%-bv%&"
19308.cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
19309If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
19310delivering in cutthrough mode or
19311testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
19312with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
19313restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
19314&%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
19315
19316&*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
19317SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
19318accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
19319user or group.
19320
19321
19322.option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
19323If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
19324addresses,
19325delivering in cutthrough mode
19326or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
19327See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19328are evaluated.
19329See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19330
19331
19332.option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
19333If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
19334or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
19335See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19336are evaluated.
19337See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19338.ecindex IIDgenoprou1
19339.ecindex IIDgenoprou2
19340
19341
19342
19343
19344
19345
19346. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19347. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19348
19349.chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
19350.cindex "&(accept)& router"
19351.cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
19352The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
19353used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
19354be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
19355specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
19356it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
19357up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
19358.code
19359localusers:
19360 driver = accept
19361 domains = mydomain.example
19362 check_local_user
19363 transport = local_delivery
19364.endd
19365The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
19366&%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
19367When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
19368address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
19369
19370
19371
19372
19373
19374
19375. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19376. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19377
19378.chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
19379.scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
19380.scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
19381The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
19382recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
19383unless &%verify_only%& is set.
19384
19385If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
19386SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
19387MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
19388However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
19389records.
19390
19391MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
19392looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
19393When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
19394except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
19395IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
19396generic option, the router declines.
19397
19398Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
19399to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
19400are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
19401
19402.cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19403.cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19404.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
19405If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
19406address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
19407happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
19408
19409
19410.section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
19411There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
19412Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
19413SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
19414MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
19415problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
19416
19417For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
19418&%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
19419&(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
19420an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
19421domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
19422such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
19423proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
19424look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
19425case routing fails.
19426
19427
19428.section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
19429.cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
19430There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
19431an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
19432domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
19433
19434The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
19435is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
19436
19437Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
19438.ilist
19439The domain does not exist in DNS
19440.next
19441The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
19442convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
19443for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
19444.next
19445Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
19446.next
19447MX record points to a non-existent host.
19448.next
19449MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
19450&%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
19451.next
19452MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
19453addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
19454.next
19455The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
19456&%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
19457.next
19458&%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
19459not be found in the MX records (see below)
19460.endlist
19461
19462
19463
19464
19465.section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
19466.cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
19467The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
19468
19469.option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
19470.cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
19471If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
19472(and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
19473process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
19474differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
19475the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19476
19477
19478.option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
19479.cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
19480The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
19481addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
19482enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
19483required. For example,
19484.code
19485check_srv = smtp
19486.endd
19487looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
19488expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
19489to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
19490submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
19491option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
19492normal way.
19493
19494When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
19495the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
19496host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
19497this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
19498SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
19499according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
19500
19501When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
19502the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
19503records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
19504this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
19505defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
19506and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
19507have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
19508trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
19509
19510See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
19511when there is a DNS lookup error.
19512
19513
19514
19515
19516.option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19517.cindex "MX record" "not found"
19518DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
19519which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
19520rather than the default behaviour of decline.
19521This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
19522domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
19523However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
19524also being queued.
19525
19526
19527.option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
19528.cindex IPv6 disabling
19529.cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
19530The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19531or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19532(checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19533only A records are used.
19534
19535.option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
19536.cindex IPv4 preference
19537.cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
19538The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19539or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19540(checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19541A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
19542
19543.option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19544.cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
19545.cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
19546A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
19547record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
19548For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
19549records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
19550setting:
19551.code
19552mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
19553.endd
19554This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
19555has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
19556the address record.
19557
19558
19559.option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19560If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19561DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
19562&<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19563
19564
19565
19566
19567.option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
19568.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19569.cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
19570When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
19571lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
19572single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
19573called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
19574&'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
19575resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
19576&'resolv.conf'&.
19577
19578
19579
19580.option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
19581.cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
19582.cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
19583If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
19584qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
19585an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
19586expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
19587occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
19588&%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
19589any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
19590header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
19591
19592This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
19593ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
19594sense.
19595
19596When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
19597servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
19598making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
19599some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
19600name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
19601header rewriting.
19602
19603
19604.option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
19605.cindex "address" "copying routing"
19606Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
19607to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
19608options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19609default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19610servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19611any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19612
19613If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19614domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
19615local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19616lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
19617routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
19618message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
19619without processing them independently,
19620provided the following conditions are met:
19621
19622.ilist
19623No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
19624&%headers_remove%&.
19625.next
19626The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
19627the domain.
19628.endlist
19629
19630
19631
19632
19633.option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
19634.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19635When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
19636lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
19637applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
19638the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
19639domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
19640up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
19641&'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
19642actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
19643
19644Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
19645record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
19646local wildcard.
19647
19648
19649
19650.option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19651If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19652DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
19653&<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19654
19655
19656
19657
19658.option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
19659.cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
19660If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
19661added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
19662if
19663.code
19664widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
19665.endd
19666is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
19667&'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
19668&'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
19669and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
19670the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
19671when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
19672
19673
19674.section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
19675When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
19676of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
19677corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
19678is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
19679
19680These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
19681for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
19682such as that implied by
19683.code
19684domains = @mx_any
19685.endd
19686that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
19687entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
19688.ecindex IIDdnsrou1
19689.ecindex IIDdnsrou2
19690
19691
19692
19693
19694
19695
19696
19697
19698
19699. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19700. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19701
19702.chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
19703.cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
19704.cindex "domain literal" "routing"
19705.cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
19706This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
19707verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
19708generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
19709takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
19710router handles the address
19711.code
19712root@[192.168.1.1]
19713.endd
19714by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
19715consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
19716are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
19717.code
19718postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
19719.endd
19720Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
19721grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
19722
19723.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
19724If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
19725declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
19726&%self%& option determines what happens.
19727
19728The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
19729controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
19730also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
19731Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
19732
19733
19734
19735. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19736. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19737
19738.chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
19739.cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
19740.cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
19741The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
19742Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
19743not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
19744must set
19745.code
19746ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
19747.endd
19748in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
19749
19750The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
19751connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
19752a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
19753message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
19754this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
19755can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
19756must not be specified for it.
19757
19758.cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
19759.option hosts iplookup string unset
19760This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
19761names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
19762(or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
19763and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
19764happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
19765
19766
19767.option optional iplookup boolean false
19768If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
19769is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
19770delivery to the address is deferred.
19771
19772
19773.option port iplookup integer 0
19774.cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
19775This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
19776call.
19777
19778
19779.option protocol iplookup string udp
19780This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
19781protocols is to be used.
19782
19783
19784.option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
19785This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
19786default value is:
19787.code
19788$local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
19789.endd
19790The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
19791query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
19792
19793
19794.option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
19795If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
19796returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
19797string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
19798in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
19799&$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
19800whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
19801up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
19802
19803
19804.option response_pattern iplookup string unset
19805This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
19806returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
19807router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
19808response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
19809check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
19810address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
19811the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
19812following could be used:
19813.code
19814response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
19815reroute = $local_part@$1
19816.endd
19817
19818.option timeout iplookup time 5s
19819This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
19820machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
19821call. It does not apply to UDP.
19822
19823
19824
19825
19826. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19827. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19828
19829.chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
19830.scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
19831.scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
19832.cindex "domain" "manually routing"
19833The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
19834routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
19835route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
19836normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
19837route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
19838messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
19839
19840The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
19841it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
19842has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
19843include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
19844&"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
19845generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
19846being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
19847
19848.vindex "&$host$&"
19849In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
19850router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
19851an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
19852transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
19853with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
19854passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
19855host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
19856text string.
19857
19858The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
19859&%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
19860or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
19861any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
19862below, following the list of private options.
19863
19864
19865.section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
19866
19867.cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
19868The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
19869
19870.option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
19871See &%host_find_failed%&.
19872
19873.option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
19874This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
19875address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
19876of the following values:
19877.code
19878decline
19879defer
19880fail
19881freeze
19882ignore
19883pass
19884.endd
19885The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
19886error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
19887forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
19888&%pass_router%&),
19889.oindex "&%more%&"
19890overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
19891router only if &%more%& is true.
19892
19893The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
19894cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
19895controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
19896as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
19897
19898The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
19899state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
19900generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
19901
19902
19903.option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
19904.cindex "randomized host list"
19905.cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
19906If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
19907is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
19908overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
19909crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
19910same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
19911(even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
19912deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
19913
19914When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
19915into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
19916set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
19917item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
19918.code
19919route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
19920.endd
19921The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
19922randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
19923If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
19924randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
19925&%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
19926
19927
19928.option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
19929If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
19930Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
19931example:
19932.code
19933route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
19934.endd
19935If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
19936router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
19937deferred.
19938
19939
19940.option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
19941This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
19942unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
19943that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
19944
19945
19946.option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
19947.cindex "address" "copying routing"
19948Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
19949router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
19950router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19951default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19952servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19953any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19954
19955If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19956domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
19957local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19958lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
19959&(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
19960addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
19961same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
19962if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
19963
19964
19965
19966
19967.section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
19968The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
19969rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
19970entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
19971described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19972Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
19973.display
19974<&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
19975.endd
19976The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
19977no options:
19978.code
19979route_list = \
19980 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
19981 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19982.endd
19983The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
19984list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
19985usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
19986single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
19987pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
19988&<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
19989except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
19990That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
19991lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
19992in a &%route_list%&).
19993
19994The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
19995matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
19996then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
19997&%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
19998
19999
20000
20001.section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
20002The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
20003routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
20004hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
20005The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
20006Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
20007expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
20008like this:
20009.code
20010dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
20011thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
20012.endd
20013This data can be accessed by setting
20014.code
20015route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
20016.endd
20017Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
20018decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
20019requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
20020possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
20021be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
20022
20023
20024
20025
20026.section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
20027A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
20028always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
20029declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
20030and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports.
20031If the list is written with spaces, it must be protected with quotes.
20032The format of each item
20033in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
20034as described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&.
20035
20036If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
20037variables are set during its expansion:
20038
20039.ilist
20040.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20041If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
20042&$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
20043.code
20044route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
20045.endd
20046.next
20047&$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
20048.next
20049&$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
20050
20051.next
20052.vindex "&$value$&"
20053If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
20054looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
20055.code
20056route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
20057.endd
20058.endlist
20059
20060Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
20061semicolon is the default route list separator.
20062
20063
20064
20065.section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
20066Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
20067optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
20068is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
20069specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
20070by a colon. This leads to some complications:
20071
20072.ilist
20073Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
20074the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
20075be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
20076.code
20077route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
20078route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
20079.endd
20080.next
20081When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
20082colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
20083enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
20084number follows. For example:
20085.code
20086route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
20087.endd
20088.endlist
20089
20090.section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
20091When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
20092the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
20093delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
20094option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
20095transport.
20096
20097Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
20098hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
20099interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
20100records in the DNS. For example:
20101.code
20102route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
20103.endd
20104If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
20105example:
20106.code
20107route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
20108.endd
20109If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
20110randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
20111that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
20112be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
20113Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
20114happens is controlled by the
20115.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20116&%self%& option of the router.
20117
20118A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
20119hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
20120lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
20121below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
20122preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
20123randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
20124defined by MX preferences.
20125
20126If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
20127not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
20128preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
20129
20130If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
20131depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
20132is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
20133Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
20134
20135If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
20136most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
20137router.
20138
20139DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
20140failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
20141&%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
20142
20143The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
20144whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
20145
20146
20147
20148.section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
20149The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
20150One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
20151&%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
20152other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
20153per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
20154routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
20155
20156.ilist
20157&%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
20158setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20159.next
20160&%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
20161overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20162.next
20163&%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
20164find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
20165also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
20166.next
20167&%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
20168no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
20169timeout), delivery is deferred.
20170.next
20171&%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
20172.next
20173&%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
20174.endlist
20175
20176For example:
20177.code
20178route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
20179 domain2 host4:host5
20180.endd
20181If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
20182DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
20183result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
20184or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
20185call.
20186
20187&*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
20188called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
20189instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
20190lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
20191function called.
20192
20193&*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
20194inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
20195option specified.
20196
20197
20198
20199If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
20200&%host_find_failed%& option.
20201
20202.vindex "&$host$&"
20203When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
20204The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
20205
20206
20207
20208.section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
20209In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
20210transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
20211
20212.ilist
20213.cindex "smart host" "example router"
20214The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
20215&'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
20216named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
20217.code
20218domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
20219.endd
20220You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
20221your first router something like this:
20222.code
20223smart_route:
20224 driver = manualroute
20225 domains = !+local_domains
20226 transport = remote_smtp
20227 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
20228.endd
20229This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
20230&'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
20231they are tried in order
20232(but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
20233Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
20234.code
20235smart_route:
20236 driver = manualroute
20237 transport = remote_smtp
20238 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
20239.endd
20240There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
20241However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
20242example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
20243precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
20244always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
20245would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
20246always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
20247&%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
20248
20249.next
20250.cindex "mail hub example"
20251A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
20252records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
20253the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
20254machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
20255&(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
20256to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
20257using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
20258lookup is easier to manage.
20259
20260If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
20261to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
20262example:
20263.code
20264hub_route:
20265 driver = manualroute
20266 transport = remote_smtp
20267 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
20268.endd
20269This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
20270whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
20271if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
20272that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
20273domain can be used to find the host:
20274.code
20275through_firewall:
20276 driver = manualroute
20277 transport = remote_smtp
20278 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
20279.endd
20280The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
20281hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
20282data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
20283next router.
20284
20285.next
20286.cindex "batched SMTP output example"
20287.cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
20288You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
20289SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
20290storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
20291can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
20292.code
20293save_in_file:
20294 driver = manualroute
20295 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
20296 route_list = saved.domain.example
20297.endd
20298though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
20299several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
20300different transports can be listed in the routing information:
20301.code
20302save_in_file:
20303 driver = manualroute
20304 route_list = \
20305 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
20306 *.saved.domain2.example \
20307 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
20308 batch_pipe
20309.endd
20310.vindex "&$domain$&"
20311.vindex "&$host$&"
20312The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
20313doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
20314file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
20315the address if the lookup fails.
20316
20317.next
20318.cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
20319Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
20320&(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
20321one way it can be done:
20322.code
20323# Transport
20324uucp:
20325 driver = pipe
20326 user = nobody
20327 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
20328 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
20329 return_fail_output = true
20330
20331# Router
20332uucphost:
20333 transport = uucp
20334 driver = manualroute
20335 route_data = \
20336 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
20337.endd
20338The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
20339.code
20340darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
20341.endd
20342It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
20343makes clear the distinction between the domain name
20344&'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
20345.endlist
20346.ecindex IIDmanrou1
20347.ecindex IIDmanrou2
20348
20349
20350
20351
20352
20353
20354
20355
20356. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20357. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20358
20359.chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
20360.scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
20361.scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
20362.cindex "routing" "by external program"
20363The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
20364and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
20365mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
20366However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
20367&%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
20368be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
20369options:
20370.cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
20371
20372.option command queryprogram string&!! unset
20373This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
20374command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
20375expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
20376&<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
20377
20378
20379.option command_group queryprogram string unset
20380.cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
20381This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
20382address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
20383uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
20384gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
20385
20386
20387.option command_user queryprogram string unset
20388.cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
20389This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
20390command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
20391it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
20392using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
20393not set, a value for the gid also.
20394
20395&*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
20396root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
20397However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
20398usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
20399is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
20400the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
20401gid.
20402
20403
20404.option current_directory queryprogram string /
20405This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
20406before running the command.
20407
20408
20409.option timeout queryprogram time 1h
20410If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
20411is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
20412timeout.
20413
20414
20415The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
20416the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
20417containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
20418the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
20419field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
20420
20421.ilist
20422&'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
20423below).
20424.next
20425&'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
20426&%no_more%& is set.
20427.next
20428&'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
20429subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
20430of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
20431included in the SMTP response.
20432.next
20433&'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
20434subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
20435included in any SMTP response.
20436.next
20437&'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
20438.next
20439&'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
20440&%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
20441.next
20442&'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
20443new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
20444or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
20445.endlist
20446
20447When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
20448number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
20449the page):
20450.code
20451ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
20452LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
20453.endd
20454The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
20455is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
20456used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
20457an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
20458
20459The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
20460As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
20461in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
20462&`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
20463(see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
20464
20465If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
20466find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
20467anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
20468goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
20469result of the lookup is the result of that call.
20470
20471.vindex "&$address_data$&"
20472If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
20473variable. For example, this return line
20474.code
20475accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
20476.endd
20477routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
20478the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
20479.ecindex IIDquerou1
20480.ecindex IIDquerou2
20481
20482
20483
20484
20485. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20486. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20487
20488.chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
20489.scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
20490.scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
20491.cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
20492.cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
20493The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
20494common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
20495(usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
20496files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
20497redirected in several different ways:
20498
20499.ilist
20500It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
20501independently.
20502.next
20503It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
20504.next
20505It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
20506.next
20507It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
20508.next
20509It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
20510.next
20511It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
20512.next
20513It can be discarded.
20514.endlist
20515
20516The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
20517However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
20518files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
20519&%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
20520
20521If success DSNs have been requested
20522.cindex "DSN" "success"
20523.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
20524redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
20525
20526
20527
20528.section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
20529The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
20530expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
20531contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
20532options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
20533aliases, in a configuration like this:
20534.code
20535system_aliases:
20536 driver = redirect
20537 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
20538.endd
20539If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
20540expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
20541expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
20542cause delivery to be deferred.
20543
20544A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
20545&_.forward_& files, like this:
20546.code
20547userforward:
20548 driver = redirect
20549 check_local_user
20550 file = $home/.forward
20551 no_verify
20552.endd
20553If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
20554empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
20555is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
20556yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
20557comments.
20558
20559.new
20560&*Warning*&: It is unwise to use &$local_part$& or &$domain$&
20561directly for redirection,
20562as they are provided by a potential attacker.
20563In the examples above, &$local_part$& is used for looking up data held locally
20564on the system, and not used directly (the second example derives &$home$& via
20565the passsword file or database, using &$local_part$&).
20566.wen
20567
20568
20569
20570.section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
20571.cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
20572It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
20573&_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
20574
20575.ilist
20576When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
20577running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
20578the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
20579practice the router may not be able to operate.
20580.next
20581However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
20582is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
20583local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
20584saves some resources.
20585.endlist
20586
20587
20588
20589
20590
20591
20592.section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
20593.cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20594.cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20595The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
20596can be interpreted in two different ways:
20597
20598.ilist
20599If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
20600&"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
20601&'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
20602respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
20603in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
20604document is intended for use by end users.
20605.next
20606Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
20607described in the next section.
20608.endlist
20609
20610When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the filename given
20611in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
20612generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
20613configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
20614for the &(appendfile)& transport.
20615
20616
20617
20618.section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
20619.cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
20620When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
20621comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
20622addresses, filenames, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
20623&<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
20624disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
20625depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
20626commas or newlines.
20627If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
20628quotes.
20629
20630Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
20631also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
20632next newline character is ignored.
20633
20634If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
20635double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
20636(but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
20637&"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
20638removed.
20639
20640.vindex "&$local_part$&"
20641&*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
20642and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
20643of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
20644special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
20645&'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
20646setting:
20647.code
20648data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
20649.endd
20650
20651
20652.section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
20653.cindex "routing" "loops in"
20654.cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
20655.cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
20656A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
20657consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
20658automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
20659is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
20660Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
20661as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
20662complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
20663
20664.cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
20665Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
20666filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
20667mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
20668&'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
20669.code
20670cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
20671.endd
20672.cindex "backslash in alias file"
20673.cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
20674For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
20675preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
20676it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
20677synonymously.
20678
20679If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
206802822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
20681domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
20682addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
20683force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
20684
20685Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
20686Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
20687contains:
20688.code
20689Sam.Reman: spqr
20690.endd
20691Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
20692messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
20693this forward file:
20694.code
20695Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20696.endd
20697With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
20698&(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
20699second time round, because it has previously routed it,
20700and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
20701should really contain
20702.code
20703spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20704.endd
20705but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
20706below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
20707&(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
20708
20709
20710
20711.section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
20712In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
20713lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
20714
20715.ilist
20716.cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
20717.cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
20718An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
20719as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
20720command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
20721Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20722which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20723
20724Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
20725the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
20726the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
20727in double quotes, for example:
20728.code
20729"|/some/command ready,steady,go"
20730.endd
20731since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
20732quote just the command. An item such as
20733.code
20734|"/some/command ready,steady,go"
20735.endd
20736is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
20737
20738Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
20739of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
20740redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
20741quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
20742string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
20743are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
20744data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
20745transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
20746an &%accept%& router.
20747
20748.next
20749.cindex "file" "in redirection list"
20750.cindex "address redirection" "to file"
20751An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
20752parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
20753.code
20754/home/world/minbari
20755.endd
20756is treated as a filename, but
20757.code
20758/s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
20759.endd
20760is treated as an address. For a filename, a transport must be specified using
20761the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
20762forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
20763filename, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
20764
20765Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20766which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20767
20768.cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
20769However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
20770bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
20771instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
20772
20773.next
20774.cindex "included address list"
20775.cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
20776If an item is of the form
20777.code
20778:include:<path name>
20779.endd
20780a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
20781point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
20782out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
20783by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
20784item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
20785the alias name. This example is incorrect:
20786.code
20787list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
20788.endd
20789It must be given as
20790.code
20791list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
20792.endd
20793.next
20794.cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
20795.cindex "delivery" "discard"
20796.cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
20797.cindex "black hole"
20798.cindex "abandoning mail"
20799Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
20800&%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
20801the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
20802.code
20803:blackhole:
20804.endd
20805can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
20806done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
20807&_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
20808
20809&*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
20810delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
20811are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
20812database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
20813&_/dev/null_&.
20814
20815.next
20816.cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
20817.cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
20818.cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
20819.cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
20820.cindex "customizing" "failure message"
20821An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
20822redirection items of the form
20823.code
20824:defer:
20825:fail:
20826.endd
20827respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
20828to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
20829text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
20830associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
20831.code
20832X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
20833.endd
20834In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
20835of a
20836.cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
20837VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
20838default.
20839.cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
20840The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
20841the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
20842
20843.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20844By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
20845&':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
20846space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
20847followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
20848code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
20849incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
20850suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
20851&%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
20852ignored.
20853
20854.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
20855In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
20856default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
20857therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
20858
20859Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
20860not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
20861normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
20862as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
20863lookup and in &':include:'& files.
20864
20865During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
20866containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
20867whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain in the queue so that a
20868subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
20869deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
20870rules still apply.
20871
20872.next
20873.cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
20874Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
20875chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
20876for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
20877&':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
20878router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
20879results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
20880.endlist
20881
20882
20883.section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
20884.cindex "duplicate addresses"
20885.cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
20886.cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
20887Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
20888to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
20889routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
20890aliasing scheme of the type
20891.code
20892pipe: |/some/command $local_part
20893localpart1: pipe
20894localpart2: pipe
20895.endd
20896does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
20897when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
20898discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
20899such as
20900.code
20901localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
20902localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
20903.endd
20904does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
20905the pipes are distinct.
20906
20907
20908
20909.section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
20910.cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
20911.cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
20912When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
20913leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
20914afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
20915delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
20916members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
20917can be used to avoid this.
20918
20919
20920.section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
20921.cindex "address redirection" "errors"
20922If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
20923error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
20924for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
20925detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
20926deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
20927
20928
20929
20930.section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
20931
20932.cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
20933The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
20934
20935
20936.option allow_defer redirect boolean false
20937Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
20938data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
20939
20940
20941.option allow_fail redirect boolean false
20942.cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
20943If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
20944and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
20945
20946
20947.option allow_filter redirect boolean false
20948.cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
20949.cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
20950Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
20951&"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
20952are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
20953lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
20954
20955It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
20956the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
20957
20958
20959The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
20960&%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
20961&%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
20962files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
20963true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
20964
20965
20966
20967.option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
20968.cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
20969Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
20970This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
20971default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
20972let ordinary users do.
20973
20974
20975
20976.option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
20977This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
20978as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
20979Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
20980configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
20981for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
20982
20983When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
20984is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
20985the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
20986and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
20987domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
20988&_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
20989.code
20990\Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
20991.endd
20992Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
20993&"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
20994originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
20995(having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
20996&"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
20997&%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
20998file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
20999original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
21000
21001
21002.option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
21003When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
21004when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
21005&%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
21006&%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
21007deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
21008is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
21009&%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
21010
21011
21012
21013.option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
21014When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
21015this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
21016permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
21017option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
21018&%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
21019
21020
21021.option data redirect string&!! unset
21022This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
21023set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
21024list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
21025expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
21026has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
21027
21028When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
21029filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
21030terminated with newline characters. For example:
21031.code
21032data = #Exim filter\n\
21033 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
21034.endd
21035If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
21036you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
21037choice into a newline.
21038
21039
21040.option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
21041A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
21042ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
21043specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
21044configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
21045
21046
21047.option file redirect string&!! unset
21048This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
21049is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
21050use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
21051failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
21052must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
21053data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
21054entirely of comments), the router declines.
21055
21056.cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
21057If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
21058runs a check on the containing directory,
21059unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
21060If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
21061happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
21062is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
21063not, the router declines.
21064
21065
21066.option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
21067.vindex "&$address_file$&"
21068A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
21069ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
21070specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
21071configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
21072it is running, the filename is in &$address_file$&.
21073
21074
21075.option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
21076When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
21077relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
21078relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
21079relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
21080
21081
21082.option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
21083.cindex "restricting access to features"
21084.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21085If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
21086redirection list.
21087
21088
21089.option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
21090.cindex "restricting access to features"
21091.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21092If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
21093&%allow_filter%& is true.
21094
21095
21096
21097
21098.option forbid_file redirect boolean false
21099.cindex "restricting access to features"
21100.cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
21101.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21102.cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
21103.cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
21104If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
21105specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
21106conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
21107set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
21108locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
21109
21110
21111.option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
21112.cindex "restricting access to features"
21113.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21114If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21115make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
21116functions.
21117
21118.option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
21119.cindex "restricting access to features"
21120.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21121.cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
21122If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21123make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
21124
21125.option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
21126.cindex "restricting access to features"
21127.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21128If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
21129permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
21130under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
21131&_.forward_& files).
21132
21133
21134.option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
21135.cindex "restricting access to features"
21136.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21137If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21138to make use of &%lookup%& items.
21139
21140
21141.option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
21142.cindex "restricting access to features"
21143.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21144This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
21145it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
21146of the embedded Perl support.
21147
21148
21149.option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
21150.cindex "restricting access to features"
21151.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21152If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21153to make use of &%readfile%& items.
21154
21155
21156.option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
21157.cindex "restricting access to features"
21158.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21159If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21160to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
21161
21162
21163.option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
21164.cindex "restricting access to features"
21165.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21166If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
21167message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
21168files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
21169&%one_time%& is set.
21170
21171
21172.option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
21173.cindex "restricting access to features"
21174.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21175If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21176to make use of &%run%& items.
21177
21178
21179.option forbid_include redirect boolean false
21180.cindex "restricting access to features"
21181.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21182If this option is true, items of the form
21183.code
21184:include:<path name>
21185.endd
21186are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
21187
21188
21189.option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
21190.cindex "restricting access to features"
21191.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21192.cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
21193If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
21194specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
21195forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
21196
21197
21198.option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
21199.cindex "restricting access to features"
21200.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21201If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
21202&%allow_filter%& is true.
21203
21204
21205.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
21206.option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
21207If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
21208of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
21209the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
21210
21211
21212
21213
21214.option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
21215.cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
21216If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
21217generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
21218generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
21219bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
21220bounce may well quote the generated address.
21221
21222
21223.option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
21224.cindex "EACCES"
21225If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21226EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
21227file did not exist.
21228
21229
21230.option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
21231.cindex "ENOTDIR"
21232If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21233ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
21234router behaves as if the file did not exist.
21235
21236Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
21237router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
21238(the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
21239against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
21240is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
21241is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
21242a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
21243that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
21244
21245
21246
21247.option include_directory redirect string unset
21248If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
21249redirection list must start with this directory.
21250
21251
21252.option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
21253This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
21254&%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
21255
21256
21257.option one_time redirect boolean false
21258.cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
21259.cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
21260.cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
21261.cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
21262.cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
21263Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
21264files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
21265of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
21266is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
21267but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
21268message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
21269lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
21270before they subscribed.
21271
21272If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
21273deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
21274&"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
21275&"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
21276attempt.
21277
21278&*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
21279router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
21280reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
21281permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
21282
21283&*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
21284to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
21285and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
21286
21287&*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
21288&%one_time%&.
21289
21290The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
21291addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
21292addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
21293&%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
21294typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
21295expansion.
21296
21297
21298.option owners redirect "string list" unset
21299.cindex "ownership" "alias file"
21300.cindex "ownership" "forward file"
21301.cindex "alias file" "ownership"
21302.cindex "forward file" "ownership"
21303This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
21304This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
21305See &%check_owner%& above.
21306
21307
21308.option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
21309This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
21310The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
21311&%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
21312
21313
21314.option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
21315.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
21316A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
21317starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
21318transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
21319name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
21320When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
21321
21322
21323.option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
21324.vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
21325If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
21326generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
21327in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
21328expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
21329to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
21330&$qualify_recipient$&.
21331
21332This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
21333but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
21334not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
21335addresses.
21336
21337.option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
21338.cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
21339.cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
21340.cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
21341If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
21342set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
21343without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
21344address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
21345&%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
21346this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
21347
21348
21349.option repeat_use redirect boolean true
21350If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
21351any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
21352the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
21353only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
21354&%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
21355
21356
21357.option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
21358A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
21359&%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
21360by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
21361transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
21362are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
21363
21364
21365.option rewrite redirect boolean true
21366.cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
21367If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
21368subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
21369and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
21370
21371
21372.option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
21373The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
21374:subaddress part of an address.
21375
21376.option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
21377The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
21378of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
21379(including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
21380
21381
21382.option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
21383.cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
21384To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
21385&%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
21386(do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
21387&%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
21388needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
21389
21390
21391
21392.option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
21393.cindex "forward file" "broken"
21394.cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
21395.cindex "alias file" "broken"
21396.cindex "broken alias or forward files"
21397.cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
21398.cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
21399.cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
21400If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
21401non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
21402&%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
21403giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
21404are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
21405&%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
21406be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
21407&%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
21408
21409If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
21410errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
21411the following routers.
21412
21413If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
21414error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
21415taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
21416so it is passed to the following routers.
21417
21418.cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
21419Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
21420action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
21421&%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
21422
21423&%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
21424lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
21425option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
21426notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
21427.code
21428userforward:
21429 driver = redirect
21430 allow_filter
21431 check_local_user
21432 file = $home/.forward
21433 file_transport = address_file
21434 pipe_transport = address_pipe
21435 reply_transport = address_reply
21436 no_verify
21437 skip_syntax_errors
21438 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
21439 syntax_errors_text = \
21440 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
21441 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
21442 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
21443 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
21444 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
21445 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
21446 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
21447 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
21448 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
21449 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
21450.endd
21451You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
21452&`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
21453put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
21454.code
21455real_localuser:
21456 driver = accept
21457 check_local_user
21458 local_part_prefix = real-
21459 transport = local_delivery
21460.endd
21461For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
21462router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
21463.code
21464 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
21465 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
21466.endd
21467
21468
21469.option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
21470See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21471
21472
21473.option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
21474See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21475.ecindex IIDredrou1
21476.ecindex IIDredrou2
21477
21478
21479
21480
21481
21482
21483. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21484. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21485
21486.chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
21487 "Environment for local transports"
21488.scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
21489.scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
21490.scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
21491Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
21492transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
21493in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
21494mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
21495
21496Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
21497some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
21498transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
21499&<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
21500
21501The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
21502different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
21503settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
21504or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
21505configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
21506
21507
21508
21509.section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
21510.cindex "concurrent deliveries"
21511.cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
21512If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
21513simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
21514the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
21515rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
21516time.
21517
21518However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
21519locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
21520.code
21521my_transport:
21522 driver = pipe
21523 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
21524.endd
21525This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
21526messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
21527&%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
21528file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
21529
21530
21531
21532
21533.section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
21534.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
21535.cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
21536All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
21537overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
21538set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
21539delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
21540group (set by the transport). For example:
21541.code
21542# Routers ...
21543# User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
21544local_users:
21545 driver = accept
21546 check_local_user
21547 transport = group_delivery
21548
21549# Transports ...
21550# This transport overrides the group
21551group_delivery:
21552 driver = appendfile
21553 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21554 group = mail
21555.endd
21556If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
21557address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
21558gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
21559set.
21560
21561.oindex "&%initgroups%&"
21562When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
21563function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
21564&%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
21565by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
21566for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
21567
21568.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
21569The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
21570is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
21571receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
21572original gid is also used.
21573
21574This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
21575following that is set is used:
21576
21577.ilist
21578A &%group%& setting of the transport;
21579.next
21580A &%group%& setting of the router;
21581.next
21582A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
21583&%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
21584.next
21585The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
21586.next
21587In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
21588the uid is the creator's uid;
21589.next
21590The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
21591.endlist
21592
21593If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
21594no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
21595This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
21596The first of the following that is set is used:
21597
21598.ilist
21599A &%user%& setting of the transport;
21600.next
21601In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
21602.next
21603A &%user%& setting of the router;
21604.next
21605A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
21606.next
21607The Exim uid.
21608.endlist
21609
21610Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
21611&%never_users%& list.
21612
21613
21614
21615
21616
21617.section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
21618.cindex "current directory for local transport"
21619.cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
21620.cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
21621.cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
21622Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
21623the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
21624However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
21625are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
21626for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21627
21628.ilist
21629The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
21630.next
21631The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
21632.next
21633The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
21634.next
21635The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
21636.endlist
21637
21638The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21639
21640.ilist
21641The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
21642.next
21643The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
21644.endlist
21645
21646
21647If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
21648value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
21649directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
21650
21651
21652
21653.section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
21654.vindex "&$domain$&"
21655.vindex "&$local_part$&"
21656.vindex "&$original_domain$&"
21657Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
21658variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
21659deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
21660at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
21661other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
21662never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
21663and &$original_domain$& is never set.
21664.ecindex IIDenvlotra1
21665.ecindex IIDenvlotra2
21666.ecindex IIDenvlotra3
21667
21668
21669
21670
21671
21672
21673
21674. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21675. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21676
21677.chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
21678.scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
21679.scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
21680.scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
21681The following generic options apply to all transports:
21682
21683
21684.option body_only transports boolean false
21685.cindex "transport" "body only"
21686.cindex "message" "transporting body only"
21687.cindex "body of message" "transporting"
21688If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
21689mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
21690or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
21691&%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
21692automatically suppress them.
21693
21694
21695.option current_directory transports string&!! unset
21696.cindex "transport" "current directory for"
21697This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
21698transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
21699If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
21700logged, and delivery is deferred.
21701
21702
21703.option disable_logging transports boolean false
21704If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
21705deliveries by the transport or for any
21706transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
21707what you are doing.
21708
21709
21710.option debug_print transports string&!! unset
21711.cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
21712If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
21713option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
21714transport is run.
21715If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
21716output, and Exim carries on processing.
21717This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
21718so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
21719option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
21720variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
21721one.
21722The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
21723transport and the router that called it.
21724
21725.option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
21726.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
21727If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
21728This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
21729header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
21730requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
21731safely be resent to other recipients.
21732
21733
21734.option driver transports string unset
21735This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
21736There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
21737
21738
21739.option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
21740.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21741If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
21742This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
21743delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
21744configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
21745address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
21746header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
21747its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
21748resent to other recipients.
21749
21750
21751.option event_action transports string&!! unset
21752.cindex events
21753This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
21754For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
21755
21756
21757.option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
21758.cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
21759This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
21760value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
21761&%user%& (see below).
21762
21763
21764.option headers_add transports list&!! unset
21765.cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
21766.cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
21767This option specifies a list of text headers,
21768newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
21769which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
21770portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
21771&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
21772routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21773is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21774errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21775
21776Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
21777for a transport; all listed headers are added.
21778
21779
21780.option headers_only transports boolean false
21781.cindex "transport" "header lines only"
21782.cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
21783.cindex "header lines" "transporting"
21784If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
21785exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
21786transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
21787checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
21788
21789
21790.option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
21791.cindex "header lines" "removing"
21792.cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
21793This option specifies a list of header names,
21794colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
21795these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
21796in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
21797routers.
21798Each list item is separately expanded.
21799If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21800is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21801errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21802
21803Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
21804for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
21805
21806&*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
21807items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
21808To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
21809
21810
21811
21812.option headers_rewrite transports string unset
21813.cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
21814.cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
21815This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
21816that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
21817option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
21818the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
21819message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
21820example,
21821.code
21822headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
21823 x@y w@z
21824.endd
21825changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
21826&'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
21827header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
21828only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
21829the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
21830filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
21831affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
21832envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
21833change envelope recipients at this time.
21834
21835
21836.option home_directory transports string&!! unset
21837.cindex "transport" "home directory for"
21838.vindex "&$home$&"
21839This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
21840overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
21841placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
21842used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
21843&%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
21844&%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
21845for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
21846deferred.
21847
21848
21849.option initgroups transports boolean false
21850.cindex "additional groups"
21851.cindex "groups" "additional"
21852.cindex "transport" "group; additional"
21853If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
21854transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
21855to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
21856
21857
21858.option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
21859.cindex limit "transport parallelism"
21860.cindex transport "parallel processes"
21861.cindex transport "concurrency limit"
21862.cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
21863If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
21864it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
21865The control does not apply to shadow transports.
21866
21867.cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
21868Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
21869incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
21870is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
21871Obviously there is scope for
21872records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21873guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21874
21875If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
21876relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21877start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21878may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21879are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
21880
21881
21882.option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
21883.cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
21884.cindex "size" "of message, limit"
21885.cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
21886This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
21887expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
21888digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
21889including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
21890delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
21891message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
21892the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
21893ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
21894&%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
21895delivered.
21896
21897
21898
21899.option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
21900.cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
21901.cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
21902.cindex "local part" "prefix"
21903.cindex "local part" "suffix"
21904When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
21905affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
21906form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
21907that contains
21908.code
21909local_part_prefix = *-
21910.endd
21911routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
21912is delivered with
21913.code
21914RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
21915.endd
21916This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
21917recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
21918whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
21919deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
21920&(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
21921
21922
21923.option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
21924.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
21925When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
21926in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
21927is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
21928deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
21929part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
21930temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
21931deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
21932
21933However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
21934as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
21935(For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
21936this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
21937
21938For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
21939the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
21940on a remote transport in the current implementation.
21941
21942
21943.option return_path transports string&!! unset
21944.cindex "envelope sender"
21945.cindex "envelope from"
21946.cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
21947.cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
21948If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
21949the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
21950that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
21951designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
21952SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
21953only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
21954header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
21955
21956&*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
21957&%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
21958
21959.vindex "&$return_path$&"
21960The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
21961either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
21962&%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
21963replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
21964option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
21965section &<<SECTverp>>&.
21966
21967&*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
21968remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
21969the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
21970This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
21971&%errors_to%& in a router.
21972
21973
21974
21975.option return_path_add transports boolean false
21976.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
21977If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
21978Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
21979mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
21980have easy access to it.
21981
21982RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
21983the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
21984header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
21985option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
21986incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
21987recipients.
21988
21989
21990.option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
21991See &%shadow_transport%& below.
21992
21993
21994.option shadow_transport transports string unset
21995.cindex "shadow transport"
21996.cindex "transport" "shadow"
21997A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
21998another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
21999
22000Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
22001&%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
22002string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
22003passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
22004expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
22005cause a log line to be written.
22006
22007The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
22008subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
22009provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
22010is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
22011ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
22012of the form
22013.code
22014ST=<shadow transport name>
22015.endd
22016If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
22017parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
22018purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
22019provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
22020headers that some sites insist on.
22021
22022
22023.option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
22024.cindex "transport" "filter"
22025.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22026This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
22027at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
22028individual users or via a system filter.
22029If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
22030
22031When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
22032&%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
22033the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
22034input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
22035command must be specified as an absolute path.
22036
22037The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
22038terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
22039SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
22040lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
22041settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
22042&(pipe)& transports.
22043
22044The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
22045standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
22046destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
22047filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
22048are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
22049
22050The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
22051care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
22052test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
22053SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
22054
22055.cindex "content scanning" "per user"
22056A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
22057at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
22058message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
22059a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
22060not possible to discard a message at this stage.
22061
22062.cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
22063A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
22064being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
22065support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
22066at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
22067more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
22068the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
22069additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
22070
22071.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22072The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
22073the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
22074parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
22075Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
22076section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
22077to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
22078of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
22079an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
22080&(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
22081
22082.vindex "&$host$&"
22083.vindex "&$host_address$&"
22084The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
22085transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
22086which the message is being sent. For example:
22087.code
22088transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
22089 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
22090.endd
22091
22092Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
22093generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
22094command is split up &'before'& expansion.
22095.ilist
22096If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
22097part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
22098expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
22099example:
22100.code
22101transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
22102.endd
22103This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
22104&(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
22105stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
22106the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
22107&`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
22108Exim tried to expand the first one.
22109.next
22110Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
22111expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
22112arguments. Consider this example:
22113.code
22114transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
22115 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
22116.endd
22117The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
22118if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
22119.code
22120transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
22121 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
22122.endd
22123.endlist
22124
22125The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
22126For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
22127normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
22128A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
22129serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
22130the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
22131bounced from a transport filter.
22132
22133If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
22134passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
22135message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
22136
22137
22138.option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
22139.cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
22140When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
22141that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
22142temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
22143&(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
22144way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
22145error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
22146becomes a temporary error.
22147
22148
22149.option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
22150.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22151.cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
22152This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
22153run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
22154given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
22155associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
22156option is not set.
22157
22158For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
22159specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
22160&%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
22161
22162.cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
22163For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
22164sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
22165to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
22166retry data.
22167.ecindex IIDgenoptra1
22168.ecindex IIDgenoptra2
22169.ecindex IIDgenoptra3
22170
22171
22172
22173
22174
22175
22176. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22177. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22178
22179.chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
22180 "Address batching"
22181.cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
22182The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
22183one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
22184remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
22185normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
22186transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
22187copy of the message is delivered each time.
22188
22189.cindex "batched local delivery"
22190.oindex "&%batch_max%&"
22191.oindex "&%batch_id%&"
22192In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
22193local transport, for example:
22194
22195.ilist
22196In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
22197delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
22198recipients saves space.
22199.next
22200In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
22201a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
22202.next
22203In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
22204to a scanner program or
22205to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
22206acceptable.
22207.endlist
22208
22209These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
22210(&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
22211repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
22212
22213The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
22214delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
22215(no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
22216&%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
22217(that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
22218to certain conditions:
22219
22220.ilist
22221.vindex "&$local_part$&"
22222If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
22223batching is possible.
22224.next
22225.vindex "&$domain$&"
22226If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
22227addresses with the same domain are batched.
22228.next
22229.cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
22230If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
22231addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
22232customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
22233including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
22234from taking place.
22235.next
22236Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
22237delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
22238group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
22239be the same.
22240.endlist
22241
22242In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
22243both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
22244is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
22245course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
22246option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
22247&"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
22248&%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
22249.code
22250check_string = "."
22251escape_string = ".."
22252.endd
22253when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
22254given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
22255&%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
22256
22257.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
22258If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
22259&'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
22260that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
22261transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
22262addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
22263
22264.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
22265.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22266If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
22267transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
22268the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
22269of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
22270argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
22271delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
22272are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
22273
22274
22275
22276
22277. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22278. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22279
22280.chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
22281.scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
22282.scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
22283.cindex "directory creation"
22284.cindex "creating directories"
22285The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
22286file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
22287files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
22288format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
22289University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
22290being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
22291to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
22292delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
22293supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
22294directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
22295
22296The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
22297default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
22298SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
22299included.
22300
22301.cindex "quota" "system"
22302Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
22303also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
22304system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
22305
22306If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
22307partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
22308modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
22309creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
22310
22311Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
22312file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
22313private options.
22314
22315The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
22316users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
22317putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
22318&"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
22319option).
22320
22321
22322
22323.section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
22324The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
22325the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
22326the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
22327normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
22328
22329.vindex "&$address_file$&"
22330.vindex "&$local_part$&"
22331However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
22332directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
22333forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
22334user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
22335the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
22336name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
22337operation. There are two cases:
22338
22339.ilist
22340If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
22341must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
22342common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
22343different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
22344default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
22345name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
22346&%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
22347.next
22348If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
22349used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
22350contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
22351.endlist
22352
22353
22354.cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
22355.cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
22356As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
22357have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
22358form:
22359.code
22360save folder23
22361.endd
22362or Sieve filter commands of the form:
22363.code
22364require "fileinto";
22365fileinto "folder23";
22366.endd
22367In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
22368must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute filename. In the
22369case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
22370is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
22371way of handling this requirement:
22372.code
22373file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
22374 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
22375 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
22376 {$address_file} \
22377 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
22378 }} \
22379 }
22380.endd
22381With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
22382location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
22383&_mail_& directory within the home directory.
22384
22385&*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
22386&_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
22387the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
22388you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
22389&%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
22390path to the transport.
22391
22392&*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
22393the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
22394
22395
22396
22397
22398.section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
22399.cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
22400
22401
22402
22403.option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
22404.cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
22405.cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
22406.cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
22407Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
22408regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
22409delivery is deferred.
22410
22411
22412.option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
22413.cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22414.cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22415By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
22416that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
22417are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
22418what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
22419are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
22420
22421
22422.option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
22423See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22424However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
22425happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
22426file.
22427
22428
22429.option batch_max appendfile integer 1
22430See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22431
22432
22433.option check_group appendfile boolean false
22434When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
22435option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
22436delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
22437file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
22438
22439
22440.option check_owner appendfile boolean true
22441When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
22442is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
22443process is running.
22444
22445
22446.option check_string appendfile string "see below"
22447.cindex "&""From""& line"
22448As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
22449matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
22450replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
22451a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
22452contains is significant.
22453
22454If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
22455are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
22456configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
22457&">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
22458&%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
22459
22460The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
22461suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
22462&"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
22463if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
22464.cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
22465.cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
22466.code
22467check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22468escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
22469message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22470message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22471.endd
22472.option create_directory appendfile boolean true
22473.cindex "directory creation"
22474When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
22475directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
22476is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
22477
22478The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
22479operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
22480example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
22481is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
22482in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
22483
22484
22485
22486.option create_file appendfile string anywhere
22487This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
22488by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
22489directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
22490delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
22491beneath.
22492
22493The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
22494&"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
22495set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit filename is
22496given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when filenames
22497are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
22498by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
22499&%file_must_exist%&.
22500
22501
22502.option directory appendfile string&!! unset
22503This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
22504or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
22505redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
22506
22507When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
22508into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
22509appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
22510(see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
22511&<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
22512
22513
22514.option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
22515.cindex "base62"
22516.vindex "&$inode$&"
22517When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
22518&%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
22519whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
22520.code
22521q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
22522.endd
22523This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
22524inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
22525option.
22526
22527
22528.option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
22529If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
22530&%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
22531
22532
22533.option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
22534See &%check_string%& above.
22535
22536
22537.option file appendfile string&!! unset
22538This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
22539&%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
22540of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
22541specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
22542&%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
22543&%file%&.
22544
22545.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22546.cindex "locking files"
22547.cindex "lock files"
22548If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
22549mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
22550
22551The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
22552path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
22553examples:
22554.code
22555file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
22556file = /home/$local_part/inbox
22557file = $home/inbox
22558.endd
22559.cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
22560In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
22561is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
22562create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
22563deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
22564run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
22565
22566
22567
22568.option file_format appendfile string unset
22569.cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
22570This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
22571before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
22572start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
22573colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
22574second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
22575string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
22576transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
22577this added to it:
22578.code
22579file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
22580 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
22581.endd
22582Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
22583a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
22584to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
22585to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
22586is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
22587match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
22588delivery is deferred.
22589
22590
22591.option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
22592If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
22593A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
22594If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
22595
22596
22597.option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
22598.cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22599.cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
22600.cindex "locking files"
22601By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
22602when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
22603sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
22604Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
22605for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
22606deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
22607mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
22608misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
22609
22610On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
22611not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
22612is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
22613and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
22614
22615If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
22616timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
22617retries is
22618.code
22619(lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
22620.endd
22621rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
22622which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
22623&%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
22624
22625You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
22626local deliveries because of errors of the form
22627.code
22628failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
22629.endd
22630
22631.option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
22632This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
22633&%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
22634&%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
22635
22636
22637.option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
22638This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
22639for details of locking.
22640
22641
22642.option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
22643This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
22644is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
22645
22646
22647.option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22648This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
22649used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
22650
22651
22652.option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
22653.cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22654When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
22655exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
22656accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
22657
22658
22659.option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
22660.cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22661.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22662If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22663number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
22664followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
22665external source that maintains the data.
22666
22667
22668.option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
22669.cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22670.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22671If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22672size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
22673This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
22674maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
22675it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
22676
22677
22678
22679.option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
22680.cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
22681If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
22682file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
22683transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
22684&(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
22685&%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
22686directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
22687SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
22688&<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22689
22690
22691.option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
22692.cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
22693.cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
22694This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
22695a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
22696directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
22697calculation. The default value is:
22698.code
22699maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
22700.endd
22701This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
22702(directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
22703&_Trash_&
22704folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
22705.code
22706maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
22707.endd
22708This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
22709directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
22710calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
22711directly into that directory.
22712
22713
22714.option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
22715This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
22716&"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22717
22718
22719.option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
22720This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
22721section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22722
22723
22724.option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
22725.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22726The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
22727If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
22728creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
22729quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
22730value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
22731&<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22732
22733.option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
22734.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
22735.cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
22736The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
22737effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
22738matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
22739containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
22740delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
22741&_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
22742See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
22743
22744
22745.option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
22746.cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
22747If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
22748new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
22749SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
22750below for further details.
22751
22752
22753.option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
22754This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22755section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22756
22757
22758.option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
22759This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22760section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22761
22762
22763.option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
22764.cindex "locking files"
22765.cindex "file" "locking"
22766.cindex "file" "MBX format"
22767.cindex "MBX format, specifying"
22768This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22769set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
22770the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
22771traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
22772IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
22773
22774&*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
22775automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
22776empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
22777combination:
22778.code
22779mbx_format = true
22780message_prefix =
22781message_suffix =
22782.endd
22783If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
22784&%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
22785is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
22786&%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
22787interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
22788should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
22789going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
22790mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
22791
22792If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
22793the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
22794(this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
22795append messages to it.
22796
22797
22798.option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22799.cindex "&""From""& line"
22800The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22801The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22802in which case it is:
22803.code
22804message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
22805 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
22806.endd
22807&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22808&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22809
22810.option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22811The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22812The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22813in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
22814setting
22815.code
22816message_suffix =
22817.endd
22818&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22819&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22820
22821.option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22822If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
22823has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
22824permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
22825if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
22826a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
22827value, and this option is ignored.
22828
22829
22830.option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
22831This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
22832mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
22833true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
22834continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
22835
22836
22837.option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
22838If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
22839successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
22840on users about incoming mail.
22841
22842
22843.option quota appendfile string&!! unset
22844.cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
22845This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
22846or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
22847is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
22848all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
22849individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
22850&%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
22851have no shell access to their mailboxes).
22852
22853As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
22854multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
22855For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
22856
22857A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
22858may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
22859If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
22860become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
22861Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
22862the obvious value which users understand most easily.
22863
22864The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
22865(decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
22866for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
22867and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
22868large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
22869be handled.
22870
22871The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22872quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22873
22874&*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
22875
22876The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
22877the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
22878be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
22879fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
22880system quota failures.
22881
22882By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
22883mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
22884last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
22885during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
22886refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
22887message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
22888changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
22889for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
22890continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
22891delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
22892
22893
22894.option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
22895This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
22896into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
22897called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
22898delivery directory.
22899
22900
22901.option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
22902This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
22903number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
22904can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
22905failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
22906&"no quota"&.
22907
22908The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22909quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22910
22911.option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
22912See &%quota%& above.
22913
22914
22915.option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
22916This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
22917for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
22918these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
22919If this is set to a regular expression that matches the filename, and it
22920captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
22921file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
22922
22923This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
22924&-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
22925facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
22926the file length to the filename. For example:
22927.code
22928maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
22929quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
22930.endd
22931An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
22932number of lines in the message.
22933
22934The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
22935filename (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
22936sometimes add other information onto the ends of message filenames.
22937
22938Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
22939
22940This option should not be used when other message-handling software
22941may duplicate messages by making hardlinks to the files. When that is done Exim
22942will count the message size once for each filename, in contrast with the actual
22943disk usage. When the option is not set, calculating total usage requires
22944a system-call per file to get the size; the number of links is then available also
22945as is used to adjust the effective size.
22946
22947
22948.option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
22949See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
22950&%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
22951.code
22952quota_warn_message = "\
22953 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
22954 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
22955 This message is automatically created \
22956 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
22957 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
22958 a warning threshold that is\n\
22959 set by the system administrator.\n"
22960.endd
22961
22962
22963.option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
22964.cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
22965.cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
22966.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22967This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
22968resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
22969size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
22970threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
22971may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
22972sign. For example:
22973.code
22974quota = 10M
22975quota_warn_threshold = 75%
22976.endd
22977If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
22978percent sign is ignored.
22979
22980The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
22981and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
22982warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
22983the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
22984can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
22985&'From:'& line, the default is:
22986.code
22987From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
22988.endd
22989.oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
22990If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
22991option.
22992
22993The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
22994are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
22995percentage.
22996
22997
22998.option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
22999.cindex "envelope from"
23000.cindex "envelope sender"
23001If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
23002format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
23003you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
23004so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
23005for details of batch SMTP.
23006
23007
23008.option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
23009.cindex "carriage return"
23010.cindex "linefeed"
23011This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
23012(carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
23013of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
23014of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
23015
23016&*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
23017(which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
23018in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
23019carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
23020have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
23021changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
23022
23023
23024.option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
23025This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
23026exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
23027&%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
23028that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
23029&%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
23030
23031
23032.option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
23033This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
23034the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
23035&[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
23036each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
23037
23038This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
23039&[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
23040where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
23041both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
23042
23043.cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
23044Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
23045have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
23046&[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
23047the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
23048error.
23049
23050&*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
23051is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
23052
23053
23054.option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
23055If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
23056appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
23057&[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
23058sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
23059&[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
23060delivering over NFS from more than one host.
23061
23062.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23063In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
23064necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
23065achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
23066file corruption.
23067
23068The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
23069It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
23070except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
23071
23072
23073.option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
23074This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
23075set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
23076locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
23077of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
23078are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
23079the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
23080rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
23081does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
23082
23083You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
23084&%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
23085MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
23086without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
23087
23088
23089
23090
23091.section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
23092.cindex "appending to a file"
23093.cindex "file" "appending"
23094Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
23095
23096.ilist
23097If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
23098return is given.
23099
23100.next
23101.cindex "directory creation"
23102If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
23103&%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
23104&%directory_mode%& option.
23105
23106.next
23107If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
23108indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
23109transport.
23110
23111.next
23112.cindex "file" "locking"
23113.cindex "locking files"
23114.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23115If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
23116reliably over NFS, as follows:
23117
23118.olist
23119Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
23120current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
23121as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
23122.next
23123Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock filename.
23124.next
23125If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
23126Unlink the hitching post name.
23127.next
23128Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
23129then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
23130of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
23131restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
23132.next
23133If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
23134up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
23135mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
23136lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
23137existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
23138it before trying again.
23139.endlist olist
23140
23141.next
23142A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
23143so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
23144than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
23145
23146.next
23147.cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
23148.cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
23149If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
23150&%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
23151checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
23152is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
23153ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
23154directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
23155idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
23156checked.
23157
23158.next
23159If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
23160and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
23161different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
23162delivery is deferred.
23163
23164.next
23165If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
23166If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
23167is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
23168permissions.
23169
23170.next
23171The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
23172If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
23173hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
23174
23175.next
23176If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
23177changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
23178have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
23179
23180.next
23181If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
23182option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
23183directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
23184open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
23185except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
23186set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
23187the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
23188that prevents link following.
23189
23190.next
23191.cindex "loop" "while file testing"
23192If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
23193existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
23194being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
23195after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
23196
23197.next
23198If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
23199
23200.next
23201.cindex "file" "locking"
23202.cindex "locking files"
23203Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
23204are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
23205&%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
23206However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
23207file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
23208.code
23209/tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
23210.endd
23211using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
23212the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
23213the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
23214
23215If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
23216depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
23217&%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
23218
23219If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
23220&%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
23221to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
23222delivery is deferred.
23223
23224If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
23225&[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
23226waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
23227immediately. It retries up to
23228.code
23229(lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
23230.endd
23231times (rounded up).
23232.endlist
23233
23234At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
23235and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
23236
23237
23238.section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
23239.cindex "delivery" "to single file"
23240.cindex "&""From""& line"
23241When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
23242delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
23243activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
23244&%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
23245router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
23246configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
23247ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
23248
23249No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
23250locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
23251separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
23252of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
23253newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
23254&%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
23255any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
23256
23257If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
23258the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
23259different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
23260deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
23261
23262
23263.cindex "maildir format"
23264.cindex "mailstore format"
23265There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
23266done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
23267&%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
23268formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
23269SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
23270
23271.cindex "directory creation"
23272In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
23273sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
23274option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
23275constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
23276the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
23277&%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
23278deferred.
23279
23280
23281
23282.section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
23283.cindex "maildir format" "description of"
23284If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
23285it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
23286directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
23287directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
23288&_new_& subdirectory.
23289
23290In the filename, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
23291<&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
23292Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
23293before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
23294filename. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
23295opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
23296Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
23297
23298Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
23299called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
23300do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
23301path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
23302&%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
23303contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
23304&_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
23305&_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
23306
23307These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
23308and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
23309folders. Consider this example:
23310.code
23311maildir_format = true
23312directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
23313 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
23314 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
23315maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
23316.endd
23317If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
23318delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
23319the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
23320not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
23321&_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
23322&_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
23323
23324However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
23325delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
23326does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
23327&_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
23328directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
23329
23330&*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
23331not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
23332&_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
23333
23334.cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23335.cindex "maildir++"
23336If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
23337&%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
23338the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
23339Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
23340down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
23341the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
23342amount of space used.
23343
23344One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
23345computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
23346checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
23347needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
23348use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
23349of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
23350
23351
23352
23353
23354.section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
23355If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
23356When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
23357tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
23358name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
23359the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
23360
23361
23362.vindex "&$message_size$&"
23363Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
23364&%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
23365happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
23366variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
23367forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
23368be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
23369Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
23370empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
23371colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
23372maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
23373backwards compatibility).
23374
23375For one common implementation, you might set:
23376.code
23377maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
23378.endd
23379but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
23380
23381It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
23382as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
23383&[stat()]& each message file.
23384
23385
23386.section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
23387.cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23388.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
23389If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
23390storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
23391within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
23392creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
23393the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
23394to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
23395
23396The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
23397messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
23398in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
23399value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
23400is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
23401need to know the quota.
23402
23403If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
23404file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
23405
23406A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
23407maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
23408See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
23409details.
23410
23411
23412.section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
23413.cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
23414If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
23415files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
23416message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
23417this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
23418contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
23419itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
23420
23421During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
23422&_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
23423&_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
23424mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
23425file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
23426the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
23427
23428The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
23429option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
23430the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
23431There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
23432greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
23433appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
23434
23435If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
23436failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
23437configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
23438&$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
23439
23440
23441.section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
23442If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
23443file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
23444messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
23445section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
23446.code
23447directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
23448.endd
23449might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
23450then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
23451expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
23452.ecindex IIDapptra1
23453.ecindex IIDapptra2
23454
23455
23456
23457
23458
23459
23460. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23461. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23462
23463.chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
23464.scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
23465.scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
23466The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
23467the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
23468automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
23469&'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
23470to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
23471
23472If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
23473&%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
23474delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
23475that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
23476another router can set up a normal message delivery.
23477
23478
23479The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
23480&"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
23481directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
23482message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
23483empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
23484
23485The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
23486by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
23487passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
23488transport is run as a consequence of a
23489&%mail%&
23490or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
23491supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
23492that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
23493case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
23494is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
23495&%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
23496
23497&(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
23498command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
23499gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
23500&<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
23501
23502There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
23503that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
23504&(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
23505address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
23506separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
23507the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
23508message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
23509
23510Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
23511message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
23512immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
23513the transport defers.
23514Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
23515controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
23516
23517If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
23518&%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
23519of the original message that is included in the generated message when
23520&%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
23521
23522.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23523If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
23524the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
23525as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
23526is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
23527problems. They are just discarded.
23528
23529
23530
23531.section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
23532.cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
23533
23534.option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
23535This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
23536message when the message is specified by the transport.
23537
23538
23539.option cc autoreply string&!! unset
23540This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
23541when the message is specified by the transport.
23542
23543
23544.option file autoreply string&!! unset
23545The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
23546is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
23547string comes first.
23548
23549
23550.option file_expand autoreply boolean false
23551If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
23552subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
23553
23554
23555.option file_optional autoreply boolean false
23556If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
23557option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
23558
23559
23560.option from autoreply string&!! unset
23561This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
23562specified by the transport.
23563
23564
23565.option headers autoreply string&!! unset
23566This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
23567when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
23568&"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
23569
23570
23571.option log autoreply string&!! unset
23572This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
23573the message is specified by the transport.
23574
23575
23576.option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
23577If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
23578used.
23579
23580
23581.option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
23582If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
23583item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
23584discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
23585generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
23586
23587
23588
23589.option once autoreply string&!! unset
23590This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
23591recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
23592This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
23593
23594If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
23595By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty filename, the message
23596is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
23597However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
23598message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
23599this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
23600prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
23601infinity.
23602
23603If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
23604and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
23605greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
23606Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
23607regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
23608
23609In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
23610which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
23611be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
23612means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
23613unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
23614file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
23615
23616
23617.option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
23618See &%once%& above.
23619
23620
23621.option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
23622See &%once%& above.
23623After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
23624
23625
23626.option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
23627This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
23628specified by the transport.
23629
23630
23631.option return_message autoreply boolean false
23632If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
23633message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
23634configuration option.
23635
23636
23637.option subject autoreply string&!! unset
23638This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
23639specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
23640automatic responses. For example:
23641.code
23642subject = Re: $h_subject:
23643.endd
23644There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
23645subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
23646bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
23647non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
23648small.
23649
23650
23651
23652.option text autoreply string&!! unset
23653This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
23654message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
23655the text comes first.
23656
23657
23658.option to autoreply string&!! unset
23659This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
23660when the message is specified by the transport.
23661.ecindex IIDauttra1
23662.ecindex IIDauttra2
23663
23664
23665
23666
23667. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23668. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23669
23670.chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
23671.cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
23672.cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
23673.cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
23674.cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
23675The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
23676specified command
23677or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
23678This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
23679transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
23680implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
23681to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
23682has it commented out. You need to ensure that
23683.code
23684TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
23685.endd
23686.cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
23687is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
23688included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
23689as follows:
23690
23691.option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
23692See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23693
23694
23695.option batch_max lmtp integer 1
23696This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23697Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
23698good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
23699batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23700
23701
23702.option command lmtp string&!! unset
23703This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
23704is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
23705arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
23706number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
23707is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
23708LMTP protocol.
23709
23710.option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
23711.cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23712If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
23713commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
23714in its response to the LHLO command.
23715
23716.option socket lmtp string&!! unset
23717This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
23718be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
23719delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
23720
23721
23722.option timeout lmtp time 5m
23723The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
23724respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
23725is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
23726LMTP transport:
23727.code
23728lmtp:
23729 driver = lmtp
23730 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
23731 batch_max = 20
23732 user = exim
23733.endd
23734This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
23735necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
23736
23737
23738
23739. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23740. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23741
23742.chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
23743.scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
23744.scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
23745The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
23746running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
23747pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
23748(such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
23749their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
23750following ways:
23751
23752.ilist
23753.vindex "&$local_part$&"
23754A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
23755transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
23756contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
23757is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
23758.next
23759.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23760If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
23761transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
23762more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
23763(because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
23764(described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
23765that are routed to the transport.
23766.next
23767.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
23768A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
23769alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
23770pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
23771&%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
23772(&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
23773this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
23774.endlist
23775
23776
23777The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
23778deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
23779implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
23780
23781In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
23782&_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
23783other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
23784transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
23785directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
23786details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
23787for a discussion of local delivery batching.
23788
23789
23790.section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
23791If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
23792delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
23793any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
23794write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
23795Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
23796of "1" to enforce serialization.
23797
23798
23799
23800
23801.section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
23802.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
23803If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
23804have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
23805the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
23806in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
23807later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
23808logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
23809&"local delivery failed"&.
23810
23811If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
23812the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
23813will be sent as normal.
23814
23815If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
23816script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
23817value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
23818apply in this case.
23819
23820If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
23821return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
23822asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
23823a non-existent command may be the problem.
23824
23825The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
23826set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
23827error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
23828return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
23829included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
23830similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
23831failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
23832&%temp_errors%&.
23833
23834
23835
23836.section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
23837.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
23838The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
23839by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
23840&%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
23841run.
23842
23843.cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
23844Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
23845double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
23846way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
23847
23848String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
23849traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
23850expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
23851For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
23852quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
23853.code
23854command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
23855.endd
23856will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
23857arguments. You have to write
23858.code
23859command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
23860.endd
23861to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
23862argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
23863result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
23864interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
23865generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
23866expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
23867example:
23868.code
23869command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
23870.endd
23871
23872.cindex "transport" "filter"
23873.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23874.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23875Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
23876&`$pipe_addresses`& (no quotes).
23877This is not a general expansion variable; the only
23878place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
23879transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
23880inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
23881avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
23882&(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
23883
23884If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, special handling takes place
23885for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
23886is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
23887argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
23888&'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
23889the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
23890should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
23891run while preserving the argument vector separation.
23892
23893After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
23894in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
23895message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
23896standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
23897read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
23898may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
23899control what is done with it.
23900
23901Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
23902in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
23903taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
23904explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
23905where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
23906under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
23907an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
23908works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
23909as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
23910&%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
23911with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
23912
23913
23914
23915.section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
23916.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23917.cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23918The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
23919This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
23920the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
23921environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
23922to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
23923.display
23924&`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
23925&`HOME `& the home directory, if set
23926&`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
23927&`LOCAL_PART `& see below
23928&`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
23929&`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
23930&`LOGNAME `& see below
23931&`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
23932&`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
23933&`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
23934&`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
23935&`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
23936&`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
23937&`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
23938&`USER `& see below
23939.endd
23940When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
23941router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
23942called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
23943the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
23944removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
23945LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
23946same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
23947
23948.cindex "HOST"
23949HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
23950associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
23951pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
23952the router.
23953
23954.cindex "HOME"
23955If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
23956for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
23957by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
23958user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
23959
23960
23961.section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
23962.cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
23963
23964
23965
23966.option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
23967.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
23968The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23969permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
23970permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
23971paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
23972&%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
23973in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
23974the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
23975&%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
23976otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
23977example, if
23978.code
23979allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
23980.endd
23981and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
23982&_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
23983&%use_shell%& is set.
23984
23985
23986.option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
23987See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23988
23989
23990.option batch_max pipe integer 1
23991This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23992See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23993
23994
23995.option check_string pipe string unset
23996As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
23997&%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
23998by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
23999&%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
24000any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
24001of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
24002the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
24003ignored.
24004
24005
24006.option command pipe string&!! unset
24007This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
24008obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
24009set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
24010the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
24011Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
24012&<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
24013
24014
24015.option environment pipe string&!! unset
24016.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
24017.cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
24018This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
24019command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
24020a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
24021environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
24022
24023
24024.option escape_string pipe string unset
24025See &%check_string%& above.
24026
24027
24028.option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
24029.cindex "exec failure"
24030.cindex "failure of exec"
24031.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
24032Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
24033any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
24034is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
24035frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
24036
24037
24038.option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
24039.cindex "signal exit"
24040.cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
24041Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
24042a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
24043frozen in Exim's queue instead.
24044
24045
24046.option force_command pipe boolean false
24047.cindex "force command"
24048.cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
24049Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
24050the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
24051is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
24052useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
24053command. For example:
24054.code
24055command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
24056force_command
24057.endd
24058
24059Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
24060&%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
24061separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
24062
24063
24064.option ignore_status pipe boolean false
24065If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
24066run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
24067Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
24068from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
24069&%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
24070
24071&*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
24072See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
24073
24074
24075.option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
24076.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
24077If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
24078one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
24079and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
24080written to the main log.
24081
24082
24083.option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
24084If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
24085stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
24086the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
24087failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
24088option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
24089be set.
24090
24091
24092.option log_output pipe boolean false
24093If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
24094stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
24095the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
24096exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
24097
24098
24099.option max_output pipe integer 20K
24100This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
24101standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
24102process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
24103catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
24104the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
24105&%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
24106exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
24107
24108
24109.option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
24110The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
24111The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
24112.code
24113message_prefix = \
24114 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
24115 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
24116.endd
24117.cindex "Cyrus"
24118.cindex "&%tmail%&"
24119.cindex "&""From""& line"
24120This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
24121However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
24122or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
24123setting
24124.code
24125message_prefix =
24126.endd
24127&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24128&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
24129
24130
24131.option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
24132The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
24133The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
24134The suffix can be suppressed by setting
24135.code
24136message_suffix =
24137.endd
24138&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24139&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
24140
24141
24142.option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
24143This option is expanded and
24144specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
24145variable of the subprocess.
24146If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
24147sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
24148apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
24149
24150
24151.option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
24152Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
24153a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
24154during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
24155It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
24156for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
24157resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
24158installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
24159of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
24160
24161
24162.option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
24163.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
24164If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
24165process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
24166to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
24167&%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
24168accept the message is used.
24169
24170
24171.option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
24172When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
24173contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
24174in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
24175command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
24176handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
24177
24178
24179.option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
24180If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
24181return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
24182is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
24183However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
24184message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
24185&%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
24186
24187
24188
24189.option return_output pipe boolean false
24190If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
24191deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
24192is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
24193However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
24194output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
24195option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
24196of them may be set.
24197
24198
24199
24200.option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
24201.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
24202This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
24203asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
24204and &%return_output%& is not set,
24205and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
24206temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
24207numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
24208codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
24209defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
24210compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
24211and 73, respectively.
24212
24213
24214.option timeout pipe time 1h
24215If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
24216causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
24217specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
24218command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
24219and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
24220if one of the processes starts a new process group.
24221
24222.option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
24223A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
24224runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
24225treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
24226is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
24227delivery to be deferred.
24228
24229.option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
24230This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
24231
24232
24233.option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
24234.cindex "envelope sender"
24235If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
24236SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
24237commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
24238you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
24239&<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
24240
24241.option use_classresources pipe boolean false
24242.cindex "class resources (BSD)"
24243This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
24244BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
24245resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
24246limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
24247class database.
24248
24249
24250.option use_crlf pipe boolean false
24251.cindex "carriage return"
24252.cindex "linefeed"
24253This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
24254(carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
24255of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
24256of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
24257
24258The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
24259written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
24260are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
24261&%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
24262values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
24263
24264
24265.option use_shell pipe boolean false
24266.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24267If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
24268instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
24269&<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
24270where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
24271modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
24272&`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
24273command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
24274its &%-c%& option.
24275
24276
24277
24278.section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
24279.cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
24280.cindex "&'procmail'&"
24281.cindex "external local delivery"
24282.cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
24283.cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
24284The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
24285delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
24286this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
24287uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
24288by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
24289necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
24290appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
24291configuration for &%procmail%&:
24292.code
24293# transport
24294procmail_pipe:
24295 driver = pipe
24296 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
24297 return_path_add
24298 delivery_date_add
24299 envelope_to_add
24300 check_string = "From "
24301 escape_string = ">From "
24302 umask = 077
24303 user = $local_part
24304 group = mail
24305
24306# router
24307procmail:
24308 driver = accept
24309 check_local_user
24310 transport = procmail_pipe
24311.endd
24312In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
24313&'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
24314or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
24315user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
24316&%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
24317home directory is the user's home directory by default.
24318
24319&*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
24320.code
24321IFS=" "
24322.endd
24323as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
24324use a shell to run pipe commands.
24325
24326.cindex "Cyrus"
24327The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
24328deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
24329.code
24330# transport
24331local_delivery_cyrus:
24332 driver = pipe
24333 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
24334 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
24335 user = cyrus
24336 group = mail
24337 return_output
24338 log_output
24339 message_prefix =
24340 message_suffix =
24341
24342# router
24343local_user_cyrus:
24344 driver = accept
24345 check_local_user
24346 local_part_suffix = .*
24347 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
24348.endd
24349Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
24350&%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
24351sender.
24352.ecindex IIDpiptra1
24353.ecindex IIDpiptra2
24354
24355
24356. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24357. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24358
24359.chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
24360.scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
24361.scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
24362The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
24363or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
24364that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
24365explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
24366&<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
24367
24368
24369.section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
24370The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
24371two ways:
24372
24373.ilist
24374If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
24375routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
24376that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
24377the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
24378does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
24379value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
24380section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
24381.next
24382.cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
24383When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
24384looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
24385connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
24386for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
24387process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
24388process.
24389.endlist
24390
24391
24392For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
24393incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
24394no further messages are sent over that connection.
24395
24396
24397
24398.section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
24399.vindex "&$host$&"
24400.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24401At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
24402&$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
24403passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
24404specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
24405&$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
24406that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
24407&%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
24408
24409
24410.section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
24411.vindex &$tls_bits$&
24412.vindex &$tls_cipher$&
24413.vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
24414.vindex &$tls_sni$&
24415At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
24416&$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
24417are the values that were set when the message was received.
24418These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
24419SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
24420variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
24421appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
24422are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
24423&%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
24424
24425These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
24426and will be removed in a future release.
24427
24428
24429.section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
24430.cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
24431The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
24432
24433
24434.option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
24435.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
24436When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
24437is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
24438runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
24439reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
24440setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
24441problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
24442
24443.option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
24444.cindex "local host" "sending to"
24445.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24446When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
24447to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
24448deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
24449the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
24450configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
24451configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
24452
24453
24454.option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
24455.cindex "Cyrus"
24456When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
24457is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
24458overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
24459forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
24460to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
24461ignored.
24462
24463The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
24464started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
24465&$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
24466particular connection.
24467
24468If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
24469&%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
24470deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
24471unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
24472
24473This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
24474deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
24475&"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
24476.code
24477authenticated_sender = $local_part
24478.endd
24479This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
24480allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
24481
24482Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
24483domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
24484value.
24485
24486
24487.option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
24488If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
24489is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
24490authenticated as a client.
24491
24492
24493.option command_timeout smtp time 5m
24494This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
24495sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
24496remote host. Its value must not be zero.
24497
24498
24499.option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
24500This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
24501to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
24502several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
24503less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
24504systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
24505option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
24506
24507
24508.option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
24509.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
24510.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
24511.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24512This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
24513over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
24514For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
24515option.
24516
24517
24518.option dane_require_tls_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24519.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers for DANE"
24520.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24521.cindex DANE "TLS ciphers"
24522This option may be used to override &%tls_require_ciphers%& for connections
24523where DANE has been determined to be in effect.
24524If not set, then &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used.
24525Normal SMTP delivery is not able to make strong demands of TLS cipher
24526configuration, because delivery will fall back to plaintext. Once DANE has
24527been determined to be in effect, there is no plaintext fallback and making the
24528TLS cipherlist configuration stronger will increase security, rather than
24529counter-intuitively decreasing it.
24530If the option expands to be empty or is forced to fail, then it will
24531be treated as unset and &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used instead.
24532
24533
24534.option data_timeout smtp time 5m
24535This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
24536the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
24537of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
24538
24539
24540.option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
24541DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24542.option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
24543DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24544.option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
24545DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24546.option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
24547DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24548.option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
24549DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24550.option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
24551DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24552.option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
24553DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24554.option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
24555DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24556.option dkim_timestamps smtp string&!! unset
24557DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24558
24559
24560.option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
24561.cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
24562.cindex retry "final cutoff"
24563This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
24564domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
24565cutoff times.
24566
24567In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
24568them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
24569Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
24570retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
24571a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
24572unhappy at this prospect, so...
24573
24574If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24575addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
24576IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24577none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
24578delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
24579addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
24580continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
24581&%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
24582to them.
24583
24584
24585.option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
24586If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
24587and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
24588the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
24589in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
24590
24591
24592.option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
24593If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
24594&%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
24595See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
24596details.
24597
24598
24599.option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" *
24600.cindex "MX record" "security"
24601.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24602.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24603.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24604DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
24605the dnssec request bit set. Setting this transport option is only useful if the
24606transport overrides or sets the host names. See the &%dnssec_request_domains%&
24607router option.
24608
24609
24610
24611.option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24612.cindex "MX record" "security"
24613.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24614.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24615.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24616DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
24617the dnssec request bit set. Setting this transport option is only
24618useful if the transport overrides or sets the host names. See the
24619&%dnssec_require_domains%& router option.
24620
24621
24622
24623.option dscp smtp string&!! unset
24624.cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
24625This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
24626of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
24627The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
24628Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
24629&`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
24630
24631The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
24632(for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
24633that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
24634equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
24635Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
24636
24637
24638.option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
24639.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24640String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
24641colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
24642port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
24643&<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24644item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24645in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
24646
24647Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
24648addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
24649&%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
24650not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
24651&%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
24652However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
24653
24654If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
24655the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
24656transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
24657address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
24658list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
24659
24660Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
24661re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
24662addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
24663copy of the message is sent.
24664
24665The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
24666&%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
24667both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
24668from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
24669fails"& facility.
24670
24671
24672.option final_timeout smtp time 10m
24673This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
24674line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
24675zero.
24676
24677.option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
24678If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
24679being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
24680(or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
24681instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
24682it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
24683
24684.option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
24685This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
24686server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
24687implementations of TLS.
24688
24689.option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
24690.cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
24691.cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
24692.cindex "LHLO argument setting"
24693The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
24694been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
24695command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
24696option is:
24697.code
24698$primary_hostname
24699.endd
24700During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
24701the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
24702&$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
24703used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
24704servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
24705that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
24706interface address, you could use this:
24707.code
24708helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
24709 {$primary_hostname}}
24710.endd
24711The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
24712callouts.
24713
24714.option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
24715Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
24716finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
24717&(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
24718email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
24719all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
24720
24721The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
24722processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
24723&%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
24724&%hosts_override%& is set.
24725
24726The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
24727list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
24728separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
24729&<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24730item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24731in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
24732of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
24733
24734If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
24735the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
24736well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
24737address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
24738&[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
24739&%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
24740that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
24741address are used.
24742
24743During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
24744unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
24745
24746
24747.option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24748.cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
24749.cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
24750.cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
24751.cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24752This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
24753example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
24754matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
24755start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
24756facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
24757
24758
24759.option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
24760.cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24761Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
24762that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
24763
24764.option hosts_pipe_connect smtp "host list&!!" unset
24765.cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
24766.cindex "pipelining" PIPE_CONNECT
24767If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
24768this option controls which to hosts the facility watched for
24769and recorded, and used for subsequent connections.
24770
24771The retry hints database is used for the record,
24772and records are subject to the &%retry_data_expire%& option.
24773When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
24774It also turns SMTP into a client-first protocol
24775so combines well with TCP Fast Open.
24776
24777See also the &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& main option.
24778
24779Note:
24780When the facility is used, the transport &%helo_data%& option
24781will be expanded before the &$sending_ip_address$& variable
24782is filled in.
24783A check is made for the use of that variable, without the
24784presence of a &"def:"& test on it, but suitably complex coding
24785can avoid the check and produce unexpected results.
24786You have been warned.
24787
24788
24789.option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24790.cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24791Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24792matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24793
24794.option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24795.cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24796Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
24797or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
24798to any host that matches this list.
24799
24800
24801.option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
24802.cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24803.cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
24804.cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
24805.cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
24806This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
24807delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
24808&<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
24809
24810
24811.option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
24812This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
24813tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
24814why it exists.
24815
24816
24817
24818.option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24819.cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24820.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24821.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24822For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
24823been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24824message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
24825explanation of when this might be needed.
24826
24827.option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24828.cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24829.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24830.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24831For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
24832been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24833message on the same session.
24834
24835The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
24836process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
24837sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
24838instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
24839the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
24840The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
24841logging.
24842
24843
24844
24845.option hosts_override smtp boolean false
24846If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
24847attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
24848&%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
24849&%fallback_hosts%&.
24850
24851
24852.option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
24853.cindex "randomized host list"
24854.cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
24855.cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
24856If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
24857&%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
24858were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
24859router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
24860is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
24861list can be used to do crude load sharing.
24862
24863When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
24864order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
24865behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
24866&`+`& in the host list. For example:
24867.code
24868hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
24869.endd
24870The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
24871randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
24872If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
24873
24874.option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24875.cindex "authentication" "required by client"
24876This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
24877before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
24878servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
24879authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
24880temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
24881hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
24882&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24883
24884
24885.option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
24886.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24887Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
24888TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24889&%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24890
24891.option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24892.cindex DANE "transport options"
24893.cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
24894If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
24895TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
24896and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made. See
24897the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
24898There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24899See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24900
24901.option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24902.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24903Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
24904TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24905&%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24906
24907.option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24908.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24909Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24910matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24911&*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
24912incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
24913
24914.option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24915.cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
24916This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24917authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
24918connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
24919unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
24920&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24921
24922.option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
24923.cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
24924.cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
24925.cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
24926This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24927CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
24928.new
24929Unless DKIM signing is being done,
24930.wen
24931BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
24932
24933.option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" *
24934.cindex DANE "transport options"
24935.cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
24936If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
24937TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
24938and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made. See
24939the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
24940There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24941See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24942
24943.option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" *
24944.cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
24945.cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
24946.cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
24947This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
24948the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
24949perform a TCP Fast Open.
24950No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
24951supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
24952the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
24953
24954The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
24955as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
24956
24957On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
24958in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
24959There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
24960it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
24961such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
24962
24963.option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
24964.cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
24965This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24966PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
24967for multi-recipient messages.
24968The option can usually be left as default.
24969
24970.option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
24971.cindex "bind IP address"
24972.cindex "IP address" "binding"
24973.vindex "&$host$&"
24974.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24975This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
24976call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
24977&`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
24978message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
24979&$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
24980outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
24981interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
24982unknown.
24983
24984During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
24985&$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
24986during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
24987string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
24988string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
24989separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
24990For example:
24991.code
24992interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
24993.endd
24994The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
24995connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
24996&%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
24997interface to use if the host has more than one.
24998
24999
25000.option keepalive smtp boolean true
25001.cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
25002This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
25003connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
25004periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
25005of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
25006or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
25007that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
25008that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
25009TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
25010unreachable hosts.
25011
25012
25013.option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
25014.cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
25015If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
25016string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
25017has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
25018
25019.option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
25020.cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
25021This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
25022SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
25023so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
25024permits this.
25025
25026
25027.option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
25028.vindex "&$domain$&"
25029When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
25030addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
25031to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
25032handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
25033&$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
25034is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
25035
25036It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
25037&$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
25038&$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
25039
25040.option port smtp string&!! "see below"
25041.cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
25042.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
25043This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
25044&*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
25045received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
25046The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
25047variable that contains an outgoing port.
25048
25049If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
25050otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
25051normally &"smtp"&,
25052but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"& the default is &"lmtp"&
25053and if &%protocol%& is set to &"smtps"& the default is &"smtps"&.
25054If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
25055is deferred.
25056
25057Note that at least one Linux distribution has been seen failing
25058to put &"smtps"& in its &"/etc/services"& file, resulting is such deferrals.
25059
25060
25061
25062.option protocol smtp string smtp
25063.cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
25064.cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
25065.cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
25066.vindex "&$port$&"
25067If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
25068the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
25069protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
25070deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
25071over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
25072
25073If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
25074changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
25075connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
25076The Internet standards bodies used to strongly discourage use of this mode,
25077but as of RFC 8314 it is perferred over STARTTLS for message submission
25078(as distinct from MTA-MTA communication).
25079
25080
25081.option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
25082Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
25083constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
25084means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
25085tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
25086addresses is not affected.
25087
25088However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
25089each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
25090the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
25091Exim to use only the host name.
25092Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
25093
25094
25095.option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25096.cindex "serializing connections"
25097.cindex "host" "serializing connections"
25098Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
25099host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
25100the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
25101slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
25102Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
25103&%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
25104
25105.cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
25106Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
25107written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
25108is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
25109records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
25110guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
25111
25112If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
25113relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
25114start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
25115may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
25116are used for ETRN serialization.
25117
25118See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
25119
25120
25121.option size_addition smtp integer 1024
25122.cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
25123.cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
25124.cindex "size" "of message"
25125.cindex "transport" "filter"
25126.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
25127If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
25128MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
25129an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
25130sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
25131configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
25132this if a lot of text is added to messages.
25133
25134Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
25135the use of the SIZE option altogether.
25136
25137
25138.option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
25139.cindex proxy SOCKS
25140This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
25141transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
25142
25143
25144.option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
25145.cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
25146.cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
25147.vindex "&$host$&"
25148.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25149The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
25150client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
25151connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
25152address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
25153details of TLS.
25154
25155&*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
25156certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
25157name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
25158assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
25159client.
25160
25161
25162.option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
25163.cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
25164.cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
25165This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
25166be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
25167
25168
25169.option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
25170.cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
25171When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
25172key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
25173for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
25174If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
25175will fail.
25176
25177Only supported when using GnuTLS.
25178
25179
25180.option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
25181.cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
25182.vindex "&$host$&"
25183.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25184The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
25185client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
25186connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
25187&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25188expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
25189result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
25190the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25191
25192
25193.option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
25194.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
25195.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
25196.vindex "&$host$&"
25197.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25198The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
25199when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
25200the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
25201&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25202expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
25203is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
25204&<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
25205ciphers is a preference order.
25206
25207
25208
25209.option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
25210.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
25211.vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
25212If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
25213TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
25214the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
25215certificate and private key for the session.
25216
25217See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
25218
25219Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
25220TLS extensions.
25221
25222
25223
25224
25225.option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
25226.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
25227When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
25228setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
25229to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
25230current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
25231option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
25232response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
25233TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
25234unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
25235in clear.
25236
25237
25238.option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
25239.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25240.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25241This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
25242certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
25243The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
25244Note that unless the host is in this list
25245TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
25246when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
25247The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
25248certificate verification succeeds.
25249
25250
25251.option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
25252.cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
25253.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25254This option give a list of hosts for which,
25255while verifying the server certificate,
25256checks will be included on the host name
25257(note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
25258versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
25259limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
25260
25261There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
25262
25263
25264.option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
25265.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25266.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25267.vindex "&$host$&"
25268.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25269The value of this option must be either the
25270word "system"
25271or the absolute path to
25272a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
25273for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
25274
25275The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
25276This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
25277is taken as empty and an explicit location
25278must be specified.
25279
25280The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
25281preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
25282
25283With OpenSSL the certificates specified
25284explicitly
25285either by file or directory
25286are added to those given by the system default location.
25287
25288The values of &$host$& and
25289&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25290expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25291
25292For back-compatibility,
25293if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
25294(a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
25295and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
25296
25297
25298.option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25299.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25300.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25301This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
25302certificate verification must succeed.
25303The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
25304If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
25305operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
25306
25307.option utf8_downconvert smtp integer!! unset
25308.cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
25309.cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
25310If built with internationalization support,
25311this option controls conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
25312to a-label form.
25313For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
25314
25315
25316
25317
25318.section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
25319 "SECTvalhosmax"
25320.cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
25321.cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
25322There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
25323tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
25324&%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
25325
25326
25327The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
25328for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
25329option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
25330multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
25331retrying.
25332
25333Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
25334multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
25335created as a result of routing one of these domains.
25336
25337Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
25338several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
25339problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
25340&%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
25341delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
25342
25343Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
25344arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
25345limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
25346some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
25347&%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
25348that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
25349see below for an exception).
25350
25351Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
25352list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
25353If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
25354but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
25355that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
25356
25357Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
25358higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
25359hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
25360which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
25361tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
25362reached their retry times.
25363
25364However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
25365large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
25366Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
25367of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
25368time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
25369without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
25370all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
25371there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
25372the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
25373every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
25374reached.
25375
25376The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
25377particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
25378out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
25379reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
25380been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
25381take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
25382
25383The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
25384Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
25385and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
25386possible IP addresses have been tried.
25387.ecindex IIDsmttra1
25388.ecindex IIDsmttra2
25389
25390
25391
25392
25393
25394. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25395. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25396
25397.chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
25398.scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
25399There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
25400addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
25401(referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
25402abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
25403
25404Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
25405messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
25406&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
25407appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
25408locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
25409unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
25410lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
25411
25412One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
25413when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
25414such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
25415do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
25416
25417
25418.section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
25419This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
25420main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
25421&%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
25422
25423Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
25424Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
25425facility; you do not have to use it.
25426
25427The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
25428configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
25429addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
25430address to which it applies.
25431
25432Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
25433the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
25434rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
25435those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
25436by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
25437are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
25438rules.
25439
25440Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
25441applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
25442well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
25443headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
25444
25445
25446In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
25447legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
25448in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
25449used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
25450Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
25451discouraged.
25452
25453There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
25454illustrated by these examples:
25455
25456.ilist
25457The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
25458exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
25459gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
25460&'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
25461.next
25462A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
25463&'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
25464.endlist
25465
25466
25467
25468.section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
25469.cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
25470.cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
25471Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
25472message's processing.
25473
25474.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25475At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
25476by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
25477ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
25478is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
25479rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
25480rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
25481RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
25482rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
25483
25484.vindex "&$domain$&"
25485.vindex "&$local_part$&"
25486Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
25487may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
25488rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
25489from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
25490for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
25491value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
25492as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
25493SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
25494
25495As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
25496recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
25497the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
25498any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
25499.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
25500before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
25501
25502When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
25503rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
25504redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
25505
25506.cindex "envelope from"
25507.cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
25508.cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
25509.cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
25510At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
25511specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
25512This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
25513section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
25514header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
25515applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
25516
25517The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
25518transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
25519transport time.
25520
25521
25522
25523
25524.section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
25525.cindex "rewriting" "testing"
25526.cindex "testing" "rewriting"
25527Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the runtime
25528configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
25529&%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
255302822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
25531transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
25532appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
25533envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
25534.code
25535exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
25536.endd
25537might produce the output
25538.code
25539sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25540from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25541to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25542cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25543bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25544reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25545env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25546env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25547.endd
25548which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
25549the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
25550present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
25551set for a particular transport.
25552
25553
25554.section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
25555.cindex "rewriting" "rules"
25556The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
25557rules in the form
25558.display
25559<&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
25560.endd
25561Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
25562transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
25563takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
25564any colons must be doubled, of course).
25565
25566The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
25567Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
25568case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
25569characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
25570ignored.
25571
25572For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
25573order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
25574replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
25575
25576The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
25577releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
25578received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
25579lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
25580address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
25581(or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
25582that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
25583
25584.vindex "&$domain$&"
25585.vindex "&$local_part$&"
25586The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
25587string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
25588rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
25589.code
25590*@* ${lookup ...
25591.endd
25592where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
25593refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25594
25595
25596.section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
25597.cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
25598.cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
25599The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
25600address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
25601single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
25602against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
25603you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
25604facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
25605
25606Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
25607case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
25608can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
25609
25610.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
25611After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
25612depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
25613replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
25614refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
25615numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
25616of pattern they are set as follows:
25617
25618.ilist
25619If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
25620refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
25621the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
25622pattern
25623.code
25624*queen@*.fict.example
25625.endd
25626is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
25627.code
25628$0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
25629$1 = hearts-
25630$2 = wonderland
25631.endd
25632Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
25633does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
25634
25635.next
25636If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
25637of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
25638for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
25639rewriting rule of the form
25640.display
25641&`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
25642.endd
25643and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
25644.code
25645$1 = foo
25646$2 = bar
25647$3 = baz.example
25648.endd
25649If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
25650wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
25651&$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
25652partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
25653whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
25654.endlist
25655
25656
25657.section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
25658.cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
25659If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
25660match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
25661rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
25662.code
25663hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
25664.endd
25665specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
25666&'From:'& headers.
25667
25668.vindex "&$domain$&"
25669.vindex "&$local_part$&"
25670If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
25671yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
25672&$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25673Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
25674cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
25675matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
25676the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
25677current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
25678expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
25679entry written to the panic log.
25680
25681
25682
25683.section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
25684There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
25685
25686.ilist
25687Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
25688c, f, h, r, s, t.
25689.next
25690A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
25691.next
25692Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
25693.endlist
25694
25695For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
25696E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
25697
25698
25699
25700.section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
25701 "SECID154"
25702.cindex "rewriting" "flags"
25703If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
25704&<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
25705and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
25706transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
25707rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
25708.display
25709&`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
25710&`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
25711&`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
25712&`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
25713&`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
25714&`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
25715&`h`& rewrite all headers
25716&`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
25717&`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
25718&`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
25719.endd
25720"All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
25721individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
25722other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
25723
25724You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
25725restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
25726
25727
25728.section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
25729.cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
25730.cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
25731.cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
25732The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
25733SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
25734before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
25735required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
25736data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
25737
25738.vindex "&$domain$&"
25739.vindex "&$local_part$&"
25740This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
25741compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
25742input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
25743the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
25744expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
25745original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
25746
25747
25748.section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
25749There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
25750take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
25751correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
25752
25753.ilist
25754If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
25755unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
25756absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
25757.next
25758If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
25759even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
25760expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
25761(does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
25762.next
25763The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
25764address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
25765rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
25766.next
25767.cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
25768When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
25769to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
25770left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
25771.code
25772From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
25773.endd
25774into
25775.code
25776From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
25777.endd
25778.cindex "RFC 2047"
25779Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
25780done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
25781causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
25782replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
257832822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
25784brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
25785(except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
25786is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
25787
25788When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
25789rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
25790.endlist
25791
25792
25793.section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
25794Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
25795.code
25796*@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
25797*@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
25798 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
25799.endd
25800Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
25801the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
25802has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
25803consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
25804present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
25805explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
25806at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
25807error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
25808
25809The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
25810domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
25811.code
25812root@*.hitch.fict.example *
25813.endd
25814were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
25815local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
25816
25817Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
25818&${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
25819messages that originate outside the local host:
25820.code
25821*@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
25822 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
25823.endd
25824The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
25825space.
25826
25827.cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
25828.cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
25829Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
25830an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
25831the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
25832remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
25833sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
25834components. For example, the rule
25835.code
25836\N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
25837.endd
25838rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
25839&'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
25840a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
25841method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
25842to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
25843use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
25844can be done on the rewritten addresses.
25845.ecindex IIDaddrew
25846
25847
25848
25849
25850
25851. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25852. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25853
25854.chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
25855.scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
25856.scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
25857The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
25858retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
25859be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
25860empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
25861errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
25862general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
25863line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
25864address, domain and error.
25865
25866The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
25867host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
25868Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
25869address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
25870been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
25871tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
25872log selector is set, the message
25873.cindex "retry" "time not reached"
25874&"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
25875skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
25876the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
25877
25878Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
25879in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
25880actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
25881failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
25882the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
25883added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
25884same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
25885domain are maintained independently.
25886
25887When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
25888receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
25889always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
25890behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
25891quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
25892suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
25893subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
25894the local address is reached.
25895
25896.section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
25897If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
25898whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
25899files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
25900always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
25901
25902The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
25903rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
25904record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
25905timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
25906and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
25907messages that it should now be retaining.
25908
25909
25910
25911.section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
25912.cindex "retry" "rules"
25913Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
25914separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
25915addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
25916enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
25917in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
25918present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
25919message's sender, respectively.
25920
25921
25922The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
25923&<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
25924which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
25925has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
25926list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
25927which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
25928example,
25929.code
25930lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25931.endd
25932provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
25933whereas
25934.code
25935alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25936.endd
25937applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
25938In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
25939part.
25940
25941.cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
25942&*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
25943must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
25944expressions work in address lists.
25945.display
25946&`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
25947&`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
25948.endd
25949
25950
25951.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
25952When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
25953example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
25954against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
25955router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
25956regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
25957A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
25958&"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
25959&%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
25960
25961Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
25962failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
25963configuration is tested against the complete address only if
25964&%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
25965local transports).
25966
25967.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
25968However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
25969suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
25970whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
25971rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
25972failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
25973recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
25974reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
25975&%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
25976lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
25977commands.
25978
25979
25980
25981.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
25982 "SECID160"
25983For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
25984example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
25985twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
25986&"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
25987the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
25988suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
25989.code
25990a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
25991 MX 6 p.q.r.example
25992 MX 7 m.n.o.example
25993.endd
25994and the retry rules are
25995.code
25996p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
25997a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
25998.endd
25999and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
26000first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
26001rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
26002to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
26003tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
26004first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
26005
26006In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
26007first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
26008&'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
26009routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
26010
26011&*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
26012However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
26013host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
26014.code
26015route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
26016.endd
26017then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
26018textual form of the IP address.
26019
26020.section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
26021.cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
26022The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
26023asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
26024
26025.vlist
26026.vitem &%auth_failed%&
26027Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
26028&%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
26029
26030.vitem &%data_4xx%&
26031A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
26032after the command, or after sending the message's data.
26033
26034.vitem &%mail_4xx%&
26035A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
26036
26037.vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
26038A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
26039.endlist
26040
26041For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
26042as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
26043recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
26044and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
26045retry rule of this form:
26046.code
26047the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
26048.endd
26049These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
26050LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
26051
26052.vlist
26053.vitem &%lost_connection%&
26054A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
26055legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
26056for the same host, it indicates something odd.
26057
26058.vitem &%lookup%&
26059A DNS lookup for a host failed.
26060Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
26061its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
26062Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
26063its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
26064
26065.vitem &%refused_MX%&
26066A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
26067
26068.vitem &%refused_A%&
26069A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
26070
26071.vitem &%refused%&
26072A connection was refused.
26073
26074.vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
26075A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
26076
26077.vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
26078A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
26079
26080.vitem &%timeout_connect%&
26081A connection attempt timed out.
26082
26083.vitem &%timeout_MX%&
26084There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
26085obtained from an MX record.
26086
26087.vitem &%timeout_A%&
26088There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
26089obtained from an MX record.
26090
26091.vitem &%timeout%&
26092There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
26093
26094.vitem &%tls_required%&
26095The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
26096&(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
26097to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
26098
26099.vitem &%quota%&
26100A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
26101transport.
26102
26103.vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
26104.cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
26105.cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
26106A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
26107transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
26108&'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
26109for four days.
26110.endlist
26111
26112.cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
26113The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
26114timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
26115it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
26116However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
26117heuristic rules:
26118
26119.ilist
26120If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
26121used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
26122quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
26123.next
26124.cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
26125For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
26126subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
26127the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
26128change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
26129MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
26130time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
26131.next
26132For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
26133obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
26134.endlist
26135
26136The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
26137mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
26138when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
26139error).
26140
26141
26142
26143.section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
26144.cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
26145You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
26146specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
26147apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
26148form:
26149.display
26150&`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
26151.endd
26152The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
26153.code
26154* rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
26155.endd
26156matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
26157host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
26158For example:
26159.code
26160a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
26161.endd
26162&*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
26163(which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
26164only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
26165its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
26166all messages, not just those with specific senders.
26167
26168When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
26169&%-f%& command line option, like this:
26170.code
26171exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
26172.endd
26173If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
26174list is never matched.
26175
26176
26177
26178
26179
26180.section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
26181.cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
26182The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
26183sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
26184.display
26185<&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
26186.endd
26187The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
26188time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
26189arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
26190time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
26191relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
26192
26193.cindex "retry" "algorithms"
26194.cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
26195.cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
26196.cindex "retry" "random intervals"
26197The available algorithms are:
26198
26199.ilist
26200&'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
26201the interval.
26202.next
26203&'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
26204specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
26205is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
26206.next
26207&'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
26208retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
26209maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
26210the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
26211rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
26212members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
26213queue processing times.
26214.endlist
26215
26216When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
26217order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
26218used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
26219case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
26220current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
26221computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
26222interval is found. The main configuration variable
26223.cindex "limit" "retry interval"
26224.cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
26225.oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
26226&%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
26227cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
26228
26229A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
26230host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
26231basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
26232for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
26233generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
26234time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
26235time.
26236
26237.cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
26238Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
26239run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
26240starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
26241new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
26242If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
26243occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
26244messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
26245processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
26246your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
26247number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
26248sending everything to a smart host, for example).
26249
26250The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
26251&'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
26252&<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
26253&'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
26254are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
26255deliveries that have been deferred.
26256
26257
26258.section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
26259Here are some example retry rules:
26260.code
26261alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
26262wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
26263wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
26264lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26265* refused_A F,2h,20m;
26266* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
26267.endd
26268The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
26269&'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
26270mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
26271hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
26272parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
26273effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
26274fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
26275days.
26276
26277The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
26278happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
26279intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
26280first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
26281so on (this is a rather extreme example).
26282
26283The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
26284They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
26285all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
26286were not obtained from an MX record.
26287
26288The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
26289first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
26290not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
26291hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
262921.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
26293
26294
26295
26296.section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
26297.cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
26298.oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
26299.cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
26300.cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
26301Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
26302consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
26303set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
26304been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
26305arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
26306failing for the first time.
26307
26308This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
26309backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
26310Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
26311down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
26312
26313If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
26314every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
26315message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
26316
26317
26318
26319
26320.section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
26321.cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
26322.cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
26323Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
26324that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
26325default retry rule:
26326.code
26327* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
26328.endd
26329the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
26330long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
26331failure for the recipient address that counts.
26332
26333When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
26334addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
26335causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
26336In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
26337time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
26338
26339For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
26340messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
26341post-cutoff retry time is not used.
26342
26343.cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
26344.cindex retry "final cutoff"
26345If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
26346.oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
26347&%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
26348default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses,
26349as set by the &%retry_data_expire%& option, is
26350reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
26351attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
26352those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
26353the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
26354
26355In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
26356for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
26357times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
26358behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
26359to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
26360notice.
26361
26362If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
26363addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
26364addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
26365no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
26366words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
26367addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
26368If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
26369&%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
26370deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
26371true.
26372
26373.section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
26374.cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
26375Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
26376intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
26377its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
26378because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
26379host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
26380failing messages remain in the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
26381reached.
26382
26383Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
26384applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
26385Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
26386examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
26387commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
26388time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
26389is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
26390time out the address.
26391
26392The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
26393the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
26394given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
26395time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
26396not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
26397considered immediately.
26398.ecindex IIDretconf1
26399.ecindex IIDregconf2
26400
26401
26402
26403
26404
26405
26406. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26407. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26408
26409.chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
26410.scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
26411.scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
26412The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's runtime configuration is concerned
26413with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
26414described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
26415to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
26416permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
26417transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
26418other.
26419
26420.cindex "AUTH" "description of"
26421Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
26422
26423.ilist
26424The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
26425the client's EHLO command.
26426.next
26427The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
26428may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
26429.next
26430The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
26431appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
26432just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
26433any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
26434with the AUTH command.
26435.next
26436The server either accepts or denies authentication.
26437.next
26438If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
26439option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
26440mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
26441connection.
26442.next
26443If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
26444authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
26445unauthenticated connection.
26446.endlist
26447
26448If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
26449mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
26450SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
26451includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
26452.display
26453&`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
26454&`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
26455&`Connected to server.example.`&
26456&`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
26457&`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
26458&*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
26459&`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
26460&`250-SIZE 52428800`&
26461&`250-PIPELINING`&
26462&`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
26463&`250 HELP`&
26464.endd
26465The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
26466authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
26467mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
26468routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
26469controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
26470included by setting
26471.code
26472AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
26473AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
26474AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
26475AUTH_EXTERNAL=yes
26476AUTH_GSASL=yes
26477AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
26478AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
26479AUTH_SPA=yes
26480AUTH_TLS=yes
26481.endd
26482in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
26483authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
26484the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
26485The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
26486work via a socket interface.
26487The fourth provides for negotiation of authentication done via non-SMTP means,
26488as defined by RFC 4422 Appendix A.
26489The fifth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
26490provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
26491The sixth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
26492supporting setting a server keytab.
26493The seventh can be configured to support
26494the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
26495not formally documented, but used by several MUAs.
26496The eighth authenticator
26497supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
26498The last is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
26499instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
26500
26501The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
26502section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
26503authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
26504authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
26505is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
26506messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
26507options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
26508
26509To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
26510&%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
26511either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
26512functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
26513to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
26514both sets of options, is required. For example:
26515.code
26516cram:
26517 driver = cram_md5
26518 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26519 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
26520 client_name = ph10
26521 client_secret = secret2
26522.endd
26523The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
26524&%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
26525
26526Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
26527The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
26528authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
26529in Exim.
26530
26531&*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
26532per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
26533account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
26534authenticating data.
26535
26536Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
26537&'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
26538and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
26539Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
26540used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
26541second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
26542user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
26543configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
26544&'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
26545as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
26546choose to honour.
26547
26548A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
26549to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
26550mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
26551typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
26552
26553
26554
26555.section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
26556.cindex "authentication" "generic options"
26557.cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
26558
26559.option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26560When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
26561&%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
26562used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
26563encrypted by a setting such as:
26564.code
26565client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
26566.endd
26567
26568
26569.option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26570When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
26571result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
26572Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
26573
26574
26575.option driver authenticators string unset
26576This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
26577authenticators is to be used.
26578
26579
26580.option public_name authenticators string unset
26581This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
26582implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
26583contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
26584but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
26585defaults to the driver's instance name.
26586
26587
26588.option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26589When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
26590is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
26591mechanism is not advertised.
26592If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
26593forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
26594See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
26595
26596
26597.option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26598This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
26599is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
26600for details.
26601
26602For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
26603mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
26604
26605For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
26606authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
26607authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
26608authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
26609to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
26610error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
26611string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26612expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
26613other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
26614the error text.
26615
26616
26617.option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
26618If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
26619command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
26620output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
26621out the values of variables.
26622If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
26623output, and Exim carries on processing.
26624
26625
26626.option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26627.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26628.vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
26629When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
26630expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
26631messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
26632lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
26633configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
26634refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
26635On a failing authentication the expansion result is instead saved in
26636the &$authenticated_fail_id$& variable.
26637If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
26638
26639
26640.option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26641This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
26642as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
26643driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
26644as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
26645remembered for later use.
26646How it is used is described in the following section.
26647
26648
26649
26650
26651
26652.section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
26653.cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
26654.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26655When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
26656the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
26657message:
26658
26659.ilist
26660If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
26661than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
26662.next
26663If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
26664.next
26665.vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
26666If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
26667running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
26668from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
26669&$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
26670return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
26671given for the MAIL command.
26672.next
26673If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
26674is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
26675authenticated.
26676.next
26677If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
26678the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
26679&%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
26680valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
26681fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
26682&$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
26683the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
26684message.
26685.endlist
26686
26687
26688When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
26689hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
26690&$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
26691process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
26692
26693.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
26694Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
26695MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
26696therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
26697value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
26698ACL is run.
26699
26700
26701
26702.section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
26703.cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
26704When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
26705authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
26706conditions:
26707
26708.ilist
26709The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
26710.next
26711It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
26712yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
26713.endlist
26714
26715The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
26716the mechanisms are advertised.
26717
26718Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
26719provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
26720even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
26721set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
26722You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
26723For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
26724that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
26725.code
26726auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
26727.endd
26728so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
26729
26730The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
26731authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
26732advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
26733such as:
26734.code
26735server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
26736.endd
26737.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26738If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
26739yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
26740
26741When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
26742immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
26743command. This is the case if
26744
26745.ilist
26746The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
26747.next
26748No authenticators are configured with server options; or
26749.next
26750Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
26751server authenticators.
26752.endlist
26753
26754
26755Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
26756to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
26757AUTH is accepted from any client host.
26758
26759If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
26760server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
26761that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
26762the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
26763fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
26764rejected with a 504 error.
26765
26766.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
26767.vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
26768When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
26769&$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
26770or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
26771public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
26772client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
26773no successful authentication.
26774
26775.cindex authentication "expansion item"
26776Successful authentication sets up information used by the
26777&%authresults%& expansion item.
26778
26779
26780
26781
26782.section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
26783.cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
26784.cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
26785.cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
26786Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
26787configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
26788encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
26789script:
26790.code
26791use MIME::Base64;
26792printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
26793.endd
26794.cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
26795This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
26796interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
26797some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
26798command line to run this script on such data might be
26799.code
26800encode '\0user\0password'
26801.endd
26802Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
26803backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
26804whose code value is zero.
26805
26806&*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
26807digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
26808you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
26809interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
26810
26811&*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
26812specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
26813example, a command such as
26814.code
26815encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
26816.endd
26817gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
26818
26819If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
26820base64-encoded strings is to run the command
26821.code
26822echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
26823.endd
26824The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
26825in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
26826output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
26827should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
26828
26829
26830
26831.section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
26832.cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
26833The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
26834&%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
26835announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
26836of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
26837
26838.ilist
26839For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
26840they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
26841mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
26842of the authenticator.
26843.next
26844.vindex "&$host$&"
26845.vindex "&$host_address$&"
26846When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
26847variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
26848that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
26849any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
26850Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
26851delivery to be deferred.
26852.next
26853If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
26854Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
26855try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
26856usual way.
26857.next
26858If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
26859carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
26860possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
26861no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
26862what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
26863&%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
26864delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
26865turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
26866deliver the message unauthenticated.
26867.endlist
26868
26869Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
26870confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
26871upon and the time that the transport runs. For example, with a manualroute
26872router given a host name, and with DNS "round-robin" used by that name: if
26873the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
26874running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
26875check which does not match the connection peer IP.
26876No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
26877
26878For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
26879
26880.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26881When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
26882parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
26883the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
26884is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
26885incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
26886allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
26887to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
26888&%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
26889&%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
26890the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
26891.ecindex IIDauthconf1
26892.ecindex IIDauthconf2
26893
26894
26895
26896
26897
26898
26899. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26900. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26901
26902.chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
26903.scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
26904.scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
26905The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
26906LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
26907plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
26908security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
26909(see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
26910use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
26911connections as you do for login accounts.
26912
26913.section "Avoiding cleartext use" "SECTplain_TLS"
26914The following generic option settings will disable &(plaintext)& authenticators when
26915TLS is not being used:
26916.code
26917 server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
26918 client_condition = ${if def:tls_out_cipher}
26919.endd
26920
26921&*Note*&: a plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not vulnerable to casual snooping,
26922but is still vulnerable to a Man In The Middle attack unless certificates
26923(including their names) have been properly verified.
26924
26925.section "Plaintext server options" "SECID171"
26926.cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
26927When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
26928
26929.option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26930This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
26931configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
26932
26933.option server_prompts plaintext "string list&!!" unset
26934The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
26935prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
26936given.
26937
26938.section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
26939.cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26940.cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26941.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
26942 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26943.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26944.cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26945
26946When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
26947expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
26948response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
26949values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
26950a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
26951are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
26952(neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
26953
26954For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
26955the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
26956variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
26957string expansions that also use them for other things.
26958
26959If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
26960supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
26961data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
26962
26963.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26964Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
26965&%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
26966authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
26967to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
26968&"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26969expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
26970generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
26971For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
26972string as the error text.
26973
26974&*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
26975password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
26976There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
26977
26978
26979
26980.section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
26981.cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
26982.cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
26983.cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26984The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
26985sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
26986separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
26987subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
26988
26989The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
26990Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
26991configured as follows:
26992.code
26993fixed_plain:
26994 driver = plaintext
26995 public_name = PLAIN
26996 server_prompts = :
26997 server_condition = \
26998 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
26999 server_set_id = $auth2
27000.endd
27001Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
27002are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
27003password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
27004or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
27005
27006The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
27007the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
27008AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
27009authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
27010.code
27011250-AUTH PLAIN
27012.endd
27013and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
27014.code
27015AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
27016.endd
27017As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
27018data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
27019.code
27020AUTH PLAIN
27021.endd
27022to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
27023prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
27024
27025The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
27026when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
27027represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
27028is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
27029second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
27030
27031Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
27032realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
27033authenticating clients it could make sense.
27034
27035A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
27036&$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
27037comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
27038this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
27039This is an incorrect example:
27040.code
27041server_condition = \
27042 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
27043.endd
27044The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
27045which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
27046incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
27047non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
27048strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
27049the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
27050name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
27051.code
27052server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
27053 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
27054.endd
27055In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
27056fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
27057used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
27058always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
27059writing the test makes the logic clearer.
27060
27061
27062.section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
27063.cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
27064.cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
27065The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
27066in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
27067user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
27068plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
27069.code
27070fixed_login:
27071 driver = plaintext
27072 public_name = LOGIN
27073 server_prompts = User Name : Password
27074 server_condition = \
27075 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
27076 server_set_id = $auth1
27077.endd
27078Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
27079with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
27080if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
27081strings are used to obtain two data items.
27082
27083Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
27084example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
27085&"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
27086strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
27087name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
27088.code
27089login:
27090 driver = plaintext
27091 public_name = LOGIN
27092 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
27093 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
27094 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
27095 ldapauth{\
27096 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
27097 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
27098 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
27099 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
27100.endd
27101We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
27102does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
27103operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
27104&%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
27105correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
27106the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
27107uninterpreted string.
27108
27109
27110.section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
27111A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
27112interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
27113traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
27114Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
27115&<<SECTexpcond>>&.
27116
27117
27118
27119
27120.section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
27121.cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
27122The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
27123
27124.option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
27125If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
27126authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
27127the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
27128usual.
27129
27130.option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
27131The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
27132string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
27133string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
27134to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
27135most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
27136with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
27137way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
27138(with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
27139so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
27140&%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
27141&$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
27142
27143&*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
27144splitting takes priority and happens first.
27145
27146Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
27147the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
27148there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
27149NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
27150the string.
27151
27152This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
27153authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
27154.code
27155fixed_plain:
27156 driver = plaintext
27157 public_name = PLAIN
27158 client_send = ^username^mysecret
27159.endd
27160The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
27161command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
27162that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
27163.code
27164fixed_login:
27165 driver = plaintext
27166 public_name = LOGIN
27167 client_send = : username : mysecret
27168.endd
27169The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
27170the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
27171prompts.
27172.ecindex IIDplaiauth1
27173.ecindex IIDplaiauth2
27174
27175
27176
27177
27178. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27179. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27180
27181.chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
27182.scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
27183.scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
27184.cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
27185.cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
27186The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
27187sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
27188name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
27189string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
27190is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
27191secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
27192available in plain text at either end.
27193
27194
27195.section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
27196.cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
27197This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
27198authenticator as a server:
27199
27200.option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
27201.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
27202When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
27203the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
27204obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
27205that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
27206string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
27207fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
27208returned to the client.
27209
27210For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
27211in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
27212deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
27213numeric variables for other things.
27214
27215For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
27216client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
27217user name, authentication fails.
27218.code
27219fixed_cram:
27220 driver = cram_md5
27221 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27222 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
27223 server_set_id = $auth1
27224.endd
27225.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27226If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
27227name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
27228secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
27229.code
27230lookup_cram:
27231 driver = cram_md5
27232 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27233 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
27234 {$value}fail}
27235 server_set_id = $auth1
27236.endd
27237Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
27238because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
27239
27240As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
27241using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
27242lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
27243realm, with:
27244.code
27245cyrusless_crammd5:
27246 driver = cram_md5
27247 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27248 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
27249 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
27250 server_set_id = $auth1
27251.endd
27252
27253.section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
27254.cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
27255When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
27256
27257
27258
27259.option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
27260This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
27261computing the response to the server's challenge.
27262
27263
27264.option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
27265This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
27266expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
27267
27268
27269.vindex "&$host$&"
27270.vindex "&$host_address$&"
27271Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
27272to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
27273expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
27274prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
27275authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
27276send the message to the current server.
27277
27278A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
27279strings, is:
27280.code
27281fixed_cram:
27282 driver = cram_md5
27283 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27284 client_name = ph10
27285 client_secret = secret
27286.endd
27287.ecindex IIDcramauth1
27288.ecindex IIDcramauth2
27289
27290
27291
27292. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27293. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27294
27295.chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
27296.scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
27297.scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
27298.cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
27299.cindex "Kerberos"
27300The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick while
27301at A L Digital Ltd.
27302
27303The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
27304library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
27305Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
27306including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
27307directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
27308
27309The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
27310the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
27311then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
27312name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
27313
27314Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example, in GSSAPI
27315or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
27316user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
27317by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
27318depending on the driver you are using.
27319
27320The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
27321be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
27322Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
27323changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
27324layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
27325implementation.
27326
27327For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
27328may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
27329variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
27330Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
27331With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
27332environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
27333is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
27334the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
27335
27336
27337.section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
27338The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
27339(on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
27340previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
27341use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
27342confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
27343things.
27344
27345
27346.option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
27347This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27348library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
27349SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
27350
27351
27352.option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
27353This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27354default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27355you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27356example:
27357.code
27358sasl:
27359 driver = cyrus_sasl
27360 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27361 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27362 server_set_id = $auth1
27363.endd
27364
27365.option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
27366This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27367
27368
27369.option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
27370This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27371
27372
27373For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
27374private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
27375the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
27376PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
27377.code
27378sasl_cram_md5:
27379 driver = cyrus_sasl
27380 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27381 server_set_id = $auth1
27382
27383sasl_plain:
27384 driver = cyrus_sasl
27385 public_name = PLAIN
27386 server_set_id = $auth2
27387.endd
27388Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
27389not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
27390but it is present in many binary distributions.
27391.ecindex IIDcyrauth1
27392.ecindex IIDcyrauth2
27393
27394
27395
27396
27397. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27398. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27399.chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
27400.scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
27401.scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
27402This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
27403Dovecot 2 POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
27404Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
27405If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
27406to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
27407authenticator only. There is only one option:
27408
27409.option server_socket dovecot string unset
27410
27411This option must specify the UNIX socket that is the interface to Dovecot
27412authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
27413mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
27414authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
27415.code
27416dovecot_plain:
27417 driver = dovecot
27418 public_name = PLAIN
27419 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27420 server_set_id = $auth1
27421
27422dovecot_ntlm:
27423 driver = dovecot
27424 public_name = NTLM
27425 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27426 server_set_id = $auth1
27427.endd
27428If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
27429&$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
27430option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
27431connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
27432option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
27433who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
27434
27435.new
27436The Dovecot configuration to match the above wil look
27437something like:
27438.code
27439conf.d/10-master.conf :-
27440
27441service auth {
27442...
27443#SASL
27444 unix_listener auth-client {
27445 mode = 0660
27446 user = mail
27447 }
27448...
27449}
27450
27451conf.d/10-auth.conf :-
27452
27453auth_mechanisms = plain login ntlm
27454.endd
27455.wen
27456
27457.ecindex IIDdcotauth1
27458.ecindex IIDdcotauth2
27459
27460
27461. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27462. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27463.chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
27464.scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
27465.scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
27466.cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
27467.cindex "authentication" "SASL"
27468.cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27469.cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27470.cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
27471.cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
27472.cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
27473.cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
27474.cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
27475.cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1-PLUS"
27476.cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-256"
27477.cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-256-PLUS"
27478The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides integration for the GNU SASL
27479library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
27480and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
27481scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
27482made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
27483without code changes in Exim.
27484
27485.new
27486The library is expected to add support in an upcoming
27487realease for the SCRAM-SHA-256 method.
27488The macro _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_SHA_256 will be defined
27489when this happens.
27490
27491
27492.option client_authz gsasl string&!! unset
27493This option can be used to supply an &'authorization id'&
27494which is different to the &'authentication_id'& provided
27495by &%client_username%& option.
27496If unset or (after expansion) empty it is not used,
27497which is the common case.
27498
27499.option client_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
27500See &%server_channelbinding%& below.
27501
27502.option client_password gsasl string&!! unset
27503This option is exapanded before use, and should result in
27504the password to be used, in clear.
27505
27506.option client_username gsasl string&!! unset
27507This option is exapanded before use, and should result in
27508the account name to be used.
27509.wen
27510
27511.option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
27512Do not set this true and rely on the properties
27513without consulting a cryptographic engineer.
27514
27515Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
27516of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
27517authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
27518ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
27519context.
27520
27521This should have meant that certificate identity and verification becomes a
27522non-issue, as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and
27523server to see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
27524
27525.new
27526This is
27527only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
27528writing, that's the SCRAM family.
27529When using this feature the "-PLUS" variants of the method names need to be used.
27530.wen
27531
27532This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
27533this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
27534of Exim might have switched the default to be true.
27535
27536However, Channel Binding in TLS has proven to be vulnerable in current versions.
27537Do not plan to rely upon this feature for security, ever, without consulting
27538with a subject matter expert (a cryptographic engineer).
27539
27540
27541.option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
27542This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27543library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27544Some mechanisms will use this data.
27545
27546
27547.option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
27548This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27549default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27550you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27551example:
27552.code
27553sasl:
27554 driver = gsasl
27555 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27556 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27557 server_set_id = $auth1
27558.endd
27559
27560
27561.option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
27562Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
27563that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
27564the password itself.
27565
27566The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
27567In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
27568The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
27569if available, else the empty string.
27570The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
27571else the empty string.
27572
27573A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
27574
27575If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
27576option to be simply "true".
27577
27578
27579.option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
27580This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27581Some mechanisms will use this data.
27582
27583
27584.option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! 4096
27585This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27586.new
27587The &$auth1$&, &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& variables are available for expansion.
27588
27589The result of expansion should be a decimal number,
27590and represents both a lower-bound on the security, and
27591a compute cost factor imposed on the client
27592(if it does not cache results, or the server changes
27593either the iteration count or the salt).
27594A minimum value of 4096 is required by the standards
27595for all current CRAM mechanism variants.
27596.wen
27597
27598
27599.option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
27600This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27601.new
27602The &$auth1$&, &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& variables are available for expansion.
27603If unset or empty after expansion the library will provides a value for the
27604protocol conversation.
27605.wen
27606
27607
27608.option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
27609This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27610Some mechanisms will use this data.
27611
27612
27613.section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
27614.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27615These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
27616They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
27617
27618Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
27619meanings for these variables:
27620
27621.ilist
27622.vindex "&$auth1$&"
27623&$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
27624.next
27625.vindex "&$auth2$&"
27626&$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
27627.next
27628.vindex "&$auth3$&"
27629&$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
27630.endlist
27631
27632On a per-mechanism basis:
27633
27634.ilist
27635.cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27636EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
27637the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27638.next
27639.cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27640ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
27641the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27642.next
27643.cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27644GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
27645&$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
27646the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27647.endlist
27648
27649An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
27650identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
27651email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
27652
27653
27654An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
27655and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
27656.code
27657gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
27658 driver = gsasl
27659 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27660 server_realm = imap.example.org
27661 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
27662 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
27663 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
27664 server_condition = yes
27665.endd
27666
27667
27668. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27669. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27670
27671.chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
27672.scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
27673.scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
27674.cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27675.cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
27676The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
27677Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
27678reliably.
27679
27680.option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
27681This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
27682for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
27683identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27684
27685.option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
27686If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
27687&_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
27688The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
27689
27690.option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
27691This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
27692&%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
27693from the keytab.
27694
27695
27696.section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
27697Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
27698to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
27699not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
27700
27701The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
27702Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
27703Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
27704role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
27705
27706.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27707.ilist
27708.vindex "&$auth1$&"
27709&$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
27710.next
27711.vindex "&$auth2$&"
27712&$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
27713authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
27714GSS Display Name.
27715.endlist
27716
27717
27718. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27719. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27720
27721.chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
27722.scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
27723.scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
27724.cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
27725.cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
27726.cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
27727.cindex "NTLM authentication"
27728The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
27729Password Authentication'& mechanism,
27730which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
27731this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
27732taken from the Samba project (&url(https://www.samba.org/)). The code for the
27733server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
27734follows:
27735
27736.ilist
27737After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
27738authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
27739.next
27740The server sends back a challenge.
27741.next
27742The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
27743and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
27744.endlist
27745
27746Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
27747
27748
27749
27750.section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
27751.cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
27752The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
27753
27754.option server_password spa string&!! unset
27755.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
27756This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
27757authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
27758compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
27759&$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
27760it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
27761for other things. For example:
27762.code
27763spa:
27764 driver = spa
27765 public_name = NTLM
27766 server_password = \
27767 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
27768.endd
27769If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27770failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27771
27772
27773
27774
27775
27776.section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
27777.cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
27778The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
27779
27780
27781
27782.option client_domain spa string&!! unset
27783This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
27784
27785
27786.option client_password spa string&!! unset
27787This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
27788
27789
27790.option client_username spa string&!! unset
27791This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
27792configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
27793&'msn.com'&:
27794.code
27795msn:
27796 driver = spa
27797 public_name = MSN
27798 client_username = msn/msn_username
27799 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
27800 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
27801.endd
27802.ecindex IIDspaauth1
27803.ecindex IIDspaauth2
27804
27805
27806
27807
27808
27809. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27810. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27811
27812.chapter "The external authenticator" "CHAPexternauth"
27813.scindex IIDexternauth1 "&(external)& authenticator"
27814.scindex IIDexternauth2 "authenticators" "&(external)&"
27815.cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27816.cindex "authentication" "X509"
27817.cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27818The &(external)& authenticator provides support for
27819authentication based on non-SMTP information.
27820The specification is in RFC 4422 Appendix A
27821(&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4422)).
27822It is only a transport and negotiation mechanism;
27823the process of authentication is entirely controlled
27824by the server configuration.
27825
27826The client presents an identity in-clear.
27827It is probably wise for a server to only advertise,
27828and for clients to only attempt,
27829this authentication method on a secure (eg. under TLS) connection.
27830
27831One possible use, compatible with the
27832K-9 Mail Andoid client (&url(https://k9mail.github.io/)),
27833is for using X509 client certificates.
27834
27835It thus overlaps in function with the TLS authenticator
27836(see &<<CHAPtlsauth>>&)
27837but is a full SMTP SASL authenticator
27838rather than being implicit for TLS-connection carried
27839client certificates only.
27840
27841The examples and discussion in this chapter assume that
27842client-certificate authentication is being done.
27843
27844The client must present a certificate,
27845for which it must have been requested via the
27846&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27847(see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27848For authentication to be effective the certificate should be
27849verifiable against a trust-anchor certificate known to the server.
27850
27851.section "External options" "SECTexternsoptions"
27852.cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (server)"
27853The &(external)& authenticator has two server options:
27854
27855.option server_param2 external string&!! unset
27856.option server_param3 external string&!! unset
27857.cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27858These options are expanded before the &%server_condition%& option
27859and the result are placed in &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& resectively.
27860If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27861failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27862
27863They can be used to clarify the coding of a complex &%server_condition%&.
27864
27865.section "Using external in a server" "SECTexternserver"
27866.cindex "AUTH" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27867.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
27868 "in &(external)& authenticator"
27869.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27870.cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27871
27872When running as a server, &(external)& performs the authentication test by
27873expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
27874response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
27875values when decoded. The decoded value is treated as
27876an identity for authentication and
27877placed in the expansion variable &$auth1$&.
27878
27879For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the value is also placed in
27880the expansion variable &$1$&. However, the use of this
27881variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
27882string expansions that also use them for other things.
27883
27884.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27885Once an identity has been received,
27886&%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
27887authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
27888to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
27889&"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
27890expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
27891generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
27892For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
27893string as the error text.
27894
27895Example:
27896.code
27897ext_ccert_san_mail:
27898 driver = external
27899 public_name = EXTERNAL
27900
27901 server_advertise_condition = $tls_in_certificate_verified
27902 server_param2 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27903 {$tls_in_peercert}}
27904 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth2} \
27905 {eq {$item}{$auth1}}}
27906 server_set_id = $auth1
27907.endd
27908This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
27909of your configured trust-anchors
27910(which usually means the full set of public CAs)
27911and which has a mail-SAN matching the claimed identity sent by the client.
27912
27913&*Note*&: up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN.
27914The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
27915TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
27916in this way.
27917
27918
27919.section "Using external in a client" "SECTexternclient"
27920.cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (client)"
27921The &(external)& authenticator has one client option:
27922
27923.option client_send external string&!! unset
27924This option is expanded and sent with the AUTH command as the
27925identity being asserted.
27926
27927Example:
27928.code
27929ext_ccert:
27930 driver = external
27931 public_name = EXTERNAL
27932
27933 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
27934 client_send = myaccount@smarthost.example.net
27935.endd
27936
27937
27938.ecindex IIDexternauth1
27939.ecindex IIDexternauth2
27940
27941
27942
27943
27944
27945. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27946. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27947
27948.chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
27949.scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
27950.scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
27951.cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27952.cindex "authentication" "X509"
27953.cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27954The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
27955authentication based on client certificates.
27956
27957It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
27958advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
27959It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
27960the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
27961by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
27962the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
27963
27964The client must present a verifiable certificate,
27965for which it must have been requested via the
27966&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27967(see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27968
27969If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
27970run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
27971and can authenticate the connection.
27972If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
27973
27974A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
27975
27976
27977.cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
27978The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
27979
27980.option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
27981.cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
27982This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
27983the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
27984If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27985failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27986
27987.option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
27988.option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
27989As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
27990
27991&%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
27992
27993
27994Example:
27995.code
27996tls:
27997 driver = tls
27998 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27999 {$tls_in_peercert}}
28000 server_condition = ${if and { {eq{$tls_in_certificate_verified}{1}} \
28001 {forany {$auth1} \
28002 {!= {0} \
28003 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
28004 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
28005 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
28006 } } } }}}
28007 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
28008.endd
28009This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
28010of your configured trust-anchors
28011(which usually means the full set of public CAs)
28012and which has a SAN with a good account name.
28013
28014Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
28015The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
28016TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
28017in this way.
28018Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
28019
28020. An alternative might use
28021. .code
28022. server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
28023. .endd
28024. to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
28025. (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
28026. This would help for per-device use.
28027.
28028. However, for the future we really need support for checking a
28029. user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
28030
28031.ecindex IIDtlsauth1
28032.ecindex IIDtlsauth2
28033
28034
28035Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
28036the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
28037a connect- or helo-ACL.
28038
28039
28040
28041. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28042. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28043
28044.chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
28045 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
28046.scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
28047.scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
28048.cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
28049.cindex "OpenSSL"
28050.cindex "GnuTLS"
28051Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
28052Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
28053GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
28054cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
28055order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
28056version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
28057You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
28058level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
28059certificates are used.
28060
28061RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
28062connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
28063server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
28064mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
28065between them is encrypted.
28066
28067Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
28068and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
28069certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
28070possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
28071encryption state.
28072
28073&*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
28074disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
28075in order to get TLS to work.
28076
28077
28078
28079.section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
28080 "SECID284"
28081.cindex "submissions protocol"
28082.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
28083.cindex "smtps protocol"
28084.cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
28085.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
28086.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
28087The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
28088contentious. As of RFC 8314, the common practice of using the historically
28089allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
28090instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
28091by them in preference to STARTTLS.
28092
28093The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
28094clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
28095Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
28096
28097This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
28098standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
28099reassigned for other use.
28100Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
28101this port.
28102In practice, a number of mail-clients have only ever supported submissions,
28103not submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
28104Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
28105
28106Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
28107global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
28108the most common use is expected to be:
28109.code
28110tls_on_connect_ports = 465
28111.endd
28112The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
28113via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
28114the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
28115the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
28116an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
28117defined elsewhere.
28118
28119There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
28120&%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
28121
28122
28123
28124
28125
28126
28127.section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
28128.cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
28129TLS is supported in Exim using either the OpenSSL or GnuTLS library.
28130To build Exim to use OpenSSL you need to set
28131.code
28132USE_OPENSSL=yes
28133.endd
28134in Local/Makefile.
28135
28136To build Exim to use GnuTLS, you need to set
28137.code
28138USE_GNUTLS=yes
28139.endd
28140in Local/Makefile.
28141
28142You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
28143include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
28144
28145There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
28146
28147.ilist
28148The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
28149cannot be the path of a directory
28150for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
28151(for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
28152.next
28153The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
28154.next
28155.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
28156.vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
28157Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
28158separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
28159affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
28160.next
28161OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
28162DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
28163RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
28164in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
28165for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
28166to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
28167&%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
28168option).
28169.next
28170The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
28171sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
28172.next
28173The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
28174When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
28175(If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
28176let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
28177.next
28178With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option
28179main option, it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
28180.next
28181Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
28182This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
28183explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
28184implementation, then patches are welcome.
28185.endlist
28186
28187
28188.section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
28189This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
28190an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
28191but not the chosen filename.
28192By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
28193See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
28194
28195GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
28196to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
28197Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
28198&_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
28199of bits requested.
28200The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
28201its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
28202parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
28203that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
28204renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
28205this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
28206place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
28207
28208For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
28209recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
28210If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
28211are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
28212not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
28213
28214Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
28215values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
28216parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
28217If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
28218until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
28219a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
28220
28221The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
28222in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
28223generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
28224
28225To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
28226and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
28227&(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
28228renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
28229.code
28230# ls
28231[ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
28232# rm -f new-params
28233# touch new-params
28234# chown exim:exim new-params
28235# chmod 0600 new-params
28236# certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
28237# openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
28238[ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
28239 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
28240 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
28241# chmod 0400 new-params
28242# mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
28243.endd
28244If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
28245stalling is removed.
28246
28247The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
28248Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
28249the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
28250a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
28251and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
28252failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
28253of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
28254which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
28255GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
28256to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
28257limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
28258
28259The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
28260value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
28261&%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
282622432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
28263
28264In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
28265increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
28266bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
28267procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
28268the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
28269
28270
28271.section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
28272.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
28273.oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
28274There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
28275suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
28276are acceptable for TLS versions prior to 1.3.
28277The list is colon separated and may contain names like
28278DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
28279directly to this function call.
28280Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
28281&'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
28282The following quotation from the OpenSSL
28283documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
28284
28285.ilist
28286It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
28287.next
28288It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
28289or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
28290ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
28291SSL v3 algorithms.
28292.next
28293Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
28294the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
28295SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
28296algorithms.
28297.endlist
28298
28299Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
28300&`-`& or &`+`&.
28301.ilist
28302If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
28303ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
28304stated.
28305.next
28306If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
28307of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
28308.next
28309If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
28310option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
28311.endlist
28312
28313If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
28314a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
28315includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
28316not be moved to the end of the list.
28317.endlist
28318
28319The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
28320string:
28321.code
28322# note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
28323$ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
28324.endd
28325
28326This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
28327there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
28328submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
28329choice of clients used:
28330.code
28331# OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
28332tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
28333 {DEFAULT}\
28334 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
28335.endd
28336
28337This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
28338.code
28339tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
28340.endd
28341
28342For TLS version 1.3 the control available is less fine-grained
28343and Exim does not provide access to it at present.
28344The value of the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is ignored when
28345TLS version 1.3 is negotiated.
28346
28347As of writing the library default cipher suite list for TLSv1.3 is
28348.code
28349TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
28350.endd
28351
28352
28353.section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
28354 "SECTreqciphgnu"
28355.cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
28356.cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
28357.cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
28358.cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
28359.cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
28360.cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
28361.oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
28362The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
28363as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
28364ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
28365
28366The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
28367and controls both protocols and ciphers.
28368
28369The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
28370controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
28371&(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
28372the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
28373the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
28374aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
28375
28376Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
28377"Priority strings". This is online as
28378&url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
28379but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
28380installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
28381then the example code
28382&url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
28383on that site can be used to test a given string.
28384
28385For example:
28386.code
28387# Disable older versions of protocols
28388tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
28389.endd
28390
28391Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
28392additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
28393"&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
28394
28395This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
28396there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
28397by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
28398where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
28399used:
28400.code
28401# GnuTLS variant
28402tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
28403 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
28404 {SECURE128}}
28405.endd
28406
28407
28408.section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
28409.cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
28410When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
28411the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
28412but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
28413that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
28414this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
28415
28416If STARTTLS is to be used you
28417need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
28418
28419If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
28420problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
28421persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
28422with the error
28423.code
28424554 Security failure
28425.endd
28426If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
28427rejected with a 554 error code.
28428
28429To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
28430must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
28431
28432If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
28433meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
28434You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
28435from someone able to intercept the communication.
28436
28437Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
28438
28439To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
28440.code
28441tls_certificate = /some/file/name
28442tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
28443.endd
28444These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
28445the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
28446contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
28447that goes with it. These files need to be
28448PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
28449always be given as full path names.
28450The key must not be password-protected.
28451They can be the same file if both the
28452certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
28453set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
28454is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
28455certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
28456the server's certificate.
28457
28458For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
28459colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
28460algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
28461public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
28462client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
28463ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
28464
28465If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
28466source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
28467few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
28468
28469&*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
28470they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
28471Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
28472transport.
28473
28474With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
28475require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
28476this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
28477.code
28478tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
28479.endd
28480is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
28481with the parameters contained in the file.
28482Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
28483available:
28484.code
28485tls_dhparam = none
28486.endd
28487This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
28488DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
28489used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
28490documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
28491
28492See the command
28493.code
28494openssl dhparam
28495.endd
28496for a way of generating file data.
28497
28498The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
28499host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
28500for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
28501in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
28502forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
28503
28504.cindex "cipher" "logging"
28505.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
28506.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
28507The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
28508an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
28509incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
28510also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
28511&"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
28512condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
28513
28514Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
28515can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
28516cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
28517example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
28518contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
28519documentation for more details.
28520
28521For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
28522(again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
28523
28524
28525.section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
28526.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
28527.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
28528If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
28529session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
28530&%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
28531apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
28532Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
28533contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
28534expected trust-anchors or certificates.
28535These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
28536an explicit file or,
28537depending on library version, a directory, identified by
28538&%tls_verify_certificates%&.
28539
28540A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
28541directory is used
28542(OpenSSL only),
28543each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
28544of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
28545certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
28546.code
28547openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
28548.endd
28549where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
28550
28551There is no checking of names of the client against the certificate
28552Subject Name or Subject Alternate Names.
28553
28554The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
28555what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
28556does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
28557&%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
28558attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
28559dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
28560session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
28561fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
28562example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
28563relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
28564
28565.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
28566When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
28567the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
28568&$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
28569
28570.cindex "log" "distinguished name"
28571Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
28572&'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
28573&"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
28574&%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
28575certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
28576
28577
28578.section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
28579.cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
28580.cindex "revocation list"
28581.cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
28582.cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
28583Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
28584certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
28585server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
28586an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
28587of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
28588CRL in PEM format.
28589The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
28590file from every certificate authority they know of.
28591
28592The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
28593Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
28594against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
28595usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
28596private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
28597is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
28598
28599The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
28600comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
28601connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
28602re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
28603
28604The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
28605issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
28606the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
28607negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
28608CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
28609resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
28610starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
28611proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
28612
28613Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
28614or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
28615support for OCSP stapling is included.
28616
28617There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
28618The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
28619an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
28620option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
28621contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
28622
28623Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
28624proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
28625Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
28626contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
28627on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
28628next connection.
28629
28630When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
28631in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
28632ignored.
28633
28634For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
28635also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
28636certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
28637of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
28638intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
28639file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
28640
28641Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
28642not any of the chain from CA to it.
28643
28644There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
28645
28646.code
28647 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
28648 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
28649 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
28650
28651 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
28652 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
28653 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
28654.endd
28655
28656
28657
28658
28659.section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECTclientTLS"
28660.cindex "cipher" "logging"
28661.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
28662.cindex "log" "distinguished name"
28663.cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
28664The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
28665deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
28666server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
28667within the &(smtp)& transport.
28668
28669It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
28670transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
28671server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
28672this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
28673transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
28674
28675If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
28676to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
28677&%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
28678those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
28679set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
28680usual way.
28681
28682When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
28683the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
28684a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
28685session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
28686&%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
28687delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
28688it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
28689STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
28690negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
28691unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
28692unencrypted.
28693
28694The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
28695transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
28696if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
28697&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
28698
28699&*Note*&: Do not use a certificate which has the OCSP-must-staple extension,
28700for client use (they are usable for server use).
28701As the TLS protocol has no means for the client to staple before TLS 1.3 it will result
28702in failed connections.
28703
28704If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
28705specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
28706These may be
28707the system default set (depending on library version),
28708a file,
28709or (depending on library version) a directory.
28710The client verifies the server's certificate
28711against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
28712in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
28713Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
28714&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
28715
28716The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
28717certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
28718or need not succeed respectively.
28719
28720The &%tls_verify_cert_hostnames%& option lists hosts for which additional
28721checks are made: that the host name (the one in the DNS A record)
28722is valid for the certificate.
28723The option defaults to always checking.
28724
28725The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
28726&%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
28727is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
28728value is empty.
28729&%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
28730a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
28731value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
28732otherwise.
28733
28734The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
28735&%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
28736for OCSP to be relevant.
28737
28738If
28739&%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
28740list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
28741the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
28742alternative hosts, if any.
28743
28744 &*Note*&:
28745These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
28746is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
28747by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
28748client.
28749
28750.vindex "&$host$&"
28751.vindex "&$host_address$&"
28752All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
28753&$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
28754which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
28755behave as if the relevant option were unset.
28756
28757.vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
28758.vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
28759.vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
28760.vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
28761Before an SMTP connection is established, the
28762&$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
28763variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
28764that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
28765successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
28766outgoing connection.
28767
28768
28769
28770.section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
28771.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
28772.vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
28773.oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
28774With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
28775information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
28776extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
28777&"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
28778client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
28779within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
28780for this session.
28781
28782This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
28783which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
28784address.
28785
28786With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
28787against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
28788provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
28789be of limited use in that environment.
28790
28791With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
28792connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
28793choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
28794wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
28795different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
28796
28797The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
28798if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
28799nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
28800only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
28801for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
28802
28803Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
28804received from a client.
28805It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
28806
28807If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
28808option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
28809during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
28810
28811.ilist
28812&%tls_certificate%&
28813.next
28814&%tls_crl%&
28815.next
28816&%tls_privatekey%&
28817.next
28818&%tls_verify_certificates%&
28819.next
28820&%tls_ocsp_file%&
28821.endlist
28822
28823Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
28824attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
28825can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
28826arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
28827Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI has arrived, so
28828an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
28829when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
28830
28831The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
28832are re-expanded.
28833
28834When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
28835for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
28836enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
28837see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
28838
28839When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
288400.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
28841built, then you have SNI support).
28842
28843
28844
28845.section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
28846 "SECTmulmessam"
28847.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
28848.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
28849Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
28850an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
28851one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
28852of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
28853connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
28854to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
28855starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
28856unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
28857
28858An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
28859&%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
28860this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
28861shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
28862before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
28863try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
28864if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
28865
28866The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
28867after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
28868just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
28869reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
28870successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
28871SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
28872should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
28873subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
28874and delay other deliveries to that host.
28875
28876To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
28877closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
28878closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
28879information is recorded.
28880
28881There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
28882&(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
28883connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
28884
28885
28886
28887
28888.section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
28889.cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
28890In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
28891certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities.
28892This is a large topic and an introductory guide is unsuitable for the Exim
28893reference manual, so instead we provide pointers to existing documentation.
28894
28895The Apache web-server was for a long time the canonical guide, so their
28896documentation is a good place to start; their SSL module's Introduction
28897document is currently at
28898.display
28899&url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_intro.html)
28900.endd
28901and their FAQ is at
28902.display
28903&url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_faq.html)
28904.endd
28905
28906Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
289070-201-61598-3) in 2001, contains both introductory and more in-depth
28908descriptions.
28909More recently Ivan Ristić's book &'Bulletproof SSL and TLS'&,
28910published by Feisty Duck (ISBN 978-1907117046) in 2013 is good.
28911Ivan is the author of the popular TLS testing tools at
28912&url(https://www.ssllabs.com/).
28913
28914
28915.section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
28916The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
28917certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
28918sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
28919not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
28920First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
28921certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
28922intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
28923certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
28924The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
28925validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
28926root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
28927install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
28928
28929Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
28930even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
28931server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
28932diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
28933
28934
28935
28936.section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
28937.cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
28938You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
28939with OpenSSL, like this:
28940. ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
28941. ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
28942.code
28943openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
28944 -days 9999 -nodes
28945.endd
28946&_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
28947delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
28948specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
28949important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
28950that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
28951prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
28952this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
28953
28954. ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
28955. ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
28956. ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
28957. ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
28958. ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
28959. ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
28960. ==== -pdp, 2012
28961NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
28962epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
28963the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
28964the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
28965of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
28966writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
28967progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
28968be a sensible resolution).
28969
28970A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
28971may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
28972encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
28973
28974However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
28975user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
28976certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
28977must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
28978authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
28979signed with that self-signed certificate.
28980
28981For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
28982user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
28983Open-source PKI book, available online at
28984&url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/ospkibook/).
28985.ecindex IIDencsmtp1
28986.ecindex IIDencsmtp2
28987
28988
28989
28990.section DANE "SECDANE"
28991.cindex DANE
28992DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
28993it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
28994operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
28995you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
28996Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
28997certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
28998
28999What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
29000that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
29001by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
29002
29003It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
29004fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
29005
29006DANE scales better than having to maintain (and side-channel communicate) copies of server certificates
29007for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
29008client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
29009
29010DANE requires a server operator to do three things: 1) run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
29011that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
29012to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
29013DNSSEC.
290142) add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
290153) offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is is anchored by one of the TLSA records.
29016
29017There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
29018Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
29019in &_Local/Makefile_&.
29020If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
29021
29022A TLSA record consist of 4 fields, the "Certificate Usage", the
29023"Selector", the "Matching type", and the "Certificate Association Data".
29024For a detailed description of the TLSA record see
29025&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7671#page-5,RFC 7671).
29026
29027The TLSA record for the server may have "Certificate Usage" (1st) field of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3).
29028These are the "Trust Anchor" and "End Entity" variants.
29029The latter specifies the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server
29030(and if only DANE-EE is used then it should be the sole one transmitted during the TLS handshake);
29031this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
29032DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
29033well-known one.
29034A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate (with certain
29035attributes) which is used to sign server certificates, but running one securely
29036does require careful arrangement.
29037With DANE-TA, as implemented in Exim and commonly in other MTAs,
29038the server TLS handshake must transmit the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate.
29039DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
29040all of which point to a single TLSA record.
29041DANE-TA and DANE-EE can both be used together.
29042
29043Our recommendation is to use DANE with a certificate from a public CA,
29044because this enables a variety of strategies for remote clients to verify
29045your certificate.
29046You can then publish information both via DANE and another technology,
29047"MTA-STS", described below.
29048
29049When you use DANE-TA to publish trust anchor information, you ask entities
29050outside your administrative control to trust the Certificate Authority for
29051connections to you.
29052If using a private CA then you should expect others to still apply the
29053technical criteria they'd use for a public CA to your certificates.
29054In particular, you should probably try to follow current best practices for CA
29055operation around hash algorithms and key sizes.
29056Do not expect other organizations to lower their security expectations just
29057because a particular profile might be reasonable for your own internal use.
29058
29059When this text was last updated, this in practice means to avoid use of SHA-1
29060and MD5; if using RSA to use key sizes of at least 2048 bits (and no larger
29061than 4096, for interoperability); to use keyUsage fields correctly; to use
29062random serial numbers.
29063The list of requirements is subject to change as best practices evolve.
29064If you're not already using a private CA, or it doesn't meet these
29065requirements, then we encourage you to avoid all these issues and use a public
29066CA such as &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt) instead.
29067
29068The TLSA record should have a "Selector" (2nd) field of SPKI(1) and
29069a "Matching Type" (3rd) field of SHA2-512(2).
29070
29071For the "Certificate Authority Data" (4th) field, commands like
29072
29073.code
29074 openssl x509 -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
29075 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
29076 | openssl sha512 \
29077 | awk '{print $2}'
29078.endd
29079
29080are workable to create a hash of the certificate's public key.
29081
29082An example TLSA record for DANE-EE(3), SPKI(1), and SHA-512 (2) looks like
29083
29084.code
29085 _25._tcp.mail.example.com. TLSA 3 1 2 8BA8A336E...
29086.endd
29087
29088At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
29089is useful for quickly generating TLSA records.
29090
29091
29092For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
29093
29094The Certificate issued by the CA published in the DANE-TA model should be
29095issued using a strong hash algorithm.
29096Exim, and importantly various other MTAs sending to you, will not
29097re-enable hash algorithms which have been disabled by default in TLS
29098libraries.
29099This means no MD5 and no SHA-1. SHA2-256 is the minimum for reliable
29100interoperability (and probably the maximum too, in 2018).
29101
29102The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
29103be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
29104default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
29105
29106.code
29107 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
29108 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
29109 {*}{}}
29110.endd
29111
29112The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
29113The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
29114found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
29115string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
29116control the OCSP request.
29117
29118This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
29119those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
29120
29121
29122For client-side DANE there are three new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%&, &%hosts_require_dane%&
29123and &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%&.
29124The &"require"& variant will result in failure if the target host is not
29125DNSSEC-secured. To get DNSSEC-secured hostname resolution, use
29126the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router or transport option.
29127
29128DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
29129
29130A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using dnssec.
29131If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
29132will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
29133be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
29134
29135If DANE is requested and usable, then the TLS cipher list configuration
29136prefers to use the option &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%& and falls
29137back to &%tls_require_ciphers%& only if that is unset.
29138This lets you configure "decent crypto" for DANE and "better than nothing
29139crypto" as the default. Note though that while GnuTLS lets the string control
29140which versions of TLS/SSL will be negotiated, OpenSSL does not and you're
29141limited to ciphersuite constraints.
29142
29143If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
29144.code
29145 hosts_require_tls
29146 tls_verify_hosts
29147 tls_try_verify_hosts
29148 tls_verify_certificates
29149 tls_crl
29150 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
29151.endd
29152
29153If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
29154verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
29155
29156The router and transport option &%dnssec_request_domains%& must not be
29157set to &"never"&, and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
29158
29159If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
29160
29161There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
29162verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
29163in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
29164and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
29165
29166.cindex DANE reporting
29167An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
29168to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
29169required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
29170&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
29171The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
29172Section 4.3 of that document.
29173
29174Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
29175
29176DANE is specified in published RFCs and decouples certificate authority trust
29177selection from a "race to the bottom" of "you must trust everything for mail
29178to get through". There is an alternative technology called MTA-STS, which
29179instead publishes MX trust anchor information on an HTTPS website. At the
29180time this text was last updated, MTA-STS was still a draft, not yet an RFC.
29181Exim has no support for MTA-STS as a client, but Exim mail server operators
29182can choose to publish information describing their TLS configuration using
29183MTA-STS to let those clients who do use that protocol derive trust
29184information.
29185
29186The MTA-STS design requires a certificate from a public Certificate Authority
29187which is recognized by clients sending to you.
29188That selection of which CAs are trusted by others is outside your control.
29189
29190The most interoperable course of action is probably to use
29191&url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt), with automated certificate
29192renewal; to publish the anchor information in DNSSEC-secured DNS via TLSA
29193records for DANE clients (such as Exim and Postfix) and to publish anchor
29194information for MTA-STS as well. This is what is done for the &'exim.org'&
29195domain itself (with caveats around occasionally broken MTA-STS because of
29196incompatible specification changes prior to reaching RFC status).
29197
29198
29199
29200. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29201. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29202
29203.chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
29204.scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
29205.cindex "control of incoming mail"
29206.cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
29207.cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
29208Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the runtime
29209configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
29210name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
29211one very small ACL:
29212.code
29213begin acl
29214small_acl:
29215 accept hosts = one.host.only
29216.endd
29217You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
29218which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
29219
29220The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
29221certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
29222when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
29223option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
29224in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
29225local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
29226a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
29227&<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
29228
29229
29230.section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
29231The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
29232configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
29233
29234
29235.section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
29236.cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
29237In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
29238options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
29239.cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
29240.cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
29241.cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
29242.cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
29243.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
29244.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
29245.cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
29246.cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
29247.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
29248.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
29249.cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
29250.cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
29251.cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
29252.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
29253.cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
29254.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
29255
29256.table2 140pt
29257.irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
29258.irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
29259.irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
29260.irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
29261.irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
29262.irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
29263.irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
29264.irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
29265.irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
29266.irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
29267.irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
29268.irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
29269.irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
29270.irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
29271.irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
29272.irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
29273.irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
29274.irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
29275.irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
29276.irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
29277.endtable
29278
29279For example, if you set
29280.code
29281acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
29282.endd
29283the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
29284in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
29285done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
29286sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
29287command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
29288trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
29289testing as possible at RCPT time.
29290
29291
29292.section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
29293.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
29294The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
29295apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
29296really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
29297the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
29298relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
29299are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
29300&$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
29301&$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
29302in any of these ACLs.
29303
29304The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
29305non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
29306analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
29307batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
29308result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
29309really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
29310on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
29311controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
29312.code
29313control = suppress_local_fixups
29314.endd
29315This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
29316run, it is too late.
29317
29318The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29319content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29320
29321The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
29322kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
29323temporary error for these kinds of message.
29324
29325
29326.section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
29327.cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
29328.oindex &%smtp_banner%&
29329The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
29330session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
29331an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
29332accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
29333the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
29334&%smtp_banner%& option.
29335
29336
29337.section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
29338.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
29339.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
29340The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
29341EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
29342&%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
29343Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
29344session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
29345setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
29346
29347Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
29348mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
29349&$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
29350
29351If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
29352modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
29353at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
29354affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
29355an EHLO response.
29356
29357
29358.section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
29359.cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
29360Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
29361command, with two responses being sent to the client.
29362When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
29363is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
29364the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
29365response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
29366added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
29367are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
29368
29369You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
29370in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
29371tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
29372received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
29373the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
29374associated with the DATA command.
29375
29376.cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
29377.cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
29378.cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
29379If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
29380the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
29381. XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
29382The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
29383the data specified is received.
29384
29385For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
29386error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
29387MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
29388before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
29389and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
29390your resources.
29391
29392The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
29393the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
29394the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
29395and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
29396
29397.section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
29398The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
29399enabled (which is the default).
29400
29401The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
29402received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
29403otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
29404
29405This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29406
29407For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
29408
29409
29410.section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
29411The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29412content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29413
29414This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29415
29416
29417.section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
29418.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
29419.oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
29420The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
29421with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
29422It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
29423client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
29424has been accepted.
29425
29426The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
29427has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
29428with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
29429The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
29430The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
29431can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
29432for some or all recipients.
29433
29434PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
29435one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
29436content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
29437.cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
29438for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
29439is &"yes"&.
29440Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
29441ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
29442will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
29443
29444See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
29445and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
29446
29447This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29448If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
29449the feature was not requested by the client.
29450
29451.section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
29452.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
29453The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
29454does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
29455does not in fact control any access.
29456For this reason, it may only accept
29457or warn as its final result.
29458
29459This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
29460session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
29461messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
29462more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
29463
29464&*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
29465the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
29466
29467You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
29468&%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
29469response to QUIT.
29470
29471This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
29472failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
29473because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
29474client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
29475connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
29476
29477
29478.section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
29479.vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
29480The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
29481an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
29482trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
29483because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
29484situation even worse.
29485
29486Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
29487logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
29488modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
29489and &%warn%&.
29490
29491.vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
29492When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
29493to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
29494connection. The possible values are:
29495.table2
29496.irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
29497.irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
29498.irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
29499.irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
29500.irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
29501.irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
29502.irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
29503.irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
29504.irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
29505.irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
29506.endtable
29507In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
29508Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
29509With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
29510overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
29511&%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
29512used.
29513
29514
29515.section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
29516.cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
29517The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
29518you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
29519.code
29520acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
29521 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
29522.endd
29523In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
29524providing an RFC 4409 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and
29525an RFC 8314 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
29526expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
29527more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
29528
29529The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
29530configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
29531string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
29532
29533.ilist
29534If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a filename, and reads its
29535contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
29536Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
29537lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
29538If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
29539causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
29540.code
29541acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
29542 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
29543 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
29544.endd
29545This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
29546back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
29547file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
29548can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
29549.next
29550If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
29551Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
29552matches the string.
29553.next
29554If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
29555the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
29556want to have something like
29557.code
29558acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
29559.endd
29560in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
29561newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
29562.endlist
29563
29564
29565
29566
29567.section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
29568.cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
29569Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
29570section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
29571&"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
29572database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
29573return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
29574&"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
29575This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
29576
29577For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
29578&"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
29579submitters of non-SMTP messages.
29580
29581
29582ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
29583has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
29584individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
29585blackholing facility. Use it with care.
29586
29587If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
29588ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
29589RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
29590recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
29591run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
29592remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
29593&%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
29594
29595If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
29596is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
29597
29598
29599.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
29600The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
29601recipients; it may create new recipients.
29602
29603
29604
29605.section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
29606.cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
29607The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
29608all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
29609not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
29610reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
29611
29612For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
29613these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
29614used to accept or reject anything.
29615
29616For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
29617&%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
29618&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
29619when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
29620
29621For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
29622&%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
29623This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
29624messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
29625configuration file.
29626
29627
29628
29629
29630.section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
29631.cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
29632.vindex &$domain$&
29633.vindex &$local_part$&
29634.vindex &$sender_address$&
29635.vindex &$sender_host_address$&
29636.vindex &$smtp_command$&
29637When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
29638that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
29639&$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
29640statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
29641&$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
29642is available in &$smtp_command$&.
29643
29644When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
29645contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
29646set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
29647how it is used.
29648
29649.vindex "&$message_size$&"
29650The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
29651the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
29652that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
29653the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
29654received).
29655
29656.vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
29657.vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
29658The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
29659The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
29660accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
29661of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
29662&$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
29663&$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
29664
29665
29666
29667
29668
29669.section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
29670.cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
29671.vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
29672.vindex &$smtp_command$&
29673When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
29674the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
29675and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
29676These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
29677here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
29678encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
29679does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
29680unencrypted connections.
29681.code
29682acl_check_auth:
29683 accept encrypted = *
29684 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
29685 {CRAM-MD5}}
29686 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
29687.endd
29688(Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
29689that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
29690encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
29691option to do this.)
29692
29693
29694
29695.section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
29696.cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
29697.cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
29698An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
29699with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
29700Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
29701set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
29702
29703If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
29704used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
29705provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
29706example:
29707.code
29708deny dnslists = list1.example
29709 dnslists = list2.example
29710.endd
29711If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
29712the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
29713happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
29714all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
29715test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
29716
29717
29718.section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
29719The ACL verbs are as follows:
29720
29721.ilist
29722.cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
29723&%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
29724of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
29725appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
29726is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
29727after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
29728check a RCPT command:
29729.code
29730accept domains = +local_domains
29731 endpass
29732 verify = recipient
29733.endd
29734If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
29735passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
29736the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
29737fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
29738&%endpass%&.
29739
29740The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
29741use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
29742that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
29743configuration.
29744
29745.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
29746If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
29747depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
29748(when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
29749statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
29750SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
29751.display
29752&`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
29753&` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
29754.endd
29755You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
29756response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
29757same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
29758
29759If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
29760an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
29761for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
29762of &%endpass%&.
29763
29764
29765.next
29766.cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
29767&%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
29768an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
29769&%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
29770temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
29771&(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
29772be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
29773
29774
29775.next
29776.cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
29777&%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
29778the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
29779example,
29780.code
29781deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29782.endd
29783rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
29784
29785
29786.next
29787.cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
29788&%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
29789&"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
29790that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
29791the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
29792recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
29793recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
29794message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
29795do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
29796
29797If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
29798its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
29799The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
29800
29801
29802.next
29803.cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
29804&%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
29805forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
29806.code
29807drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
29808 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
29809.endd
29810There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
29811The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
29812
29813.next
29814.cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
29815&%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
29816statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
29817example, when checking a RCPT command,
29818.code
29819require message = Sender did not verify
29820 verify = sender
29821.endd
29822passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
29823verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
29824&%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
29825discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
29826
29827.next
29828.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
29829&%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
29830&%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
29831to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
29832written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
29833message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
29834duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
29835
29836If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
29837and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
29838&%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
29839first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
29840&<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
29841
29842If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
29843some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
29844This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
29845is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
29846conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
29847is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
29848onwards.
29849
29850
29851.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29852When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
29853text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
29854want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
29855.code
29856warn !verify = sender
29857 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
29858.endd
29859.endlist
29860
29861At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
29862
29863As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
29864written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
29865subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
29866continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
29867mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
29868
29869
29870
29871.section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
29872.cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
29873There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
29874can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
29875of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
29876transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
29877variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
29878an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
29879alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
29880the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
29881.ilist
29882The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
29883throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
29884while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
29885on the same SMTP connection.
29886.next
29887The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
29888while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
29889reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
29890.endlist
29891
29892When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
29893preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
29894time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
29895.code
29896accept hosts = whatever
29897 set acl_m4 = some value
29898accept authenticated = *
29899 set acl_c_auth = yes
29900.endd
29901&*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
29902be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
29903&%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
29904
29905.oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
29906What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
29907referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
29908false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
29909error is generated.
29910
29911Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
29912their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
29913
29914
29915.section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
29916.cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
29917.cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
29918An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
29919.code
29920deny domains = *.dom.example
29921 !verify = recipient
29922.endd
29923causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
29924&'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
29925negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
29926two statements are equivalent:
29927.code
29928deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
29929deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
29930.endd
29931However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
29932side negation of the whole condition is possible.
29933
29934The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
29935of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
29936condition is true. Consider these two statements:
29937.code
29938accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
29939 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
29940accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
29941 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
29942.endd
29943Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
29944the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
29945different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
29946condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
29947therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
29948the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
29949and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
29950
29951ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
29952specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
29953others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
29954warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
29955message is handled.
29956
29957The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
29958processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
29959modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
29960consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
29961.code
29962require message = Can't verify sender
29963 verify = sender
29964 message = Can't verify recipient
29965 verify = recipient
29966 message = This message cannot be used
29967.endd
29968If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
29969&"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
29970so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
29971recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
29972verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
29973because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
29974
29975For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
29976modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
29977happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
29978the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
29979.code
29980deny hosts = ...
29981 !senders = *@my.domain.example
29982 message = Invalid sender from client host
29983.endd
29984The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
29985by which time Exim has set up the message.
29986
29987
29988
29989.section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
29990.cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
29991The ACL modifiers are as follows:
29992
29993.vlist
29994.vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29995This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
29996incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
29997accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
29998
29999.vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30000.cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
30001.cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
30002This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
30003continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
30004the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
30005update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
30006write rather ugly lines like this:
30007.display
30008&`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
30009.endd
30010Instead, all you need is
30011.display
30012&`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
30013.endd
30014
30015.vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30016.cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
30017This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
30018incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
30019lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
30020lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
30021controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
30022even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
30023
30024As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
30025separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
30026in several different ways. For example:
30027
30028. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
30029. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
30030. ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
30031. ==== way.
30032
30033.ilist
30034It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
30035.code
30036 accept ...some conditions
30037 control = queue_only
30038.endd
30039In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
30040other words, when the conditions are all true.
30041
30042.next
30043It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
30044.code
30045 accept ...some conditions...
30046 control = queue_only
30047 ...some more conditions...
30048.endd
30049If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
30050statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
30051In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
30052to be relevant.
30053
30054.next
30055It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
30056decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
30057example:
30058.code
30059 warn ...some conditions...
30060 control = freeze
30061 accept ...
30062.endd
30063This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
30064&%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
30065log entry.
30066
30067.next
30068If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
30069&%require%& verb. For example:
30070.code
30071 require control = no_multiline_responses
30072.endd
30073.endlist
30074
30075.vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
30076.cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
30077.oindex "&%-bh%&"
30078This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
30079the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
30080&%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
30081output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
30082happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
30083output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
30084
30085Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
30086example:
30087.code
30088deny ...some conditions...
30089 delay = 30s
30090.endd
30091The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
30092&"deny"&. Compare this with:
30093.code
30094deny delay = 30s
30095 ...some conditions...
30096.endd
30097which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
30098can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
30099.code
30100warn ...some conditions...
30101 delay = 2m
30102 control = freeze
30103accept ...
30104.endd
30105
30106If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
30107responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
30108they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
30109delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
30110appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
30111unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
30112using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
30113
30114
30115.vitem &*endpass*&
30116.cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
30117This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
30118&%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
30119failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
30120failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
30121confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
30122&"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
30123
30124
30125.vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30126.cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
30127This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
30128ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
30129.code
30130require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
30131 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
30132.endd
30133&%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
30134example:
30135.display
30136&`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
30137&` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
30138.endd
30139When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
30140that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
30141recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
30142message.
30143
30144The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
30145the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
30146denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
30147available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
30148variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
30149&%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
30150ignored.
30151
30152.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30153If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
30154verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
30155error message.
30156
30157If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
30158the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
30159more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
30160actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
30161of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
30162is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
30163
30164If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
30165example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
30166the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
30167logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
30168both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
30169logging rejections.
30170
30171
30172.vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
30173.cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
30174.cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
30175This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
30176about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
30177be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
30178may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
30179ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
30180.display
30181&`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
30182&` log_reject_target =`&
30183.endd
30184This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
30185permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
30186current ACL.
30187
30188
30189.vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30190.cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
30191.cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
30192This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
30193processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
30194&%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
30195access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
30196ACLs. For example:
30197.display
30198&`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
30199&` control = freeze`&
30200&` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
30201.endd
30202By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
30203with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
30204another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
30205example:
30206.code
30207logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
30208logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
30209.endd
30210
30211
30212.vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30213.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
30214This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
30215message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
30216or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
30217there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
30218&%accept%& for details.)
30219
30220The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
30221to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
30222generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
30223&%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
30224the &%hosts%& condition fails:
30225.code
30226require message = Host not recognized
30227 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
30228.endd
30229(Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
30230processed.)
30231
30232.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
30233.oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
30234For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
30235of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
30236is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
30237is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
30238overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
30239accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
30240truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
30241EHLO options.
30242
30243When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
30244consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
30245of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
30246.code
30247deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
30248 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
30249.endd
30250The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
30251by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
30252access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
302532&'xx'&.
30254
30255Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
30256the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
30257
30258The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
30259literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
30260anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
30261response.
30262
30263.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30264For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
30265stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
30266
30267If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
30268specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
30269However, the original message is available in the variable
30270&$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
30271wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
30272routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
30273use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
30274
30275For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
30276is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
30277modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
30278all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
30279&%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
30280&%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
30281effect.
30282
30283
30284.vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30285.cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
30286.cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
30287This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
30288for the message.
30289It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
30290the DATA ACL).
30291This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
30292of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
30293Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
30294If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
30295
30296
30297.vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30298This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
30299 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
30300the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
30301
30302
30303.vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
30304.cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
30305This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
30306&<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
30307
30308
30309.vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
30310.cindex "UDP communications"
30311This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
30312collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
30313the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
30314of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
30315server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
30316separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
30317example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
30318when:
30319.code
30320udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
30321 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
30322.endd
30323.endlist
30324
30325
30326
30327
30328.section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
30329.cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
30330The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
30331
30332.vlist
30333.vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
30334This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
30335has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
30336apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
30337HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
30338really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
30339not work without it. For example:
30340.code
30341warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
30342 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
30343.endd
30344Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
30345the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
30346matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
30347mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
30348by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
30349
30350
30351.vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
30352 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
30353.cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
30354.cindex "case of local parts"
30355.vindex "&$local_part$&"
30356These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
30357(that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
30358are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
30359any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
30360for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
30361is encountered.
30362
30363These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
30364local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
30365in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
30366handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
30367configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
30368
30369This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
30370containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
30371spam score:
30372.code
30373warn control = caseful_local_part
30374 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
30375 $acl_m4 + \
30376 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
30377 }
30378 control = caselower_local_part
30379.endd
30380Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
30381is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
30382
30383
30384.vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
30385.cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
30386.cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
30387This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
30388
30389The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
30390If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
30391and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
30392is used for all recipients of the message,
30393then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
30394and data is copied from one to the other.
30395
30396An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
30397for a mail will be quietly ignored.
30398If a recipient-verify callout
30399(with use_sender)
30400connection is subsequently
30401requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
30402any subsequent recipients and the data,
30403otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
30404
30405Note that routers are used in verify mode,
30406and cannot depend on content of received headers.
30407Note also that headers cannot be
30408modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
30409Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
30410The &'Received-By:'& header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
30411rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
30412this will affect the timestamp.
30413
30414All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
30415rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
30416the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
30417Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
30418message body.
30419
30420Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
30421of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
30422before the entire message has been received from the source.
30423It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
30424or CHUNKING
30425options in use.
30426
30427Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
30428a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
30429If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
30430the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
30431before the acceptance "<=" line.
30432
30433If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
30434usual fashion.
30435This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
30436to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
30437&"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
30438and does not queue the message.
30439Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
30440
30441Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
30442(possibly faked)
30443sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
30444
30445
30446.vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
30447.cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
30448.cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
30449This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
30450with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
30451by default called &'debuglog'&.
30452The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
30453may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
30454the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
30455option.
30456Logging started this way may be stopped, and the file removed,
30457with the &'kill'& option.
30458Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
30459contexts):
30460.code
30461 control = debug
30462 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
30463 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
30464 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
30465 control = debug/kill
30466.endd
30467
30468
30469.vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
30470.cindex "disable DKIM verify"
30471.cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
30472This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
30473the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
30474
30475
30476.vitem &*control&~=&~dmarc_disable_verify*&
30477.cindex "disable DMARC verify"
30478.cindex "DMARC" "disable verify"
30479This control turns off DMARC verification processing entirely. For details on
30480the operation and configuration of DMARC, see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
30481
30482
30483.vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
30484.cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
30485.cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
30486This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
30487connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
30488strings or to numeric value.
30489The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
30490Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
30491&`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
30492
30493The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
30494(for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
30495that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
30496equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
30497Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
30498
30499
30500.vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
30501 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
30502.cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
30503.cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
30504These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
30505is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
30506state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
30507in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
30508
30509The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
30510connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
30511messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
30512&%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
30513before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
30514synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
30515work with.
30516
30517
30518.vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
30519.cindex "fake defer"
30520.cindex "defer, fake"
30521This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
30522except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
30523550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
30524messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
30525use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
30526
30527.vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
30528.cindex "fake rejection"
30529.cindex "rejection, fake"
30530This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
30531words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
30532message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
30533However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
30534only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
30535the same SMTP connection.
30536
30537The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
30538message is supplied, the following is used:
30539.code
30540550-Your message has been rejected but is being
30541550-kept for evaluation.
30542550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
30543550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
30544.endd
30545This facility should be used with extreme caution.
30546
30547.vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
30548.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
30549This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
30550other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
30551it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
30552current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
30553SMTP connection.
30554
30555This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
30556&%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
30557is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
30558are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
30559
30560.vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
30561.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
30562Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
30563avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
30564use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
30565disables such output flushing.
30566
30567.vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
30568.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30569Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
30570avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
30571use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
30572that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
30573
30574.vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
30575This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
30576extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
30577of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
30578or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
30579needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
30580only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
30581the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
30582to be useful in production.
30583
30584.vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
30585.cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
30586This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
30587It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
30588SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
30589
30590If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
30591suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
30592one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
30593(&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
30594responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
30595sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
30596
30597.ilist
30598Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
30599sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
30600verification failed"&) is sent.
30601.next
30602If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
30603line is output.
30604.endlist
30605
30606The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
30607calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
30608
30609.vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
30610.cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
30611This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
30612the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
30613response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
30614controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
30615&%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
30616
30617.vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
30618.oindex "&%queue_only%&"
30619.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
30620This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
30621other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
30622it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
30623runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
30624effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
30625to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
30626same SMTP connection.
30627
30628.vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
30629.cindex "message" "submission"
30630.cindex "submission mode"
30631This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
30632latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
30633the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
30634operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
30635necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
30636This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
30637late (the message has already been created).
30638
30639Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
30640messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
30641submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
30642The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
30643that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
30644
30645.vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
30646.cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
30647This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
30648complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
30649normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
30650
30651.ilist
30652Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
30653dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
30654.next
30655No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
30656.next
30657There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
30658.endlist ilist
30659
30660This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
30661passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
30662used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
30663and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
30664data is read.
30665
30666&*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
30667that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
30668
30669.vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
30670This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
30671to a-label form.
30672For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
30673.endlist vlist
30674
30675
30676.section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
30677All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
30678
30679.ilist
30680Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
30681.next
30682Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
30683&`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
30684.next
30685Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
30686.next
30687Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
30688.endlist
30689
30690
30691
30692.section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
30693.cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
30694.cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
30695.cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
30696The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
30697to an incoming message, as in this example:
30698.code
30699warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30700 dialup.mail-abuse.org
30701 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
30702.endd
30703The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
30704MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
30705receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
30706&%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
30707any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
30708RCPT ACL).
30709
30710Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
30711DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
30712
30713Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
30714the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
30715contains one or more newlines that
30716are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
30717lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
30718front of any line that is not a valid header line.
30719
30720Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
30721They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
30722However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
30723is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
30724during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
30725with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
30726lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
30727In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
30728non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
30729message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
30730are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
30731
30732.cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
30733Header lines are not visible in string expansions
30734of message headers
30735until they are added to the
30736message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
30737ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
30738header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
30739ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
30740passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
30741this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
30742&<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
30743
30744The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
30745
30746The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
30747processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
30748.display
30749&`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
30750&` `&<&'some condition'&>
30751
30752&`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
30753&` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
30754.endd
30755In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
30756condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
30757condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
30758ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
30759honoured.
30760
30761.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
30762For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
30763&%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
30764effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
30765them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
30766usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
30767are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
30768specifications.
30769
30770By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
30771header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
30772be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
30773after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
30774that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
30775
30776This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
30777&":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
30778header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
30779to be a header name first.) For example:
30780.code
30781warn add_header = \
30782 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
30783.endd
30784If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
30785each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
30786you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
30787up in reverse order.
30788
30789&*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
30790added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
30791system filter or in a router or transport.
30792
30793
30794
30795.section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
30796.cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
30797.cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
30798.cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
30799The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
30800from an incoming message, as in this example:
30801.code
30802warn message = Remove internal headers
30803 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
30804.endd
30805The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
30806MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
30807receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
30808&%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
30809with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
30810any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
30811
30812Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
30813DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
30814
30815More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
30816list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
30817not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
30818create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
30819are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
30820.code
30821warn hosts = +internal_hosts
30822 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
30823warn message = Remove internal headers
30824 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
30825.endd
30826Header names for removal are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
30827Matching header lines are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
30828If multiple header lines match, all are removed.
30829There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor in removing
30830a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
30831during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
30832if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
30833accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
30834all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
30835ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
30836would have been removed.
30837
30838.cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
30839Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
30840is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
30841not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
30842removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
30843this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
30844passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
30845you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
30846&<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
30847
30848The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
30849processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
30850.display
30851&`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
30852&` `&<&'some condition'&>
30853
30854&`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
30855&` remove_header = X-Internal`&
30856.endd
30857In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
30858condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
30859condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
30860same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
30861are honoured.
30862
30863&*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
30864present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
30865in a system filter or in a router or transport.
30866
30867
30868
30869
30870.section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
30871.cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
30872Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
30873compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
30874for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
30875content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30876
30877Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
30878senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
30879result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
30880done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
30881can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
30882same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
30883The conditions are as follows:
30884
30885
30886.vlist
30887.vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
30888.cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
30889.cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
30890.cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
30891.cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
30892The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
30893&%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
30894&"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
30895false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
30896condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
30897condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
30898ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
30899
30900If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
30901can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
30902and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
30903Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
30904The name and values are expanded separately.
30905Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
30906will act as argument separators.
30907
30908If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
30909the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
30910&%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
30911conditions are tested.
30912
30913ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
30914loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
30915circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
30916for different local users or different local domains.
30917
30918.vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
30919.cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
30920.cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
30921.cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
30922If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
30923the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
30924authentication by any authenticator, you can set
30925.code
30926authenticated = *
30927.endd
30928
30929.vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
30930.cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
30931.cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
30932.cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
30933.cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
30934This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
30935expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
30936&"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
30937number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
30938any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
30939&"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
30940ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
30941negative.
30942
30943.vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
30944.cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
30945This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30946content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
30947&%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
30948If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
30949problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
30950chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30951
30952.vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
30953.cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
30954.cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
30955.cindex "black list (DNS)"
30956.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
30957This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
30958&"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
30959use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
30960different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
30961&<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
30962
30963.vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30964.cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
30965.cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
30966.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
30967.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
30968This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
30969of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
30970enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
30971lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
30972&%domains%& test.
30973
30974&*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
30975use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
30976
30977
30978.vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
30979.cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
30980.cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
30981.cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
30982If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
30983name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
30984encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
30985.code
30986encrypted = *
30987.endd
30988
30989
30990.vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
30991.cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
30992.cindex "host" "ACL checking"
30993.cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
30994This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
30995name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
30996you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
30997.code
30998accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30999.endd
31000The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
31001the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
31002and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
31003
31004The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
31005Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
31006but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
31007find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
31008opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
31009found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
31010
31011If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
31012address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
31013.code
31014accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
31015accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
31016.endd
31017The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
31018is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
31019statement can then check the IP address.
31020
31021.vindex "&$host_data$&"
31022If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
31023of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
31024allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
31025.code
31026deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
31027message = $host_data
31028.endd
31029which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
31030
31031.vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
31032.cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
31033.cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
31034.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
31035.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
31036This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
31037part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
31038enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
31039result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
31040the next &%local_parts%& test.
31041
31042.vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
31043.cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
31044.cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
31045.cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
31046This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31047content-scanning extension
31048and only after a DATA command.
31049It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
31050viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31051
31052.vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
31053.cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
31054.cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
31055This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31056content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
31057&%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
31058with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
31059&<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31060
31061.vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
31062.cindex "rate limiting"
31063This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
31064messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
31065
31066.vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
31067.cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
31068.cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
31069.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
31070This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
31071recipient address against a list of recipients.
31072
31073.vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
31074.cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
31075.cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
31076This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31077content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
31078non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
31079any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31080
31081.vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
31082.cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
31083.cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
31084.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
31085.vindex "&$domain$&"
31086.vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
31087This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
31088domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
31089&$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
31090of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
31091lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
31092RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
31093influence the sender checking.
31094
31095&*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
31096relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
31097
31098.vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
31099.cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
31100.cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
31101.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
31102This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
31103for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
31104.code
31105senders = :
31106.endd
31107&*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
31108relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
31109
31110.vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
31111.cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
31112.cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
31113This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31114content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
31115SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31116
31117.vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
31118.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31119.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
31120.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
31121.cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
31122.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
31123This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
31124certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
31125server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
31126or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
31127
31128.vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
31129.cindex "CSA verification"
31130This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
31131send email. Details of how this works are given in section
31132&<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
31133
31134.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
31135.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31136.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
31137.cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
31138.cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
31139This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31140received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31141&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
31142there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
31143allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
31144
31145Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
31146problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
31147detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
31148
31149.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
31150.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31151.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
31152.cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
31153.cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
31154.cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
31155This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31156received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31157&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
31158of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
31159is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
31160However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
31161that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
31162to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
31163might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
31164
31165Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
31166section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
31167&<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
31168condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
31169.code
31170deny senders = :
31171 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
31172 !verify = header_sender
31173.endd
31174
31175.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
31176.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31177.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
31178.cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
31179.cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
31180This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31181received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31182&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
31183lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
31184and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
31185Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
31186permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
31187&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
31188appropriate.
31189
31190Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
31191ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
31192.code
31193To: @
31194.endd
31195and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
31196common as they used to be.
31197
31198.vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
31199.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31200.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
31201.cindex "HELO" "verifying"
31202.cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
31203.cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
31204.cindex "verifying" "HELO"
31205This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
31206client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
31207attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
31208condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
31209&%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
31210independently of this condition, and for detail of the verification.
31211
31212For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
31213option), this condition is always true.
31214
31215
31216.vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind/*&<&'options'&>
31217.cindex "verifying" "not blind"
31218.cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
31219This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
31220Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
31221&'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
31222case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
31223&'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
31224used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
31225
31226There is one possible option, &`case_insensitive`&. If this is present then
31227local parts are checked case-insensitively.
31228
31229There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
31230recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
31231
31232
31233.vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
31234.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31235.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
31236.cindex "recipient" "verifying"
31237.cindex "verifying" "recipient"
31238.vindex "&$address_data$&"
31239This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
31240recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
31241&<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
31242of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
31243This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
31244verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
31245address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
31246value for the child address.
31247
31248.vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
31249.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31250.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
31251.cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
31252This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
31253address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
31254was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
31255Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
31256one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
31257original IP address.
31258
31259There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
31260DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
31261
31262If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
31263is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
31264
31265.vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
31266.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31267.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
31268.cindex "sender" "verifying"
31269.cindex "verifying" "sender"
31270This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
31271message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
31272the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
31273condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
31274
31275.vindex "&$address_data$&"
31276.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
31277If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
31278value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
31279value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
31280statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
31281want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
31282
31283Details of verification are given later, starting at section
31284&<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
31285to avoid doing it more than once per message.
31286
31287.vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
31288.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31289This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
31290verified as a sender.
31291
31292Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
31293(eg. is generated from the received message)
31294they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
31295.code
31296verify = sender=${sg{${address:$h_sender:}}{/}{//}}
31297.endd
31298.endlist
31299
31300
31301
31302.section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
31303.cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
31304.cindex "black list (DNS)"
31305.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
31306In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
31307is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
31308address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
31309domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
31310special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
31311address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
31312.code
31313deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
31314 dialups.mail-abuse.org
31315.endd
31316the following records are looked up:
31317.code
3131843.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
3131943.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
31320.endd
31321As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
31322Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
31323to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
31324use two separate conditions:
31325.code
31326deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31327 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
31328.endd
31329If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
31330behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
31331record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
31332processed.
31333
31334This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
31335(which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
31336blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
31337following special items in the list:
31338.display
31339&`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
31340&`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
31341&`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
31342.endd
31343.cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
31344.cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
31345.cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
31346Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
31347.code
31348deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
31349.endd
31350Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
31351warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
31352.code
31353deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31354warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
31355 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
31356.endd
31357.cindex caching "of dns lookup"
31358.cindex DNS TTL
31359DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
31360(but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
31361so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
31362connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
31363Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
31364connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
31365
31366There are a number of DNS lists to choose from, some commercial, some free,
31367or free for small deployments. An overview can be found at
31368&url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Comparison_of_DNS_blacklists).
31369
31370
31371
31372.section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
31373.cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
31374By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
31375of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
31376after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
31377.code
31378deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
31379.endd
31380This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
31381use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
31382MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
31383&<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
31384
31385
31386
31387
31388.section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
31389.cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
31390There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
31391addresses (see, e.g., the &'domain based zones'& link at
31392&url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
31393with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
31394listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
31395.code
31396deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
31397 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31398.endd
31399This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
31400RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
31401example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
31402up by this example is
31403.code
31404tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
31405.endd
31406A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
31407addresses. For example:
31408.code
31409deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31410 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31411.endd
31412The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
31413name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
31414
31415
31416
31417
31418.section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
31419.cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
31420The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
31421names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
31422name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
31423As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
31424this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
31425either to double the separators like this:
31426.code
31427dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
31428.endd
31429or to change the separator character, like this:
31430.code
31431dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
31432.endd
31433If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
31434blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
31435occurs. Consider this condition:
31436.code
31437dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
31438.endd
31439The DNS lookups that occur are:
31440.code
314412.1.168.192.black.list.tld
31442a.domain.black.list.tld
31443.endd
31444Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
31445address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
31446are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
31447or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
31448only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
31449successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
31450error for a previous item.
31451
31452The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
31453syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
31454.code
31455dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
31456dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
31457.endd
31458However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
31459is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
31460.code
31461deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
31462 $sender_address_domain \
31463 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
31464 see $dnslist_text.
31465 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
31466 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
31467 $sender_address_domain} }} }
31468.endd
31469Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
31470multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
31471and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
31472of expanding the condition might be something like this:
31473.code
31474dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
31475.endd
31476Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
31477domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
31478
31479The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
31480&$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
31481
31482
31483
31484
31485.section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
31486.cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
31487DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
31488just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
31489RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
31490The values used on the RBL+ list are:
31491.display
31492127.1.0.1 RBL
31493127.1.0.2 DUL
31494127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
31495127.1.0.4 RSS
31496127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
31497127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
31498127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
31499.endd
31500Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
31501different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
31502see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
31503
31504
31505.section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
31506.cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
31507.cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
31508.vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
31509.vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
31510.vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
31511.vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
31512When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
31513the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
31514&`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
31515(for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
31516the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
31517&$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
31518cases, for example:
31519.code
31520deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
31521.endd
31522the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
31523&$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
31524For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
31525might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
31526.code
31527deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
31528.endd
31529If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
31530&`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
31531
31532If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
31533addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
31534The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
31535record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
31536very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
31537information.
31538
31539You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
31540&-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
31541expanded until after it has failed. For example:
31542.code
31543deny hosts = !+local_networks
31544 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
31545 at $dnslist_domain
31546 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
31547.endd
31548
31549
31550
31551.section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
31552.cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
31553You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
31554in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
31555For example,
31556.code
31557deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
31558.endd
31559rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
31560any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
31561that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
31562describes how multiple records are handled.
31563
31564More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
31565separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
31566&%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
31567.code
31568deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31569.endd
31570If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
31571addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
31572first. For example:
31573.code
31574deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
31575 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
31576.endd
31577
31578If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
31579listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
31580In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
31581true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
31582tested. For example:
31583.code
31584dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
31585.endd
31586matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
31587want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
31588being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
31589.code
31590dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
31591.endd
31592matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
31593an odd number.
31594
31595
31596
31597.section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
31598You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
31599condition. Whereas
31600.code
31601deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31602.endd
31603means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
31604IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
31605.code
31606deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31607.endd
31608means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
31609IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
31610words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
31611the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
31612
31613&*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
31614host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
31615
31616If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
31617previous example is precisely equivalent to
31618.code
31619deny dnslists = a.b.c
31620 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31621.endd
31622However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
31623Consider this example:
31624.code
31625deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31626 list.dsbl.org : \
31627 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
31628 relays.ordb.org
31629.endd
31630Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
31631.code
31632deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31633 list.dsbl.org
31634deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
31635 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
31636deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
31637.endd
31638which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
31639
31640
31641
31642
31643.section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
31644A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
31645thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
31646is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
31647the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
31648the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
31649.code
31650dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
31651.endd
31652What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
31653127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
31654condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
31655because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
31656affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
31657additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
31658
31659.ilist
31660If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
31661IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
31662condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
31663.next
31664If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
31665looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
31666changed to:
31667.code
31668dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
31669.endd
31670and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31671false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
31672.code
31673dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
31674.endd
31675for the condition to be true.
31676.endlist
31677
31678When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
31679the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
31680.ilist
31681If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
31682addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
31683.code
31684dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
31685.endd
31686If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31687false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
31688.next
31689If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
31690looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
31691.code
31692dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
31693.endd
31694If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31695true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
31696.code
31697dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
31698.endd
31699for the condition to be false.
31700.endlist
31701When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
31702between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
31703
31704
31705
31706
31707.section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
31708.cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
31709When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
31710the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
31711the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
31712address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
31713only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
31714can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
31715in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
31716lists.
31717
31718A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
31719two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
31720do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
31721If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
31722restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
31723a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
31724domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
31725.code
31726deny message = \
31727 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
31728 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
31729 dnslists = \
31730 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
31731 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
31732.endd
31733For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
31734&'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
31735match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
31736value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
31737record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
31738The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
31739
31740If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
31741given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
31742the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
31743.code
31744deny dnslists = \
31745 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
31746 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
31747 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
31748 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
31749.endd
31750In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
31751values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
31752done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
31753
31754
31755
31756.section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
31757.cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
31758.cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
31759If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
31760nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
317613ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
31762.code
317631.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
31764 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31765.endd
31766(split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
31767lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
31768IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
31769.code
31770*.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
31771.endd
31772is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
31773Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
31774
31775You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
31776&%condition%& condition, as in this example:
31777.code
31778deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
31779 dnslists = some.list.example
31780.endd
31781
31782If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
31783address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
31784(DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
31785.code
31786 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
31787.endd
31788
31789.section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
31790.cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
31791.cindex "limiting client sending rates"
31792.oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
31793The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
31794which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
31795&%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
31796commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
31797works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
31798host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
31799.display
31800&`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
31801.endd
31802If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
31803period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
31804
31805As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
31806&$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
31807configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
31808of &'p'&.
31809
31810The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
31811time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
31812means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
31813parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
31814send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
31815in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
31816constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
31817changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
31818both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
31819
31820There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
31821log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
31822when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
31823instructions when it is run with no arguments.
31824
31825The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
31826sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
31827retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
31828which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
31829By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
31830of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
31831user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
31832&$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
31833example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
31834authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
31835
31836The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
31837rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
31838&`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
31839ACL.
31840
31841Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
31842specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example, messages or recipients
31843or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
31844&%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
31845using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
31846separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
31847
31848Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
31849any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
31850stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
31851remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
31852remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
31853behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
31854the &%count=%& option.
31855
31856
31857.section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
31858.cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
31859The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
31860normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
31861&%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
31862
31863The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
31864the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
31865&%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
31866&%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
31867
31868The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
31869the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
31870in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
31871used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
31872in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
31873follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
31874in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
31875
31876The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
31877accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
31878&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
31879&%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
31880ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
31881in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
31882recipients as a large high-speed burst.
31883
31884The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
31885number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
31886last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
31887recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
31888&%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
31889
31890The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
31891condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
31892command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
31893multiple different commands.
31894
31895The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
31896measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
31897&`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
31898increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
31899other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
31900
31901The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
31902
31903
31904.section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
31905.cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
31906You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
31907control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
31908mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
31909
31910If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
31911previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
31912
31913For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
31914it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
31915can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
31916in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
31917new rate.
31918.code
31919acl_check_connect:
31920 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
31921 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
31922 (max $sender_rate_limit)
31923# ...
31924acl_check_mail:
31925 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
31926 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
31927 (max $sender_rate_limit)
31928.endd
31929
31930If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
31931processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
31932it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
31933in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
31934same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
31935multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
31936checks.
31937
31938The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
31939use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
31940update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
31941&%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
31942next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
31943
31944
31945.section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
31946.cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
31947If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
31948engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
31949&%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
31950counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
31951rest of the ACL.
31952
31953The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
31954updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
31955client's average rate of successfully sent email,
31956up to the given limit.
31957This is appropriate if the countermeasure when the condition is true
31958consists of refusing the message, and
31959is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
31960If the action when true is anything more complex then this option is
31961likely not what is wanted.
31962
31963The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
31964updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
31965of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
31966actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
31967counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
31968pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
31969again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
31970attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
31971.code
31972 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
31973.endd
31974
31975
31976.section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
31977.cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
31978The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
31979rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
31980mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
31981sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
31982&`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
31983measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
31984options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
31985
31986For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
31987has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
31988rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
31989per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
31990go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
31991recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
31992
31993When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
31994&%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
31995rate.
31996
31997The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
31998other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
31999unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
32000required increases with larger limits.
32001
32002The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
32003will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
32004the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
32005the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
32006events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
32007times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
32008throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
32009limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
32010are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
32011as intended.
32012
32013
32014.section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
32015Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
32016when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
32017(for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
32018policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
32019message. For example:
32020.code
32021# Log all senders' rates
32022warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
32023 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
32024
32025# Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
32026# at the decimal point.
32027warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
32028 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
32029 $sender_rate_limit }s
32030
32031# Keep authenticated users under control
32032deny authenticated = *
32033 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
32034
32035# System-wide rate limit
32036defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
32037 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
32038
32039# Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
32040# set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
32041defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
32042 messages per $sender_rate_period
32043 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
32044 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
32045 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
32046.endd
32047&*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
32048especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
32049bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
32050making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
32051RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
32052this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
32053hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
32054
32055
32056
32057.section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
32058.cindex "verifying address" "options for"
32059.cindex "policy control" "address verification"
32060Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
32061&<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
32062&<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
32063The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
32064verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
32065other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
32066.code
32067verify = sender/callout
32068verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
32069.endd
32070The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
32071address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
32072difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
32073be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
32074(see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
32075The available options are as follows:
32076
32077.ilist
32078If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
32079remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
32080check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
32081.next
32082If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
32083normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
32084options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
32085verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
32086.next
32087The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
32088discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
32089.next
32090The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
32091immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
32092generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
32093discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
32094.endlist
32095
32096.cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
32097.vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
32098.vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
32099.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
32100After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
32101error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
32102coding like this:
32103.code
32104warn !verify = sender
32105 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
32106.endd
32107If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
32108denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
32109verification failure.
32110
32111In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
32112appropriate) contains one of the following words:
32113
32114.ilist
32115&%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
32116was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
32117.next
32118&%route%&: Routing failed.
32119.next
32120&%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
32121occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
32122connection, HELO, or MAIL).
32123.next
32124&%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
32125.next
32126&%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
32127.endlist
32128
32129The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
32130rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
32131
32132The above variables may also be set after a &*successful*&
32133address verification to:
32134
32135.ilist
32136&%random%&: A random local-part callout succeeded
32137.endlist
32138
32139
32140
32141
32142.section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
32143.cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
32144.cindex "callout" "verification"
32145.cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
32146For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
32147checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
32148the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
32149&'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
32150a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
32151address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
32152sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
32153deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
32154sender's domain.
32155
32156Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
32157request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
32158described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
32159lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
32160cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
32161caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
32162
32163Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
32164the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
32165callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
32166callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
32167on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
32168
32169If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
32170second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
32171one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
32172&(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
32173router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
32174&%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
32175&%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
32176supplies a host list.
32177Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
32178
32179The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
32180remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
32181specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
32182specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
32183specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
32184the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
32185&$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
32186
32187For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
32188test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
32189following SMTP commands are sent:
32190.display
32191&`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
32192&`MAIL FROM:<>`&
32193&`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
32194&`QUIT`&
32195.endd
32196LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
32197set to &"lmtp"&.
32198
32199The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
32200settings.
32201
32202A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
32203for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
32204the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
32205that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
32206do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
32207&%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
32208
32209If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
32210succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
32211Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
32212hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
32213&%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
32214
32215.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
32216A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
32217output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
32218clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
32219disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
32220
32221
32222
32223
32224.section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
32225.cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
32226The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
32227optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
32228.code
32229verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
32230.endd
32231The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
32232separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
32233deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
32234
32235
32236.vlist
32237.vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
32238.cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
32239This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
32240For example:
32241.code
32242verify = sender/callout=5s
32243.endd
32244The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
32245remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
32246the &%connect%& parameter.
32247
32248
32249.vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
32250.cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
32251This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
32252for making the SMTP connection. For example:
32253.code
32254verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
32255.endd
32256If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
32257
32258.vitem &*defer_ok*&
32259.cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
32260When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
32261of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
32262updated in this circumstance.
32263
32264.vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
32265.cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
32266This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
32267&'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
32268accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
32269unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
32270
32271
32272.vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
32273.cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
32274When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
32275verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
32276sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
32277whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
32278MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
32279as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
32280(empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
32281address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
32282.code
32283require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
32284.endd
32285This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
32286
32287
32288.vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
32289.cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
32290This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
32291For example:
32292.code
32293verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
32294.endd
32295This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
32296commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
32297be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
32298very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
32299(for example, when network connections are timing out).
32300
32301
32302.vitem &*no_cache*&
32303.cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
32304.cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
32305When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
32306
32307.vitem &*postmaster*&
32308.cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
32309When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
32310check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
32311rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
32312the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
32313used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
32314made, until the cache record expires.
32315
32316.vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
32317The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
32318You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
32319For example:
32320.code
32321require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
32322.endd
32323If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
32324one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
32325.code
32326require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
32327.endd
32328&*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
32329account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
32330a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
32331postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
32332
32333
32334.vitem &*random*&
32335.cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
32336When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
32337check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
32338really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
32339&%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
32340.code
32341$primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
32342.endd
32343The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
32344parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
32345specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
32346a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
32347succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
32348
32349.vitem &*use_postmaster*&
32350.cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
32351This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32352.code
32353deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
32354.endd
32355.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
32356It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
32357performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
32358that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
32359domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
32360
32361.vitem &*use_sender*&
32362This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32363.code
32364require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
32365.endd
32366It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
32367command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
32368need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
32369sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
32370usefulness of callout caching.
32371
32372.vitem &*hold*&
32373This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32374.code
32375require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
32376.endd
32377It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
32378and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
32379Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
32380when that is used for the connections.
32381The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
32382(which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
32383if the use_sender option is used,
32384if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
32385and if no other callouts intervene.
32386.endlist
32387
32388If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
32389command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
32390&%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
32391usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
32392that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
32393Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
32394these circumstances.
32395
32396However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
32397host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
32398callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
32399sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
32400callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
32401own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
32402is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
32403
32404Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
32405caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
32406by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
32407actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
32408
32409
32410
32411
32412.section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
32413.cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
32414.cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
32415.cindex "caching" "callout"
32416Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
32417used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
32418option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
32419different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
32420a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
32421entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
32422
32423When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
32424the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
32425is not available.
32426
32427The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
32428independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
32429(default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
32430
32431If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
32432commands up to and including
32433.code
32434MAIL FROM:<>
32435.endd
32436(but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
32437any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
32438domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
32439making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
32440separate expiry times for domain cache records:
32441&%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
32442&%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
32443
32444Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
32445cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
32446Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
32447ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
32448will eventually be noticed.
32449
32450The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
32451being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
32452behaviour will be the same.
32453
32454
32455
32456.section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
32457.cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
32458See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
32459verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
32460failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
32461relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
32462you might see:
32463.code
32464MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
32465250 OK
32466RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
32467550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
32468550-Called: 192.168.34.43
32469550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
32470550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
32471550 Sender verification failed
32472.endd
32473If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
32474only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
32475out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
32476&`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
32477example:
32478.code
32479verify = sender/no_details
32480.endd
32481
32482.section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
32483.cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
32484.cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
32485A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
32486during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
32487or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
32488it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
32489
32490.ilist
32491When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
32492continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
32493verification also fails.
32494.next
32495When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
32496verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
32497.endlist
32498
32499This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
32500way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
32501example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
32502.code
32503A.Wol: aw123
32504aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
32505.endd
32506work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
32507redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
32508mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
32509verification to succeed.
32510
32511It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
32512redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
32513generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
32514option. For example:
32515.code
32516require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
32517.endd
32518In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
32519the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
32520
32521When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
32522redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
32523also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
32524address and a report is output for each of them.
32525
32526
32527
32528.section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
32529.cindex "CSA" "verifying"
32530Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
32531which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
32532special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
32533domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
32534Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
32535.code
32536verify = csa
32537.endd
32538This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
32539valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
32540succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
32541&$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
32542&"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
32543be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
32544
32545The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
32546detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
32547looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
32548address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
32549
32550.ilist
32551The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
32552.next
32553The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
32554.next
32555The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
32556(for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
32557.next
32558The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
32559that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
32560.endlist
32561
32562The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
32563use for the DNS query. The default is:
32564.code
32565verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
32566.endd
32567This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
32568is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
32569address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
32570the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
32571meaningful to say:
32572.code
32573verify = csa/$sender_host_address
32574.endd
32575In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
32576This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
32577&%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
32578
32579If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
32580is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
32581making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
32582using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
32583default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
32584default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
32585(&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
32586of legitimate HELO domains.
32587
32588The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
32589direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
32590search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
32591addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
32592lookup such as:
32593.code
32594${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
32595.endd
32596has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
32597The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
32598authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
32599
32600
32601
32602
32603.section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
32604.cindex "BATV, verifying"
32605Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
32606of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
32607Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
32608recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
32609bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
32610spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
32611
32612There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
32613&"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
32614the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
32615address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
32616item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
32617The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
32618&<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
32619The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
32620
32621As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
32622database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
32623like this:
32624.code
32625PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
32626 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
32627 }{$value}}
32628.endd
32629Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
32630list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
32631use this:
32632.code
32633# Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
32634deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
32635 senders = :
32636 recipients = +batv_senders
32637
32638# Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
32639deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
32640 senders = :
32641 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
32642 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
32643 !condition = $prvscheck_result
32644.endd
32645The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
32646to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
32647send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
32648recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
32649the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
32650
32651A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
32652&%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
32653prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
32654the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
32655the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
32656timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
32657of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
32658
32659There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
32660you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
32661deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
32662router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
32663.code
32664batv_redirect:
32665 driver = redirect
32666 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
32667.endd
32668This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
32669of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
32670address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
32671local addresses.
32672
32673To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
32674can be used:
32675.code
32676external_smtp_batv:
32677 driver = smtp
32678 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
32679 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
32680 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
32681 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
32682 {$value}fail}}}
32683.endd
32684If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
32685
32686
32687
32688.section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
32689.cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
32690.cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
32691.cindex "policy control" "relay control"
32692An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
32693delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
32694within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
32695passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
32696.cindex "&""percent hack""&"
32697but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
32698
32699Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
32700A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
32701relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
32702a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
32703with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
32704same host is fulfilling both functions,
32705. ///
32706. as illustrated in the diagram below,
32707. ///
32708but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
32709not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
32710system to arbitrary domains.
32711
32712
32713You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
32714runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
32715Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
32716example, suppose you want to do the following:
32717
32718.ilist
32719Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
32720locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
32721&'my.dom2.example'&.
32722.next
32723Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
32724These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
32725.next
32726Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
32727Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
32728.endlist
32729
32730
32731In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
32732.code
32733domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
32734domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
32735hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
32736.endd
32737Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
32738command:
32739.code
32740acl_check_rcpt:
32741 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
32742 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
32743.endd
32744The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
32745the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
32746statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
32747hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
32748than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
32749default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
32750in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
32751
32752
32753
32754.section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
32755.cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
32756You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
32757that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
32758the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
32759.ecindex IIDacl
32760
32761
32762
32763. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32764. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32765
32766.chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
32767.scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
32768The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
32769as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
32770was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
32771maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
32772specification.
32773
32774It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
32775&[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
32776scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
32777messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
32778chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
32779
32780If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
32781Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
32782&_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
32783
32784.ilist
32785Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
32786for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
32787.next
32788Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
32789&%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
32790run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
32791.next
32792An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
32793of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
32794.next
32795Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
32796conditions.
32797.next
32798Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
32799.endlist
32800
32801Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
32802added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
32803changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
32804EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
32805this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
32806&_doc/experimental.txt_&.
32807
32808All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
32809temporarily created in a file called:
32810.display
32811<&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
32812.endd
32813The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
32814expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
32815first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
32816scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
32817removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
32818.code
32819control = no_mbox_unspool
32820.endd
32821has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
32822same directory by default.
32823
32824
32825
32826.section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
32827.cindex "virus scanning"
32828.cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
32829.cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
32830The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
32831It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
32832specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
32833in memory and thus are much faster.
32834
32835Since message data needs to have arrived,
32836the condition may be only called in ACL defined by
32837&%acl_smtp_data%&,
32838&%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
32839&%acl_smtp_mime%& or
32840&%acl_smtp_dkim%&
32841
32842A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
32843if it expires then a defer action is taken.
32844
32845.oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
32846You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
32847to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
32848are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
32849.display
32850&`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
32851.endd
32852If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
32853.code
32854av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
32855.endd
32856If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
32857before use.
32858The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
32859The following scanner types are supported in this release,
32860though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
32861
32862.vlist
32863.vitem &%avast%&
32864.cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
32865This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
32866Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
32867You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
32868at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
32869This scanner type takes one option,
32870which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
32871or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
32872The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
32873single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
32874A list of options may follow. These options are interpreted on the
32875Exim's side of the malware scanner, or are given on separate lines to
32876the daemon as options before the main scan command.
32877
32878.cindex &`pass_unscanned`& "avast"
32879If &`pass_unscanned`&
32880is set, any files the Avast scanner can't scan (e.g.
32881decompression bombs, or invalid archives) are considered clean. Use with
32882care.
32883
32884For example:
32885.code
32886av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
32887av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:pass_unscanned:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
32888av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
32889.endd
32890If you omit the argument, the default path
32891&_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
32892is used.
32893If you use a remote host,
32894you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
32895as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
32896For information about available commands and their options you may use
32897.code
32898$ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
32899 FLAGS
32900 SENSITIVITY
32901 PACK
32902.endd
32903
32904If the scanner returns a temporary failure (e.g. license issues, or
32905permission problems), the message is deferred and a paniclog entry is
32906written. The usual &`defer_ok`& option is available.
32907
32908.vitem &%aveserver%&
32909.cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
32910This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
32911at &url(https://www.kaspersky.com/). This scanner type takes one option,
32912which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
32913example:
32914.code
32915av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
32916.endd
32917
32918
32919.vitem &%clamd%&
32920.cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
32921This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
32922&url(https://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
32923unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
32924in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
32925
32926The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
32927a UNIX socket specification,
32928a TCP socket specification,
32929or a (global) option.
32930
32931A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
32932For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
32933for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
32934and the second a port number,
32935Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
32936These per-server options are supported:
32937.code
32938retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
32939.endd
32940
32941The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
32942a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
32943
32944If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
32945
32946Examples:
32947.code
32948av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
32949av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
32950av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
32951av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
32952av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
32953.endd
32954If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
32955&`local`&
32956option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
32957to be scanned, which should normally result in less I/O happening and be
32958more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
32959Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
32960
32961The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
32962randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
32963that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
32964socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
32965unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
32966When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
32967not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
32968selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
32969email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
32970.code
329712013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
32972 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
32973 (Connection refused)
32974.endd
32975
32976If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
32977contributing the code for this scanner.
32978
32979.vitem &%cmdline%&
32980.cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
32981This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
32982used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
32983type takes 3 mandatory options:
32984
32985.olist
32986The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
32987and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
32988
32989.next
32990A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
32991virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
32992absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
32993the &"trigger"& expression.
32994
32995.next
32996Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
32997match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
32998&"name"& expression.
32999.endlist olist
33000
33001For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
33002.code
33003Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
33004.endd
33005For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
33006name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
33007for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
33008configuration setting:
33009.code
33010av_scanner = cmdline:\
33011 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
33012 found in file:'(.+)'
33013.endd
33014.vitem &%drweb%&
33015.cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
33016The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(https://www.sald.ru/)) interface
33017takes one option,
33018either a full path to a UNIX socket,
33019or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
33020The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
33021single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
33022For example:
33023.code
33024av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
33025av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
33026.endd
33027If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
33028is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
33029
33030.vitem &%f-protd%&
33031.cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
33032The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
33033One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
33034(or port-range).
33035For example:
33036.code
33037av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
33038.endd
33039If you omit the argument, the default values shown above are used.
33040
33041.vitem &%f-prot6d%&
33042.cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
33043The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
33044One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
33045For example:
33046.code
33047av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
33048.endd
33049If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
33050
33051.vitem &%fsecure%&
33052.cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
33053The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(https://www.f-secure.com/)) takes one
33054argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
33055.code
33056av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
33057.endd
33058If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
33059Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
33060
33061.vitem &%kavdaemon%&
33062.cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
33063This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
33064Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
33065scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
33066For example:
33067.code
33068av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
33069.endd
33070The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
33071
33072.vitem &%mksd%&
33073.cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
33074This was a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users,
33075though some documentation was available in English.
33076The history can be shown at &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mks_vir)
33077and this appears to be a candidate for removal from Exim, unless
33078we are informed of other virus scanners which use the same protocol
33079to integrate.
33080The only option for this scanner type is
33081the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
33082provided that mksd has
33083been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
33084.code
33085av_scanner = mksd:2
33086.endd
33087You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
33088
33089.vitem &%sock%&
33090.cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
33091This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
33092running on the local machine.
33093There are four options:
33094an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
33095a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
33096the path to the mail file to be scanned),
33097an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
33098and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
33099For example:
33100.code
33101av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
33102.endd
33103Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
33104there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
33105The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
33106Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
33107specify an empty element to get this.
33108
33109.vitem &%sophie%&
33110.cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
33111Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
33112You can get Sophie at &url(http://sophie.sourceforge.net/). The only option
33113for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
33114client communication. For example:
33115.code
33116av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
33117.endd
33118The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
33119the option.
33120.endlist
33121
33122When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
33123the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
33124ACL.
33125
33126The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
33127makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
33128The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
33129for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
33130However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
33131which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
33132message.
33133
33134The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
33135use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
33136The first element can then be one of
33137
33138.ilist
33139&"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
33140The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
33141recommended usage.
33142.next
33143&"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
33144the condition fails immediately.
33145.next
33146A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
33147condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
33148expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
33149Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
33150unless the separator is changed (in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
33151.endlist
33152
33153You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
33154messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
33155Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
33156
33157You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
33158specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
33159For example:
33160.code
33161malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
33162.endd
33163A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
33164
33165.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
33166When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
33167is set to record the actual address used.
33168
33169.vindex "&$malware_name$&"
33170When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
33171&$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
33172&%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
33173logging data.
33174
33175Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
33176imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
33177
33178Here is a very simple scanning example:
33179.code
33180deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33181 malware = *
33182.endd
33183The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
33184.code
33185deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33186 malware = */defer_ok
33187.endd
33188The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
33189aveserver. It assumes you have set:
33190.code
33191av_scanner = $acl_m0
33192.endd
33193in the main Exim configuration.
33194.code
33195deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33196 set acl_m0 = sophie
33197 malware = *
33198
33199deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33200 set acl_m0 = aveserver
33201 malware = *
33202.endd
33203
33204
33205.section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
33206.cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
33207.cindex "spam scanning"
33208.cindex "SpamAssassin"
33209.cindex "Rspamd"
33210The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
33211score and a report for the message.
33212Support is also provided for Rspamd.
33213
33214For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
33215Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
33216&url(https://spamassassin.apache.org/) and &url(https://www.rspamd.com/)
33217
33218SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
33219.code
33220perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
33221.endd
33222SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
33223documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
33224nicely, however.
33225
33226.oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
33227By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
33228intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
33229&%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
33230you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
33231configuration as follows (example):
33232.code
33233spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 783
33234.endd
33235The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
33236If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
33237iptables firewall, consider setting
33238&%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
33239timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
33240server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
33241connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
33242soon.
33243
33244
33245To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
33246on TCP port 11333)
33247you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
33248.code
33249spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
33250.endd
33251
33252As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
33253sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
33254filename instead of an address/port pair:
33255.code
33256spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
33257.endd
33258You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
33259reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
33260&%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
33261option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&):
33262.code
33263spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
33264 192.168.2.11 783 : \
33265 192.168.2.12 783
33266.endd
33267Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
33268When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
33269servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
33270condition defers.
33271
33272Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
33273Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
33274and changeable in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
33275take care to not double the separator.
33276
33277For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
33278subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
33279and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
33280In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
33281
33282Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
33283are options.
33284The supported options are:
33285.code
33286pri=<priority> Selection priority
33287weight=<value> Selection bias
33288time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
33289retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
33290tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
33291variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
33292.endd
33293
33294The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
33295higher values being tried first.
33296The default priority is 1.
33297
33298The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
33299Within a priority set
33300servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
33301The default value for selection bias is 1.
33302
33303Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
33304in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
33305Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
33306characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
33307
33308Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
33309are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
33310
33311The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
33312The default value is two minutes.
33313
33314The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
33315a failed connect is made.
33316The default is to not retry.
33317
33318The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
33319a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
33320used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
33321expansion.
33322
33323.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
33324When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
33325is set to record the actual address used.
33326
33327.section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
33328Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
33329.code
33330deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33331 spam = joe
33332.endd
33333The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
33334relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
33335to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
33336default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
33337Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
33338right-hand side.
33339
33340The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
33341principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
33342have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
33343&%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
33344read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
33345are not set.
33346Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
33347(e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
33348after the first),
33349or the use of PRDR,
33350.cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
33351are needed to use this feature.
33352
33353The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
33354you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
33355&"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
33356
33357
33358Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
33359large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
33360are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
33361example:
33362.code
33363deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33364 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
33365 spam = nobody
33366.endd
33367
33368The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
33369SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
33370&%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
33371it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
33372
33373.cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
33374When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
33375variables.
33376Except for &$spam_report$&,
33377these variables are saved with the received message so are
33378available for use at delivery time.
33379
33380.vlist
33381.vitem &$spam_score$&
33382The spam score of the message, for example, &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
33383for inclusion in log or reject messages.
33384
33385.vitem &$spam_score_int$&
33386The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
33387example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
33388because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
33389The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
33390
33391.vitem &$spam_bar$&
33392A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
33393integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
33394&$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
33395headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
33396spam bar is 50 characters.
33397
33398.vitem &$spam_report$&
33399A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
33400message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
33401This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
33402Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
33403when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
33404unencoded in headers.
33405
33406.vitem &$spam_action$&
33407For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
33408spam score versus threshold.
33409For Rspamd, the recommended action.
33410
33411.endlist
33412
33413The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
33414spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
33415does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
33416
33417The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
33418the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
33419failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
33420statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
33421spam condition, like this:
33422.code
33423deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33424 spam = joe/defer_ok
33425.endd
33426This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
33427
33428Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
33429condition:
33430.code
33431# put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
33432warn spam = nobody:true
33433 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
33434 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
33435
33436# add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
33437# is over threshold
33438warn spam = nobody
33439 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
33440
33441# reject spam at high scores (> 12)
33442deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
33443 spam = nobody:true
33444 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
33445.endd
33446
33447
33448
33449.section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
33450.cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
33451.cindex "MIME content scanning"
33452.oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
33453.oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
33454The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
33455each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
33456of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
33457specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
33458options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
33459cases.
33460
33461These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
33462ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
33463the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
33464message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
33465ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
33466result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
33467&%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
33468
33469You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
33470only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
33471condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
33472&%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
33473&<<SECTscanregex>>&).
33474
33475At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
33476information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
33477of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
33478parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
33479part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
33480syntax is:
33481.display
33482&`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
33483.endd
33484The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
33485the value can be:
33486
33487.olist
33488&"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
33489.next
33490The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
33491&"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
33492a sequential filename consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
33493full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
33494.next
33495A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
33496directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
33497is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
33498the full path and filename.
33499.next
33500If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
33501filename, and the default path is then used.
33502.endlist
33503The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
33504errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
33505a file with its original, proposed filename using
33506.code
33507decode = $mime_filename
33508.endd
33509However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
33510anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
33511automatically unlinked.
33512
33513For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
33514content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
33515as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
33516variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
33517before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
33518
33519The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
33520used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
33521respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
33522
33523.cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
33524The following list describes all expansion variables that are
33525available in the MIME ACL:
33526
33527.vlist
33528.vitem &$mime_boundary$&
33529If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
33530have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
33531has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
33532contains the empty string.
33533
33534.vitem &$mime_charset$&
33535This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
33536&'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
33537.code
33538us-ascii
33539gb2312 (Chinese)
33540iso-8859-1
33541.endd
33542Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
33543case-insensitively.
33544
33545.vitem &$mime_content_description$&
33546This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
33547header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
33548implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
33549only used for display purposes.
33550
33551.vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
33552This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
33553header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
33554
33555.vitem &$mime_content_id$&
33556This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
33557This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
33558
33559.vitem &$mime_content_size$&
33560This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
33561successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
33562size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
33563has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
33564
33565.vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
33566This variable contains the normalized content of the
33567&'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
33568type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
33569
33570.vitem &$mime_content_type$&
33571If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
33572value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
33573are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
33574.code
33575text/plain
33576text/html
33577application/octet-stream
33578image/jpeg
33579audio/midi
33580.endd
33581If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
33582empty string.
33583
33584.vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
33585This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
33586successfully run. It contains the full path and filename of the file
33587containing the decoded data.
33588.endlist
33589
33590.cindex "RFC 2047"
33591.vlist
33592.vitem &$mime_filename$&
33593This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
33594proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
33595&'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
33596RFC2047
33597or RFC2231
33598decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
33599 If no filename was
33600found, this variable contains the empty string.
33601
33602.vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
33603This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
33604attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
33605content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
33606
33607The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
33608cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
33609follows:
33610
33611.olist
33612The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
33613
33614.next
33615If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
33616so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
33617
33618.next
33619If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
33620and the rest are attachments.
33621
33622.next
33623All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
33624.endlist olist
33625
33626As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
33627alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
33628coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
33629.code
33630deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
33631!condition = $mime_is_rfc822
33632condition = $mime_is_coverletter
33633condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
33634.endd
33635.vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
33636This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
33637&"multipart"&, for example, &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
33638Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
33639want to carry out specific actions on them.
33640
33641.vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
33642This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
33643checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
33644decoding is fully recursive.
33645
33646.vitem &$mime_part_count$&
33647This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
33648starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
33649counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
33650&$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
33651complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
33652parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
33653.endlist
33654
33655
33656
33657.section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
33658.cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
33659.cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
33660You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
33661the message, or on individual MIME parts.
33662
33663The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
33664matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
33665MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
33666linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
33667have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
33668
33669The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
33670to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
33671part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
33672is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
33673and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
3367432K characters are checked.
33675
33676The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
33677literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
33678expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
33679with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
33680Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
33681.code
33682deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
33683 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
33684.endd
33685The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
33686&$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
33687matching regular expression.
33688The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
33689are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
33690
33691&*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
33692CPU-intensive.
33693
33694.ecindex IIDcosca
33695
33696
33697
33698
33699. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33700. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33701
33702.chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
33703 "Local scan function"
33704.scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
33705.cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
33706.cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
33707In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
33708want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
33709
33710The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
33711passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
33712a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
33713condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
33714non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
33715
33716To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
33717possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
33718in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
33719can of course use a little C stub to call it.
33720
33721The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
33722when Exim is just about to accept the message.
33723It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
33724well as messages arriving via SMTP.
33725
33726Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
33727option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
33728Zero means &"no timeout"&.
33729Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
33730before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
33731are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
33732incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
33733For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
33734code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
33735
33736
33737
33738.section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
33739.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
33740To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
33741function is before building Exim, by setting
33742both HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN and
33743LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
33744&_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
33745directory, so you might set
33746.code
33747HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN=yes
33748LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
33749.endd
33750for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&;
33751.new
33752the source file(s) for it should first #define LOCAL_SCAN
33753and then #include "local_scan.h".
33754.wen
33755It is called by
33756Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
33757be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
33758function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
33759commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
33760_src/local_scan.c_.
33761
33762If you want to make use of Exim's runtime configuration file to set options
33763for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
33764.code
33765LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
33766.endd
33767in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
33768
33769
33770
33771
33772.section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
33773.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
33774.cindex &%dlfunc%& "API description"
33775You must include this line near the start of your code:
33776.code
33777#include "local_scan.h"
33778.endd
33779This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
33780prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
33781almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
33782for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
33783It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
33784strings and pointers to character strings:
33785.code
33786#define CS (char *)
33787#define CCS (const char *)
33788#define CSS (char **)
33789#define US (unsigned char *)
33790#define CUS (const unsigned char *)
33791#define USS (unsigned char **)
33792.endd
33793The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
33794.code
33795extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
33796.endd
33797The arguments are as follows:
33798
33799.ilist
33800&%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
33801(the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
33802recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
33803
33804The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
33805character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
33806id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
33807macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
33808case this changes in some future version.
33809.next
33810&%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
33811string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
33812.endlist
33813
33814The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
33815
33816.vlist
33817.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
33818.vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
33819The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
33820the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
33821newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
33822maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
33823
33824.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
33825This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
33826queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
33827
33828.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
33829This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
33830queued without immediate delivery.
33831
33832.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
33833The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
33834passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
33835they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
33836&`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
33837used.
33838
33839.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
33840The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
33841message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
33842problem"& is used.
33843
33844.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
33845This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
33846message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
33847&%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
33848&%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
33849&%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
33850same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
33851
33852.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
33853This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
33854LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
33855.endlist
33856
33857If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
33858reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
33859&%-oe%& command line options.
33860
33861
33862
33863.section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
33864.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
33865It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
33866that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
33867want to do this, you must have the line
33868.code
33869LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
33870.endd
33871in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
33872&_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
33873file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
33874to define them.
33875
33876The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
33877&`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
33878and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
33879alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
33880variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
33881entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
33882.code
33883static int my_integer_option = 42;
33884static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
33885
33886optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
33887 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
33888 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
33889};
33890
33891int local_scan_options_count =
33892 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
33893.endd
33894The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
33895configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
33896.code
33897begin local_scan
33898my_integer = 99
33899my_string = some string of text...
33900.endd
33901The available types of option data are as follows:
33902
33903.vlist
33904.vitem &*opt_bool*&
33905This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
33906variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
33907that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
33908whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
33909TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
33910values.)
33911
33912.vitem &*opt_fixed*&
33913This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
33914The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
33915multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
33916
33917.vitem &*opt_int*&
33918This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
33919&`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
33920Exim.
33921
33922.vitem &*opt_mkint*&
33923This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
33924&%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
33925printed with the suffix K or M.
33926
33927.vitem &*opt_octint*&
33928This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
33929octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
33930always output in octal.
33931
33932.vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
33933This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
33934variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
33935
33936.vitem &*opt_time*&
33937This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
33938type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
33939.endlist
33940
33941If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
33942out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
33943
33944
33945
33946.section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
33947.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
33948The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
33949are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
33950Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
33951including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
33952C variables are as follows:
33953
33954.vlist
33955.vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
33956This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
33957It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
33958
33959.vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
33960This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
33961It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
33962
33963.vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
33964This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
33965is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
33966&[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
33967
33968.ilist
33969The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
33970testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
33971other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
33972
33973.next
33974The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
33975by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
33976of debugging bits.
33977.endlist ilist
33978
33979Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
33980selected, you should use code like this:
33981.code
33982if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
33983 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
33984.endd
33985.vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
33986After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
33987variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
33988
33989.vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
33990A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
33991discussed below.
33992
33993.vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
33994A pointer to the last of the header lines.
33995
33996.vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
33997The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
33998
33999.vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
34000This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
34001&%-bh%& command line option.
34002
34003.vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
34004The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
34005is NULL for locally submitted messages.
34006
34007.vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
34008The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
34009command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
34010specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
34011
34012.vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
34013This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
34014&$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
34015
34016.vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
34017The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
34018
34019.vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
34020The number of accepted recipients.
34021
34022.vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
34023.cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
34024.cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
34025The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
34026&%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
34027can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
34028below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
34029adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
34030&%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
34031value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
34032blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
34033and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
34034
34035.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
34036The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
34037
34038.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
34039The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
34040locally-submitted messages.
34041
34042.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
34043The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
34044was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
34045
34046.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
34047The name of the sending host, if known.
34048
34049.vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
34050The port on the sending host.
34051
34052.vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
34053This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
34054
34055.vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
34056This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
34057
34058.vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
34059The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
34060requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
34061.endlist
34062
34063
34064.section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
34065The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
34066You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
34067(see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
34068their type to *.
34069
34070
34071.vlist
34072.vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
34073A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
34074
34075.vitem &*int&~type*&
34076A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
34077characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
34078Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
34079with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
34080rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
34081lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
34082
34083.vitem &*int&~slen*&
34084The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
34085internal newlines.
34086
34087.vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
34088A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
34089a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
34090.endlist
34091
34092
34093
34094.section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
34095The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
34096
34097.vlist
34098.vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
34099This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
34100
34101.vitem &*int&~pno*&
34102This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
34103the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
34104and must always contain -1 at this stage.
34105
34106.vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
34107If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
34108recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
34109envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
34110router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
34111an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
34112&%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
34113is NULL for all recipients.
34114.endlist
34115
34116
34117
34118.section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
34119.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
34120The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
34121These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
34122release:
34123
34124.vlist
34125.vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
34126 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
34127
34128This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
34129&%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
34130be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
34131for the process in &%newumask%&.
34132
34133Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
34134and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
34135standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
34136descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
34137argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
34138
34139The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
34140
34141.vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
34142This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
34143seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
34144return value is as follows:
34145
34146.ilist
34147>= 0
34148
34149The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
34150ending status.
34151
34152.next
34153< 0 and > &--256
34154
34155The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
34156signal number.
34157
34158.next
34159&--256
34160
34161The process timed out.
34162.next
34163&--257
34164
34165The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
34166.endlist
34167
34168.vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
34169This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
34170Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
34171want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
34172forks a subprocess that is running
34173.code
34174exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
34175.endd
34176and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
34177that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
34178of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
34179recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
34180
34181When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
34182finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
34183fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
34184addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
34185
34186
34187.vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
34188 *sender_authentication)*&
34189This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
34190that it runs is:
34191.display
34192&`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
34193.endd
34194The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
34195
34196
34197.vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
34198This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
34199output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
34200calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
34201conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
34202.code
34203if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
34204 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
34205.endd
34206
34207.vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
34208This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
34209expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
34210The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
34211expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
34212the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
34213block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
34214&<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
34215
34216.vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
34217This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
34218existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
34219character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
34220substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
34221if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
34222
34223.vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
34224 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
34225This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
34226chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
34227
34228If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
34229&%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
34230NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
34231matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
34232&%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
34233found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
34234marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
34235option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
34236top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
34237headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
34238.code
34239header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
34240 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
34241.endd
34242Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
34243there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
34244
34245
34246.vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
34247This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
34248occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
34249particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
34250match the specification, the function does nothing.
34251
34252
34253.vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
34254 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
34255This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
34256a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
34257colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
34258&"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
34259.code
34260if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
34261.endd
34262.vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
34263.cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
34264This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
34265The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
34266back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
34267zero-terminated.
34268
34269.vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
34270This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
34271zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
34272to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
34273string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
34274yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
34275easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
34276added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
34277
34278.vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
34279This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
34280matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
34281.display
34282&`OK `& match succeeded
34283&`FAIL `& match failed
34284&`DEFER `& match deferred
34285.endd
34286DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
34287inability to contact a database.
34288
34289.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
34290 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
34291This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
34292controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
34293&'lss_match_domain()'&.
34294
34295.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
34296 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
34297This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
34298controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
34299matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
34300
34301.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
34302 uschar&~*list)*&"
34303This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
34304expected to be
34305.code
34306lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
34307.endd
34308.vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
34309An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
34310is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
34311looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
34312values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
34313returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
34314failed.
34315
34316.vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
34317 *format,&~...)*&"
34318This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
34319is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
34320&`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
34321them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
34322arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
34323contain any newlines, not even at the end.
34324
34325
34326.vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
34327This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
34328is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
34329with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
34330
34331This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
34332described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
34333the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
34334value afterwards. For example:
34335.code
34336 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
34337 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
34338 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
34339.endd
34340
34341.vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
34342This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
34343recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
34344matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
34345address.
34346.endlist
34347
34348
34349.cindex "RFC 2047"
34350.vlist
34351.vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
34352 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
34353This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
34354these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
34355from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
34356a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
34357made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
34358binary string is returned with an error message.
34359
34360The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
34361maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
34362encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
34363
34364.cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
34365.cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
34366If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
34367contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
34368not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
34369
34370The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
34371&%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
34372which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
34373
34374If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
34375argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
34376set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
34377returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
34378with translation.
34379
34380
34381.vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
34382This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
34383below.
34384
34385.vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,BOOL,&~...)*&
34386The arguments of this function are almost like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
34387output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
34388stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
34389SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
34390is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
34391opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
34392test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
34393is involved.
34394
34395If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
34396output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
34397
34398The second argument is used to request that the data be buffered
34399(when TRUE) or flushed (along with any previously buffered, when FALSE).
34400This is advisory only, but likely to save on system-calls and packets
34401sent when a sequence of calls to the function are made.
34402
34403The argument was added in Exim version 4.90 - changing the API/ABI.
34404Nobody noticed until 4.93 was imminent, at which point the
34405ABI version number was incremented.
34406
34407Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
34408must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
34409LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
34410LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
34411initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
34412to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
34413that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
34414.code
34415smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
34416return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
34417.endd
34418Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
34419the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
34420&'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
34421multiple output lines.
34422
34423The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
34424does not
34425guarantee a flush of
34426pending output, and therefore does not test
34427the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
34428detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
34429you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
34430dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
34431arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
34432is an error.
34433
34434.new
34435.vitem &*void&~*store_get(int,BOOL)*&
34436This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
34437chunk of memory whose size is given by the first argument.
34438The second argument should be given as TRUE if the memory will be used for
34439data possibly coming from an attacker (eg. the message content),
34440FALSE if it is locally-sourced.
34441Exim bombs out if it ever
34442runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
34443.wen
34444
34445.vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int,BOOL)*&
34446This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
34447permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
34448
34449.vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
34450See below.
34451
34452.vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
34453See below.
34454
34455.vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
34456These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
34457The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
34458number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
34459and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
34460pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
34461more discussion.
34462.endlist
34463
34464
34465
34466.section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
34467.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
34468No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
34469The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
34470recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
34471to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
34472message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
34473terminates.
34474
34475Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
34476data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
34477connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
34478one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
34479
34480If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
34481in the same SMTP connection, you should set
34482.code
34483store_pool = POOL_PERM
34484.endd
34485before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
34486restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
34487the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
34488set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
34489
34490The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
34491&'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
34492There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
34493block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
34494&%store_pool%&.
34495.ecindex IIDlosca
34496
34497
34498
34499
34500. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34501. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34502
34503.chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
34504.scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
34505.scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
34506.scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
34507The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
34508that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
34509also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
34510they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
34511
34512The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
34513is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
34514It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
34515commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
34516The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
34517
34518The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
34519is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
34520the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
34521If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
34522of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
34523prevent it happening on retries.
34524
34525.vindex "&$domain$&"
34526.vindex "&$local_part$&"
34527&*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
34528specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
34529&$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
34530you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
34531independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
34532described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
34533
34534
34535.section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
34536.cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
34537.cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
34538The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
34539setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
34540other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
34541&%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
34542.code
34543system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
34544system_filter_user = exim
34545.endd
34546If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
34547&%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
34548specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
34549&%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
34550&%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
34551by the &%reply%& command.
34552
34553
34554.section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
34555You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
34556filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
34557are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
34558
34559If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
34560you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
34561
34562
34563
34564.section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
34565The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
34566files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
34567mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
34568available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
34569If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
34570they cause errors.
34571
34572.cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
34573There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
34574files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
34575is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
34576&%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
34577subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
34578manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
34579
34580&*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
34581specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
34582succeed, it will not be tried again.
34583If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
34584arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
34585
34586When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
34587&$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
34588users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
34589to which users' filter files can refer.
34590
34591
34592
34593.section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
34594.vindex "&$recipients$&"
34595The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
34596of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
34597filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
34598
34599
34600
34601.section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
34602.cindex "freezing messages"
34603.cindex "message" "freezing"
34604.cindex "message" "forced failure"
34605.cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
34606.cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
34607.cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
34608There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
34609always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
34610filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
34611for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
34612word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
34613.code
34614fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
34615.endd
34616The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
34617
34618The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
34619message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
34620and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
34621delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
34622that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
34623run.
34624
34625The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
34626not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
34627filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
34628is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
34629
34630.cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
34631.cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
34632The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
34633well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
34634up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
34635log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
34636two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
34637strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
34638message. For example:
34639.code
34640fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
34641 because it contains attachments that we are \
34642 not prepared to receive."
34643.endd
34644
34645.cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
34646Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
34647the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
34648the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
34649command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
34650Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
34651use, for example
34652.code
34653if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
34654then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
34655.endd
34656though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
34657alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
34658generated by the filter.
34659
34660The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
34661&%defer%&,
34662&%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
34663set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
34664as
34665.code
34666mail ...
34667freeze
34668.endd
34669to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
34670failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
34671take place.
34672
34673
34674
34675.section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
34676.cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
34677.cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
34678.cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
34679Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
34680.code
34681headers add <string>
34682headers remove <string>
34683.endd
34684The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
34685added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
34686filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
34687space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
34688forced to fail, the command has no effect.
34689
34690You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
34691continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
34692including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
34693example:
34694.code
34695headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
34696 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
34697 X-header-2: ...."
34698.endd
34699Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
34700be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
34701space after input continuations is ignored.
34702
34703The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
34704This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
34705those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
34706&'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
34707header with the same name, they are all removed.
34708
34709The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
34710of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
34711from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
34712modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
34713Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
34714used for all recipients of the message.
34715
34716During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
34717header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
34718that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
34719routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
34720routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
34721until the message is actually being written (see section
34722&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
34723
34724If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
34725added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
34726present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
34727present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
34728message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
34729conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
34730modified more than once.
34731
34732Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
34733use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
34734For example:
34735.code
34736headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
34737headers remove "Subject"
34738headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
34739headers remove "Old-Subject"
34740.endd
34741
34742
34743
34744.section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
34745.cindex "envelope from"
34746.cindex "envelope sender"
34747In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
34748.code
34749errors_to <some address>
34750.endd
34751in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
34752delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
34753user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
34754might use
34755.code
34756unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
34757.endd
34758to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
34759address if its delivery failed.
34760
34761
34762
34763.section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
34764.vindex "&$domain$&"
34765.vindex "&$local_part$&"
34766In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
34767delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
34768operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
34769such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
34770filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
34771which implements such a filter:
34772.code
34773central_filter:
34774 check_local_user
34775 driver = redirect
34776 domains = +local_domains
34777 file = /central/filters/$local_part
34778 no_verify
34779 allow_filter
34780 allow_freeze
34781.endd
34782The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
34783&%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
34784the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
34785use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
34786
34787Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
34788specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
34789its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
34790address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
34791normal way.
34792.ecindex IIDsysfil1
34793.ecindex IIDsysfil2
34794.ecindex IIDsysfil3
34795
34796
34797
34798
34799
34800
34801. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34802. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34803
34804.chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
34805.scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
34806Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
34807all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
34808these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
34809this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
34810removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
34811before it is placed on Exim's queue.
34812
34813Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
34814&"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
34815that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
34816its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
34817set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
34818
34819&*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
34820or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
34821loopback interface specially in any way.
34822
34823If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
34824that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
34825
34826
34827
34828
34829.section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
34830.cindex "message" "submission"
34831.cindex "submission mode"
34832Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
34833&%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
34834received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
34835state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
34836.code
34837control = submission
34838.endd
34839in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
34840&<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
34841a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
34842known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
34843example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
34844interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
34845.code
34846warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
34847 control = submission
34848.endd
34849.cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
34850There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
34851is used to separate options. For example:
34852.code
34853control = submission/sender_retain
34854.endd
34855Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
34856true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
34857of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
34858the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
34859authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
34860&'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
34861attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
34862
34863When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
34864domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
34865example:
34866.code
34867control = submission/domain=some.domain
34868.endd
34869The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
34870&<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
34871that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
34872&'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
34873.code
34874accept authenticated = *
34875 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
34876 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
34877 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
34878.endd
34879Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
34880option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
34881the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
34882.code
34883bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
34884.endd
34885then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
34886line would be:
34887.code
34888Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
34889.endd
34890.cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
34891By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
34892used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
34893specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
34894
34895&*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
34896ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
34897untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
34898specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
34899does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
34900spoof another's address.
34901
34902.section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
34903.cindex "line endings"
34904.cindex "carriage return"
34905.cindex "linefeed"
34906RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
34907linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
34908SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
34909conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
34910use CRLF or just CR.
34911
34912Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
34913using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
34914receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
34915Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
34916MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
34917has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
34918that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
34919other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
34920follows:
34921
34922.ilist
34923LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
34924.next
34925CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
34926is ignored.
34927.next
34928The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
34929nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
34930terminator.
34931.next
34932If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
34933the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
34934is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
34935people trying to play silly games.
34936.next
34937If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
34938bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
34939line.
34940.endlist
34941
34942
34943
34944
34945
34946.section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
34947.cindex "unqualified addresses"
34948.cindex "address" "qualification"
34949By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
34950host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
34951SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
34952messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
34953requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
34954
34955Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
34956sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
34957&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
34958cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
34959value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
34960
34961.oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
34962.oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
34963Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
34964that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
34965line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
34966are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
34967other words, such qualification is also controlled by
34968&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
34969
34970
34971
34972
34973.section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
34974.cindex "&""From""& line"
34975.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
34976.cindex "sender" "address"
34977.oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
34978.oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
34979.cindex "envelope from"
34980.cindex "envelope sender"
34981.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
34982Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
34983with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
34984&"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
34985.code
34986From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
34987From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
34988.endd
34989This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
34990Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
34991via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
34992such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
34993&%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
34994and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
34995regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
34996default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
34997that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
34998
34999.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
35000When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
35001a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
35002contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
35003then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
35004qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
35005the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
35006
35007If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
35008sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
35009that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
35010
35011Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
35012treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
35013as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
35014incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
35015
35016
35017
35018.section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
35019.cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
35020.cindex "header lines" "Resent-"
35021RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
35022&`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
35023recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
35024&'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
35025&'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
35026
35027.blockquote
35028&'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
35029processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
35030.endblockquote
35031
35032This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
35033address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
35034follows:
35035
35036.ilist
35037A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
35038is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
35039.next
35040If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
35041&%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
35042&'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
35043.next
35044For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
35045also removed.
35046.next
35047For a locally-submitted message,
35048if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
35049&'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
35050the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
35051included in log lines in this case.
35052.next
35053The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
35054&%Resent-%& header lines are present.
35055.endlist
35056
35057
35058
35059
35060.section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
35061Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
35062includes the header line:
35063.code
35064Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
35065.endd
35066
35067.section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
35068.cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
35069If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
35070message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
35071extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
35072existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
35073
35074
35075.section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
35076.cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
35077.cindex "header lines" "Date:"
35078If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
35079Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
35080&%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
35081
35082.section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
35083.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
35084.oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
35085&'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
35086set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
35087the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
35088in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
35089set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
35090messages.
35091
35092
35093.section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
35094.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
35095.cindex "header lines" "Envelope-to:"
35096.oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
35097&'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
35098Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
35099generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
35100messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
35101(the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
35102messages.
35103
35104
35105.section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
35106.cindex "&'From:'& header line"
35107.cindex "header lines" "From:"
35108.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
35109.cindex "message" "submission"
35110.cindex "submission mode"
35111If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
35112adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
35113
35114.ilist
35115The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
35116message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
35117.next
35118.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
35119The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
35120.olist
35121.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
35122If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
35123&$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
35124.next
35125If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
35126part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
35127.next
35128If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
35129&$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
35130.endlist
35131.endlist
35132
35133A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
35134
35135If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
35136line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
35137containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
35138are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
35139They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
35140&%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
35141&%qualify_domain%&.
35142
35143For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
35144&'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
35145user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
35146name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
35147
35148
35149.section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
35150.cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
35151.cindex "header lines" "Message-ID:"
35152.cindex "message" "submission"
35153.oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
35154If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
35155&'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
35156&%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
35157to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
35158creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
35159message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
35160followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
35161in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
35162&%message_id_header_domain%& options.
35163
35164
35165.section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
35166.cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
35167.cindex "header lines" "Received:"
35168A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
35169contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
35170Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
35171
35172The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
35173have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
35174line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
35175that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
35176
35177Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
35178changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
35179-H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
35180
35181
35182.section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
35183.cindex "&'References:'& header line"
35184.cindex "header lines" "References:"
35185Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
35186header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
35187section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
35188header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
35189responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
35190processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
35191than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
35192incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
3519311 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
35194
35195
35196
35197.section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
35198.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
35199.cindex "header lines" "Return-path:"
35200.oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
35201&'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
35202it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
35203transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
35204transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
35205default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
35206
35207
35208
35209.section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
35210.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
35211.cindex "message" "submission"
35212.cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
35213For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
35214existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
35215these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
35216&%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
35217control setting.
35218
35219When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
35220&%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
35221control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
35222&'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
35223that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
35224&%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
35225be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
35226appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
35227line is added to the message.
35228
35229If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
35230the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
35231&%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
35232options true at the same time.
35233
35234.cindex "submission mode"
35235By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
35236received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
35237a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
35238not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
35239
35240.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
35241First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
35242authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
35243created as follows:
35244
35245.ilist
35246.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
35247If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
35248&$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
35249.next
35250If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
35251is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
35252.next
35253If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
35254&$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
35255.endlist
35256
35257This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
35258are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
35259added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
35260by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
35261
35262.cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
35263&*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
35264the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
35265except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
35266
35267
35268
35269.section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
35270 "SECTheadersaddrem"
35271.cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
35272.cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
35273When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
35274specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
35275process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
35276modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
35277as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
35278
35279In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
35280specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
35281addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
35282changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
35283transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
35284they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
35285
35286&*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
35287the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
35288expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
35289
35290For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
35291option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
35292newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
35293.code
35294headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
35295 X-added-second: another added header line
35296.endd
35297Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
35298
35299Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
35300specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
35301Each header-line is separately expanded.
35302
35303The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
35304list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
35305often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
35306not part of the names. For example:
35307.code
35308headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
35309.endd
35310
35311Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
35312specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
35313Each item is separately expanded.
35314Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
35315form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
35316will act as list separators.
35317
35318When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
35319items are expanded at routing time,
35320and then associated with all addresses that are
35321accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
35322an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
35323forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
35324
35325.oindex "&%unseen%&"
35326However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
35327the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
35328&"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
35329
35330Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
35331settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
35332dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
35333requirements.
35334
35335The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
35336with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
35337these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
35338recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
35339consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
35340names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
35341instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
35342
35343After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
35344lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
35345the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
35346header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
35347
35348This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
35349the following consequences:
35350
35351.ilist
35352The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
35353remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
35354to it, at all times.
35355.next
35356Header lines that are added by a router's
35357&%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
35358expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
35359.next
35360Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
35361in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
35362.next
35363Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
35364a later router or by a transport.
35365.next
35366An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
35367removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
35368.code
35369headers_remove = subject
35370headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
35371.endd
35372.endlist
35373
35374&*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
35375for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
35376
35377
35378
35379
35380
35381.section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
35382.cindex "address" "constructed"
35383.cindex "constructed address"
35384When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
35385the form
35386.display
35387<&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
35388.endd
35389For example:
35390.code
35391Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
35392.endd
35393The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
35394otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
35395&"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
35396ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
35397upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
35398&%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
35399The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
35400there is no password file entry.
35401
35402.cindex "RFC 2047"
35403In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
35404parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
35405characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
35406including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
35407&%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
35408characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
35409&%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
35410is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
35411
35412
35413
35414.section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
35415.cindex "case of local parts"
35416.cindex "local part" "case of"
35417RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
35418be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
35419addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
35420because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
35421routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
35422original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
35423router option.
35424
35425.cindex "mixed-case login names"
35426If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
35427assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
35428your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
35429correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
35430.code
35431correct_case:
35432 driver = redirect
35433 domains = +local_domains
35434 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
35435 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
35436 @$domain
35437.endd
35438For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
35439(&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
35440up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
35441on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
35442local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
35443
35444
35445
35446.section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
35447.cindex "dot" "in local part"
35448.cindex "local part" "dots in"
35449RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
35450part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
35451middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
35452empty components for compatibility.
35453
35454
35455
35456.section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
35457.cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
35458Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
35459happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
35460in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
35461&'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
35462
35463Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
35464in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
35465routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
35466example, a header such as
35467.code
35468To: hare@teaparty
35469.endd
35470might get rewritten as
35471.code
35472To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
35473.endd
35474Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
35475does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
35476been routed.
35477
35478Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
35479addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
35480result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
35481deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
35482immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
35483routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
35484.ecindex IIDmesproc
35485
35486
35487
35488. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35489. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35490
35491.chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
35492.scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
35493.scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
35494Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
35495LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
35496closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
35497processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
35498
35499.ilist
35500SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
35501.next
35502SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
35503.next
35504Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
35505.endlist
35506
35507For mail delivery, the following are available:
35508
35509.ilist
35510SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
35511.next
35512LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
35513&"lmtp"&);
35514.next
35515LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
35516transport);
35517.next
35518Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
35519the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
35520.endlist
35521
35522&'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
35523stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
35524used to contain the envelope information.
35525
35526
35527
35528.section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
35529.cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
35530.cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
35531.cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
35532.cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
35533.cindex "EHLO"
35534.cindex "HELO"
35535.cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
35536Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
35537The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
35538processing is the same in both cases.
35539
35540If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
35541parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
35542command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
35543&%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
35544such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
35545.cindex "transport" "filter"
35546.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
35547transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
35548suppressed.
35549
35550If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
35551pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
35552required for the transaction.
35553
35554If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
35555was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
35556server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
35557Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
35558is called for verification.
35559
35560If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
35561the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
35562in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
35563
35564.cindex "carriage return"
35565.cindex "linefeed"
35566Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
35567LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
35568order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
35569line terminator.
35570
35571If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
35572characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
35573same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
35574even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
35575of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
35576they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
35577each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
35578in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
35579significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
35580
35581When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
35582message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
35583records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
35584particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
35585
35586.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
35587Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
35588a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
35589See the next section for more detail about error handling.
35590
35591.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
35592.cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
35593When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
35594looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
35595messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
35596creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
35597a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
35598so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
35599does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
35600turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
35601
35602The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
35603limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
35604
35605.cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
35606The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
35607identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
35608square bracket of the IP address.
35609
35610
35611
35612
35613.section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
35614.cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
35615.cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
35616.cindex "host" "error"
35617Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
35618message errors, and recipient errors.
35619
35620.vlist
35621.vitem "&*Host errors*&"
35622A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
35623particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
35624
35625.ilist
35626Connection refused or timed out,
35627.next
35628Any error response code on connection,
35629.next
35630Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
35631.next
35632Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
35633.next
35634I/O errors at any time,
35635.next
35636Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
35637the &"."& at the end of the data.
35638.endlist ilist
35639
35640For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
35641EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
35642error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
35643host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
35644the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
35645alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
35646host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
35647made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
35648
35649.vitem "&*Message errors*&"
35650.cindex "message" "error"
35651A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
35652particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
35653message errors are:
35654
35655.ilist
35656Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
35657the data,
35658.next
35659Timeout after MAIL,
35660.next
35661Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
35662timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
35663connection at any other time.
35664.endlist ilist
35665
35666For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
35667to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
35668temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
35669addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
35670a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
35671message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
35672that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
35673time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
35674affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
35675it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
35676
35677If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
35678to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
35679over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
35680response to MAIL.
35681
35682.vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
35683.cindex "recipient" "error"
35684A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
35685recipient errors are:
35686
35687.ilist
35688Any error response to RCPT,
35689.next
35690Timeout after RCPT.
35691.endlist
35692
35693For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
35694recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
35695sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
35696address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
35697used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
35698routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
35699operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
35700to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
35701if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
35702(&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
35703have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
35704the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
35705the retry clock is reset.
35706
35707The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
35708host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
35709other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
35710in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
35711proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
35712than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
35713if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
35714through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
35715recipient's retry time.
35716.endlist
35717
35718In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
35719current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
35720tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
35721own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
35722until the next delivery attempt.
35723
35724Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
35725MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
35726would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
35727host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
35728What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
35729is created.
35730
35731The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
35732these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
35733procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
35734response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
35735it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
35736message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
35737helpful to treat this case as a message error.
35738
35739Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
35740host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
35741or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
35742the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
35743then to be treated as a host error.
35744
35745There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
35746terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
35747reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
35748should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
35749host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
35750
35751
35752
35753
35754.section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
35755.cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
35756.cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
35757.cindex "inetd"
35758.cindex "daemon"
35759Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
35760listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
35761&_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
35762.code
35763smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
35764.endd
35765Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
35766agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
35767a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
35768the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
35769with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
35770stream and exits with an error code.
35771
35772By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
35773disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
35774unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
35775&%smtp_connection%& log selector.
35776
35777.cindex "carriage return"
35778.cindex "linefeed"
35779Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
35780LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
35781order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
35782line terminator.
35783Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
35784sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
35785sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
35786
35787.cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
35788.cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
35789One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
35790HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
35791commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
35792the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
35793Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
35794match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
35795
35796.cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
35797.cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
35798The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
35799a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
35800&%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
35801false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
35802&%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
35803value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
35804message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
35805
35806When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
35807its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
35808logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
35809
35810The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
35811prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
35812number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
35813&%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
35814rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
35815
35816The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
35817subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
35818for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
35819things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
35820processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
35821sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
35822it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
35823
35824When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
35825and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
35826high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
35827&%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
35828applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
35829
35830Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
35831can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
35832&%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
35833number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
35834SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
35835&%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
35836subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
35837a delivery process.
35838
35839The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
35840&%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
35841started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
35842handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
35843however, available with &'inetd'&.
35844
35845Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
35846are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
35847to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
35848section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
35849
35850Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
35851MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
35852&%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
35853
35854
35855
35856.section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
35857.cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
35858If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
35859commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
35860the error response to the last command. The default value for
35861&%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
35862abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
35863circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
35864
35865
35866.section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
35867.cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
35868.cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
35869A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
35870something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
35871address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
35872sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
35873&%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
35874drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
35875default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
35876broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
35877
35878
35879
35880.section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
35881.cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
35882The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
35883DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
35884many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
35885denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
35886client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
35887defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
35888
35889When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
35890allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
35891but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
35892or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
35893starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
35894counted.
35895
35896The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
35897STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
35898RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
35899
35900You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
35901&%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
35902&%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
35903the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
35904specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
35905
35906
35907
35908
35909.section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
35910When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
35911runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
35912appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
35913
35914.cindex "VRFY" "processing"
35915When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
35916setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
35917(with a 252 SMTP response code)
35918in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
35919When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
35920called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
35921SMTP response codes.
35922
35923.cindex "EXPN" "processing"
35924If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
35925When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
35926EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
35927than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
35928as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
35929of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
35930VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
35931RCPT failures.
35932
35933
35934
35935.section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
35936.cindex "ETRN" "processing"
35937RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
35938overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
35939disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
35940the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
35941should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
35942
35943The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
35944delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
35945the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
35946text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
35947specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
35948the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
35949argument. For example,
35950.code
35951ETRN #brigadoon
35952.endd
35953runs the command
35954.code
35955exim -R brigadoon
35956.endd
35957which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
35958containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
35959default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
35960for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
35961a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
35962
35963.cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
35964Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
35965record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
35966the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
35967the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
35968a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
35969left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
35970Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
35971
35972.oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
35973For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
35974used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
35975whatever the form of its argument. For
35976example:
35977.code
35978smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
35979 $sender_host_address
35980.endd
35981.vindex "&$domain$&"
35982The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
35983expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
35984and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
35985wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
35986under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
35987for it to change them before running the command.
35988
35989
35990
35991.section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
35992.cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
35993Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
35994standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
35995line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
35996&%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
35997messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
35998sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
35999an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
36000identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
36001runs for RCPT commands:
36002.code
36003accept hosts = :
36004.endd
36005This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
36006
36007
36008
36009.section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
36010.cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
36011.cindex "batched SMTP output"
36012Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
36013batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
36014be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
36015delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
36016envelope along with the message.
36017
36018The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
36019MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
36020the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
36021HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
36022can be used to specify it.
36023
36024Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
36025one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
36026to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
36027this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
36028chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
36029
36030.vindex "&$host$&"
36031When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
36032sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
36033transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
36034router:
36035.code
36036begin routers
36037route_append:
36038 driver = manualroute
36039 transport = smtp_appendfile
36040 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
36041
36042begin transports
36043smtp_appendfile:
36044 driver = appendfile
36045 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
36046 batch_max = 1000
36047 use_bsmtp
36048 user = exim
36049.endd
36050This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
36051format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
36052message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
36053
36054
36055
36056.section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
36057.cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
36058.cindex "batched SMTP input"
36059The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
36060reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
36061is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
36062sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
36063rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
36064and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
36065as NOOP; QUIT quits.
36066
36067Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
36068ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
36069
36070If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
36071the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
36072standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
36073make some use of automatically, for example:
36074.code
36075554 Unexpected end of file
36076Transaction started in line 10
36077Error detected in line 14
36078.endd
36079It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
36080file, for example:
36081.code
36082An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
36083The error message was:
36084
36085501 '>' missing at end of address
36086
36087The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
36088The error was detected in line 12.
36089The SMTP command at fault was:
36090
36091rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
36092
360931 previous message was successfully processed.
36094The rest of the batch was abandoned.
36095.endd
36096The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
36097messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
36098accepted.
36099.ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
36100.ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
36101
36102
36103
36104. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36105. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36106
36107.chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
36108 "Customizing messages"
36109When a message fails to be delivered, or remains in the queue for more than a
36110configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
36111to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
36112the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
36113string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
36114
36115The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
36116cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
36117option. Exim also adds the line
36118.code
36119Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
36120.endd
36121to all warning and bounce messages,
36122
36123
36124.section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
36125.cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
36126.cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
36127If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
36128message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
36129delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
36130&%bounce_message_file%& is set.
36131
36132When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
36133constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
36134separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
36135opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
36136logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
36137item.
36138
36139.vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
36140.vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
36141Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
36142expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
36143the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
36144&$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
36145option, rounded to a whole number.
36146
36147The items must appear in the file in the following order:
36148
36149.ilist
36150The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
36151&'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
36152.next
36153The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
36154failing addresses with their error messages.
36155.next
36156The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
36157returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
36158.next
36159The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
36160The fields exist for back-compatibility
36161.endlist
36162
36163The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
36164following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
36165other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
36166.code
36167Subject: Mail delivery failed
36168 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
36169 {: returning message to sender}}
36170****
36171This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
36172
36173A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
36174 {that you sent }{sent by
36175
36176<$sender_address>
36177
36178}}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
36179This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
36180****
36181The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
36182****
36183------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
36184 ------
36185****
36186------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
36187 only the first
36188------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
36189****
36190.endd
36191.section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
36192.cindex "customizing" "warning message"
36193.cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
36194The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
36195warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
36196text sections:
36197
36198.ilist
36199The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
36200&'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
36201.next
36202The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
36203the delayed addresses.
36204.next
36205The third item then ends the message.
36206.endlist
36207
36208The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
36209have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
36210.code
36211Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
36212 $warn_message_delay
36213****
36214This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
36215
36216A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
36217{that you sent }{sent by
36218
36219<$sender_address>
36220
36221}}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
36222more than $warn_message_delay in the queue on $primary_hostname.
36223
36224The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
36225The subject of the message is: $h_subject
36226The date of the message is: $h_date
36227
36228The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
36229****
36230No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
36231continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
36232intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
36233mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
36234the message will be returned to you.
36235.endd
36236.vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
36237.vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
36238However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
36239appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
36240&$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
36241minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
36242of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
36243multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
36244handled them.
36245
36246
36247
36248
36249. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36250. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36251
36252.chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
36253This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
36254common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
36255
36256
36257
36258.section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
36259.cindex "smart host" "example router"
36260If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
36261should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
36262routing explicitly:
36263.code
36264send_to_smart_host:
36265 driver = manualroute
36266 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
36267 transport = remote_smtp
36268.endd
36269You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
36270If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
36271receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
36272synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
36273&<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
36274
36275
36276
36277
36278.section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
36279.cindex "mailing lists"
36280Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
36281requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
36282Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
36283
36284The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
36285is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
36286independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
36287lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
36288.code
36289lists:
36290 driver = redirect
36291 domains = lists.example
36292 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
36293 forbid_pipe
36294 forbid_file
36295 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
36296 no_more
36297.endd
36298This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
36299in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
36300such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
36301routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
36302
36303The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
36304expanded into a filename or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
36305a mailing list.
36306
36307.oindex "&%errors_to%&"
36308The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
36309taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
36310original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
36311the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
36312
36313For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
36314&'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
36315&_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
36316&'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
36317There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
36318the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
36319such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
36320or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
36321&%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
36322
36323
36324
36325.section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
36326.cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
36327If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
36328delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
36329list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
36330list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
36331addresses are not rigorously checked.
36332
36333If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
36334entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
36335&%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
36336whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
36337&%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
36338
36339
36340
36341.section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
36342.cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
36343Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
36344in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
36345recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
36346cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
36347delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
36348account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
36349the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
36350message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
36351
36352If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
36353on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
36354router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
36355&"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
36356&"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
36357subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
36358failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
36359pre-existing messages.
36360
36361The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
36362addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
36363addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
36364&%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
36365one level of expansion anyway.
36366
36367
36368
36369.section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
36370.cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
36371The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
36372send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
36373from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
36374&%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
36375
36376The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
36377of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
36378.code
36379lists_request:
36380 driver = redirect
36381 domains = lists.example
36382 local_part_suffix = -request
36383 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
36384 no_more
36385
36386lists_post:
36387 driver = redirect
36388 domains = lists.example
36389 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
36390 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
36391 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
36392 forbid_pipe
36393 forbid_file
36394 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
36395 no_more
36396
36397lists_closed:
36398 driver = redirect
36399 domains = lists.example
36400 allow_fail
36401 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
36402.endd
36403All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
36404they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
36405&%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
36406mailing list.
36407
36408The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
36409checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
36410checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
36411necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
36412because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
36413not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
36414means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
36415&%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
36416&"unrouteable address"& error.
36417
36418The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
36419a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
36420the address, giving a suitable error message.
36421
36422
36423
36424
36425.section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
36426.cindex "VERP"
36427.cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
36428.cindex "envelope from"
36429.cindex "envelope sender"
36430Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(https://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
36431are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
36432address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
36433the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
36434if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
36435original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
36436
36437.oindex &%errors_to%&
36438.oindex &%return_path%&
36439Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
36440facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
36441list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
36442these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
36443host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
36444of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
36445of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
36446.code
36447verp_smtp:
36448 driver = smtp
36449 max_rcpt = 1
36450 return_path = \
36451 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
36452 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
36453.endd
36454This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
36455SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
36456&"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
36457local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
36458example, that a message whose return path has been set to
36459&'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
36460&'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
36461rewritten as
36462.code
36463somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
36464.endd
36465.vindex "&$local_part$&"
36466For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
36467have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
36468achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
36469might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
36470&$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
36471
36472Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
36473probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
36474extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
36475can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
36476.code
36477dnslookup:
36478 driver = dnslookup
36479 domains = ! +local_domains
36480 transport = \
36481 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
36482 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
36483 no_more
36484.endd
36485If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
36486of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
36487routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
36488errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
36489address.
36490
36491On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
36492&(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
36493SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
36494and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
36495of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
36496.code
36497verp_dnslookup:
36498 driver = dnslookup
36499 domains = ! +local_domains
36500 transport = remote_smtp
36501 errors_to = \
36502 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
36503 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
36504 no_more
36505.endd
36506Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
36507configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
36508Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
36509router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
36510them.
36511
36512The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
36513message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
36514host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
36515a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
36516a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
36517than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
36518used).
36519
36520
36521
36522
36523
36524
36525.section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
36526.cindex "virtual domains"
36527.cindex "domain" "virtual"
36528The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
36529meanings:
36530
36531.ilist
36532A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
36533aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
36534top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
36535.next
36536One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
36537with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
36538have login accounts on that host.
36539.endlist
36540
36541The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
36542the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
36543aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
36544virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
36545whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
36546to a router of this form:
36547.code
36548virtual:
36549 driver = redirect
36550 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
36551 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
36552 no_more
36553.endd
36554The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
36555is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
36556domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
36557part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
36558setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
36559string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
36560
36561This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias filenames
36562follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
36563can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
36564a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
36565
36566The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
36567way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
36568valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
36569.code
36570my_domains:
36571 driver = accept
36572 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
36573 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
36574 transport = my_mailboxes
36575.endd
36576The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
36577can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
36578file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
36579option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
36580because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
36581follows:
36582.code
36583my_mailboxes:
36584 driver = appendfile
36585 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
36586 user = mail
36587.endd
36588This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
36589required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
36590
36591The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
36592requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
36593up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
36594information about the domains.
36595
36596
36597
36598.section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
36599.cindex "multiple mailboxes"
36600.cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
36601.cindex "local part" "prefix"
36602.cindex "local part" "suffix"
36603Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
36604incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
36605allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
36606identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
36607parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
36608&%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
36609example, consider this router:
36610.code
36611userforward:
36612 driver = redirect
36613 check_local_user
36614 file = $home/.forward
36615 local_part_suffix = -*
36616 local_part_suffix_optional
36617 allow_filter
36618.endd
36619.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
36620It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
36621&'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
36622cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
36623.code
36624if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
36625save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
36626endif
36627.endd
36628If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
36629fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
36630&%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
36631control over which suffixes are valid.
36632
36633Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
36634&_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
36635another MTA:
36636.code
36637userforward:
36638 driver = redirect
36639 check_local_user
36640 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
36641 local_part_suffix = -*
36642 local_part_suffix_optional
36643 allow_filter
36644.endd
36645If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
36646example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
36647does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
36648subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
36649&_.forward_& file to use as a default.
36650
36651
36652
36653.section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
36654.cindex "vacation processing"
36655The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
36656a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
36657(see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
36658This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
36659that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
36660
36661.ilist
36662A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
36663can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
36664alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
36665&_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
36666.code
36667spqr, vacation-spqr
36668.endd
36669.next
36670The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
36671vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
36672user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
36673ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
36674to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
36675message.
36676.endlist
36677
36678Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
36679use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
36680
36681
36682
36683.section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
36684.cindex "message" "copying every"
36685Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
36686be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
36687command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
36688each day's messages.
36689
36690There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
36691messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
36692delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
36693notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
36694
36695
36696
36697.section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
36698.cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
36699It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
36700Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
36701arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
36702permanently connected.
36703
36704Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
36705particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
36706Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
36707
36708
36709.section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
36710It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
36711host to remain in Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
36712approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
36713being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
36714some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
36715to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
36716resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
36717
36718A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
36719intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
36720into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
36721format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
36722destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
36723in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
36724if required.
36725
36726On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
36727you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
36728intermittent host. For example:
36729.code
36730cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
36731.endd
36732This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
36733which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
36734online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
36735options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
36736causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
36737connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
36738immediately.
36739
36740If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
36741issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
36742mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
36743used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
36744avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
36745Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
36746arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
36747
36748
36749
36750.section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
36751The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
36752increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
36753connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
36754delivered immediately.
36755
36756.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
36757.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
36758.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
36759Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
36760not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
36761possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
36762each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
36763avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
36764&%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
36765first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
36766normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
36767destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
36768single SMTP connection.
36769
36770
36771
36772. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36773. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36774
36775.chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
36776 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
36777.cindex "client, non-queueing"
36778.cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
36779On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
36780email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
36781configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
36782However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
36783configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
36784&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
36785messages this way.
36786
36787If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
36788run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
36789any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
36790continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
36791email is not desirable.
36792
36793There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
36794&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
36795any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
36796host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
36797informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
36798to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
36799to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
36800
36801There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
36802that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
36803ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
36804before sending a message to the smart host.
36805
36806Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
36807tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
36808overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
36809
36810.oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
36811There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
36812Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
36813assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
36814just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
36815compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
36816router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
36817
36818When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
36819following ways:
36820
36821.ilist
36822A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
36823In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
36824.next
36825Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
36826assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
36827&%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
36828does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
36829successful, a zero return code is given.
36830.next
36831Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
36832be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
36833the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
36834must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
36835deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
36836are.
36837.next
36838If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
36839failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
36840successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
36841.next
36842Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
36843is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
36844smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
36845the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
36846there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
36847.next
36848If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
36849connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
36850failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
36851.next
36852When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
36853(as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
36854value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
36855are ever generated.
36856.next
36857No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
36858.next
36859A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
36860true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
36861&%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
36862.endlist
36863
36864The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
36865the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
36866deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
36867privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
36868to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
36869the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
36870
36871
36872
36873
36874. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36875. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36876
36877.chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
36878.scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
36879.cindex "log" "types of"
36880Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
36881and the panic log:
36882
36883.ilist
36884.cindex "main log"
36885The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
36886line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
36887down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
36888out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
36889them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
36890they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
36891analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
36892&<<SECTmailstat>>&).
36893.next
36894.cindex "reject log"
36895The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
36896of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
36897The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
36898the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
36899is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
36900lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
36901reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
36902host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
36903can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
36904false.
36905.next
36906.cindex "panic log"
36907.cindex "system log"
36908When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
36909error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
36910are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
36911other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
36912therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
36913regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
36914panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
36915is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
36916message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
36917.endlist
36918
36919Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
36920example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
36921In the log file, this would be all on one line:
36922.code
369232001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
36924 by QUIT
36925.endd
36926By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
36927ways of changing this:
36928
36929.ilist
36930You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
36931you set
36932.code
36933timezone = UTC
36934.endd
36935the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
36936.next
36937If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
36938example:
36939.code
369402003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
36941.endd
36942.endlist
36943
36944.cindex "log" "process ids in"
36945.cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
36946Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
36947request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
36948&<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
36949brackets, immediately after the time and date.
36950
36951
36952
36953
36954.section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
36955.cindex "log" "destination"
36956.cindex "log" "to file"
36957.cindex "log" "to syslog"
36958.cindex "syslog"
36959The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
36960should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
36961are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
36962arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
36963It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
36964need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
36965Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
36966
36967The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
36968&_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the runtime
36969configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
36970references to the host name:
36971.code
36972log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
36973.endd
36974It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
36975rather than at runtime, because then the setting is available right from the
36976start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
36977before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
36978configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
36979log at all.
36980
36981The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
36982list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
36983facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
36984colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
36985otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
36986point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
36987implying the use of a default path.
36988
36989When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
36990LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
36991&"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
36992mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
36993files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
36994equivalent to the setting:
36995.code
36996log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
36997.endd
36998If you do not specify anything at build time or runtime,
36999or if you unset the option at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
37000that is where the logs are written.
37001
37002A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log filenames
37003are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
37004
37005Here are some examples of possible settings:
37006.display
37007&`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
37008&`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
37009&`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
37010&`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
37011.endd
37012If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
37013error is logged.
37014
37015
37016
37017.section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
37018.cindex "log" "cycling local files"
37019.cindex "cycling logs"
37020.cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
37021.cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
37022Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
37023log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
37024provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
37025main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
37026keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
37027
37028An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
37029and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
37030example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
37031message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
37032that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
37033something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
37034ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
37035&[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
37036does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
37037tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
37038for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
37039renamed.
37040
37041
37042
37043.section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
37044.cindex "log" "datestamped files"
37045Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
37046periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
37047for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
37048&_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
37049the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
37050point where the datestamp is required. For example:
37051.code
37052log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
37053log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
37054log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
37055log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
37056.endd
37057As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
37058examples of names generated by the above examples:
37059.code
37060/var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
37061/var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
37062/var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
37063/var/log/exim/main.200212
37064.endd
37065When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
37066files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
37067will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
37068run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
37069
37070The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
37071is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
37072When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
37073the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
37074non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
37075character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
37076log names:
37077.code
37078/var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
37079/var/log/exim-panic.log
37080/var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
37081/var/log/exim/panic
37082.endd
37083
37084
37085.section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
37086.cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
37087The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
37088except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
37089Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
37090that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
37091&"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
37092by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
37093&%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
37094SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
37095&_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
37096LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
37097the time and host name to each line.
37098The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
37099
37100.ilist
37101&'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
37102.next
37103&'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
37104.next
37105&'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
37106.endlist
37107
37108Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
37109written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
37110these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
37111by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
37112
37113Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
37114entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
37115these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
37116calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
37117870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
37118additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
37119replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
37120RFC 3164, you should set
37121.code
37122SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
37123.endd
37124in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
37125lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
37126
37127To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
37128entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
37129where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
37130components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
37131because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
37132delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
37133870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
37134&'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
37135name, and pid as added by syslog:
37136.code
37137[1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
37138[2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
37139[3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
37140[4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
37141[5/5] mple>)
37142.endd
37143The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
37144(LOG_NOTICE):
37145.code
37146[1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
37147[2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
37148[3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
37149[4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
37150[5\18] .example>)
37151[6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
37152[7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
37153[8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
37154[9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
37155[10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
37156[11\18] 09:43 +0100
37157[12\18] F From: <>
37158[13\18] Subject: this is a test header
37159[18\18] X-something: this is another header
37160[15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
37161[16\18] le>
37162[17\18] B Bcc:
37163[18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
37164.endd
37165Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
37166without modification.
37167
37168If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
37169display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
37170the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
37171where it is.
37172
37173
37174
37175.section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
37176One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
37177successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
37178picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
37179timestamp. The flags are:
37180.display
37181&`<=`& message arrival
37182&`(=`& message fakereject
37183&`=>`& normal message delivery
37184&`->`& additional address in same delivery
37185&`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
37186&`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
37187&`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
37188&`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
37189.endd
37190
37191
37192.section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
37193.cindex "log" "reception line"
37194The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
37195message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
37196several lines in order to fit it on the page:
37197.code
371982002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
37199 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
37200 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
37201.endd
37202The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
37203bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
37204generated, this is followed by an item of the form
37205.code
37206R=<message id>
37207.endd
37208which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
37209
37210.cindex "HELO"
37211.cindex "EHLO"
37212For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
37213record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
37214received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
37215host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
37216above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
37217&%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
37218by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
37219verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
37220EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
37221name in parentheses.
37222
37223Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
37224without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
37225the log containing text like these examples:
37226.code
37227H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
37228H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
37229.endd
37230This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
37231on.
37232
37233For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
37234the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
37235of Exim.
37236
37237.cindex "authentication" "logging"
37238.cindex "AUTH" "logging"
37239For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
37240message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
37241of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
37242extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
37243session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
37244suite that was used.
37245
37246.cindex log protocol
37247The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
37248hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
37249value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
37250there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
37251was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
37252&%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
37253authenticator name.
37254
37255.cindex "size" "of message"
37256The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
37257received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
37258headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
37259message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
37260other).
37261
37262The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
37263data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
37264
37265
37266
37267.section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
37268.cindex "log" "delivery line"
37269The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
37270delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
37271deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
37272to fit it on the page:
37273.code
372742002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
37275 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
372762002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
37277 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
37278 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
37279.endd
37280For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
37281after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
37282intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
37283last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
37284fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
37285
37286If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
37287followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
37288If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
37289option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
37290
37291If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
37292for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
37293.display
37294&`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
37295.endd
37296If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
37297parentheses afterwards.
37298
37299.cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
37300When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
37301SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
37302flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
37303down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
37304lines for the second and subsequent messages.
37305When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
37306DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
37307will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
37308TLS cipher information is still available.
37309
37310.cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
37311.cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
37312When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
37313line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
37314rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
37315
37316The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
37317&"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
37318
37319The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
37320data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
37321
37322
37323.section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
37324.cindex "discarded messages"
37325.cindex "message" "discarded"
37326.cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
37327When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
37328obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
37329.code
373302002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
37331 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
37332.endd
37333is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
37334because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
37335.code
373361999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
37337 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
37338.endd
37339
37340
37341.section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
37342When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
37343.code
373442002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
37345 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
37346.endd
37347In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
37348last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
37349written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
37350.code
373512002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
37352 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
37353.endd
37354When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
37355a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
37356appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
37357
37358
37359
37360.section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
37361.cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
37362If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
37363following form is logged:
37364.code
373651995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
37366 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
37367.endd
37368If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
37369the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
37370.code
373712002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
37372 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
37373 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
37374 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
37375 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
37376.endd
37377The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
37378used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
37379disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
37380flagged with &`**`&.
37381
37382
37383
37384.section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
37385.cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
37386If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
37387used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
37388&"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
37389
37390
37391
37392.section "Completion" "SECID257"
37393A line of the form
37394.code
373952002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
37396.endd
37397is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
37398at the end of its processing.
37399
37400
37401
37402
37403.section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
37404.cindex "log" "summary of fields"
37405A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
37406the following table:
37407.display
37408&`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
37409&`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
37410&` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
37411&`CV `& certificate verification status
37412&`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
37413&`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
37414&`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
37415&`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
37416&`DT `& on &`=>`&, &'=='& and &'**'& lines: time taken for, or to attempt, a delivery
37417&`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
37418&`H `& host name and IP address
37419&`I `& local interface used
37420&`id `& message id (from header) for incoming message
37421&`K `& CHUNKING extension used
37422&`L `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: PIPELINING extension used
37423&`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
37424&`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
37425&` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
37426&`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
37427&`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
37428&`Q `& alternate queue name
37429&`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
37430&` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
37431&`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
37432&` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
37433&`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
37434&`S `& size of message in bytes
37435&`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
37436&`ST `& shadow transport name
37437&`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
37438&`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
37439&` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
37440&`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
37441&`X `& TLS cipher suite
37442.endd
37443
37444
37445.section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
37446Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
37447self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
37448
37449.ilist
37450.cindex "retry" "time not reached"
37451&'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
37452during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
37453This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
37454during the first delivery attempt.
37455.next
37456&'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
37457temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
37458for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
37459.next
37460.cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
37461&'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
37462some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
37463common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
37464&'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
37465doing.
37466.next
37467.cindex "error" "ignored"
37468&'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
37469message:
37470.olist
37471Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
37472&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
37473.next
37474A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
37475failed. The delivery was discarded.
37476.next
37477A delivery set up by a router configured with
37478. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
37479. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
37480.code
37481 errors_to = <>
37482.endd
37483failed. The delivery was discarded.
37484.endlist olist
37485.next
37486.cindex DKIM "log line"
37487&'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
37488logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
37489.endlist ilist
37490
37491
37492
37493
37494
37495.section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
37496.cindex "log" "selectors"
37497By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
37498default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
37499&%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
37500example:
37501.code
37502log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
37503.endd
37504The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
37505selection marked by asterisks:
37506.display
37507&` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
37508&`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
37509&` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
37510&` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
37511&` arguments `& command line arguments
37512&`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
37513&`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
37514&` deliver_time `& time taken to attempt delivery
37515&` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
37516&`*dkim `& DKIM verified domain on <= lines
37517&` dkim_verbose `& separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature
37518&`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
37519&` dnssec `& DNSSEC secured lookups
37520&`*etrn `& ETRN commands
37521&`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
37522&` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
37523&` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
37524&` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
37525&`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
37526&` millisec `& millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times
37527&`*msg_id `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value
37528&` msg_id_created `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value when one had to be added
37529&` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
37530&` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
37531&`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
37532&` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
37533&` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
37534&` pid `& Exim process id
37535&` pipelining `& PIPELINING use, on <= and => lines
37536&` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
37537&` receive_time `& time taken to receive message
37538&` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
37539&` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
37540&`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
37541&`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
37542&` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
37543&` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
37544&`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
37545&`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
37546&`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
37547&`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
37548&` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
37549&` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
37550&` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
37551&` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
37552&` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
37553&` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
37554&` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
37555&`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
37556&`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
37557&` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
37558&` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
37559&` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
37560
37561&` all `& all of the above
37562.endd
37563See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
37564section &<<SECID99>>&
37565
37566More details on each of these items follows:
37567
37568.ilist
37569.cindex "8BITMIME"
37570.cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
37571&%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
37572which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
37573that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
37574&`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
37575&`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
37576.next
37577.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
37578&%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
37579its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
37580this log selector is set.
37581.next
37582.cindex "log" "rewriting"
37583.cindex "rewriting" "logging"
37584&%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
37585rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
37586such users cannot access the log).
37587.next
37588.cindex "log" "full parentage"
37589&%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
37590delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
37591parentheses between them.
37592.next
37593.cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
37594.cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
37595&%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
37596to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
37597feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
37598&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
37599privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
37600that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
37601are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
37602because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
37603only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
37604between the caller and Exim.
37605.next
37606.cindex "log" "connection rejections"
37607&%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
37608connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
37609.next
37610.cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
37611.cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
37612&%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
37613started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
37614messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
37615process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
37616.next
37617.cindex "log" "delivery duration"
37618&%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
37619perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
37620If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37621precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
37622.next
37623.cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
37624.cindex "size" "of message"
37625&%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
37626the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
37627.next
37628.cindex log "DKIM verification"
37629.cindex DKIM "verification logging"
37630&%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
37631verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
37632.next
37633.cindex log "DKIM verification"
37634.cindex DKIM "verification logging"
37635&%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
37636.next
37637.cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
37638.cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
37639.cindex "black list (DNS)"
37640&%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
37641DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
37642.next
37643.cindex log dnssec
37644.cindex dnssec logging
37645&%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
37646dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
37647For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
37648It does not cover helo-name verification.
37649For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
37650.next
37651.cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
37652.cindex "ETRN" "logging"
37653&%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
37654is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
37655command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
37656selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
37657.next
37658.cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
37659&%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
37660any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
37661log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
37662routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
37663.next
37664.cindex "log" "ident timeout"
37665.cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
37666&%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
37667client's ident port times out.
37668.next
37669.cindex "log" "incoming interface"
37670.cindex "log" "local interface"
37671.cindex "log" "local address and port"
37672.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
37673.cindex "interface" "logging"
37674&%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
37675to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
37676followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
37677added to other SMTP log lines, for example, &"SMTP connection from"&, to
37678rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
37679The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
37680.next
37681.cindex log "incoming proxy address"
37682.cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
37683.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
37684&%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
37685of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
37686on a proxied connection
37687or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
37688See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
37689.next
37690.cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
37691.cindex "port" "logging remote"
37692.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
37693.vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
37694.vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
37695&%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
37696added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
37697in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
37698changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
37699&$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
37700important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
37701.next
37702.cindex "log" "dropped connection"
37703&%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
37704connection is unexpectedly dropped.
37705.next
37706.cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
37707.cindex millisecond logging
37708.cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
37709&%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
37710appended to the seconds value.
37711.next
37712.cindex "log" "message id"
37713&%msg_id%&: The value of the Message-ID: header.
37714.next
37715&%msg_id_created%&: The value of the Message-ID: header, when one had to be created.
37716This will be either because the message is a bounce, or was submitted locally
37717(submission mode) without one.
37718The field identifier will have an asterix appended: &"id*="&.
37719.next
37720.cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
37721.cindex "log" "local interface"
37722.cindex "log" "local address and port"
37723.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
37724.cindex "interface" "logging"
37725&%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
37726interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
37727followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
37728off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
37729.next
37730.cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
37731.cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
37732.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
37733&%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
37734containing => tags) following the IP address.
37735The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
37736&%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
37737This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
37738configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
37739local port is a random ephemeral port.
37740.next
37741.cindex "log" "process ids in"
37742.cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
37743&%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
37744immediately after the time and date.
37745.next
37746.cindex log pipelining
37747.cindex pipelining "logging outgoing"
37748&%pipelining%&: A field is added to delivery and accept
37749log lines when the ESMTP PIPELINING extension was used.
37750The field is a single "L".
37751
37752On accept lines, where PIPELINING was offered but not used by the client,
37753the field has a minus appended.
37754
37755.cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
37756If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
37757accept "L" fields have a period appended if the feature was
37758offered but not used, or an asterisk appended if used.
37759Delivery "L" fields have an asterisk appended if used.
37760
37761.next
37762.cindex "log" "queue run"
37763.cindex "queue runner" "logging"
37764&%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
37765.next
37766.cindex "log" "queue time"
37767&%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
37768local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
37769&`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
37770includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
37771This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
37772delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
37773message has been successfully received.
37774If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37775precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
37776.next
37777&%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
37778the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
37779example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
37780message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
37781.next
37782.cindex "log" "receive duration"
37783&%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
37784perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
37785If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37786precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
37787.next
37788.cindex "log" "recipients"
37789&%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
37790as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
37791that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
37792addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
37793has taken place.
37794Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
37795in the list.
37796.next
37797.cindex "log" "sender reception"
37798&%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
37799the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
37800&"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
37801.next
37802.cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
37803&%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
37804rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
37805log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
37806rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
37807.next
37808.cindex "log" "retry defer"
37809&%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
37810retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
37811message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
37812attempt.
37813.next
37814.cindex "log" "return path"
37815&%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
37816the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
37817This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
37818or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
37819.next
37820.cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
37821&%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
37822and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
37823This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
37824necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
37825.next
37826.cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
37827&%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
37828gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
37829the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
37830detail is lost.
37831.next
37832.cindex "log" "size rejection"
37833&%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
37834it is too big.
37835.next
37836.cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
37837.cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
37838&%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
37839queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
37840it.
37841.cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
37842The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
37843.next
37844.cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
37845.cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
37846.cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
37847&%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
37848outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
37849A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
37850response.
37851.next
37852.cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
37853.cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
37854&%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
37855established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
37856&%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
37857only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
37858processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
37859dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
37860not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
37861of connections unless this selector is enabled.
37862
37863For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
37864included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
37865reset if the daemon is restarted.
37866Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
37867subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
37868whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
37869match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
37870logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
37871.next
37872.cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
37873.cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
37874&%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
37875RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
37876and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
37877line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
37878.next
37879.cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
37880.cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
37881&%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
37882connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
37883the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
37884does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
37885an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
37886already have their own log lines.
37887
37888The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
37889way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
37890If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
37891an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
37892DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
37893the same logging options.
37894
37895Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
37896is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
37897.code
37898C=EHLO,QUIT
37899.endd
37900shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
37901than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
37902the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
37903setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
37904have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
37905.next
37906&%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
37907colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
37908log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
37909was accepted or used.
37910.next
37911.cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
37912.cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
37913&%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
37914encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
37915because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
37916been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
37917it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
37918received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
37919.next
37920.cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
37921.cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
37922.cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
37923.cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
37924.cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
37925&%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
37926encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
37927external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
37928using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
37929.next
37930.cindex "log" "subject"
37931.cindex "subject, logging"
37932&%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
37933preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
37934Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
37935specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
37936unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
37937.next
37938.cindex "log" "certificate verification"
37939.cindex log DANE
37940.cindex DANE logging
37941&%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
37942when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
37943verified
37944using a CA trust anchor,
37945&`CA=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
37946and &`CV=no`& if not.
37947.next
37948.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
37949.cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
37950&%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
37951connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
37952.next
37953.cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
37954.cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
37955&%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
37956connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
37957added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
37958.next
37959.cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
37960.cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
37961&%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
37962the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
37963added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
37964.next
37965.cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
37966&%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
37967result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
37968.endlist
37969
37970
37971.section "Message log" "SECID260"
37972.cindex "message" "log file for"
37973.cindex "log" "message log; description of"
37974.cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
37975.oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
37976In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
37977that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
37978they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
37979message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
37980makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
37981to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
37982is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
37983only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
37984
37985On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
37986per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
37987&%message_logs%& option false.
37988.ecindex IIDloggen
37989
37990
37991
37992
37993. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37994. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37995
37996.chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
37997.scindex IIDutils "utilities"
37998A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
37999described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
38000the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
38001
38002.itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
38003.irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
38004 "list what Exim processes are doing"
38005.irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
38006.irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
38007.irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
38008.irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
38009 various criteria"
38010.irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
38011.irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
38012 "extract statistics from the log"
38013.irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
38014 "check address acceptance from given IP"
38015.irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
38016.irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
38017.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
38018.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
38019.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
38020.irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
38021.endtable
38022
38023Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
38024&'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
38025&url(https://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
38026
38027
38028
38029
38030.section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
38031.cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
38032.cindex "process, querying"
38033.cindex "SIGUSR1"
38034On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
38035(most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
38036a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
38037Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
38038processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
38039second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
38040order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
38041send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
38042
38043&*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
38044use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
38045script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
38046
38047
38048Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
38049varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
38050but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
38051system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
38052it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
38053options:
38054.display
38055&`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
38056&`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
38057&`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
38058&`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
38059.endd
38060An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
38061.code
38062164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
3806310483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
3806410492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
38065 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
3806610592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
3806710628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
38068.endd
38069The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
38070been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
38071
38072
38073
38074.section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
38075.cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
38076.cindex "queue" "grepping"
38077This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
38078.code
38079exim -bpu
38080.endd
38081or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
38082.code
38083exim -bp
38084.endd
38085The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
38086contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
38087
38088to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
38089that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
38090
38091.vlist
38092.vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
38093Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
38094tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
38095.code
38096exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
38097.endd
38098.vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
38099Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
38100tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
38101
38102.vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
38103Match against the size field.
38104
38105.vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
38106Match messages that are younger than the given time.
38107
38108.vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
38109Match messages that are older than the given time.
38110
38111.vitem &*-z*&
38112Match only frozen messages.
38113
38114.vitem &*-x*&
38115Match only non-frozen messages.
38116
38117.vitem &*-G*&&~<&'queuename'&>
38118Match only messages in the given queue. Without this, the default queue is searched.
38119.endlist
38120
38121The following options control the format of the output:
38122
38123.vlist
38124.vitem &*-c*&
38125Display only the count of matching messages.
38126
38127.vitem &*-l*&
38128Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
38129the default.
38130
38131.vitem &*-i*&
38132Display message ids only.
38133
38134.vitem &*-b*&
38135Brief format &-- one line per message.
38136
38137.vitem &*-R*&
38138Display messages in reverse order.
38139
38140.vitem &*-a*&
38141Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
38142.endlist
38143
38144There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
38145
38146
38147
38148.section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
38149.cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
38150.cindex "queue" "summary"
38151The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
38152-bp`& and produces a summary of the messages in the queue. Thus, you use it by
38153running a command such as
38154.code
38155exim -bp | exiqsumm
38156.endd
38157The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
38158it, as in the following example:
38159.code
381603 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
38161.endd
38162Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
38163volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
38164been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
38165number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
38166
38167A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
38168domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
38169the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
38170respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
38171domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
38172separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
38173sender.
38174
38175The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
38176this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
38177generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
38178option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
38179level"& addresses).
38180
38181
38182
38183
38184.section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
38185 "SECTextspeinf"
38186.cindex "&'exigrep'&"
38187.cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
38188The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
38189files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
38190extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
38191match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
38192given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
38193The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
38194If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
38195included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
38196.display
38197&`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
38198.endd
38199If no log filenames are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
38200
38201The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
38202condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
38203they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds in the queue.
38204
38205By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
38206makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
38207large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
38208option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
38209case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
38210
38211The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
38212pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
38213regular expression.
38214
38215The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
38216if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
38217
38218The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
38219that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
38220normally.
38221
38222Example of &%-M%&:
38223user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
38224&'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
38225displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
38226the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
38227when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
38228&"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
38229search term.
38230
38231If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
38232ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
38233whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
38234If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
38235autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
38236
38237
38238.section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
38239.cindex "&'exipick'&"
38240John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
38241lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
38242of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
38243the &%--help%& option.
38244
38245
38246.section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
38247.cindex "log" "cycling local files"
38248.cindex "cycling logs"
38249.cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
38250The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
38251&'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
38252you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
38253&<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
38254for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
38255There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
38256.ilist
38257&%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
38258default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
38259.next
38260&%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
38261&%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
38262overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
38263configuration.
38264.endlist
38265
38266Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the filenames get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
38267the main log filename is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
38268run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
38269&_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
38270&%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
38271logs are handled similarly.
38272
38273If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
38274&_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
38275to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
38276any existing log files.
38277
38278If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
38279the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
38280using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
38281setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
38282root &%crontab%& entry of the form
38283.code
382841 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
38285.endd
38286assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
38287&'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
38288
38289
38290
38291.section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
38292.cindex "statistics"
38293.cindex "&'eximstats'&"
38294A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
38295information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
38296. --- 2018-09-07: LogReport's Lire appears to be dead; website is a Yahoo Japan
38297. --- 404 error and everything else points to that.
38298
38299The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
38300latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
38301lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
38302various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
38303list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
38304.code
38305eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
38306.endd
38307By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
38308messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
38309both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
38310are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
38311addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
38312options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
38313also produced per user.
38314
38315The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
38316histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
38317hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
38318example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
38319as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
38320
38321Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
38322have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
38323messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
38324and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
38325recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
38326an entirely separate message.
38327
38328&'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
38329of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
38330each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
38331not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
38332least one address that failed.
38333
38334The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
38335or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
38336transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
38337(default per hour), information about the time messages spent in the queue,
38338a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
38339senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
38340and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
38341
38342The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
38343came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
38344without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
38345
38346There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
38347outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
38348by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
38349.code
38350perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
38351.endd
38352
38353.section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
38354.cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
38355.cindex "policy control" "checking access"
38356.cindex "checking access"
38357The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
38358debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
38359policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
38360familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
38361sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
38362access?"& without bothering with any further details.
38363
38364The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
38365two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
38366.code
38367exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
38368.endd
38369The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
38370given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
38371connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
38372is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
38373.code
38374Rejected:
38375550 Relay not permitted
38376.endd
38377When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
38378for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
38379options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
38380that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
38381you can use:
38382.code
38383exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
38384 -f himself@there.example
38385.endd
38386Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
38387mandatory arguments.
38388
38389Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
38390while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
38391&%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
38392
38393
38394
38395.section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
38396.cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
38397.cindex "building DBM files"
38398.cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
38399.cindex "lower casing"
38400.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
38401The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
38402the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
38403&<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
38404names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
38405can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
38406
38407A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
38408the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
38409&'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
38410strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
38411files.
38412
38413The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
38414single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
38415It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
38416well.
38417
38418.cindex "USE_DB"
38419If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
38420configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two
38421filenames must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions
38422create a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
38423.code
38424exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
38425.endd
38426reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
38427&_/etc/aliases.db_&.
38428
38429In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
38430Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
38431environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
38432&'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
38433when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
38434recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the filename.
38435
38436If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
38437finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
38438option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
38439this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
38440&%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
38441There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
38442&%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
38443return code is 2.
38444
38445
38446
38447
38448.section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
38449.cindex "retry" "times"
38450.cindex "&'exinext'&"
38451A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
38452fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
38453complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
38454information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
38455is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
38456output. For example:
38457.code
38458$ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
38459kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
38460 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
38461 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
38462 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
38463roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
38464 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
38465 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
38466 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
38467 past final cutoff time
38468.endd
38469You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
38470will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
38471A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
38472message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
38473suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
38474&'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
38475run very often.
38476
38477The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
38478of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
38479passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
38480configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
38481file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
38482environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
38483
38484
38485
38486.section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
38487.cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
38488.cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
38489Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
38490uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
38491arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
38492second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
38493
38494.ilist
38495&'retry'&: the database of retry information
38496.next
38497&'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
38498for remote hosts
38499.next
38500&'callout'&: the callout cache
38501.next
38502&'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
38503.next
38504&'misc'&: other hints data
38505.endlist
38506
38507The &'misc'& database is used for
38508
38509.ilist
38510Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
38511.next
38512Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
38513&(smtp)& transport)
38514.next
38515Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
38516in a transport)
38517.endlist
38518
38519
38520
38521.section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
38522.cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
38523The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
38524&'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
38525spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
38526.code
38527exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
38528.endd
38529Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
38530.code
38531T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
3853231-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
38533.endd
38534The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
38535of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
38536transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
38537a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
38538address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
38539transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
38540to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
38541and a textual description of the error.
38542
38543The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
38544the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
38545ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
38546exceeded.
38547
38548Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
38549consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
38550waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
38551one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
38552may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
38553may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
38554cross-references.
38555
38556
38557
38558.section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
38559.cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
38560The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
38561database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
38562days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
38563updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
38564since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
38565for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
38566updated sufficiently often.
38567
38568The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
38569followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
38570the retry database:
38571.code
38572exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
38573.endd
38574Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
38575message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
38576they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
38577are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
38578types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
38579message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
38580queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
38581&'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
38582For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
38583removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
38584whenever it removes information from the database.
38585
38586Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
38587needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
38588down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
38589first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
38590records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
38591
38592It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
38593hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
38594a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
38595work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
38596but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
38597After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
38598point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
38599tidied.
38600
38601&*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
38602databases is likely to keep on increasing.
38603
38604
38605
38606
38607.section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
38608.cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
38609The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
38610Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
38611getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
38612is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
38613key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
38614displayed.
38615
38616If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
38617except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
38618out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
38619data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
38620by new data, for example:
38621.code
38622> 4 951102:1000
38623.endd
38624resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
38625sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
38626used as optional separators.
38627
38628
38629
38630
38631.section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
38632.cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
38633.cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
38634.cindex "locking mailboxes"
38635The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
38636Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
38637&'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
38638a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
38639the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
38640argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
38641second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
38642is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
38643is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
38644
38645.vlist
38646.vitem &%-fcntl%&
38647Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
38648
38649.vitem &%-flock%&
38650Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
38651supports it.
38652
38653.vitem &%-interval%&
38654This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
38655interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
38656
38657.vitem &%-lockfile%&
38658Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
38659
38660.vitem &%-mbx%&
38661Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
38662
38663.vitem &%-q%&
38664Suppress verification output.
38665
38666.vitem &%-retries%&
38667This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
38668the lock (default 10).
38669
38670.vitem &%-restore_time%&
38671This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
38672locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
38673example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
38674subsequently sees.
38675
38676.vitem &%-timeout%&
38677This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
38678timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
38679default), a non-blocking call is used.
38680
38681.vitem &%-v%&
38682Generate verbose output.
38683.endlist
38684
38685If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
38686default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
38687mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
38688&%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
38689requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
38690file does not last forever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
38691more than 30 minutes old.
38692
38693The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
38694&%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
38695to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
38696&_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
38697number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
38698can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
38699
38700The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
38701&%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
38702suppresses all output except error messages.
38703
38704A command such as
38705.code
38706exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
38707.endd
38708runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
38709.display
38710&`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
38711<&'some commands'&>
38712&`End`&
38713.endd
38714runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
38715suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
38716such as
38717.code
38718exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
38719 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
38720.endd
38721Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
38722second argument &-- hence the quotes.
38723.ecindex IIDutils
38724
38725
38726. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38727. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38728
38729.chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
38730.scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
38731.cindex "X-windows"
38732.cindex "&'eximon'&"
38733.cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
38734.cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
38735The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
38736about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
38737perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
38738such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
38739monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
38740
38741
38742
38743.section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
38744The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
38745script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
38746binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
38747be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
38748&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
38749parameters are for.
38750
38751The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
38752a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
38753preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
38754.code
38755EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
38756.endd
38757(in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
38758the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
38759overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
38760&'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
38761syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
38762
38763X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
38764way. For example, a resource setting of the form
38765.code
38766Eximon*background: gray94
38767.endd
38768changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
38769stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
38770black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
38771data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
38772&"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
38773For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
38774reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
38775.code
38776xrdb -merge <<End
38777Eximon*highlight: gray
38778End
38779.endd
38780.cindex "admin user"
38781In order to see the contents of messages in the queue, and to operate on them,
38782&'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
38783
38784The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
38785contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
38786if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
38787binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
38788versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
38789
38790The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
38791more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
38792main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
38793delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
38794different parts of the display.
38795
38796
38797
38798
38799.section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
38800.cindex "stripchart"
38801The first stripchart is always a count of messages in the queue. Its name can
38802be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
38803&_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
38804configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
38805it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
38806hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
38807received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
38808period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
38809parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
38810
38811The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
38812displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
38813title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
38814For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
38815
38816It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
38817a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
38818to a single partition.
38819
38820.cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
38821This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
38822the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
38823this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
38824100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
38825SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
38826&_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
38827
38828
38829
38830
38831.section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
38832.cindex "size" "of monitor window"
38833.cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
38834.cindex "window size"
38835Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
38836to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
38837shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
38838stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
38839the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
38840in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
38841
38842When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
38843currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
38844size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
38845remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
38846
38847The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
38848stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
38849the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
38850The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
38851&'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
38852the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38853
38854Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
38855built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
38856START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38857
38858
38859
38860.section "The log display" "SECID267"
38861.cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
38862The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
38863the main log is maintained.
38864To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
38865removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
38866The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
38867syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
38868to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
38869
38870The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
38871move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
38872scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
38873LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
38874to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
38875much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
38876a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
38877only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
38878available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
38879normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
38880configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38881
38882Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
38883and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
38884respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
38885It cannot go further back up the log.
38886
38887The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
38888normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
38889by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
38890by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
38891back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
38892the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
38893
38894Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
38895There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
38896the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
38897happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
38898&"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
38899^C is typed the search is cancelled.
38900
38901The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
38902widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
38903&"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
38904eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
38905However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
38906provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
38907come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
38908unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
38909on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
38910window.
38911
38912
38913
38914.section "The queue display" "SECID268"
38915.cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
38916The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
38917are in the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
38918as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
38919parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
38920at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
38921the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
38922there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
38923to force an update of the queue display at any time.
38924
38925When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
38926and this can make it hard to deal with other messages in the queue. To help
38927with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
38928pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
38929type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
38930such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
38931of the texts, the message is not displayed.
38932
38933If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
38934are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
38935example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
38936&'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
38937has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
38938cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
38939a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
38940
38941While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
38942else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
38943queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
38944pressing the &"Hide"& button.
38945
38946The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
38947time it has been in the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
38948message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
38949a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
38950recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
38951listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
38952an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
38953not shown.
38954
38955.cindex "frozen messages" "display"
38956If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
38957
38958The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
38959of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
38960The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
38961available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
38962display is updated.
38963
38964
38965
38966.section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
38967.cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
38968If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
38969pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
38970line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
38971any selected text.
38972
38973If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
38974MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
38975set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
38976value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
38977run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
38978.code
38979EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
38980.endd
38981The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
38982follows:
38983
38984.ilist
38985&'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
38986in a new text window.
38987.next
38988&'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
38989information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
38990&<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
38991.next
38992&'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
38993displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
38994amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
38995option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at runtime.
38996.next
38997&'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
38998delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
38999frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
39000a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
39001up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
39002.next
39003&'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
39004that the message be frozen.
39005.next
39006.cindex "thawing messages"
39007.cindex "unfreezing messages"
39008.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
39009&'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
39010that the message be thawed.
39011.next
39012.cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
39013&'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
39014that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
39015for any remaining undelivered addresses.
39016.next
39017&'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
39018that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
39019message.
39020.next
39021&'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
39022be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
39023is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
39024Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
39025causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
39026additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
39027which case no action is taken.
39028.next
39029&'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
39030can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
39031is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
39032Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
39033causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
39034recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
39035case no action is taken.
39036.next
39037&'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
39038mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
39039.next
39040&'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
39041sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
39042&%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
39043in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
39044bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
39045not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
39046the address is qualified with that domain.
39047.endlist
39048
39049When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
39050other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
39051particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
39052output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
39053from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
39054&_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
39055if no output is generated.
39056
39057The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
39058thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
39059&_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
39060force an update of the display after one of these actions.
39061
39062In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
39063cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
39064and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
39065.ecindex IIDeximon
39066
39067
39068
39069
39070
39071. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39072. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39073
39074.chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
39075.scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
39076This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
39077which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
39078
39079For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
39080Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
39081existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
39082chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
39083security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
39084its security as compared with other MTAs.
39085
39086What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
39087have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
39088absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
39089as soon as possible.
39090
39091
39092.section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
39093.cindex "security" "build-time features"
39094There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
39095to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
39096Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
39097penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
39098
39099.ilist
39100ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
39101start of any filenames used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these
39102filenames are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if
39103the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
39104&_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
39105default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
39106
39107If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
39108which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
39109into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
39110configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
39111.next
39112
39113If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
39114or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
39115file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
39116the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
39117root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
39118right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
39119reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
39120it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
39121privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
39122separate commands.
39123
39124.next
39125The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
39126with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
39127CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
39128requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
39129the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
39130but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
39131previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
39132.next
39133If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
39134is disabled.
39135.next
39136FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
39137never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
39138option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
39139to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
39140is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
39141.endlist
39142
39143
39144
39145.section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
39146.cindex "setuid"
39147.cindex "root privilege"
39148The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
39149privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
39150example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
39151may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
39152discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
39153is required for two things:
39154
39155.ilist
39156To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
39157the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
39158not required.
39159.next
39160To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
39161perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
39162configuration.
39163.endlist
39164
39165It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
39166receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
39167obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
39168For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
39169&_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
39170group"&. Their values can be changed by the runtime configuration, though this
39171is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
39172&'mail'& or another user name altogether.
39173
39174Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
39175abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
39176&[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
39177
39178After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
39179uid and gid in the following cases:
39180
39181.ilist
39182.oindex "&%-C%&"
39183.oindex "&%-D%&"
39184If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
39185the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
39186calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
39187the calling process.
39188However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
39189option may not be used at all.
39190If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
39191can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
39192user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
39193.next
39194.oindex "&%-be%&"
39195.oindex "&%-bf%&"
39196.oindex "&%-bF%&"
39197If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
39198(&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
39199calling process.
39200.next
39201If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
39202process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
39203uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
39204runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
39205testing address verification
39206.oindex "&%-bv%&"
39207.oindex "&%-bh%&"
39208(the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
39209option).
39210.next
39211For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
39212remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
39213.endlist
39214
39215The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
39216
39217.ilist
39218A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
39219user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
39220function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
39221will be used during message reception.
39222.next
39223A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
39224job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
39225.next
39226A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
39227but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
39228subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
39229deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
39230remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
39231subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
39232while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
39233generating bounce and warning messages.
39234
39235While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
39236process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
39237this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
39238gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
39239.next
39240A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
39241the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
39242.endlist
39243
39244
39245
39246
39247.section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
39248.cindex "privilege, running without"
39249.cindex "unprivileged running"
39250.cindex "root privilege" "running without"
39251Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
39252operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
39253by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
39254gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
39255(and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
39256routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
39257to any other uid.
39258
39259.cindex SIGHUP
39260.cindex "daemon" "restarting"
39261Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
39262that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
39263correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
39264
39265An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
39266to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
39267process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
39268when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
39269SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
39270
39271It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
39272stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
39273been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
39274effect.
39275
39276If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
39277set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
39278to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
39279
39280In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
39281those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
39282Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
39283that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
39284discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
39285have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
39286number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
39287address this problem at this time.
39288
39289For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
39290is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
39291&%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
39292be used in the most straightforward way.
39293
39294If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
39295number of restrictions on what you can do:
39296
39297.ilist
39298You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
39299&%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
39300normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
39301work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
39302explicit specification of another user causes an error.
39303.next
39304Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
39305not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
39306.next
39307Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
39308the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
39309and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
39310enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
39311.next
39312Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
39313some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
39314
39315.olist
39316They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
39317implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
39318mode of the mailbox files themselves.
39319.next
39320You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
39321owned by the Exim user.
39322.next
39323You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
39324on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
39325mailboxes need to be created manually.
39326.endlist olist
39327.endlist ilist
39328
39329
39330These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
39331However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
39332gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
39333gives more security at essentially no cost.
39334
39335If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
39336&<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
39337
39338
39339
39340
39341.section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
39342Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
39343are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
39344
39345
39346
39347.section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
39348.cindex "security" "local commands"
39349.cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
39350There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
39351commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
39352configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
39353run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
39354
39355.ilist
39356Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
39357injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
39358be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
39359allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
39360has &%use_shell%& enabled.
39361.next
39362A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
39363&%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
39364&_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
39365hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
39366NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
39367forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
39368need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
39369.next
39370The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
39371administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
39372Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
39373.next
39374Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
39375taint checking might apply to their usage.
39376.next
39377Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
39378administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
39379instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
39380.next
39381Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
39382Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
39383each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
39384of opaque strings.
39385The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
39386real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
39387injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
39388Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
39389.endlist
39390
39391
39392
39393
39394.section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
39395.cindex "security" "data sources"
39396.cindex "security" "regular expressions"
39397.cindex "regular expressions" "security"
39398.cindex "PCRE" "security"
39399If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
39400are some issues to be aware of:
39401
39402.ilist
39403Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
39404.next
39405Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
39406.next
39407Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
39408data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
39409"backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
39410expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
39411when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
39412possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
39413data.
39414.next
39415It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
39416&%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
39417items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
39418.next
39419Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
39420expected to yield one result.
39421.endlist
39422
39423
39424
39425
39426.section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
39427.cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
39428.cindex "IP source routing"
39429Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
39430some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
39431IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
39432IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
39433
39434
39435
39436.section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
39437Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
39438be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
39439
39440
39441
39442
39443.section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
39444.cindex "trusted users"
39445.cindex "admin user"
39446.cindex "privileged user"
39447.cindex "user" "trusted"
39448.cindex "user" "admin"
39449Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
39450able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
39451addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
39452local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
39453permit a remote host to be specified.
39454
39455.oindex "&%-f%&"
39456However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
39457in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
39458message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
39459but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
39460permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
39461the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
39462
39463Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
39464other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
39465the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
39466as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
39467group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
39468
39469Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
39470can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
39471them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
39472the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
39473includes the contents of files on the spool.
39474
39475.oindex "&%-M%&"
39476.oindex "&%-q%&"
39477By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
39478delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
39479restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
39480Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
39481queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
39482setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
39483
39484Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
39485the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
39486the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
39487group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
39488the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
39489unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
39490files.
39491
39492By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
39493introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
39494setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
39495This affects most of the checking options,
39496such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
39497
39498
39499.section "Spool files" "SECID275"
39500.cindex "spool directory" "files"
39501Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
39502set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
39503&_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
39504any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
39505
39506
39507
39508.section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
39509Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
39510of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
39511with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
39512to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
39513this.
39514
39515
39516
39517.section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
39518The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
39519are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
39520Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
39521converted output.
39522
39523
39524
39525.section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
39526Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
39527to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
39528does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
39529arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
39530
39531
39532
39533.section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
39534Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
39535defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
39536loading it.
39537
39538
39539.section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
39540.cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
39541A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
39542&'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
39543The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
39544that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
39545conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
39546
39547The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
39548the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
39549string.
39550
39551
39552
39553.section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
39554Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
39555formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
39556the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
39557
39558
39559
39560.section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
39561These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
39562enough to hold the result.
39563.ecindex IIDsecurcon
39564
39565
39566
39567
39568. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39569. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39570
39571.chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
39572.scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
39573.scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
39574.scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
39575.cindex "spool files" "editing"
39576A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
39577followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
39578the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
39579kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
39580two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
39581is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
39582themselves are recoverable.
39583
39584The file formats may be changed, or new formats added, at any release.
39585Spool files are not intended as an interface to other programs
39586and should not be used as such.
39587
39588Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
39589need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
39590on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
39591
39592.ilist
39593You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
39594fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
39595which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
39596place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
39597lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
39598.next
39599.vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
39600If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
39601&$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
39602cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
39603.next
39604If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
39605.next
39606If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
39607signature.
39608.endlist
39609All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
39610
39611Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
39612its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
39613files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
39614the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
39615the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
39616is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
39617file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
39618-J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
39619attempt.
39620
39621Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
39622These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
39623They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
39624relics of crashes and can be removed.
39625
39626.section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
39627.cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
39628.cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
39629The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
39630process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
39631gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
39632message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
39633normally the Exim user.
39634
39635The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
39636transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
39637empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
39638in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
39639created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
39640&%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
39641leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
39642&"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
39643
39644The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
39645was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
39646start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
39647warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
39648
39649There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
39650order, and are omitted when not relevant:
39651
39652.vlist
39653.vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39654This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
39655&%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
39656recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
39657this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
39658identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
39659the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
39660the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
39661the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
39662newlines.
39663
39664.vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39665A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
39666defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
39667The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
39668starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
39669character. It may contain internal newlines.
39670
39671.vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39672A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
39673Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
39674length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
39675starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
39676character. It may contain internal newlines.
39677
39678.vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
39679This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
39680&$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
39681
39682.vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
39683This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
39684lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
39685transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
39686messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
39687
39688.vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
39689This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
39690(to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
39691time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
39692hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
39693
39694.vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
39695The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
39696&-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
39697
39698.vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
39699The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
39700&$authenticated_sender$& variable.
39701
39702.vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
39703This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
39704present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
39705
39706.vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
39707This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
39708present if the number is greater than zero.
39709
39710.vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
39711This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
39712file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
39713
39714.vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
39715.cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
39716The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
39717
39718.vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
39719This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
39720command.
39721
39722.vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
39723This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
39724the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
39725messages.
39726
39727.vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
39728If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
39729the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
39730&$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
39731
39732.vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
39733This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
39734address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
39735
39736.vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
39737.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
39738.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
39739This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
39740if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
39741received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
39742
39743.vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
39744For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
39745unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
39746ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
39747supplied by the remote host, if any.
39748
39749.vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
39750This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
39751which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
39752generated messages.
39753
39754.vitem &%-local%&
39755The message is from a local sender.
39756
39757.vitem &%-localerror%&
39758The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
39759
39760.vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
39761This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
39762when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
39763variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
39764
39765.vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
39766The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
39767Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
39768
39769.vitem &%-N%&
39770A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
39771actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
39772&%-N%& is assumed.
39773
39774.vitem &%-received_protocol%&
39775This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
39776the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
39777
39778.vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
39779The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
39780to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
39781
39782.vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
39783If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
39784of &$spam_score_int$&.
39785
39786.vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
39787The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
39788rather than Unix-format.
39789The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
39790There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
39791
39792.vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
39793A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
39794certificate was verified by the server.
39795
39796.vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
39797When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
39798name of the cipher suite that was used.
39799
39800.vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
39801When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
39802was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
39803certificate.
39804.endlist
39805
39806Any of the above may have an extra hyphen prepended, to indicate the the
39807corresponding data is untrusted.
39808
39809Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
39810is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
39811line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
39812is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
39813the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
39814balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
39815to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
39816original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
39817addresses are complete.
39818
39819If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
39820the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
39821Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
39822tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
39823right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
39824follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
39825.code
39826YY darcy@austen.fict.example
39827NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
39828NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39829.endd
39830After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
39831This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
39832recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
39833delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
39834example:
39835.code
398364
39837editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39838darcy@austen.fict.example
39839rdo@foundation
39840alice@wonderland.fict.example
39841.endd
39842However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
39843result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
39844line is of the following form:
39845.display
39846<&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
39847 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
39848.endd
39849The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
39850the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
39851fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
39852original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
39853envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
39854length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
39855characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
39856that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
39857
39858
39859A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
39860which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
39861when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
39862character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
39863embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
39864following:
39865
39866.table2 50pt
39867.row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
39868.row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
39869.row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
39870.row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
39871.row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
39872.row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
39873.row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
39874.row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
39875.row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
39876.row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
39877.endtable
39878
39879Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
39880purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
39881typical set of headers:
39882.code
39883111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
39884id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
39885049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
39886038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
39887042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
39888049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
39889099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
39890darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39891104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
39892darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39893038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
39894.endd
39895The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
39896&'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
39897unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
39898.ecindex IIDforspo1
39899.ecindex IIDforspo2
39900.ecindex IIDforspo3
39901
39902.section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
39903The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
39904an ASCII newline character.
39905However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
39906can have an alternate format.
39907This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
39908The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
39909suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
39910ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
39911Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
39912There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
39913
39914. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39915. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39916
39917.chapter "DKIM, SPF and DMARC" "CHAPdkim" &&&
39918 "DKIM, SPF and DMARC Support"
39919
39920.section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
39921.cindex "DKIM"
39922
39923DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
39924linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
39925be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
39926DKIM is documented in RFC 6376.
39927
39928As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
39929by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
39930any original DKIM signature.
39931
39932DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
39933It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
39934
39935Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
39936.olist
39937Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
39938It can co-exist with all other Exim features
39939(including transport filters)
39940except cutthrough delivery.
39941.next
39942Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
39943ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
39944different signature contexts.
39945.endlist
39946
39947In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
39948default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
39949Exim's standard controls.
39950
39951Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
39952on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
39953
39954Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
39955When set, for each signature in incoming email,
39956exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
39957signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
39958.code
399592009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
39960 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
39961 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
39962 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
39963.endd
39964
39965You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
39966or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
39967control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
39968where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
39969senders).
39970
39971
39972.section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
39973.cindex "DKIM" "signing"
39974
39975For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
39976Note that RFC 8301 (which does not cover EC keys) says:
39977.code
39978rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39979
39980Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
39981Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
39982.endd
39983
39984Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
39985in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
39986for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
39987(equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
39988but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
39989
39990Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
39991These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
39992
39993.option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
39994The domain(s) you want to sign with.
39995After expansion, this can be a list.
39996Each element in turn,
39997lowercased,
39998is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
39999while expanding the remaining signing options.
40000If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
40001and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
40002
40003.option dkim_selector smtp string list&!! unset
40004This sets the key selector string.
40005After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
40006Each element in turn is put in the expansion
40007variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
40008option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
40009If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
40010and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
40011
40012.option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
40013This sets the private key to use.
40014You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
40015&%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
40016The result can either
40017.ilist
40018be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
40019.next
40020with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
40021be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
40022.next
40023start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
40024the private key
40025.next
40026be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
40027be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
40028is set.
40029.endlist
40030
40031To generate keys under OpenSSL:
40032.code
40033openssl genrsa -out dkim_rsa.private 2048
40034openssl rsa -in dkim_rsa.private -out /dev/stdout -pubout -outform PEM
40035.endd
40036Take the base-64 lines from the output of the second command, concatenated,
40037for the DNS TXT record.
40038See section 3.6 of RFC6376 for the record specification.
40039
40040Under GnuTLS:
40041.code
40042certtool --generate-privkey --rsa --bits=2048 --password='' -8 --outfile=dkim_rsa.private
40043certtool --load-privkey=dkim_rsa.private --pubkey-info
40044.endd
40045
40046Note that RFC 8301 says:
40047.code
40048Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
40049Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
40050.endd
40051
40052EC keys for DKIM are defined by RFC 8463.
40053They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
40054As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
40055(by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
40056for some transition period.
40057The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
40058for EC keys.
40059
40060OpenSSL 1.1.1 and GnuTLS 3.6.0 can create Ed25519 private keys:
40061.code
40062openssl genpkey -algorithm ed25519 -out dkim_ed25519.private
40063certtool --generate-privkey --key-type=ed25519 --outfile=dkim_ed25519.private
40064.endd
40065
40066To produce the required public key value for a DNS record:
40067.code
40068openssl pkey -outform DER -pubout -in dkim_ed25519.private | tail -c +13 | base64
40069certtool --load_privkey=dkim_ed25519.private --pubkey_info --outder | tail -c +13 | base64
40070.endd
40071
40072Exim also supports an alternate format
40073of Ed25519 keys in DNS which was a candidate during development
40074of the standard, but not adopted.
40075A future release will probably drop that support.
40076
40077.option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
40078Can be set to any one of the supported hash methods, which are:
40079.ilist
40080&`sha1`& &-- should not be used, is old and insecure
40081.next
40082&`sha256`& &-- the default
40083.next
40084&`sha512`& &-- possibly more secure but less well supported
40085.endlist
40086
40087Note that RFC 8301 says:
40088.code
40089rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
40090.endd
40091
40092.option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
40093If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
40094the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
40095syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
40096local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
40097tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
40098
40099.option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
40100This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
40101The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
40102The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
40103only supports signing with the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
40104
40105.option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
40106This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
40107should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
40108either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
40109unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
40110variables here.
40111
40112.option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
40113If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
40114list of header names.
40115Headers with these names, or the absence or such a header, will be included
40116in the message signature.
40117When unspecified, the header names listed in RFC4871 will be used,
40118whether or not each header is present in the message.
40119The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
40120"_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS".
40121
40122If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
40123will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
40124message are signed first, if there are multiples.
40125
40126A name can be prefixed with either an '=' or a '+' character.
40127If an '=' prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
40128will be signed.
40129If a '+' prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
40130will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
40131name will be appended.
40132
40133.option dkim_timestamps smtp integer&!! unset
40134This option controls the inclusion of timestamp information in the signature.
40135If not set, no such information will be included.
40136Otherwise, must be an unsigned number giving an offset in seconds from the current time
40137for the expiry tag
40138(eg. 1209600 for two weeks);
40139both creation (t=) and expiry (x=) tags will be included.
40140
40141RFC 6376 lists these tags as RECOMMENDED.
40142
40143
40144.section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECDKIMVFY"
40145.cindex "DKIM" "verification"
40146
40147Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is done for all
40148messages for which an ACL control &%dkim_disable_verify%& has not been set.
40149.cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
40150Individual classes of signature algorithm can be ignored by changing
40151the main options &%dkim_verify_hashes%& or &%dkim_verify_keytypes%&.
40152The &%dkim_verify_minimal%& option can be set to cease verification
40153processing for a message once the first passing signature is found.
40154
40155.cindex authentication "expansion item"
40156Performing verification sets up information used by the
40157&%authresults%& expansion item.
40158
40159For most purposes the default option settings suffice and the remainder
40160of this section can be ignored.
40161
40162The results of verification are made available to the
40163&%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL, which can examine and modify them.
40164A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
40165By default, the ACL is called once for each
40166syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
40167If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
40168If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
40169summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
40170
40171To evaluate the verification result in the ACL
40172a large number of expansion variables
40173containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
40174runtime of the ACL.
40175
40176Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
40177more advanced policies. For that reason, the main option
40178&%dkim_verify_signers%&, and an expansion variable
40179&%$dkim_signers%& exist.
40180
40181The main option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
40182list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
40183called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
40184the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
40185list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
40186&%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
40187it defaults as:
40188.code
40189dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
40190.endd
40191This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
40192DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
40193call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
40194.code
40195dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
40196.endd
40197This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
40198and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
40199You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
40200.code
40201dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
40202.endd
40203
40204If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
40205&%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
40206
40207Note that if the option is set using untrustworthy data
40208(such as the From: header)
40209care should be taken to force lowercase for domains
40210and for the domain part if identities.
40211The default setting can be regarded as trustworthy in this respect.
40212
40213If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
40214for each matching signature.
40215
40216
40217Inside the DKIM ACL, the following expansion variables are
40218available (from most to least important):
40219
40220
40221.vlist
40222.vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
40223The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
40224an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
40225&%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
40226
40227.vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
40228Within the DKIM ACL,
40229a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
40230.ilist
40231&%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
40232identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40233.next
40234&%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
40235More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
40236.next
40237&%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
40238available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
40239.next
40240&%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
40241.endlist
40242
40243This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
40244This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
40245hash-method or key-size:
40246.code
40247 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
40248 condition = ${if eq {${length_3:$dkim_algo}}{rsa}}
40249 condition = ${if or {{eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
40250 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}}}}
40251 logwrite = NOTE: forcing DKIM verify fail (was pass)
40252 set dkim_verify_status = fail
40253 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
40254.endd
40255
40256So long as a DKIM ACL is defined (it need do no more than accept),
40257after all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
40258colon-separated list of the values after each run.
40259This is maintained for the mime, prdr and data ACLs.
40260
40261.vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
40262A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
40263"fail" or "invalid". One of
40264.ilist
40265&%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
40266key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
40267.next
40268&%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
40269record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
40270.next
40271&%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
40272body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
40273means that the message body was modified in transit.
40274.next
40275&%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
40276could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
40277re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
40278DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
40279.endlist
40280
40281This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
40282
40283.vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
40284The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
40285an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
40286reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40287
40288.vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
40289The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
40290if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
40291identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40292
40293.vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
40294The key record selector string.
40295
40296.vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
40297The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
40298If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
40299may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
40300The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
40301for EC keys.
40302
40303Note that RFC 8301 says:
40304.code
40305rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
40306
40307DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
40308algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
40309.endd
40310
40311To enforce this you must either have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
40312and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above,
40313or have set the main option &%dkim_verify_hashes%& to exclude
40314processing of such signatures.
40315
40316.vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
40317The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
40318
40319.vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
40320The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
40321
40322.vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
40323A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
40324(copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
40325Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
40326not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
40327strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
40328
40329.vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
40330The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
40331limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
40332that this variable always expands to an integer value.
40333&*Note:*& The presence of the signature tag specifying a signing body length
40334is one possible route to spoofing of valid DKIM signatures.
40335A paranoid implementation might wish to regard signature where this variable
40336shows less than the "no limit" return as being invalid.
40337
40338.vitem &%$dkim_created%&
40339UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
40340When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
40341
40342.vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
40343UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
40344signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
40345signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
40346integer size comparisons against this value.
40347Note that Exim does not check this value.
40348
40349.vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
40350A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
40351
40352.vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
40353"1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
40354
40355.vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
40356"1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
40357
40358.vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
40359Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
40360in the key record.
40361
40362.vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
40363Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
40364in the key record.
40365
40366.vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
40367Notes from the key record (tag n=).
40368
40369.vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
40370Number of bits in the key.
40371
40372Note that RFC 8301 says:
40373.code
40374Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
40375less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
40376.endd
40377
40378To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
40379and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
40380As EC keys are much smaller, the check should only do this for RSA keys.
40381
40382.endlist
40383
40384In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
40385
40386.vlist
40387.vitem &%dkim_signers%&
40388ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
40389for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
40390(reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
40391verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
40392
40393.code
40394# Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
40395warn log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
40396 sender_domains = gmail.com
40397 dkim_signers = gmail.com
40398 dkim_status = none
40399.endd
40400
40401Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
40402for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
40403
40404.vitem &%dkim_status%&
40405ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
40406results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
40407to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
40408
40409.code
40410deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
40411 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
40412 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
40413 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
40414.endd
40415
40416The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
40417see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
40418for more information of what they mean.
40419.endlist
40420
40421
40422
40423
40424.section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
40425.cindex SPF verification
40426
40427SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
40428messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by RFC 7208.
40429For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.open-spf.org), a static copy of
40430the &url(http://openspf.org).
40431. --- 2019-10-28: still not https, open-spf.org is told to be a
40432. --- web-archive copy of the now dead openspf.org site
40433. --- See https://www.mail-archive.com/mailop@mailop.org/msg08019.html for a
40434. --- discussion.
40435
40436Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
40437This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
40438
40439SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
40440&_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
40441&url(https://www.libspf2.org/).
40442There is no Exim involvement in the transmission of messages;
40443publishing certain DNS records is all that is required.
40444
40445For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
40446.cindex authentication "expansion item"
40447Performing verification sets up information used by the
40448&%authresults%& expansion item.
40449
40450
40451.cindex SPF "ACL condition"
40452.cindex ACL "spf condition"
40453The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
40454It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
40455and will succeed for any matching outcome.
40456Valid strings are:
40457.vlist
40458.vitem &%pass%&
40459The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
40460
40461.vitem &%fail%&
40462The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
40463domain in the envelope-from address.
40464
40465.vitem &%softfail%&
40466The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
40467is a forgery.
40468
40469.vitem &%none%&
40470The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
40471
40472.vitem &%neutral%&
40473The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
40474published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
40475its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
40476
40477.vitem &%permerror%&
40478This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
40479You may deny messages when this occurs.
40480
40481.vitem &%temperror%&
40482This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
40483SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
40484.endlist
40485
40486You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
40487its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
40488"fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
40489short-circuit fashion.
40490
40491Example:
40492.code
40493deny spf = fail
40494 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
40495 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
40496 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
40497 Please see http://www.open-spf.org/Why?scope=\
40498 ${if def:sender_address_domain {mfrom}{helo}};\
40499 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
40500 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
40501 ip=$sender_host_address
40502.endd
40503
40504When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
40505variables:
40506
40507.cindex SPF "verification variables"
40508.vlist
40509.vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
40510.vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
40511 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
40512 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
40513 it for logging purposes.
40514
40515.vitem &$spf_received$&
40516.vindex &$spf_received$&
40517 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header that can be
40518 added to the message. Please note that according to the SPF
40519 draft, this header must be added at the top of the header
40520 list. Please see section 10 on how you can do this.
40521
40522 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
40523 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
40524
40525.vitem &$spf_result$&
40526.vindex &$spf_result$&
40527 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
40528 one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror or
40529 temperror.
40530
40531.vitem &$spf_result_guessed$&
40532.vindex &$spf_result_guessed$&
40533 This boolean is true only if a best-guess operation was used
40534 and required in order to obtain a result.
40535
40536.vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
40537.vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
40538 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
40539 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
40540.endlist
40541
40542
40543.cindex SPF "ACL condition"
40544.cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
40545.cindex SPF "best guess"
40546In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
40547"Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
40548SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
40549capability.
40550Refer to &url(http://www.open-spf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
40551for a description of what it means.
40552. --- 2019-10-28: still not https:
40553
40554To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
40555of the spf one. For example:
40556
40557.code
40558deny spf_guess = fail
40559 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
40560.endd
40561
40562In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
40563should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
40564is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
40565reject message.
40566
40567When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
40568variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
40569
40570Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
40571what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
40572&%spf_guess%& option.
40573For example, the following:
40574
40575.code
40576spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
40577.endd
40578
40579would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
40580
40581
40582.cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
40583.cindex lookup spf
40584A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
40585address as the key and an IP address
40586(v4 or v6)
40587as the database:
40588
40589.code
40590 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
40591.endd
40592
40593The lookup will return the same result strings as can appear in
40594&$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
40595
40596
40597
40598
40599
40600.section DMARC SECDMARC
40601.cindex DMARC verification
40602
40603DMARC combines feedback from SPF, DKIM, and header From: in order
40604to attempt to provide better indicators of the authenticity of an
40605email. This document does not explain the fundamentals; you
40606should read and understand how it works by visiting the website at
40607&url(http://www.dmarc.org/).
40608
40609If Exim is built with DMARC support,
40610the libopendmarc library is used.
40611
40612For building Exim yourself, obtain the library from
40613&url(http://sourceforge.net/projects/opendmarc/)
40614to obtain a copy, or find it in your favorite package
40615repository. You will need to attend to the local/Makefile feature
40616SUPPORT_DMARC and the associated LDFLAGS addition.
40617This description assumes
40618that headers will be in /usr/local/include, and that the libraries
40619are in /usr/local/lib.
40620
40621. subsection
40622
40623There are three main-configuration options:
40624.cindex DMARC "configuration options"
40625
40626The &%dmarc_tld_file%& option
40627.oindex &%dmarc_tld_file%&
40628defines the location of a text file of valid
40629top level domains the opendmarc library uses
40630during domain parsing. Maintained by Mozilla,
40631the most current version can be downloaded
40632from a link at &url(https://publicsuffix.org/list/public_suffix_list.dat).
40633See also the util/renew-opendmarc-tlds.sh script.
40634.new
40635The default for the option is unset.
40636If not set, DMARC processing is disabled.
40637.wen
40638
40639
40640The &%dmarc_history_file%& option, if set
40641.oindex &%dmarc_history_file%&
40642defines the location of a file to log results
40643of dmarc verification on inbound emails. The
40644contents are importable by the opendmarc tools
40645which will manage the data, send out DMARC
40646reports, and expire the data. Make sure the
40647directory of this file is writable by the user
40648exim runs as.
40649The default is unset.
40650
40651The &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& option
40652.oindex &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
40653defines an alternate email address to use when sending a
40654forensic report detailing alignment failures
40655if a sender domain's dmarc record specifies it
40656and you have configured Exim to send them.
40657If set, this is expanded and used for the
40658From: header line; the address is extracted
40659from it and used for the envelope from.
40660If not set (the default), the From: header is expanded from
40661the dsn_from option, and <> is used for the
40662envelope from.
40663
40664. I wish we had subsections...
40665
40666.cindex DMARC controls
40667By default, the DMARC processing will run for any remote,
40668non-authenticated user. It makes sense to only verify DMARC
40669status of messages coming from remote, untrusted sources. You can
40670use standard conditions such as hosts, senders, etc, to decide that
40671DMARC verification should *not* be performed for them and disable
40672DMARC with an ACL control modifier:
40673.code
40674 control = dmarc_disable_verify
40675.endd
40676A DMARC record can also specify a "forensic address", which gives
40677exim an email address to submit reports about failed alignment.
40678Exim does not do this by default because in certain conditions it
40679results in unintended information leakage (what lists a user might
40680be subscribed to, etc). You must configure exim to submit forensic
40681reports to the owner of the domain. If the DMARC record contains a
40682forensic address and you specify the control statement below, then
40683exim will send these forensic emails. It is also advised that you
40684configure a &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& because the default sender address
40685construction might be inadequate.
40686.code
40687 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
40688.endd
40689(AGAIN: You can choose not to send these forensic reports by simply
40690not putting the dmarc_enable_forensic control line at any point in
40691your exim config. If you don't tell exim to send them, it will not
40692send them.)
40693
40694There are no options to either control. Both must appear before
40695the DATA acl.
40696
40697. subsection
40698
40699DMARC checks cam be run on incoming SMTP messages by using the
40700&"dmarc_status"& ACL condition in the DATA ACL. You are required to
40701call the &"spf"& condition first in the ACLs, then the &"dmarc_status"&
40702condition. Putting this condition in the ACLs is required in order
40703for a DMARC check to actually occur. All of the variables are set
40704up before the DATA ACL, but there is no actual DMARC check that
40705occurs until a &"dmarc_status"& condition is encountered in the ACLs.
40706
40707The &"dmarc_status"& condition takes a list of strings on its
40708right-hand side. These strings describe recommended action based
40709on the DMARC check. To understand what the policy recommendations
40710mean, refer to the DMARC website above. Valid strings are:
40711.display
40712&'accept '& The DMARC check passed and the library recommends accepting the email.
40713&'reject '& The DMARC check failed and the library recommends rejecting the email.
40714&'quarantine '& The DMARC check failed and the library recommends keeping it for further inspection.
40715&'none '& The DMARC check passed and the library recommends no specific action, neutral.
40716&'norecord '& No policy section in the DMARC record for this sender domain.
40717&'nofrom '& Unable to determine the domain of the sender.
40718&'temperror '& Library error or dns error.
40719&'off '& The DMARC check was disabled for this email.
40720.endd
40721You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert its
40722meaning, for example "!accept" will match all results but
40723"accept". The string list is evaluated left-to-right in a
40724short-circuit fashion. When a string matches the outcome of the
40725DMARC check, the condition succeeds. If none of the listed
40726strings matches the outcome of the DMARC check, the condition
40727fails.
40728
40729Of course, you can also use any other lookup method that Exim
40730supports, including LDAP, Postgres, MySQL, etc, as long as the
40731result is a list of colon-separated strings.
40732
40733Performing the check sets up information used by the
40734&%authresults%& expansion item.
40735
40736Several expansion variables are set before the DATA ACL is
40737processed, and you can use them in this ACL. The following
40738expansion variables are available:
40739
40740.vlist
40741.vitem &$dmarc_status$&
40742.vindex &$dmarc_status$&
40743.cindex DMARC result
40744A one word status indicating what the DMARC library
40745thinks of the email. It is a combination of the results of
40746DMARC record lookup and the SPF/DKIM/DMARC processing results
40747(if a DMARC record was found). The actual policy declared
40748in the DMARC record is in a separate expansion variable.
40749
40750.vitem &$dmarc_status_text$&
40751.vindex &$dmarc_status_text$&
40752Slightly longer, human readable status.
40753
40754.vitem &$dmarc_used_domain$&
40755.vindex &$dmarc_used_domain$&
40756The domain which DMARC used to look up the DMARC policy record.
40757
40758.vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
40759.vindex &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
40760The policy declared in the DMARC record. Valid values
40761are "none", "reject" and "quarantine". It is blank when there
40762is any error, including no DMARC record.
40763.endlist
40764
40765. subsection
40766
40767By default, Exim's DMARC configuration is intended to be
40768non-intrusive and conservative. To facilitate this, Exim will not
40769create any type of logging files without explicit configuration by
40770you, the admin. Nor will Exim send out any emails/reports about
40771DMARC issues without explicit configuration by you, the admin (other
40772than typical bounce messages that may come about due to ACL
40773processing or failure delivery issues).
40774
40775In order to log statistics suitable to be imported by the opendmarc
40776tools, you need to:
40777.ilist
40778Configure the global option &%dmarc_history_file%&
40779.next
40780Configure cron jobs to call the appropriate opendmarc history
40781import scripts and truncating the dmarc_history_file
40782.endlist
40783
40784In order to send forensic reports, you need to:
40785.ilist
40786Configure the global option &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
40787.next
40788Configure, somewhere before the DATA ACL, the control option to
40789enable sending DMARC forensic reports
40790.endlist
40791
40792. subsection
40793
40794Example usage:
40795.code
40796(RCPT ACL)
40797 warn domains = +local_domains
40798 hosts = +local_hosts
40799 control = dmarc_disable_verify
40800
40801 warn !domains = +screwed_up_dmarc_records
40802 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
40803
40804 warn condition = (lookup if destined to mailing list)
40805 set acl_m_mailing_list = 1
40806
40807(DATA ACL)
40808 warn dmarc_status = accept : none : off
40809 !authenticated = *
40810 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: $dmarc_status $dmarc_used_domain
40811
40812 warn dmarc_status = !accept
40813 !authenticated = *
40814 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: '$dmarc_status' for $dmarc_used_domain
40815
40816 warn dmarc_status = quarantine
40817 !authenticated = *
40818 set $acl_m_quarantine = 1
40819 # Do something in a transport with this flag variable
40820
40821 deny condition = ${if eq{$dmarc_domain_policy}{reject}}
40822 condition = ${if eq{$acl_m_mailing_list}{1}}
40823 message = Messages from $dmarc_used_domain break mailing lists
40824
40825 deny dmarc_status = reject
40826 !authenticated = *
40827 message = Message from $dmarc_used_domain failed sender's DMARC policy, REJECT
40828
40829 warn add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
40830.endd
40831
40832
40833
40834
40835
40836. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40837. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40838
40839.chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
40840 "Proxy support"
40841.cindex "proxy support"
40842.cindex "proxy" "access via"
40843
40844A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
40845Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
40846
40847
40848.section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
40849.cindex proxy inbound
40850.cindex proxy "server side"
40851.cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
40852.cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
40853
40854Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
40855that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
40856To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
40857in Local/Makefile.
40858
40859It was built on the HAProxy specification, found at
40860&url(https://www.haproxy.org/download/1.8/doc/proxy-protocol.txt).
40861
40862The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
40863such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
40864to distribute load.
40865Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
40866the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
40867There is no logging if a host passes or
40868fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
40869recorded in an ACL (example is below).
40870
40871Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
40872main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
40873hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
40874Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
40875automatically determines which version is in use.
40876
40877The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
40878and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
40879negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
40880Exim and the proxy server.
40881
40882The following expansion variables are usable
40883(&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
40884of the proxy):
40885.display
40886&'proxy_external_address '& IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy
40887&'proxy_external_port '& Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy
40888&'proxy_local_address '& IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy
40889&'proxy_local_port '& Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy
40890&'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
40891.endd
40892If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
40893there was a protocol error.
40894The variables &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&
40895will have values for the actual client system, not the proxy.
40896
40897Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
40898per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
40899evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
40900handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
40901With the option set so high, you lose the ability
40902to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
40903In order to prevent your server from overload, you
40904need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
40905A possible solution is:
40906.display
40907 # Set max number of connections per host
40908 LIMIT = 5
40909 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
40910 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
40911
40912 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
40913 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
40914.endd
40915
40916
40917
40918.section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
40919.cindex proxy outbound
40920.cindex proxy "client side"
40921.cindex proxy SOCKS
40922.cindex SOCKS proxy
40923Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
40924using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
40925The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
40926Local/Makefile.
40927
40928Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
40929on an smtp transport.
40930The option value is expanded and should then be a list
40931(colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
40932Each proxy specifier is a list
40933(space-separated by default) where the initial element
40934is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
40935
40936Options are a string <name>=<value>.
40937The list of options is in the following table:
40938.display
40939&'auth '& authentication method
40940&'name '& authentication username
40941&'pass '& authentication password
40942&'port '& tcp port
40943&'tmo '& connection timeout
40944&'pri '& priority
40945&'weight '& selection bias
40946.endd
40947
40948More details on each of these options follows:
40949
40950.ilist
40951.cindex authentication "to proxy"
40952.cindex proxy authentication
40953&%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
40954Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
40955for access to the proxy.
40956Default is &"none"&.
40957.next
40958&%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
40959Default is empty.
40960.next
40961&%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
40962Default is empty.
40963.next
40964&%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
40965Default is 1080.
40966.next
40967&%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
40968Default is 5.
40969.next
40970&%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
40971higher values being tried first.
40972The default priority is 1.
40973.next
40974&%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
40975Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
40976weighted by this value.
40977The default value for selection bias is 1.
40978.endlist
40979
40980Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
40981and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
40982overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
40983
40984.section Logging SECTproxyLog
40985To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
40986add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
40987This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
40988
40989. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40990. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40991
40992.chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
40993 "Internationalisation""
40994.cindex internationalisation "email address"
40995.cindex EAI
40996.cindex i18n
40997.cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
40998
40999Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
41000To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
41001Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
41002
41003If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
41004instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
41005requirement, upon libidn2.
41006
41007.section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
41008.cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
41009The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
41010a host list. If this matches the sending host and
41011accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
41012SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
41013
41014If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
41015international handling for the message is enabled and
41016the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
41017
41018The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
41019message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
41020whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
41021when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
41022
41023Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
41024UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
41025require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
41026the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
41027
41028HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
41029components expanded to a-label form,
41030and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
41031form of the name.
41032
41033.cindex log protocol
41034.cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
41035.cindex i18n logging
41036Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
41037prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
41038
41039The following expansion operators can be used:
41040.code
41041${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
41042${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
41043${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
41044${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
41045.endd
41046
41047.cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
41048.cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
41049The RCPT ACL
41050may use the following modifier:
41051.display
41052control = utf8_downconvert
41053control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
41054.endd
41055This sets a flag requiring that addresses are converted to
41056a-label form before smtp delivery, for use in a
41057Message Submission Agent context.
41058If a value is appended it may be:
41059.display
41060&`1 `& (default) mandatory downconversion
41061&`0 `& no downconversion
41062&`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
41063.endd
41064
41065If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
41066is initially set to -1.
41067
41068The smtp transport has an option &%utf8_downconvert%&.
41069If set it must expand to one of the three values described above,
41070and it overrides any previously set value.
41071
41072
41073There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
41074Configurations supporting these should inspect
41075&$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
41076
41077There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
41078Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
41079for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
41080
41081There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
41082and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
41083
41084
41085
41086.section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
41087To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
41088the following expansion operator can be used:
41089.code
41090${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
41091.endd
41092
41093The string is converted from the charset specified by
41094the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
41095or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
41096to the
41097modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
41098with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
41099(which has to be a single character)
41100are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
41101<sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
41102
41103The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
41104The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
41105
41106This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
41107by many other IMAP servers.
41108
41109Examples:
41110.display
41111&`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
41112&`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
41113&`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
41114.endd
41115
41116Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
41117must be representable in UTF-16.
41118
41119
41120. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41121. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41122
41123.chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
41124 "Events"
41125.cindex events
41126
41127The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
41128of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
41129actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
41130processing actions.
41131
41132Most installations will never need to use Events.
41133The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
41134in &_Local/Makefile_&.
41135
41136There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
41137The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
41138a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
41139
41140Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
41141An example might look like:
41142.cindex logging custom
41143.code
41144event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
41145{${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
41146 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
41147 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
41148 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
41149 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
41150 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
41151 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
41152 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
41153} {}}
41154.endd
41155
41156Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
41157The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
41158expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
41159
41160.new
41161The current list of events is:
41162.wen
41163.display
41164&`dane:fail after transport `& per connection
41165&`msg:complete after main `& per message
41166&`msg:defer after transport `& per message per delivery try
41167&`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
41168&`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
41169&`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
41170&`msg:host:defer after transport `& per host per delivery try; host errors
41171&`msg:fail:delivery after transport `& per recipient
41172&`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
41173&`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
41174&`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
41175&`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
41176&`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
41177&`smtp:ehlo after transport `& per connection
41178.endd
41179New event types may be added in future.
41180
41181The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
41182event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
41183or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
41184
41185The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
41186before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
41187can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
41188
41189The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
41190should define the event action.
41191
41192An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
41193with the event type:
41194.display
41195&`dane:fail `& failure reason
41196&`msg:defer `& error string
41197&`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation message
41198&`msg:fail:internal `& failure reason
41199&`msg:fail:delivery `& smtp error message
41200&`msg:host:defer `& error string
41201&`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
41202&`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
41203&`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
41204&`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
41205&`smtp:ehlo `& smtp ehlo response
41206.endd
41207
41208The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
41209
41210For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
41211however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
41212the course of its processing:
41213.ilist
41214variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
41215transport call
41216.next
41217acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
41218and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
41219.endlist
41220Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
41221a useful way of writing to the main log.
41222
41223The expansion of the event_action option should normally
41224return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
41225following will be forced:
41226.display
41227&`tcp:connect `& do not connect
41228&`tls:cert `& refuse verification
41229&`smtp:connect `& close connection
41230.endd
41231All other message types ignore the result string, and
41232no other use is made of it.
41233
41234For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
41235then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
41236the target system.
41237
41238For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
41239chain element received on the connection.
41240For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
41241loaded locally.
41242
41243. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41244. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41245
41246.chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
41247 "Adding drivers or lookups"
41248.cindex "adding drivers"
41249.cindex "new drivers, adding"
41250.cindex "drivers" "adding new"
41251The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
41252authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
41253
41254.olist
41255Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
41256existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
41257.next
41258Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
41259.display
41260<&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
41261.endd
41262where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
41263code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
41264should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
41265.next
41266Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
41267.code
41268#define <type>_NEWDRIVER
41269.endd
41270.next
41271Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
41272and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
41273.next
41274Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
41275near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
41276Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
41277As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
41278simple form that most lookups have.
41279.next
41280Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
41281&_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
41282driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
41283.next
41284Edit &_OS/Makefile-Base_& adding a &_.o_& file for the predefined-macros, to the
41285definition of OBJ_MACRO. Add a set of line to do the compile also.
41286.next
41287Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
41288&_src_&.
41289.next
41290Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
41291as for other drivers and lookups.
41292.endlist
41293
41294Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
41295proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
41296occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
41297options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
41298searched using a binary chop procedure.
41299
41300There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
41301the interface that is expected.
41302
41303
41304
41305
41306. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41307. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41308
41309. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41310. These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
41311. Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
41312. PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
41313. processors.
41314. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41315
41316.literal xml
41317<?sdop
41318 format="newpage"
41319 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
41320 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
41321?>
41322.literal off
41323
41324.makeindex "Options index" "option"
41325.makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
41326.makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
41327
41328
41329. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41330. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////